USER MANUAL (Air-Cooled B Frame) Bulletin 7000 Solid state equipment has operational characteristics differing from those of electro- mechanical equipment. Safety Guidelines for the Application, Installation and Maintenance of Solid State Controls (Publication SGI-1.1 available from your local Rockwell Automation sales office or online at http://www.rockwellautomation.com/literature) describes some important differences between solid state equipment and hard-wired electromechanical devices. Because of this difference, and also because of the wide variety of uses for solid state equipment, all persons responsible for applying this equipment must satisfy themselves that each intended application of this equipment is acceptable. In no event will Rockwell Automation, Inc. be responsible or liable for indirect or consequential damages resulting from the use or application of this equipment. The examples and diagrams in this manual are included solely for illustrative purposes. Because of the many variables and requirements associated with any particular installation, Rockwell Automation, Inc. cannot assume responsibility or liability for actual use based on the examples and diagrams. No patent liability is assumed by Rockwell Automation, Inc. with respect to use of information, circuits, equipment, or software described in this manual. Reproduction of the contents of this manual, in whole or in part, without written permission of Rockwell Automation, Inc. is prohibited. Throughout this manual, when necessary we use notes to make you aware of safety considerations. Important User Information Identifies information about practices or circumstances that can cause an explosion in a hazardous environment, which may lead to personal injury or death, property damage, or economic loss. Identifies information that is critical for successful application and understanding of the product. Identifies information about practices or circumstances that can lead to personal injury or death, property damage, or economic loss. Attentions help you identify a hazard, avoid a hazard, and recognize the consequences. Labels may be located on or inside the equipment (e.g., drive or motor) to alert people that dangerous voltage may be present. Labels may be located on or inside the equipment (e.g., drive or motor) to alert people that surfaces may be at dangerous temperatures. PowerFlex is a trademark of Rockwell Automation, Inc. A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T S H O C K H A Z A R D S H O C K H A Z A R D B U R N H A Z A R D B U R N H A Z A R D W A R N I N G W A R N I N G Table of Contents
7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Preface Overview Who should use this Manual ....................................................P-1 What is not in this Manual .......................................................P-1 Manual Conventions ................................................................P-1 General Precautions .................................................................P-2 Who to call for Commissioning ...............................................P-3
Chapter 1 Overview of Drive Introduction .............................................................................. 1-1 Topology .................................................................................. 1-1 Rectifier Designs 6-pulse Rectifier ................................................................ 1-2 18-pulse Rectifier .............................................................. 1-3 Active Front End (PWM Rectifier) ................................... 1-4 Direct-to-Drive Technology ................................................... 1-5 Motor Compatibility ................................................................ 1-7 SGCT Features and Benefits ................................................... 1-8 Specifications ........................................................................... 1-9 Simplified Electrical Drawings 2400 volt 18-pulse, 6-pulse and AFE ........................... 1-12 3300/4160 volt 18-pulse, 6-pulse and AFE .................. 1-13 6000-6600 volt 18-pulse, 6-pulse and AFE .................. 1-14 Control Overview .................................................................. 1-15 Direct Vector Control ............................................................ 1-15 Control Hardware .................................................................. 1-16 Operator Interface .................................................................. 1-17 Ratings, Dimensions and Weights ......................................... 1-17
Chapter 2 Drive Installation Safety and Codes ..................................................................... 2-1 Unpacking and Inspection ....................................................... 2-1 Transportation and Handling ................................................... 2-2 Overhead Lifting ............................................................... 2-3 Rod or Pipe Rollers ........................................................... 2-4 Fork Lift Trucks ................................................................ 2-4 Storage ............................................................................... 2-5 Siting of the Drive ................................................................... 2-5 Site Considerations ............................................................ 2-5 Installation ............................................................................... 2-7 Shock Indication Labels .................................................... 2-7 Installation of Exhaust Air Hood ...................................... 2-8 Cabinet Layout and Dimensional Drawings of Drive ............ 2-11 PowerFlex 7000 Dimensional Drawings ............................... 2-12 Control/Cabling Cabinet ........................................................ 2-24 Major Components Cabling Cabinet for 18-pulse Rectifier ........................... 2-24 Cabling Cabinet for 6-pulse/AFE Rectifier ..................... 2-25 AC Line Reactor with Connection Cabinet ..................... 2-26 Converter Cabinet ........................................................... 2-27 DC Link/Fan Cabinet ...................................................... 2-28 ii Table of Contents
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
IEC Component and Device Designations ............................ 2-29 Power Wiring Selection ......................................................... 2-29 Cable Insulation .............................................................. 2-30 Wire Group Numbers ...................................................... 2-32 Power Cabling Access ........................................................... 2-33 To access the customer power cable terminations .......... 2-33 Swing-out of Low Voltage Compartment ....................... 2-34 Access to Power Terminals ............................................. 2-35 Power Connections ................................................................ 2-36 Incoming Connections ..................................................... 2-36 Power Cabling Installation Requirements ....................... 2-36 Front View of 900 mm Control/Cabling Cabinet .................. 2-37 Detail Power Terminal Dimensions ...................................... 2-38 Power and Control Wiring ..................................................... 2-39 Control Cables ................................................................. 2-39 Information regarding termination of customer cables ... 2-40 Grounding Practices ............................................................... 2-41 Grounding Guidelines and Practices for Drive Signal and Safety Grounds ......................................................... 2-42 Grounding Requirements and Specifications for Customer and Power Integrators ..................................... 2-42 Identification of Types of Electrical Supplies Grounded and Ungrounded Systems ............................ 2-43 Ground Bus ..................................................................... 2-43 Interlocking ............................................................................ 2-43
Chapter 3 Operator Interface Chapter Objectives ................................................................... 3-1 Terminology ............................................................................ 3-1 Overview ................................................................................. 3-3 Keypad .............................................................................. 3-3 Function (Softkeys) Keys ........................................... 3-3 Cursor (Selection) Keys .............................................. 3-4 Data Entry Keys .......................................................... 3-4 What is a Screen? .............................................................. 3-5 Components ................................................................ 3-5 Information Windows ................................................. 3-6 Accessing/Writing to Drive .................................. 3-7 Communication Error ........................................... 3-7 Language Changing ............................................. 3-8 General Operation ....................................................... 3-8 Operator Interface Power-up Sequence ............................. 3-9 Top Level Menu .............................................................. 3-11 Chapter 2 Drive Installation (cont.)
Table of Contents iii 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
How to: Obtain Help ..................................................................... 3-12 Related Topics .......................................................... 3-12 Help On Help ............................................................ 3-13 Modify Operator Interface Operation (Utility) ............... 3-14 Changing Backlight Delay ........................................ 3-14 Changing Contrast .................................................... 3-15 Setting Time ............................................................. 3-16 Setting Date .............................................................. 3-17 Selecting Meters ....................................................... 3-17 Viewing Revision Levels .......................................... 3-20 Transfer Data in Memory ......................................... 3-21 Picking an Access Level ........................................... 3-21 Select a Parameter ............................................................ 3-22 Via Groups ................................................................ 3-22 Via Name .................................................................. 3-23 Via Code ................................................................... 3-24 Edit Text .......................................................................... 3-26 Configure the Drive ......................................................... 3-28 Enter/Modify an Access Level ................................. 3-28 Drive Set-up .............................................................. 3-32 Language Selection ............................................ 3-33 Modify Parameters ............................................. 3-34 Numerical Value ................................................ 3-34 Enumerated Value .............................................. 3-36 Bit Encoded Value ............................................. 3-37 Analog Ports ....................................................... 3-38 Fault Masks ........................................................ 3-39 User Definable External Text ............................. 3-42 PLC .................................................................... 3-43 XIO ..................................................................... 3-45 Message Prompting .................................................. 3-45 Store/Retrieve Configuration (NVRAM) ................. 3-46 Initialize ............................................................. 3-46 Save .................................................................... 3-47 Load ................................................................... 3-47 Display Parameters .......................................................... 3-48 Custom Group ........................................................... 3-50 View Drive Status ........................................................... 3-51 View and Reset Alarms ................................................... 3-51 Help for Alarms ........................................................ 3-52 Request Printouts ............................................................ 3-53 Perform Diagnostic Trending .......................................... 3-54 Assigning a Trace ..................................................... 3-55 Setting the Trigger .................................................... 3-56 Defining Sample Rate and Positioning ..................... 3-57 Chapter 3 Operator Interface (cont.)
iv Table of Contents
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Starting the Trace ............................................................ 3-58 Flash Memory Transfers ................................................. 3-59 Format Flash Card .................................................... 3-61 View a Directory ....................................................... 3-62 Select a filename ................................................ 3-62 Enter a filename ................................................. 3-63 Loading Programs (Firmware) ................................. 3-63 Parameter Transfers .................................................. 3-65 Upload to Operator Interface ............................. 3-66 Download from Operator Interface .................... 3-66 Upload to Memory Card .................................... 3-66 Download from Memory Card ........................... 3-67 Parameter File Format ................................. 3-67 Loading Language Modules ..................................... 3-68 System Programming ................................................ 3-69 Advanced Screen Operations .......................................... 3-70 Communications Statistics ........................................ 3-70 Protocol Analyzer ..................................................... 3-71 Print Screen ............................................................... 3-72 Memory Dump ......................................................... 3-72 Database Download .................................................. 3-74 Operator Interface Menu Hierarchy Chart ............................ 3-75 What does it show? ......................................................... 3-75 How do you read it? ........................................................ 3-75 Example ........................................................................... 3-76 PowerFlex 7000 Terminal Menu Tree ............................ 3-77 PCMCIA Memory Card Installation Data ............................ 3-79 Description ...................................................................... 3-79 Installing the Memory Card ............................................ 3-79
Table of Contents v 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Drive Application Review ..................................................... 4-13 Rockwell Automation Drive Line-up Drawings ............. 4-13 Electrical System One-line Diagram ............................... 4-14 Verify One-line Diagram on Site .................................... 4-14 Inspect Process ................................................................ 4-14 Safety Tests ............................................................................ 4-15 Lockout Tagout ............................................................... 4-15 Step Down Transformer Fusing ...................................... 4-16 Fuse and O/L Protection .................................................. 4-16 Installation Review ................................................................ 4-17 Inspect for Shipping Damage .......................................... 4-17 Inspect Cabinets for Debris ............................................. 4-17 Protective Barriers ........................................................... 4-17 Component Grounding .................................................... 4-17 Information on Splice Kits .............................................. 4-18 Power Cabling ................................................................. 4-18 Control Wiring ................................................................ 4-19 Service Data ........................................................................... 4-20 Why this Information is Needed ..................................... 4-20 Customer Information ..................................................... 4-21 Drive Nameplate Data ..................................................... 4-22 Motor Nameplate Data .................................................... 4-23 Tachometer/Encoder Nameplate Data ............................. 4-23 Miscellaneous Information .............................................. 4-24 Drive Circuit Boards ................................................. 4-25 Spare Drive Control Boards ...................................... 4-26 Control Power Off Tests ........................................................ 4-27 Interlocking ..................................................................... 4-27 Resistance Check ............................................................ 4-29 SGCT Testing .................................................................. 4-30 SGCT Anode to Cathode Resistance .............................. 4-30 Snubber Resistance (SGCT Device) ............................... 4-32 Snubber Capacitance (SGCT Device) ............................. 4-33 SCR Testing .................................................................... 4-33 SCR Anode to Cathode Resistance ................................. 4-35 SCR Sharing Resistance Test .......................................... 4-36 Gate to Cathode Resistance ............................................. 4-37 Snubber Resistance (SCR Device) .................................. 4-38 Snubber Capacitance (SCR Device) ............................... 4-39 Control Power Tests .............................................................. 4-40 Three-phase Input ............................................................ 4-40 Three-phase Input/Single Phase Input ............................. 4-41 Power Supply Tests ......................................................... 4-41 Circuit Board Healthy Lights .......................................... 4-41 Chapter 4 Commissioning (cont.)
vi Table of Contents
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Control Power Transformer (CPT) ................................. 4-42 AC/DC Converter (PS1) .................................................. 4-43 DC/DC Converter (PS2) .................................................. 4-43 SGCT Power Supplies (IGDPS) ..................................... 4-46 Board LEDs ..................................................................... 4-47 Gating Tests ........................................................................... 4-48 Gating Tests Mode .......................................................... 4-48 SCR Firing Test ............................................................... 4-50 SGCT Firing Test ............................................................ 4-51 System Test ............................................................................ 4-53 System Test Mode ........................................................... 4-53 Start/Stop Control Circuit ................................................ 4-55 Status Indicators .............................................................. 4-55 Analog I/O ....................................................................... 4-56 Analog Inputs ........................................................... 4-56 Analog Outputs ......................................................... 4-57 Configurable Alarms ....................................................... 4-60 18-pulse Phasing Test ............................................................ 4-60 Line Terminal Resistance Measurements ....................... 4-61 Application of Medium Voltage ..................................... 4-62 Diagnostic Setup ............................................................. 4-62 How to Setup Trending ................................................... 4-62 Input Phasing Check ....................................................... 4-65 DC Current Test ..................................................................... 4-67 Tuning Procedure ................................................................... 4-69 1. Commutation Inductance .......................................... 4-69 2. Current Regulator ..................................................... 4-72 3. Stator Resistance ....................................................... 4-76 4. Leakage Inductance .................................................. 4-77 5. Flux Regulator .......................................................... 4-78 6. Speed Regulator ........................................................ 4-84 Running the Load .................................................................. 4-87 Motor Starting Torque ..................................................... 4-87 Reaching Specific Load Points ....................................... 4-87 Capturing Data ....................................................................... 4-93 Drive Variables ...................................................................... 4-94
Chapter 4 Commissioning (cont.)
Table of Contents vii 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Chapter 5 Functional Description Introduction .............................................................................. 5-1 Description of Operation ......................................................... 5-2 Speed Command ...................................................................... 5-3 Speed Reference ..................................................................... 5-4 Speed Control ......................................................................... 5-6 Flux Control ............................................................................. 5-8 Flux Control for Synchronous Motor .................................... 5-10 Current Control ...................................................................... 5-12 Line Converter Feedback ....................................................... 5-14 Machine Converter Feedback ................................................ 5-15 Motor Model .......................................................................... 5-16 Line/Machine Converter Protection ....................................... 5-18 Power Semiconductor Diagnostics ........................................ 5-19 Off Line Detection of Failed SCRs/SGCTs .................... 5-20 Line Converter .......................................................... 5-20 Machine Converter ................................................... 5-22 On-line Detection of Failed SCRs/SGCTs ...................... 5-23 Test Modes ............................................................................. 5-24 Flying Start (Induction Motor) .............................................. 5-26 Tachometer/Encoder Option .................................................. 5-28 Synchronous Transfer ............................................................ 5-29 Transfer to Bypass ........................................................... 5-31 Transfer to Drive ............................................................. 5-34 Analog Outputs ...................................................................... 5-35
Checking Clamping Pressure ................................................ 6-23 Clamping Pressure Adjustment ...................................... 6-23 Temperature Sensing ............................................................. 6-24 Symmetrical Gate Commutated Thyristor Replacement ....... 6-26 Silicon Controlled Rectifier and SCR Self-Powered Gate Driver Board Replacement ..................................... 6-29 Heatsink Replacement ........................................................... 6-32 PowerCage Gasket ................................................................. 6-34 Replacement of PowerCage Gaskets ............................... 6-34 Removal of old Gasket Material ..................................... 6-34 PowerCage Removal ............................................................. 6-35 Snubber Resistors .................................................................. 6-37 Testing Snubber Resistors ............................................... 6-37 Snubber and Sharing Resistor Replacement .......................... 6-38 Sharing Resistors ................................................................... 6-40 Testing Sharing Resistors ................................................ 6-40 SGCT PowerCages ................................................... 6-41 Replacing Sharing Resistor ............................................. 6-42 SCR PowerCages ...................................................... 6-42 Resistance Measurements ............................................... 6-43 Self-Powered Gate Driver Board SPGDB .......................... 6-44 Description ...................................................................... 6-44 Board Calibration ............................................................ 6-44 Test Points Description ................................................... 6-45 Terminal/Connections Description ................................. 6-46 Testing Procedure for SCR Self-Powered Gate Driver Board ... 6-47 Fiber Optic Cabling ............................................................... 6-51 Air Pressure Sensor ................................................................ 6-52 Air Pressure Sensor Replacement ................................... 6-52 DC Link and Fan Cabinet Components ................................. 6-53 DC Link Reactor .................................................................... 6-54 Fan Removal and Replacement ............................................. 6-56 Safety Notes .................................................................... 6-56 Fan Installation ................................................................ 6-57 Impeller Maintenance ............................................................ 6-57 Impeller Removal from Motor Shaft ............................... 6-57 Safety Notes .................................................................... 6-57 Installation of Impeller Assembly onto Motor Shaft ....... 6-58 Inlet Ring Removal and Replacement ................................... 6-60 Safety Notes .................................................................... 6-60 Replacement of Air Filters ..................................................... 6-61 Procedure ......................................................................... 6-61 Control Power Components ................................................... 6-64 Ride-Through .................................................................. 6-64 AC/DC Power Supply ............................................................ 6-67 Description ...................................................................... 6-67 Location ........................................................................... 6-68 Terminal/Connections Descriptions ................................ 6-68 Replacement Procedure ................................................... 6-70 Chapter 6 Component Definition and Maintenance (cont.)
Table of Contents ix 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
UPS Option ............................................................................ 6-71 UPS Replacement Procedure .......................................... 6-72 Low Voltage Control Section ................................................ 6-73 DC/DC Power Supply ............................................................ 6-74 Description ...................................................................... 6-74 LEDs ............................................................................... 6-75 Terminal/Connections Descriptions ................................ 6-75 Replacement Procedure ................................................... 6-76 Printed Circuit Board Replacement ....................................... 6-77 Drive Control Boards ............................................................. 6-78 Drive Control Board Replacement .................................. 6-80 Instructions to replace the Drive Control Boards ............ 6-80 Customer Interface Board ...................................................... 6-83 Analog Inputs and Outputs .............................................. 6-84 Current Loop Transmitter ................................................ 6-84 Current Loop Receiver .................................................... 6-85 LEDs ............................................................................... 6-86 Customer Interface Board Replacement .......................... 6-87 Signal Conditioning Boards ................................................... 6-88 Signal Conditioning Board Replacement ........................ 6-90 External Input/Output Boards ................................................ 6-91 External Input/Output Board Replacement ..................... 6-92 Fiber Optic Interface Boards .................................................. 6-93 Fiber Optic Interface Board Replacement ....................... 6-94 Downloading Firmware ......................................................... 6-95 Introduction ..................................................................... 6-95 Overview ......................................................................... 6-95 Preparation for Downloading Firmware ................................ 6-96 Setting up Hyperterminal ................................................ 6-98 PF7000 in Download Mode .......................................... 6-100 Reloading the Parameters .................................................... 6-102 Loading Additional Languages ..................................... 6-103 Programming the Terminal .................................................. 6-104 Flash Memory Card ....................................................... 6-104 DOSFWDL ................................................................... 6-104 Setting up the PowerFlex 7000 Trending Feature ............... 6-105 Environmental Considerations ............................................. 6-106 Hazardous Materials .................................................. 6-106 Disposal ..................................................................... 6-107 Preventive Maintenance Check List .................................... 6-108 Operational Maintenance ..................................................... 6-108 Annual Maintenance ............................................................ 6-109 Initial Information Gathering ..................................... 6-109 Physical Checks ......................................................... 6-109 Control Power Checks ............................................... 6-111 Final Power Checks before Restarting ....................... 6-111 Additional Tasks During Preventive Maintenance .... 6-112 Final Reporting .......................................................... 6-112 Chapter 6 Component Definition and Maintenance (cont.)
x Table of Contents
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Time Estimations ......................................................... 6-113 Tool/Parts/Information Requirements .......................... 6-114
Chapter 7 Troubleshooting Documenting Shutdowns ......................................................... 7-1 Acronyms and Abbreviations Used in this Manual ................. 7-2 Drive Fault Messages .............................................................. 7-3 Drive Warning Messages ....................................................... 7-32
Appendix A Catalog Number Catalog Number Explanation................................................... A-1 Explanation Service Duty Rating, Continuous Current Rating and Altitude Rating Code ........................................................ A-2 Nominal Line Voltage, Control Voltage, System Frequency ... A-2 PowerFlex 7000 Drive Selection Explanation ........................ A-3 When is a Tachometer Required? ........................................... A-4 PowerFlex 7000 Drive Performance ....................................... A-5 Glossary of Terms ................................................................... A-5 Typical Application Load Torque Profiles ............................. A-6
Appendix B Torque Requirements Torque Requirements for Threaded Fasteners ........................ B-1
Appendix C Drive Logic Command Logic Command Word Database 2.001 ............................... C-1 Logic Status Word Database 2.001....................................... C-2 Product Specific Logic Command Database 2.001.................. C-3 Logic Command Word Database 3.001 and later ................ C-4 Logic Status Word Database 3.001 and later ....................... C-5 Product Specific Logic Command Database 3.001 and 3.002 .. C-6 Product Specific Logic Command Firmware 3.004 to 5.001 ... C-7
Appendix D Meggering Drive Meggering .................................................................... D-1 Meggering the PowerFlex 7000 .............................................. D-1 Equipment Required ......................................................... D-2 Procedure .......................................................................... D-2
Chapter 6 Component Definition and Maintenance (cont.)
Preface 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Overview
Who Should Use This Manual This manual is intended for use by personnel familiar with medium voltage and variable speed solid-state drive equipment. The manual contains material that will allow the user to operate, maintain, and troubleshoot the drive system.
What Is Not in this Manual This manual is designed to provide only general information on the PowerFlex 7000 drive. Therefore customer specific topics are not presented. These customer specific topics include:
Dimensional and Electrical Drawings generated for each customer specific order. (This manual does provide generic drawings for illustrative purposes only.)
Spare Parts Lists compiled for each customer specific order. (This manual does provide a generic list of possible components and a description of their characteristics and functionality.)
The above information is provided to the customer during the order process cycle.
Please note: This manual deals specifically with the PowerFlex 7000 drive. Information on auxiliary cabinetry or special components we are contracted to supply with the drive will be contained within the Service Manual you will receive with your order.
Manual Conventions Symbols are used throughout this manual to indicate specific types of information.
W A R N I N G W A R N I N G
Warnings tell readers where people may be hurt if procedures are not followed properly.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Cautions tell readers where machinery may be damaged or economic loss can occur if procedures are not followed properly.
P-2 Preface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Both of the above could indicate: A possible trouble spot Tell what causes the trouble spot Give the result of an improper action Tell the reader how to avoid trouble
S H O C K H A Z A R D S H O C K H A Z A R D This symbol alerts the user to a potential electrical shock hazard that exists on a component or printed circuit board.
General Precautions A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N This drive contains ESD (Electrostatic Discharge) sensitive parts and assemblies. Static control precautions are required when installing, testing, servicing or repairing this assembly. Component damage may result if ESD control procedures are not followed. If you are not familiar with static control procedures, reference Allen-Bradley publication 8000-4.5.2, Guarding Against Electrostatic Damage or any other applicable ESD protection handbook.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N An incorrectly applied or installed drive can result in component damage or a reduction in product life. Wiring or application errors, such as, undersizing the motor, incorrect or inadequate AC supply, or excessive ambient temperatures may result in malfunction of the system.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N Only personnel familiar with the PowerFlex 7000 Adjustable Speed Drive (ASD) and associated machinery should plan or implement the installation, start-up and subsequent maintenance of the system. Failure to comply may result in personal injury and/or equipment damage.
Preface P-3 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Who to Call for Commissioning The Medium Voltage Support provides customer support for our product line.
They may be contacted at 519-740-4747 and 519-740-4746.
The support they offer includes, but is not limited to:
Quoting and Managing Product On-site Start-ups. Ongoing Preventative Maintenance Planning for our products. Parts Management and on site inventory agreements. Customer in-house and on-site product training.
P-4 Preface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Chapter 1 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Overview of Drive
Introduction The PowerFlex 7000 represents the third generation of medium voltage drives at Rockwell Automation. The PowerFlex 7000 medium voltage AC drive is part of the PowerFlex family of AC drive products. The Allen-Bradley PowerFlex family of Drives incorporates leading-edge technology, embedded communications, and significant commonality across multiple platforms, networks, operator interface programming and hardware. Designed for end users, solution providers and OEMs, PowerFlex 7000 air-cooled drives meet applications ranging from fractional to 5,500 horsepower.
The PowerFlex 7000 is a general purpose stand alone medium voltage drive that controls speed, torque, direction, starting, and stopping of standard asynchronous or synchronous AC motors. It is intended for use on a host of standard and specialty applications such as fans, pumps, compressors, mixers, conveyors, kilns, fan-pumps, and test stands. Primary industries for these applications include petrochemical, cement, mining and metals, forest products, power generation, and water / waste water.
The PowerFlex 7000 is a global product that adheres to the most common standards from NEC, IEC, NEMA, UL, and CSA. It is available with the worlds most common supply voltages at medium voltage, from 2400-6600 volts.
The design focus is on high reliability, ease of use, and lower total cost of ownership.
Topology The PowerFlex 7000 utilizes a Pulse Width Modulated (PWM) Current Source Inverter (CSI) for the machine side converter as shown in Figure 1.1. This topology offers a simple, reliable, cost effective power structure that is easy to apply to a wide voltage and power range. The power semiconductor switches used are easy-to- series for any medium voltage level. Semi-conductor fuses are not required for the power structure due to the current limiting DC link inductor.
With 6500 volt PIV rated power semiconductor devices, the number of inverter components is kept to a minimum. For example, only six inverter switching devices are required at 2400V, 12 at 3300-4160V, and 18 at 6600V. 1-2 Overview of Drive 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
The PowerFlex 7000 has the additional benefit of inherent regenerative braking for applications where the load is overhauling the motor, or where high inertia loads need to be slowed down quickly. Symmetrical Gate Commutated Thyristors (SGCTs) are used for machine converter switches. Silicon-controlled rectifiers (SCRs) (for 6/18 pulse) or SGCTs (for AFE rectifiers) are used for the line converter switches.
Rectifier Designs There are three offered designs for the rectifier of the PowerFlex drive.
6-Pulse Rectifier
A 6-pulse thyristor phase controlled rectifier (with optional passive tuned filters) is shown in Figure 1.2. The line current before and after the filter is shown. It can be seen that the current before the filter contains the 5 th , 7 th and 11 th harmonics, however, the current after the filter is more sinusoidal since these harmonics are redirected through the tuned filters. The tuned filters also serve to improve input power factor to near unity. The total harmonic distortion (THD) of line current with the 6-pulse rectifier and tuned filters is approximately 5.2%. The THD of line voltage (line-to-line) is approximately 2.6%. (THD of line voltage is a function of system impedance.) CONVERTER LINE L- M- DC LINK L+ M+ MACHINE CONVERTER 2U(X1) 2V(X2) 2W(X3) U(T1) V(T2) W(T3) SCRs SGCTs Figure 1.1 PWM-CSI AC Drive Overview of Drive 1-3 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
The 6-pulse rectifier can be used in conjunction with a rectifier duty isolation transformer as shown or with an AC line reactor. A rectifier duty isolation transformer is required when the drive is being applied to existing or retrofit motors or when the supply voltage is higher than the drive rated voltage. (Refer to Specification 80001-005, Rectifier Duty Transformers for more details on transformer requirements and features.)
An AC line reactor can be used in front of the 6-pulse rectifier when the drive is being applied to new motors. (Refer to Specification 80001-004, Requirements for Medium Voltage Motors Without Common Mode Voltage Elimination). Elimination of the isolation transformer reduces capital and installation costs, saves on valuable floor space, and increases overall system efficiency.
Figure 1.2 6-pulse Rectifier with input waveforms a) Line current without filter b) Line current with filter c) Line-to-line voltage at point of common coupling (PCC)
18-Pulse Rectifier
An 18-pulse phase controlled rectifier is shown in Figure 1.3. In an 18-pulse configuration, the IEEE 519-1992 requirements are met in the majority of cases without the need for passive filters; however, a multi-winding isolation transformer is required to mitigate the low order harmonics by phase shifting principles. The 18-pulse solution is superior to 6- or 12-pulse offerings in terms of lowering line side harmonics.
Isolation transformers are available in both indoor dry type and outdoor oil-filled designs for maximum flexibility in dealing with floor space, installation costs, and control room air conditioner loading. (Refer to Specification 80001-005, Rectifier Duty Transformers, for more details on transformer requirements and features.)
a)
b)
c) 1-4 Overview of Drive 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Sample line current and voltage are also shown in Figure 1.3. The THD of line current is approximately 5.6%, while the THD of line voltage (line-to-line) is approximately 2.0%. (THD of line voltage is a function of system impedance.) The 18-pulse rectifier consists of one master bridge and two slave bridges and will always have a total of 18 SCR switching devices.
Figure 1.3 18-pulse Rectifier and its input waveforms a) Line current b) Line-to-line voltage at PCC
Active Front End (PWM Rectifier)
An active front end (AFE rectifier) suitable for the PowerFlex 7000 topology is also commonly called a PWM rectifier. This is particularly attractive for applications with new motors since it does not require an isolation transformer to meet IEEE-519. (See Specification 80001-004, Requirements for Medium Voltage Motors Without Common Mode Voltage Elimination). Most available technologies in todays MV market require a multi-winding transformer to mitigate the unwanted harmonics through cancellation by phase shifting the transformer secondary windings. Depending on the topology, the transformer can have up to 15 sets of secondary windings. Elimination of the isolation transformer reduces capital and installation costs, saves on valuable floor space, and increases overall system efficiency.
The AFE rectifier requires a switching pattern that complies with similar rules as the inverter. The pattern used for the example shown in Figure 1.4 is a 42-pulse selective harmonic elimination (SHE) pattern, which eliminates the 5 th , 7th and 11 th harmonics. The integral input capacitors are designed to reduce the current harmonics of the higher order. The filter transfer function technique is used to place the filter break frequency in a region where no harmonics are present. This prevents the excitation of system harmonic frequencies. Other factors that are considered when designing the filter are the input power factor and the requirement on Total Harmonic Distortion (THD) of input current and voltage waveforms. a)
b)
Overview of Drive 1-5 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
The small integral AC line reactor (see Fig. 1.4) provides additional filtering and current limiting features to a line side short circuit fault. The rectifier input current, the rectifier terminal voltage and the line current and voltage waveforms are shown in Figure 1.4. The line current THD is approximately 4.5%, while line-to-line voltage THD is approximately 1.5%. (THD of line voltage is a function of system impedance.) Input power factor with the AFE rectifier is equal to or greater than 0.98 for the entire speed and load range when applied to variable torque loads.
Figure 1.4 Active rectifier (PWM) and its input current/voltage waveforms a) Line current b) Line-to-line voltage at PCC
Direct-to-Drive Technology The PowerFlex 7000 with Direct-to-Drive technology allows you to: connect supply power directly to the drive without an Isolation Transformer connect a new or existing motor directly to the drive without extra motor filtering.
Most Medium Voltage Drive Manufacturers use multi-winding isolation transformers to mitigate unwanted harmonics by phase shifting the transformer secondary windings. Depending on the topology, the transformer can have up to 15 sets of secondary windings. The disadvantages to this method are the high degree of drive and transformer complexity, a very high component count and many interconnecting cables and connection points. This leads to much higher maintenance requirements and lower reliability.
Manufacturers also use transformers to protect motors from Common Mode Voltage stress. When transformers are used they allow the motor neutral point to be connected to ground, but with this method, the common mode voltage that would otherwise be impressed on the motor is impressed on the transformer. The disadvantage to this method is that increased transformer insulation and increased cable insulation is required between the transformer and the drive so it can withstand the common mode voltage stress. a)
b)
1-6 Overview of Drive 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Rather than use an Isolation Transformer, the Direct-to-Drive Active Front End uses the semi-conductor switching pattern to reduce line current harmonics to levels that comply to the worlds most accepted harmonic standards. The Active Front End is the best method of harmonic cancellation because it does not suffer from complexity and high component count like multi-pulse drive topologies do.
Direct-to-Drive technology produces almost no common mode voltage so it is suitable for new or existing motors and imposes no stress on the drive input. The advantage of Direct-to-Drive technology over an Isolation Transformer is that no extra insulation is required in the motor, in the motor cables or in the line cables.
In addition to mitigating Common Mode Voltage, Direct-to-Drive technology does not generate dv/dt or Reflected Wave Voltage Stress on Motors.
The simplicity of its design results in a lower initial capital investment, lower operating cost, lower installation cost and lower maintenance cost relative to drives that require isolation transformers.
The PowerFlex 7000 with Direct-to-Drive technology is typically smaller and lighter than drive technologies that use Isolation Transformers. Isolation Transformers represent 30 to 50% of a drive system size and 50 to 70% of the systems weight. This means that there is no interwiring between drive and transformer (for external transformer configurations), and no shipping splits in the drive (for integral transformer configurations). This makes the PowerFlex 7000 the simplest to install.
Direct-to-Drive Technology (cont.) Overview of Drive 1-7 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Motor Compatibility The PowerFlex 7000 achieves near sinusoidal current and voltage waveforms to the motor, resulting in no significant additional heating or insulation stress. Temperature rise in the motor connected to the VFD is typically 3 C (37 F) higher compared to across the line operation. Dv/dt in the voltage waveform is less than 10 volts / microsecond. The peak voltage that the motor insulation will see is the rated motor RMS voltage divided by 0.707. Reflected wave and dv/dt issues often associated with VSI (voltage source inverter) drives are a non-issue with the PowerFlex 7000. Typical motor waveforms are shown in Figure 1.5. These motor friendly waveforms are achieved by utilizing a selective harmonic elimination (SHE) pattern in the inverter to eliminate major order harmonics, in conjunction with a small output capacitor (integral to the drive) to eliminate harmonics at higher speeds.
Standard motors are compatible without de-rating, even on retrofit applications.
Motor cable distance is virtually unlimited. This technology has been tested, controlling motors up to 15 km (9.3 miles) away from the drive.
Figure 1.5 Motor waveforms @ full load, full speed 4160V, 933 kW, 60 Hz
Motor current
Motor voltage
1-8 Overview of Drive 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
SGCT Features and Benefits An SGCT is a Symmetrical Gate Commutated Thyristor with an integrated gate drive. Positioning the gate drive close to the SGCT as shown in Figure 1.6, creates a low inductance path that provides more efficient and uniform gating of the device. As a result, the device is better suited than a conventional GTO to handle the fluctuating levels of voltage and current while it is switching on and off during gating.
An SGCT has similar characteristics to an IGCT (used on some VSI drives), including low conduction and switching losses, low failure rate, and double sided cooling for low thermal stress. However, the SGCT achieves voltage blocking capability in both forward and reverse directions up to 6500 volts by a NPT (Non-Punch-Through) structure and nearly symmetrical pnp transistor in the wafer, while the current is unidirectional.
The IGCT only blocks voltage in one direction and allows current flow in both forward and reverse direction, thus needs a built-in anti- parallel diode.
Implementing SGCTs in the PowerFlex 7000 results in significant advantages including:
1. Simplification of the snubber design and a reduction in the size of the snubber capacitor by a factor of 10. 2. Operation at a higher switching frequency (420-540 Hz), hence reducing the size of passive components (DC link inductor and motor filter cap) by 50%. 3. Improving performance of the drive. 4. Reduction of component count, hence improving reliability, cost, and size of the drive. 5. Fail safe failure mode (non-rupture).
Figure 1.6 SGCT with integrated gate drive (left) and unit cell structure (right) Overview of Drive 1-9 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Description NEMA IEC Power Rating (Air Cooled) 200 to 5,500 hp 150 to 4,100 kW Motor Type Induction or Synchronous Input Voltage Rating 2400V, 3300V, 4160V, 6600V Input Voltage Tolerance 10%of Nominal Voltage Sag -30% Power Loss Ride-Through 5 Cycles (Std) > 5 Cycles (Optional UPS) Input Protection Metal Oxide Varistor (MOV) Input Frequency 50/60 Hz, +/- 5% Input Short-circuit Current Withstand 5 Cycle 2400 V 6600 V 25 MVA RMS SYM Basic Impulse Level 50 kV (0 1000m) Power Bus Design Copper Tin plated Ground Bus Copper Tin plated 6 x 51 mm ( x 2 in.) Customer Control Wire Way Separate and Isolated Input Power Circuit Protection Vacuum Contactor with Fused Isolating Switch or Circuit Breaker Input Impedance Device Isolation Transformer or AC Line Reactor Output Voltage 0 2300 V 0 3300 V 0 4160 V 0 -6000 V, 0 6300 V, 0- 6600 V Inverter Design PWM Inverter Switch Symmetrical Gate Commutated Thyristor (SGCT) Inverter Switch Failure Mode Non-rupture, Non-arc Inverter Switch Failure Rate (FIT) 100 per 1 Billion Hours Operation Inverter Switch Cooling Double Sided, Low Thermal Stress Inverter Switching Frequency 420-540 Hz Voltage SGCTs (per phase) Number of Inverter SGCTs 2400 V 3300 V 4160 V 6600 V 2 4 4 6 Voltage PIV SGCT PIV Rating (Peak Inverse Voltage) 2400 V 3300 V 4160 V 6600 V 6500 V 6500 V 6500 V 6500 V Rectifier Designs 6 Pulse 18 Pulse Active Front End (PWM) Rectifier Switch SCR (6/18 Pulse), SGCT (Active Rectifier) Rectifier Switch Failure Mode Non-rupture, Non-arc Rectifier Switch Failure Rate (FIT) 50 (SCR) 100 (SGCT) per 1 Billion Hours Operation Rectifier Switch Cooling Double Sided, Low Thermal Stress Short-circuit fault rating based on input protection device (contactor or circuit breaker) BIL derating based on altitudes < 1000 m (3,300 ft.). Refer to factory for derating.
Specifications 1-10 Overview of Drive 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Description NEMA IEC Voltage 6-Pulse 18-Pulse AFE Number of Rectifier Devices per phase 2400 V 3300 V 4160 V 6600 V 2 4 4 6 6 6 6 6 2 4 4 6 Voltage 6-Pulse 18-Pulse AFE SCR PIV Rating (Peak Inverse Voltage) 2400 V 3300 V 4160 V 6600 V 6500 V 6500 V 6500 V 6500 V 4500 V 4500 V 4500 V 6500 V 6500 V 6500 V 6500 V 6500 V Output Current THD (1 st 49 th ) < 5% Output Waveform to Motor Sinusoidal Current / Voltage Medium Voltage Isolation Fiber Optic Modulation techniques SHE (Selective Harmonic Elimination) PWM (Pulse Width Modulation) Control Method Digital Sensorless Direct Vector Full Vector Control with Tach Feedback (Optional) Tuning Method Auto Tuning via Setup Wizard Speed Regulator Bandwidth 5-25 Radians / Second Torque Regulator Bandwidth 15-50 Radians / Second Speed Regulation 0.1%without Tachometer Feedback 0.01-0.02%with Tachometer Feedback Acceleration/Deceleration Range Independent Accel/Decel 4 x 30 sec. Acceleration/Deceleration Ramp Rates 4 x Independent Accel/Decel S Ramp Rate Independent Accel/Decel 2 x 999 sec. Critical Speed Avoidance 3 x Independent with Adjustable bandwidth Stall Protection Delay / Speed Load Loss Detection Adjustable level, delay, speed set points Control Mode Speed or Torque Current Limit Adjustable in Motoring and Regenerative Output Frequency Range 0.2-75 Hz Normal Duty Heavy Duty Service Duty Rating 110%Overload for 1 minute every 10 minutes (Variable Torque Load) 150%Overload for 1 minute every 10 minutes (Constant Torque Load) Typical VFD Efficiency > 98%(6/18 Pulse) > 97.5%(AFE) Contact Factory for Guaranteed Efficiency of Specific Drive Rating VFD Noise Level < 85 dB(A) per OSHA Standard 3074 Regenerative Braking Capability Inherent No Additional Hardware or Software Required Flying Start Capability Yes Able to Start into and Control a Spinning Load in Forward or Reverse Direction Operator Interface 40-character, 16-line formatted text 0.1 Hz Display speed resolution Languages English Spanish French Chinese Based on a motor 50 or 60 Hz base frequency Redundant fan and fan exhaust ducting options will affect noise level
Specifications (cont.) Overview of Drive 1-11 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Description NEMA IEC Control Power 208-575 V, 3 Phase, 50/60 Hz External I/O 16 Digital Inputs, 16 Digital Outputs External Input Ratings 50-60 Hz AC or DC 120-240 V 1 mA External Output Ratings 50-60 Hz AC or DC 30-260 V 1 Amp Analog Inputs (1) Isolated, (1) Non-isolated, 4-20 mA or 0-10 V (250 ohm) Analog Resolution Analog input 12 Bit (4-20 mA) Internal parameter 32 Bit resolution Serial Communication 16 Bit resolution (.1Hz) (Digital Speed Reference) Analog Outputs (1) Isolated, (7) Non-isolated, 4-20 mA or 0-10 V (600 ohm) Communication Interface SCANPort /DPI Scan Time Internal ScanPort 10 ms Internal DPI 5 ms Communications Protocols (Optional) RS232/422/485 Ethernet DH485 Interbus Remote I/O LON Works DeviceNet Can Open ControlNet Profibus Modbus/Modbus Plus Johnson Controls Enclosure NEMA 1 IP21 Lifting Device Standard / Removable Mounting Arrangement Mounting Sill channels Structure Finish Epoxy Power Paint Exterior Sandtex Light Grey (RAL 7038) Black (RAL 8022) Internal Control Sub Plates High Gloss White (RAL 9003) Interlocking Key provision for customer input Disconnecting Device Corrosion Protection Unpainted Parts (Zinc Plated / Bronze Chromate) Ambient Temperature 0 to 40C (32F to 104F) Fiber Optic Interface Rectifier Inverter Cabinet (Warning / Trip) Door Filter Painted Diffuser with Matted Filter Media Door Filter Blockage Air Flow Restriction (Trip / Warning) Storage and Transportation Temperature Range -40C to 70C (-40F to 185F) Relative Humidity Max. 95%Non-Condensing Altitude (Standard) 0 to 1000 m (0 to 3300 ft.) Altitude (Optional) 1001 to 5000 m (0 to 16400 ft.) Seismic (UBC Rating) 1, 2, 3, 4
1-12 Overview of Drive 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame Simplified Electrical Drawings LINECONVERTER L- M- DC LINK L+ M+ MACHINECONVERTER U (T1) V (T2) W(T3) 4U(Z1) 4V(Z2) 4W(Z3) ISTX SCRs 3U(Y1) 3V(Y2) 3W(Y3) 2U(X1) 2V(X2) 2W(X3) SGCTs LINECONVERTER L- M- DC LINK L+ M+ MACHINECONVERTER U (T1) V (T2) W(T3) 4U(Z1) 4V(Z2) 4W(Z3) ISTX SCRs 3U(Y1) 3V(Y2) 3W(Y3) 2U(X1) 2V(X2) 2W(X3) SGCTs LINECONVERTER L- M- DC LINK L+ M+ MACHINECONVERTER U (T1) V (T2) W(T3) 4U(Z1) 4V(Z2) 4W(Z3) ISTX SCRs 3U(Y1) 3V(Y2) 3W(Y3) 2U(X1) 2V(X2) 2W(X3) SGCTs
2400 Volt 18 Pulse
LINE CONVERTER L- M- DC LINK L+ M+ MACHINECONVERTER U (T1) V (T2) W(T3) SCRs 2U (X1) 2V(X2) 2W(X3) SGCTs LINE CONVERTER L- M- DC LINK L+ M+ MACHINECONVERTER U (T1) V (T2) W(T3) SCRs 2U (X1) 2V(X2) 2W(X3) SGCTs
Overview of Drive 1-13 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
LINECONVERTER L- M- DC LINK L+ M+ MACHINE CONVERTER U (T1) V (T2) W(T3) 4U(Z1) 4V(Z2) 4W(Z3) ISTX SCRs 3U(Y1) 3V(Y2) 3W(Y3) 2U(X1) 2V(X2) 2W(X3) SGCTs LINECONVERTER L- M- DC LINK L+ M+ MACHINE CONVERTER U (T1) V (T2) W(T3) 4U(Z1) 4V(Z2) 4W(Z3) ISTX SCRs 3U(Y1) 3V(Y2) 3W(Y3) 2U(X1) 2V(X2) 2W(X3) SGCTs
3300 / 4160 Volt 18 Pulse
LINE CONVERTER L- M- DC LINK L+ M+ MACHINECONVERTER U (T1) V(T2) W(T3) SCRs 2U (X1) 2V (X2) 2W(X3) SGCTs LINE CONVERTER L- M- DC LINK L+ M+ MACHINECONVERTER U (T1) V(T2) W(T3) SCRs 2U (X1) 2V (X2) 2W(X3) SGCTs
6000-6600 Volt Active Front End Overview of Drive 1-15 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Control Overview
Motor Motor Model Line Protection Machine Converter Line Converter DC Link inductor Motor filter cap Machine side feedback and gating Line side feedback and gating F l u x
a n g l e Alpha machine I x
c o m m a n d I y
c o m m a n d Speed command Line filter cap AC Line reactor Idc Feedback Line voltage Source Tach feedback Slip freq Stator freq Speed Control Sync Transfer Flux Control Current Control Alpha line Machine Protection Line current Motor voltage Motor current Speed feedback Flux feedback Faults Faults
Figure 1.7 PowerFlex 7000 Function Block Diagram
Direct Vector Control The method of control in the PowerFlex 7000 medium voltage AC drive is called sensorless direct vector control, meaning that the stator current is divided into torque producing and flux producing components, allowing the motor torque to be changed quickly without affecting motor flux. This method of control is used without tachometer feedback for applications requiring continuous operation above 6 Hertz and less than 100% starting torque.
Full vector control can also be achieved with tachometer feedback for applications requiring continuous operation down to 0.2 Hertz with up to 150% starting torque. Vector control offers superior performance over volts/hertz type drives. The speed bandwidth range is .1-15 radians per second, while the torque bandwidth range is 20-100 radians per second. 1-16 Overview of Drive 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Control Hardware The control hardware includes identical drive control boards for machine and line side complete with up to three fiber optic interface boards (depending on the voltage and number of switching devices), signal conditioning boards for machine and line side, customer interface board and external I/O board. The common drive control boards are used for the rectifier and inverter, induction or synchronous drive control, and the three rectifier types (6-pulse, 18-pulse, or Active Rectifier).
The drive control boards feature a floating point digital signal processor and field programmable gate arrays for advanced functions such as gating and diagnostics, fault handling, and drive synchronization control.
Drive Control Board MACHINE Drive Control Board LINE Signal Conditioning Board LINE Signal Conditioning Board MACHINE Customer Interface Board External I/O Board Fiber Optic Board Fiber Optic Board Fiber Optic Board Fiber Optic Board Fiber Optic Board Fiber Optic Board
Figure 1.8 Control Hardware Layout for PowerFlex 7000
Overview of Drive 1-17 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
The operator interface terminal features a 16-line, 40-character, pixel based LCD display that makes text and graphics easy to read. Bar chart meters are configurable for common process variables including speed, voltage and load.
Everything is user friendly about the PowerFlex 7000 operator interface terminal including the greeting on the opening screen. The terminal is designed for the greatest ease of use for start-up, monitoring and troubleshooting. The setup wizard helps the user to set the required parameter menus by asking questions or prompting selections for desired operation. Warnings and comments appear complete with help text to keep the user on the right track. The setup wizard combined with the auto-tuning feature allows the drive to be tuned to the motor and load as quickly and accurately as possible, resulting in fast start-ups, smooth operation, and less down time.
Up to five test modes are available including low voltage gate check, and running at full current without motor connected.
Enhanced diagnostic functions are available on the operator interface terminal including separate fault and warning queues in non-volatile RAM (NVRAM), extended fault text strings and on line help, and trend buffers for 8 variables.
Operator Interface 1-18 Overview of Drive 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Chapter 2 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Drive Installation
Safety and Codes A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
The Canadian Electrical Code (CEC), National Electrical Code (NEC), or local codes outline provisions for safely installing electrical equipment. Installation MUST comply with specifications regarding wire type, conductor sizes, branch circuit protection and disconnect devices. Failure to do so may result in personal injury and/or equipment damage.
Unpacking and Inspection Before leaving the factory, all drives have been tested both mechanically and electrically. Immediately upon receiving the drive, remove the packing and check for possible shipping damage. Report any damage immediately to the claims office of the common carrier.
After unpacking the material, check the item(s) received against the bill of lading to assure that the nameplate description of each item agrees with the material ordered. Inspect the PowerFlex 7000 drive for physical damage, as stated in the Rockwell Automation Conditions of Sale.
I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T
All claims for breakage and damage whether concealed or obvious must be made to the carrier by the Customer as soon as possible after receipt of the shipment. Rockwell Automation will be glad to render the Customer reasonable assistance in the securing of adjustment for such damage claims.
Remove all packing material, wedges, or braces from within the drive. Operate the contactors and relays manually to assure that they operate freely. If any part of the equipment will not be installed when it is unpacked, it should be stored in a clean, dry place. The storage temperature must be between -40C (-40F) and 70C (185F) with a maximum humidity of 95%, non-condensing, to guard against damage to temperature sensitive components in the controller.
2-2 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Transportation and Handling The PowerFlex 7000 drive is shipped on a wooden skid, which is bolted to the underside of the cabinetry. The drive should remain bolted to the shipping skid until it is delivered to its final installation area. Lifting angles are supplied bolted to the top of the cabinetry. The drive must be kept in an upright position during any handling. Refer to General Handling Procedures, publication 7000-IN002_-EN-P for a more detailed description.
The drive must be transported on a pallet or via use of the lifting beam supplied as part of all 2300-mm (91-inch) high cabinets.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Ensure that the load rating of the lifting device is sufficient to safely raise the controller sections. Refer to the packing slip enclosed with shipment for shipping weights.
Round rollers can be used to assist in moving the drive to the installation site. Once at the final site, the pipe rolling technique can be used to place the cabinet in the desired position.
W A R N I N G W A R N I N G
Care must be exercised when using either a forklift or the pipe rolling technique for positioning purposes to ensure that the equipment is not scratched, dented or damaged in any manner. Always exercise care to stabilize the drive during handling to guard against tipping and injury to personnel.
NOTE: It cannot be sufficiently stressed how important it is that the customer installation duties are performed correctly. Any errors will certainly cause delays in the drive commissioning, if not damage as well.
Never attempt to lift or move the drive by any means other than the methods listed, as structural damage or personal injury could result. The following methods of handling are recommended:
Drive Installation 2-3 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Overhead Lifting
1. Attach rigging to the lifting angles on the top of the cabinetry.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Ensure that the load rating of the lifting device and rigging is sufficient to safely raise the drive. Refer to shipping weights on the packing slip enclosed with the shipment.
2. Do not pass ropes or cables through the support holes in the lifting angles. Use slings with safety hooks or shackles.
3. Select or adjust the rigging lengths to compensate for an unequal weight distribution of load and maintain the drive in an upright position.
4. To reduce the tension on the rigging and the compressive load on the lifting device, do not allow the angle between the lifting cables/chains and vertical to exceed 45 degrees.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Drives may contain heavy equipment that could be adversely affected by tilting.
45.0 Max
Figure 2.1 Overhead Lifting
2-4 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame Rod or Pipe Rollers
This method is only suitable when there are no inclines and the drive is being moved on one floor level.
1. Boards 50.8 mm 152.4 mm (2 in. 6 in.) or equivalent and at least 300 mm (12 inches) longer than the drive must be placed under the shipping skid.
2. Carefully ease the shipping platform over the roller pipes until the drive weight is borne on the roller pipes.
3. The drive can be rolled to its designated location. Steady the load to prevent tipping.
(50.8 mm 152.4 mm)
Figure 2.2 Rod or Pipe Rollers
Fork Lift Trucks
A single fork lift truck may be used on drives not exceeding 3 m (120 inches) in length if the lift truck has sufficient lifting capacity. Larger drives can be moved with two forklift trucks operating in tandem.
1. Insert forks into openings of shipping skids from the rear of the drive.
2. Carefully balance the drive on the forks because the drives are usually heavier at one side.
3. Use safety straps when handling to steady the drive while moving.
Drive Installation 2-5 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 Storage
If it is necessary to store the drive, be certain to store in a clean dry dust free area.
Storage temperature should be maintained between -20C and 65C (-4F and 149F). If storage temperature fluctuates or if humidity exceeds 85%, space heaters should be used to prevent condensation. The drive should be stored in a heated building having adequate air circulation. The drive must never be stored outdoors.
Siting of the Drive Site Considerations
The standard environment in which the equipment is designed to operate is: Elevation above sea level less than 1000 meters (3250 feet) Ambient air temperature between 0C (32F) and 40C (104F) Relative humidity of the air not to exceed 95% non-condensing
For the equipment to operate in conditions other than those specified consult the local Rockwell Automation Sales office.
The equipment requires the following site conditions: (A) Indoor installation only, no dripping water or other fluids (B) Clean air for cooling requirements (C) Level floor for anchoring the equipment. Refer to dimension drawings for the location of the anchoring points. (D) The room in which the equipment is located must allow for full opening of the doors of the equipment, typically 1200 mm (48 inches). Also, allowances have to be made for clearance for fan removal. This fan allowance must be greater than 700 mm (27.5 inches). or Dimension drawings can be obtained by contacting the local Rockwell Automation Sales office. The equipment does not require rear access for servicing. (E) Allowance must be made for the stream of cooling air which exits the drive at the top. The flow of cooling air into and out the drive must be kept clear and uninhibited. 2-6 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
(F) The room in which the equipment is located must be large enough to accommodate the thermal losses of the equipment since air conditioning may be required; the ambient temperature must not exceed that for which the equipment is rated. The heat created by the drive is directly proportional to the power of the motor being driven and the efficiency of equipment within the room. If thermal load data is required contact the Rockwell Automation Sales office. (G) The area in which the drive is located should be free of radio frequency interference such as encountered with some welding units. This may cause erroneous fault conditions and shut down the drive. (H) The equipment must be kept clean. Dust in the equipment decreases system reliability and inhibits cooling. (I) Power cable lengths to the motor are virtually unlimited due to the near sinusoidal voltage and current waveforms. Unlike voltage source drives, there are no capacitive coupling, dv/dt, or peak voltage issues that can damage the motor insulation system. The CSI-PWM topology utilized in the PowerFlex 7000 medium voltage AC drive has been tested with motors located up to 15 kilometers from the drive. (J) Only personnel familiar with the function of the drive should have access to the equipment. (K) The drive is designed for front access and should be installed with adequate and safe clearance to allow for total door opening. The back of the unit may be placed against a wall although some customers prefer back access also. If back access is desired, set drive 300 mm (12 inches) out from wall.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
An incorrectly applied or installed drive can result in component damage or a reduction in product life. Ambient conditions not within the specified ranges may result in malfunction of the drive.
Drive Installation 2-7 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Installation When the drive has been placed at its installation area, the lag bolts that fasten the shipping skid to the drive must be removed. The drive is moved off the shipping skid and the shipping skid can be discarded.
Position the drive in its desired location. Verify that the drive is on a level surface and that the position of the drive will be vertical when the anchor bolts are installed.
The location of the anchor points is provided with the dimension drawing of the drive.
Install and tighten the anchor bolts. (M12 or hardware required). Engineered bolt systems are required for seismic requirements. Consult factory.
Remove the top lifting angles, retain the hardware.
Install the hardware from the lifting angles in the tapped holes at the top of drive; this prevents leakage of cooling air as well as keeping dust out of the equipment.
Shock Indication Labels
Shock indication labels are devices that permanently record the physical shock to which equipment is subjected.
At the time of final preparation for shipment from the factory, a shock indication label is installed on the inside door of the converter cabinet.
During the shipping and installation process drives may inadvertently be subjected to excess shock and vibration which may impair its functionality.
When the drive has been placed in its installation area, the converter door is to be opened and the shock indication labels inspected.
The drive is shipped with a label that records shock levels in excess of 10G. If these shock levels have been attained, the chevron shaped window will appear blue in one of the two windows.
If these shock levels have been attained, record the values. There is a greater possibility of the drive having sustained internal damage if it has been subjected to physical shock during the shipping and installation process. 2-8 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Installation (cont.) If the indicators show that no shock was attained, full inspection and verification in accordance with the Commissioning process outlined in Chapter 4 is still essential.
Red Plastic Housing Window Area appears Blue if subjected to shock 51 mm (2.0) 21 mm (0.8)
Figure 2.3 Shock Indicator
Installation of Exhaust Air Hood
On the top of the cabinet with the cooling fan, a sheet metal exhaust hood is to be installed. The components to make up the exhaust hood have been packaged and shipped with the drive and are to be found in the control/cabling cabinet.
The first step is to remove the protective plate covering the fan opening on the drive. It is a flat cover plate bolted to the top plate. Remove the bolts and plate and set aside for re-use.
Secondly, loosely assemble the two L-shaped panel components shipped with the drive as per Figure 2.4.
Drive Installation 2-9 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Locate the exhaust hood on top of the cabinet per Figure 2.5 and re- install the original cover plate previously set aside. (Care must be taken that the notches on the bottom flange are oriented toward the sides of the drive). Affix assembly to the drive top plate. Tighten all hardware.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Any screws that are accidentally dropped in the equipment must be retrieved as damage or injury may occur.
2-10 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Drive Installation 2-11 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Cabinet Layout and Dimensional Drawings of Drive The following drawings are generic in nature and will not accurately detail your drive. They are provided here to give you a general overview of a typical drive. The Dimensional Drawings are order specific and will show the information outlined.
The dimension drawing provides important information for the installation of the equipment.
The FLOOR PLAN shows:
the locations for anchoring the equipment to the floor (balloon D) size and location of openings for bottom power cable entry (balloons A and B) size and location of openings for bottom control wiring entry (balloon C) size and location of openings for bottom fan power wiring entry (balloon J)
The ROOF PLAN shows:
size and location of openings for top power cable entry (balloons A and B) size and location of openings for top control wiring entry (balloon C) size and location of openings for top fan power wiring entry (balloon J) minimum aisle clearance in front of equipment (balloon M)
The Front View shows:
minimum clearance required at top of drive for fan maintenance (balloon K)
2-12 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame PowerFlex 7000 Dimensional Drawings
Note: Contact Factory for Seismic Mounting Information. Drive Installation 2-13 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Note: Contact Factory for Seismic Mounting Information. 2-14 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Note: Contact Factory for Seismic Mounting Information. Drive Installation 2-15 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Note: Contact Factory for Seismic Mounting Information. 2-16 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Note: Contact Factory for Seismic Mounting Information. Drive Installation 2-17 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Note: Contact Factory for Seismic Mounting Information. 2-18 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Note: Contact Factory for Seismic Mounting Information. Drive Installation 2-19 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Note: Contact Factory for Seismic Mounting Information. 2-20 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Note: Contact Factory for Seismic Mounting Information. Drive Installation 2-21 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Note: Contact Factory for Seismic Mounting Information. 2-22 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Note: Contact Factory for Seismic Mounting Information. Drive Installation 2-23 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Note: Contact Factory for Seismic Mounting Information. 2-24 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Control/Cabling Cabinet Shows the medium voltage area located in the control/cabling cabinet behind the low voltage compartment and with barriers removed.
Note: The control/cabling cabinet comes in two different configurations: 18-pulse rectifier (Figure 2.6) 6-pulse/PWM (Figure 2.7)
Major Components The following four diagrams are presented to show what the typical layout of each cabinet will be for the PowerFlex 7000 Drive. Motor Terminals Transient Suppression Networks Line Terminals Current Transformers Hall-Effect Sensor Voltage Sensing Hall-Effect Sensor
Figure 2.6 Cabling Cabinet for 18-Pulse Rectifier (Motor Filter Capacitors Not Shown) Drive Installation 2-25 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
(For use with Isolation Transformers) or Ground Filter (For use with Line Reactors) Hall Effect Sensors Sensing Boards Grounding Network Motor Filter Capacitors Power Terminals Current Transformers Transient Suppression Network (For use with Isolation Transformers) or Ground Filter (For use with Line Reactors) Hall Effect Sensors Sensing Boards Grounding Network Motor Filter Capacitors Power Terminals Current Transformers Transient Suppression Network
Figure 2.7 Cabling Cabinet for 6-Pulse/PWM Rectifier
2-26 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Line Capacitors Line Reactor Motor Terminals Motor Filter Capacitors Line Terminals Zero Sequence Current Transformer (if supplied)
Figure 2.8 AC Line Reactor with Connection Cabinet
Drive Installation 2-27 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Differential Pressure sensor Inverter Modules Ground bus Rectifier Modules Gate driver power supplies
Figure 2.9 Major Components of the Converter Cabinet (2400V version shown)
2-28 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
AC/AC Converters 3-phase fan power transformer Ground Bus Hold up Capacitor DC Link Inductor (Barrier removed) Fan Power Cable Entry (bottom) Fan Power Disconnect
Figure 2.10 Major Components of DC Link/Fan Cabinet
Drive Installation 2-29 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
IEC Component and Device PowerFlex 7000 electrical drawings use conventions that are based Designations on IEC (International Electrotechnical Commission) standards, while remaining basically compatible with North American ANSI (American National Standards Institute) standards. The symbols used to identify components on the drawings are international and a full listing of the symbols is given as part of each PowerFlex 7000 elementary drawing (ED) set. The device designations used on the drawings and labeling are also listed with explanations on each drawing set.
Wiring identification uses a source/destination wire number convention on point to point multi-conductor wiring and in situations where the system is warranted. The wire-numbering system of unique, single numbers for multi-drop and point to point wiring continues to be used for general control and power wiring. Wiring that connects between the sheets or that ends at one point and starts at another point on a drawing has an arrow and drawing reference to indicate the ongoing connection. The drawing reference indicates the sheet and the X/Y coordinates of the continuation point. The reference system is explained on a sheet in each drawing set. The unique wire numbering system serves as confirmation that the correct wire is being traced from sheet to sheet or across a drawing. Wires in multi-conductor cables are typically identified by colour rather than by number. The abbreviations used to identify the colours on the drawings are fully identified on a sheet in the drawing set.
Power Wiring Selection The following tables identify general wire selections that will be encountered when installing the PowerFlex 7000 drive line-up.
General Notes:
Adherence to the following recommended field power cabling insulation levels for medium voltage drives will help to ensure trouble-free start-up and operation. The cable insulation level must be increased over that which would be supplied for an Across-the- line application with the same rated line to line voltage.
Either shielded or unshielded cable may be used based on the criteria considered by the distribution system designer. 2-30 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Power Wiring Selection (cont.) Cable Insulation
The cable insulation requirements for the PowerFlex 7000 drive are given in the tables below.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Voltage ratings shown in the following tables are peak line to ground. Some cable manufacturers rate voltage line to line RMS. Ensure the cable meets the rating specified in the following tables.
Cable Insulation Requirements for 6P / PWM Drives with Line Reactor Cable Insulation Rating (kV) (Maximum Peak Line to Ground) System Voltage (V, RMS) Line Side Machine Side 2400 2.2 4.1 3000 2.75 5.12 3300 3.0 5.63 4160 3.8 7.1 6000 5.5 10.8 6300 5.8 11.4 6600 6.0 11.8
Cable Insulation Requirements for 18P and 6P / PWM Drives with Isolation Transformer Cable Insulation Rating (kV) (Maximum Peak Line to Ground) System Voltage (V, RMS) Line Side Machine Side 2400 4.1 2.2 3000 5.12 2.75 3300 5.63 3.0 4160 7.1 3.8 6000 10.8 5.5 6300 11.4 5.8 6600 11.8 6.0
Cable Insulation Requirements for Direct-to-Drive Technology Cable Insulation Rating (kV) (Maximum Peak Line to Ground) System Voltage (V, RMS) Line Side Machine Side 2400 2.2 2.2 3000 2.75 2.75 3300 3.0 3.0 4160 3.8 3.8 6000 5.5 5.5 6300 5.8 5.8 6600 6.0 6.0 Drive Installation 2-31 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
The following table identifies general wire categories that will be encountered when installing the PowerFlex 7000 Drive. Each category has an associated wire group number that is used in the following sections to identify the wire to be used. Application and signal examples along with the recommended type of cable for each group are provided. A matrix providing the recommended minimum spacing between different wire groups run in the same tray or separate conduit is also provided.
For Tray: Recommended spacing between different wire groups in the same tray. For Conduit: Recommended spacing for wire groups in separate conduit mm(inches). Wire Category Wire Group Application Signal Example Recommended Cable Wire Group Power 1 Power 2 Control 3 Control 4 Signal 5 Signal 6 1 AC Power (> 600V AC) 2.3 kV, 3 AC Lines Per IEC / NEC Local Codes and Application Requirements In Tray 228.6 (9.00) 228.6 (9.00) 228.6 (9.00) 228.6 (9.00)
Between Conduit 76.2 (3.00) Between Conduit
2 AC Power (TO 600V AC) 480V, 3 Per IEC / NEC Local Codes and Application Requirements In Tray 228.6 (9.00) 228.6 (9.00) 152.4 (6.00) 152.4 (6.00)
Power
Between Conduit 76.2 (3.00) Between Conduit
3 115V AC or 115V DC Logic Relay Logic PLC I/O Per IEC / NEC Local Codes and Application Requirements In Tray 228.6 (9.00) 152.4 (6.00) 228.6 (9.00) 152.4 (6.00)
115V AC Power Power Supplies Instruments
Between Conduit 76.2 (3.00) Between Conduit
4
24V AC or 24V DC Logic PLC I/O Per IEC / NEC Local Codes and Application Requirements In Tray 228.6 (9.00) 152.4 (6.00) 152.4 (6.00) 228.6 (9.00)
Control Between Conduit 76.2 (3.00) Between Conduit
5 Analog Signals DC Supplies 5-24V DC Supplies Belden 8760 Belden 8770 Belden 9460
Digital (Low Speed) Power Supplies TTL Logic Level
Signal 6 Digital (High Speed) Pulse Train Input Tachometer PLC Communications Belden 8760 Belden 9460 Belden 9463 All signal wiring must be run in separate steel conduit. A wire tray is not suitable.
The minimumspacing between conduits containing different wire groups is 76.2 mm(3 inches).
Note 1: Steel conduit or cable tray may be used for all PowerFlex 7000 Drive power or control wiring, and steel conduit is required for all PowerFlex 7000 Drive signal wiring. All input and output power wiring, control wiring or conduit should be brought through the drive conduit entry holes of the enclosure. Use appropriate connectors to maintain the environmental rating of the enclosure. The steel conduit is REQUIRED for all control and signal circuits, when the drive is installed in European Union countries. The connection of the conduit to the enclosure shall be on full 360 degree and the ground bond at the junction shall be less than 0.1 ohms. In EU countries this is a usual practice to install the control and signal wiring. Note 2: Spacing between wire groups is the recommended minimum for parallel runs of 61 m (200 feet) or less. Note 3: The customer is responsible for the grounding of shields. On drives shipped after November 28/02, the shields are removed from the drive boards. On drives shipped prior to November 28/02, all shields are connected at the drive end and these connections must be removed before grounding the shield at the customer end of the cable. Shields for cables from one enclosure to another must be grounded only at the source end cabinet. If splicing of shielded cables is required, the shield must remain continuous and insulated from ground. Note 4: AC and DC circuits must be run in separate conduits or trays. Note 5: Voltage drop in motor leads may adversely affect motor starting and running performance. Installation and application requirements may dictate that larger wire sizes than indicated in IEC / NEC guidelines are used.
Table 2.A Wire Group Numbers
2-32 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Power Wiring Selection (cont.) The wire sizes must be selected individually, observing all applicable safety and CEC or IEC / NEC regulations. The minimum permissible wire size does not necessarily result in the best operating economy. The minimum recommended size for the wires between the drive and the motor is the same as that used if a main voltage source connection to the motor was used. The distance between the drive and motor may affect the size of the conductors used.
Consult the wiring diagrams and appropriate CEC or IEC / NEC regulations to determine correct power wiring. If assistance is needed, contact your local Rockwell Automation Sales Office.
Power Cabling Access The drive is built with provision for either the top or bottom power cable entry.
Cable access plates are provided on the top and bottom plates of the connection cabinet identified by the customer specific dimension drawing.
To access the customer power cable terminations
Open the door of the low voltage control compartment.
The low voltage control compartment is hinged on its left side. The power terminals are behind the low voltage control compartment.
Note that there is a key interlock to prevent swinging the low voltage control compartment open unless the medium voltage source is locked out.
Turn each of the three latches on the right side of the low voltage compartment one-quarter turn using an 8-mm hexagonal key wrench.
There is a pull handle provided on the right side of the low voltage compartment.
Slowly pull the handle so that the low voltage compartment swings out. The power terminals are now visible.
The installer is responsible for modifying the power cable access plates to suit the requirements.
Note that appropriate connectors must be used to maintain the environmental rating of the enclosure.
Drive Installation 2-33 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Latch Key interlock Handle Terminal blocks Customer (TBC) Low voltage door
Figure 2.11 Swing-out of Low Voltage Compartment
2-34 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Low Voltage Compartment (Open) Power Terminals Low Voltage Door
Figure 2.12 Access to Power Terminals
Drive Installation 2-35 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Power Connections The installer must ensure that interlocking with the upstream power source has been installed and is functioning.
The installer is responsible for ensuring that power connections are made to the equipment in accordance with local electrical codes.
The drive is supplied with provision for cable lugs. The power terminals are identified as follows:
Figure 2.14 Detail Power Terminal Dimensions (6-pulse and PWM Rectifier)
2-38 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
The installer is responsible for ensuring that power connections are made with appropriate torque. (Refer to Appendix B "Torque Requirements" in back of manual.)
The drive is supplied with provision for grounding of cable shields and stress cones near the power terminals.
Power and Control Wiring Drive line-ups (i.e. Drive and Input Starter) which are delivered in two or more sections, for ease of handling, will require that the power and control wiring be re-connected. After the sections are brought together, the power and control wiring is to be re-connected as per the schematic drawings provided.
Control Cables
Control cable entry/exit should be located near the terminal block 'TBC' the customer's connections are to be routed along the empty side of the TBC terminals. These terminals are sized to accept a maximum AWG #14 wire gauge. The low voltage signals (includes 4-20mA) are to be connected using twisted shielded cable, with a minimum AWG #18 wire gauge. (Based on using a W4 terminal block for customer connections, comparable wire sizes would be 0.5 4 mm 2 as equivalent to #22-#10 AWG.)
Of special concern is the tachometer signal. Two tachometer inputs are provided to accommodate a quadrature tachometer (senses motor direction). The tachometer power supply is isolated and provides +15 Volts and a ground reference. Many tachometer outputs have an open collector output, in which case a pull-up resistor must be added to ensure that proper signals are fed to the system logic. (Refer to Appendix A "When is a Tachometer Required?" to see if one needs to be supplied.)
I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T
Low voltage signals are to be connected using twisted shielded cable with the shield connected at the signal source end only. The shield at the other end is to be wrapped with electrical tape and isolated. Connections are to be made as shown on the drawings provided.
Drive Installation 2-39 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 Information regarding termination of customer cables
Customer termination assemblies can accommodate either top or bottom customer cable entry. The assemblies as provided are for bottom cable entry. 4-hole insulator Bolts Customer supplied lugs 4 lugs per phase maximum M10 bus connection hardware Lug pad shown with bottom cable entry orientation
Figure 2.15 Typical Line Cable Termination (assembled for bottom cable entry 18-pulse)
For top line cable entry, it is necessary to remove the lug pads and re-orient them as shown in Figure 2.16. To remove the lug pads, disconnect the M10 bus connection hardware (17 mm hex tooling required). Remove the two bolts that secure the lug pad to the 4-hole insulator. See Appendix B for Torque Values of electrical connections.
Lug pad oriented for top cable entry
Figure 2.16 Typical Line Cable Terminal Assembly (modified for top cable entry 18-pulse) 2-40 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Grounding Practices The purpose of grounding is to:
provide for the safety of personnel limit dangerous voltages on exposed parts with respect to ground facilitate proper over current device operation under ground fault conditions, and provide for electrical interference suppression
I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T
Generally, the means used for external grounding of equipment should be in accordance with the Canadian Electrical Code (CEC), C22.1 or the National Electrical Code (NEC), NFPA 70 and applicable local codes.
Refer to the grounding diagrams that follow for ground connections. The drives main ground bus must be connected to the system ground. This ground bus is the common ground point for all grounds internal to the drive. ISOLATION TRANSFORMER AC MOTOR U (T1) V (T2) W (T3) 2U 2V 2W GROUND BUS Connected to the neutral point of the output capacitor OUTPUT GROUND NETWORK ISOLATION TRANSFORMER AC MOTOR U (T1) V (T2) W (T3) 2U 2V 2W GROUND BUS Connected to the neutral point of the output capacitor OUTPUT GROUND NETWORK
Figure 2.17 Ground Connection Diagram with Isolation Transformer
AC MOTOR U (T1) V (T2) W (T3) 2U 2V 2W GROUND BUS AC REACTOR TRANSFORMER Connected to the neutral point of the output capacitor NOTCH FILTER AC MOTOR U (T1) V (T2) W (T3) 2U 2V 2W GROUND BUS AC REACTOR TRANSFORMER Connected to the neutral point of the output capacitor NOTCH FILTER
Figure 2.18 Ground Connection Diagram with Line Reactor
Each power feeder from the substation transformer to the drive must be provided with properly sized ground cables. Utilizing the conduit or cable armor as a ground on its own is not adequate.
Drive Installation 2-41 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Note that if a drive isolation transformer is used, the WYE secondary neutral point should not be grounded.
Each AC motor frame must be bonded to grounded building steel within 6 m (20 feet) of its location and tied to the drive's ground bus via ground wires within the power cables and/or conduit. The conduit or cable armor should be bonded to ground at both ends.
Grounding Guidelines and Practices for Drive Signal and Safety Grounds
When interface cables carrying signals where the frequency does not exceed 1 MHz are attached for communications with the drive, the following general guidelines should be followed:
It is good practice for the mesh of a screen to be grounded around its whole circumference, rather than forming a pigtail that is grounded at one point.
Coaxial cables with a single conductor surrounded by a mesh screen should have the screen grounded at both ends.
Where a multi-layer screened cable is used (that is, a cable with both a mesh screen and a metal sheath or some form of foil), there are two alternative methods:
The mesh screen may be grounded at both ends to the metal sheath. The metal sheath or foil (known as the drain) should, unless otherwise specified, be grounded at one end only, again, as specified above, at the receiver end or the end which is physically closest to the main equipment ground bus.
or
The metal sheath or foil may be left insulated from ground and the other conductors and the mesh cable screen grounded at one end only as stated above
2-42 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Grounding Practices (cont.) Grounding Requirements and Grounding Specification for Customers and Power Integrators
An external ground must be attached to the main ground bus. The grounding means must comply with applicable local codes and standards. As general guidelines, for information only, the ground path must be of sufficiently low impedance and capacity that:
the rise in potential of the drive ground point when subjected to a current of twice the rating of the supply should be no higher than 4 volts over ground potential.
the current flowing into a ground fault will be of sufficient magnitude to cause the protection to operate.
The main grounding conductor(s) should be run separately from power and signal wiring so that faults:
do not damage the grounding circuit,
or
will not cause undue interference with or damage to protection or metering systems, or cause undue disturbance on power lines.
Identification of Types of Electrical Supplies Grounded and Ungrounded Systems
When dealing with an ungrounded, three-phase electrical supply system, the cable insulation must be capable of handling not only the phase to phase voltage, but also the voltage to ground if one of the other phases develops a ground fault. In practice, the cable insulation of an ungrounded, three-phase system must be good for at least a continuous voltage of root three (1.732) times the rated voltage of the supply.
Ground Bus
The drive ground bus runs along the top of the drive at the front. The ground bus is accessible at the top of each of the drive enclosures when the enclosure door is opened (and the low voltage compartment hinged out in the case of the incomer cabinet). It is the responsibility of the installer to ensure that the drive is grounded properly, typically at the point on the ground bus in the incomer cabinet, close to the incoming power terminations.
Drive Installation 2-43 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 Interlocking Access to the medium voltage areas of the drive is restricted by the use of key interlocking for safety. At installation the key interlocking is set up so that access to the medium voltage compartments of the equipment can only be made when the upstream power is locked in the off position. Additionally, the key interlocking prohibits the upstream power being applied until the medium voltage drives access doors have been closed and locked shut. It is the responsibility of the installer to ensure that the key interlocking is installed properly to the upstream equipment. 2-44 Drive Installation 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Chapter 3 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Operator Interface
Chapter Objectives This chapter describes how you use the operator interface to modify and obtain information contained within the drive. In this chapter you will learn how to: Modify information associated with the initial drive setup. View: - drive parameters, - drive status. View & Reset Alarm Conditions. Request printouts of the information in the drive. Perform diagnostic trending. Modify the operation of the operator interface.
The chapter deals only with the operation of the operator interface. Specific references to a particular parameter are only for illustrative purposes. Refer to Medium Voltage AC Drive Parameters Technical Data (Publication 7000-TD001_-EN-P) for information about the actual 'tags' within the drive and their use.
Terminology Parameter A memory location within the drive to which data may be written to or read. Setting a parameter (i.e. writing to it) will modify how the drive behaves. Prior to using the drive a number of parameters must be set. Additional parameters may be changed while the drive is in use in order to adjust its operation, (i.e. the speed could be changed via a parameter).
Read-only Parameter A memory location which can only be read. A read-only parameter contains real-time data and is used to read the current conditions within the drive, such as running speed.
Tag A generic reference to either a parameter or a read-only parameter.
PanelView 550 The PanelView 550 is a product marketed by Rockwell Automation consisting of a hardware terminal and a software package, integrated into a single product. The Medium Voltage Drive only uses the hardware portion of the product and has replaced the software package. 3-2 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
PowerFlex Operator interface References to the operator interface refer to the product consisting of the PanelView 550 interface hardware and the unique software contained within it, which allows it to function with the Medium Voltage Drive.
Editing Field An area of a screen that is displayed in reverse video. When the field is in this state, data may be entered into it via the keypad.
XIO the eXternal Inputs and Output adapters used by the drive to interface hardwired signals to the drive.
Operation A task which is to be performed. In order to complete the task, a number of screens may be involved; i.e. selecting a parameter is an operation that requires at minimum two screens. This operation itself is an operation of modifying a parameter.
NVRAM Non-Volatile Random Access Memory. This is memory that is not affected by loss of power. It is used for long term storage of data such as parameters and alarm queues.
Flash A type of memory technology which will indefinitely store information and is unaffected by power loss. It is used for storage of firmware, parameters and data files.
PCMCIA A standard for flash memory cards. Personal Computer Memory Card International Association.
Operator Interface 3-3 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Overview The operator interface used on the PowerFlex 7000 Medium Voltage Drive is that of the PanelView 550 terminal (Figure 3.1). This terminal however does not behave as a PanelView, as only the hardware for the operator interface has been utilized. The PanelView software has been replaced with unique software to tailor it to the requirements of the Medium Voltage Drive, and its faceplate has been modified (Figure 3.1).
Keypad The keypad of the operator interface consists of two rows of five function keys (item 1 of Figure 3.1) located below the operator interface 's display area (item 4 of Figure 3.1). In the lower right corner of the operator interface are four keys, which will be referred to as the cursor keys (item 2 of Figure 3.1). Above the cursor keys are data entry keys consisting of the numeric values 0-9, a decimal point (.), a negative (-), a backspace key and a data entry key (item 3 of Figure 3.1).
All keys are of a membrane type. The key is executed upon release.
Function (Softkeys) Keys
Along the bottom of the display area is one or two rows of 'Softkeys'. These 'Softkeys' represent the physical function keys. The function of the actual keys will vary between displays. The bottom row of keys (i.e. F6-F10) is always shown. The upper row is shown only if they are required for keys (F2-F5). Thus a single row of 'Softkeys' always refers to the keys F6-F10.
3-4 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Even though the upper row of Softkeys (i.e. F1-F5) may not be shown on some displays, the F1-HELP key is always active. (F2-F5) are only active if shown.
Cursor (Selection) Keys
The cursor keys are normally used to select an item on the display. When an item on the display is selected, that item will be displayed in reverse video. To change the selection, press the key in the desired direction.
On selection screens having more than one page, the page will automatically change when the cursor is moved beyond the displayed list.
Some displays, such as the Utility screen, use these keys to modify the data value. Pressing the [cursor up] and [cursor down] keys will change the value by a fine amount, i.e. 1 unit. Using the [cursor left] and [cursor right] keys will change the value by a course amount, i.e. 10 units.
For entries requiring a HEX value, the keys (cursor up/down) are used to scroll to the desired HEX value.
For parameters which contain an Enumeration string, pressing either the up or down key will provide a list of options to pick from. Using the cursor keys, make a selection and press enter. If more options exist than can be displayed on the screen, a triangle symbol or inverted triangle to the right of the list will show that there are more selections available in the indicated direction. Continue to use the up/down cursor keys to move to these additional selections.
For parameters that are comprised of bit fields, the left/right keys are used to move to the desired bit field. The up and down keys toggle the bit between its possible states.
All four cursor keys have an auto feature such that after holding the key for 2 seconds, the key will automatically repeat at a rate of 5 presses per second.
Data Entry Keys
As the name implies, these keys are used to enter data. Pressing the keys [0] to [9] will enter the corresponding value into the 'editing field'. Pressing the [-] key will change the value to a negative number. Pressing the [.] will allow a fractional value to be entered. Operator Interface 3-5 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
While entering a value, the value may be edited using the [backspace] key. This key will remove the right most digit (or decimal point or negative). The help screen uses the backspace key to return to the previous level of help.
The enter key varies depending on the screen. If you are in the process of a selection operation, the enter key will accept the selection and proceed to a different screen based on the selection in order to complete the operation. If you are in the process of entering data, the enter key will accept the edited data.
What is a Screen? The operator interface uses menu driven screens to perform various operations on the drive. You can think of a screen as a window or template, overlaying data from the drive. The operator interface combines a screen with the drive data, to formulate what you see on the display area of the operator interface. Individual screens display a particular type of data and allow selected operations to be performed on this data. A number of different screens may be used while performing a single operation.
Components
Although the data displayed on any particular screen will vary, the general makeup of a screen is the same for all. Figure 3.2 shows a typical screen and its components.
Screen Name Softkeys Heartbeat Selected Item Page Number
Figure 3.2 Screen Components
3-6 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
The upper left-hand corner contains the name of the screen (i.e. SELECT GROUP:). Knowing the name of the screen will assist you in the orientation of the menu system. On some screens to the right of the screen name, will be the name of the selected item from the previous screen as shown in Figure 3.3.
Some screens have more than one page associated with them. The current page number and the number of pages which make up the data currently being displayed on the screen is shown in the upper right hand corner, (i.e. showing page 1 of 2 pages).
Along the bottom of the screen are one or two rows of 'Softkeys' which represent the assignment to the actual function keys. In Figure 3.2, Softkeys F6-F10 are shown. Pressing F8 will display the next page of data.
In the very lower right-hand corner is a small dot. This dot indicates the healthy state of the operator interface terminal. Under normal conditions this dot will flash at a rate of .5 Hz. During communication errors, the dot will flash at a rate of .1 Hz.
Figure 3.3 Screen Name & Item
The remainder of the screen shows the data from the drive. The presentation of the data is dependent on the screen. Screens that allow an item to be selected show the current selection in reverse video. An example of this is shown in Figure 3.2 in which the Speed Control group is selected.
Information Windows
Numerous screens require communications with the drive in order to function. At times, the duration of this activity will be noticeable to you. During this activity, a special 'window' is used within the current screen to inform you of this activity. The time required for the activity will vary. Operator Interface 3-7 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Accessing/Writing to Drive
When first powered up, the operator interface knows very little about the information in the drive. As each screen is activated, the operator interface requests information from the drive, which it will store within the operator interface for future reference. When the operator interface requests information from the drive, a window is used to display a message "Accessing Drive ...". During this time, the operator interface will not respond to any user input, until the task at hand is completed. You will notice that subsequent activation of the same screen for the same data will be much quicker since the operator interface already has most or all of its required information.
You can selectively choose to download the complete database to the operator interface on command, thus eliminating the initial access delays. If uninterrupted, the operator interface will automatically download the database on power-up, or during periods of inactivity. Refer to the section on "Advanced Screen Operations - Database Download".
Some screens require that information be written to the drive. During this task, a window is used to display the message "Writing to Drive... During this time, the operator interface will not respond to any user input, until the task at hand is completed.
Communication Error
While the operator interface is reading or writing to the drive, it is possible for communications to be disrupted for a number of reasons. If this were to occur, a special window is used to inform you of this. During this time, the operator interface will not respond to any user input, until the task at hand is completed.
The window for the "Communication Error" can take on two forms. If a window has already been displayed showing "Accessing Drive" or Writing to Drive", then the communication error message will be added to the window already in use. Some screens constantly read from the drive in order to show real-time data. An example of this is the 'Top Level Menu. When a communication error occurs on a screen showing real-time data, a window is opened showing a box around the "Communication Error". Two examples of this are shown in Figures 3.4 and 3.5.
In both cases, once communications has been re-established, the information window will be removed and the operator interface will return to normal operation.
3-8 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Figure 3.4 Communications Error
Figure 3.5 Communications Error
Language Changing
When the language used by the drive changes, (either via the operator interface or an external device), the operator interface must do considerable work. The database strings are all invalidated, the character set for the server is changed and all strings used by the operator interface are linked to the new language. During this possibly lengthy process, the Language Changing ... message is displayed.
General Operation
The operations that can be performed on a screen vary depending on the actual screen being displayed. The majority of the operations are activated by the function keys located along the bottom of the screen. Although the meaning of these keys do change from one screen to the next, there are some functions which are available on most screens and always have the same assignment. Operator Interface 3-9 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
The operations for these latter keys will not be explained within the description of individual screen operations. They are explained here and apply equally to all screens.
F1 - Help
This operation is active on every screen, even if the 'Softkey' is not displayed. Help is context sensitive and will display help that relates to the screen that you are currently viewing.
F6 - Alarms
The F6 'Softkey' will always get you to the Alarm Summary Screen. A new alarm will cause this key to flash in reverse video.
F8 - Next Page
When a screen is capable of displaying data that requires more than one page, this 'Softkey' will be active. The 'Softkey' will increment the page number being viewed.
F9 - Previous Page
When a screen is capable of displaying data that requires more than one page, this 'Softkey' will be active. The 'Softkey' will decrement the page number being viewed.
F10 - Exit
When you are viewing any screen other than the Top Level Menu, this 'Softkey' will return you to the previous screen.
Operator Interface Power-up When the operator interface is powered up or reset, it will go Sequence through two noticeable operations:
a) Linking to Drive - During this phase the operator interface is establishing communications with the drive communications board. The screen will also show information about the software product contained in the PowerFlex operator interface, such as: - software part number and revision level, - date and time stamp of program creation. 3-10 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
b) Obtaining Drive Database - During this phase, the database of information about the drive is obtained from the drive. Obtaining the database at this point in time is optional and may be aborted by pressing any key on the operator interface. Obtaining the entire database does however speed up subsequent operations since relevant portions of the database do not have to be obtained. (Without obtaining the entire database, the operator interface will access portions of the drive database as required. This slows down the first access to the operation that requires the data. Subsequent operations requiring the same data are not affected). Aborting the download will not affect portions of the database already obtained. Once the database has been obtained, the operator interface will start up in one of two modes, depending on to what degree the drive has previously been configured:
a) On an unconfigured drive, the operator interface will enter the 'Setup Wizard' mode. Until the user has gone through the entire 'Setup Wizard', this will be the default mode to power up in. The 'Setup Wizard' can be cancelled at any time by pressing the appropriate softkey. b) Once the drive has been configured through the 'Setup Wizard', the Top Level Menu, will be displayed from this point forward. The 'Setup Wizard' can be re-entered via the Setup Menu.
Operator Interface 3-11 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Top Level Menu This screen (Figure 3.6) represents the main menu from which all other screens (and the operations which they perform) are activated. To activate an operation, simply press the function key corresponding to the 'Softkey' shown on the screen. A screen for that operation will be displayed. Refer to the section entitled "How To:" for information about the various operations which may be performed.
The screen identifies the drive product to which the operator interface is attached and its overall state of operation. Four digital meters show four selected parameters located in the drive. A Hobbs meter displays the number of hours that the drive has been running.
The status of the drive will show one of the following:
NOT READY drive is not ready to start READY drive will start when commanded FORWARD RUN drive is running in the forward direction REVERSE RUN drive is running in the reverse direction WARNING drive has a warning FAULTED the drive is faulted DISCHARGING waiting for input filter capacitors to discharge on a PWM rectifier before restart
Figure 3.6 Top Level Menu
3-12 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame How To: The following sections describe how to perform the various operations on the drive, using the operator interface. Throughout the discussion, a number of screens will be used to achieve the desired operation. In many cases, the same screen will be used for more than one operation, however with possibly different data from the drive.
Throughout the section, you want to focus on how the operation is performed. The operator interface will take care of what screens are needed to perform the operation.
Obtain Help
Help is obtained for any screen by pressing the [F1] function key. Figure 3.7 shows the help screen, which is displayed for the Top Level Menu. After the name of the screen (i.e. HELP:) is the name of the screen for which help is being accessed. (In this case the name of the Top Level Menu is REV.) This particular help screen contains three pages. To view page two, press the [F8] key. Page 2 is displayed. To return to page 1, press the [F9] key.
You can return to the original screen from which you asked for help at any time by pressing the [F10] key.
Figure 3.7 Typical Help Screen
Related Topics
All of the help screens will have additional topics relating to the help currently being displayed. These topics are highlighted just above the Softkeys. Additional topics are selected via the [cursor left] and [cursor right] keys. Figure 3.7 shows the additional topic of "SOFTKEYS" selected. To access this information, press the [enter] key.
The help for the additional topic will be displayed as in Figure 3.8 . As with the original help screen, the related topic help may also have related topics. Operator Interface 3-13 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Press the [backspace] key to return to the previous level of help, (i.e. the previous related topic. To exit help completely press [F10] to return to the screen from which help was called.
Figure 3.8 Help on Related Topic (Softkey)
Help on Help
The previous sections described how you could access help for a particular screen, by pressing the [F1] key while on that screen. This also applies while in any of the help screens.
Pressing [F1] while in a help screen will give you a help screen describing how to use the help system. An example of a screen giving help on the help system is shown in Figure 3.9. As with the help screens previously described, the screens will contain related topics.
To return to a previous screen of help information, press the [backspace] key. To return to the screen from which help was originally accessed, press the [F10] key.
Figure 3.9 Help on Help
3-14 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame Modify Operator Interface The utility operation of screens change the characteristics of Operation (Utility) the operator interface. Within this operation you will: Set the clock and calendar Change the delay for the display backlight shutoff Change the contrast of the display Define the meters that will be displayed on the Top Level Menu View the revision levels of all software in the drive line-up. Transfer data between the operator interface flash memory, flash memory card and the drive. Load a new language module.
You will access the Utility operation from the Top Level Menu by pressing the [F2] key. This results in the display of the screen shown in Figure 3.10 .
In all operations on this screen, the value currently being acted upon is shown in reverse video. Only when the value is in this state, may it be modified.
Figure 3.10 Utility Operation Screen
Changing Backlight Delay
The display of the operator interface is only readable with the aid of a backlight. In order to preserve the life of the lamp that provides this, the backlighting is automatically shut off after a duration of inactivity on the keypad. The backlight is restored by pressing any key. The pressed key will not have any other affect on the operator interface when pressed with the backlight off. Operator Interface 3-15 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
To change the duration of the delay, press the [F2] key. The current backlight delay will be shown in reverse video (Figure 3.11). The value can be adjusted from 0 to 60 minutes. A value of zero (0) will disable the delay, keeping the light on indefinitely. Press the [cursor up] or [cursor down] keys to change the value by a resolution of 1 minute. Press the [cursor left] and [cursor right] keys to change the value by a resolution of 10 minutes. To abort the change, press the [backspace] key and the setting will return to its original value. To accept the change press the [enter] key. The backlight delay has been saved.
The setting may also be aborted by pressing any of the assigned function keys (other than F1). The function associated with that key will be executed.
Figure 3.11 Utility Light
Changing Contrast
The contrast controls the horizontal angle to which the display may be viewed. To change the contrast, press the [F3] key. The current value of the contrast will be shown in reverse video (Figure 3.12). Press the [cursor up] or [cursor down] keys to change the value of the contrast. The screen will change instantly to show the effect of the change. To abort the change, press the [backspace] key and the setting will return to its original value. To accept the change press the [enter] key. The contrast setting has been saved.
The setting may also be aborted by pressing any of the assigned function keys (other than F1). The function associated with that key will be executed.
3-16 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Figure 3.12 Utility Contrast
Setting Time
The clock setting controls the time stamp that the drive uses on the information contained on the alarm summary screen. To change the time, press the [F5] key. The hours position of the clock will be in reverse video (Figure 3.13). Press the [cursor up] or [cursor down] keys to change the value by a resolution of 1 unit. Press the [cursor left] and [cursor right] keys to change the value by a resolution of 10 units. To change the minutes press the [F5] key again and repeat the procedure. Likewise to change the seconds press the [F5] key again. Each press of the [F5] key will highlight the next position of the clock. The highlighted position may be modified via the cursor keys.
To abort the change, press the [backspace] key and the clock will return to its original time. To accept the change press the [enter] key. The new clock setting has been recorded.
The setting may also be aborted by pressing any of the assigned function keys (other than F1 and F5). The function associated with that key will be executed.
Figure 3.13 Utility Time
Operator Interface 3-17 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Setting Date
The calendar setting controls the date stamp that the drive uses on the information contained on the alarm summary screen. To change the date, press the [F4] key. The year position of the calendar will be in reverse video (Figure 3.14). Press the [cursor up] or [cursor down] keys to change the value by a resolution of 1 unit. Press the [cursor left] and [cursor right] keys to change the value by a resolution of 10 units. To change the month press the [F4] key again and repeat the procedure. Likewise, to change the day, press the [F4] key again. Each press of the [F4] key will highlight the next position of the calendar. The highlighted position may be modified via the cursor keys.
To abort the change, press the [backspace] key and the calendar will return to its original date. To accept the change press the [enter] key. The new calendar setting has been recorded.
The setting may also be aborted by pressing any of the assigned function keys (other than F1 and F4). The function associated with that key will be executed.
You can not set the day of the week. The operator interface will determine the day of the week based on the date that you set in the calendar.
Figure 3.14 Utility Date
Selecting Meters
The utility screen (Figure 3.10 ) shows the four tags assigned to the four meters on the 'Top Level Menu'. Pressing the [F8] key can change these. This displays a new screen (Figure 3.15) from which the selection and text associated with the meter is changed.
3-18 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Figure 3.15 Utility Meter
To change the tag attach to a meter, use the [cursor up] and [cursor down] keys to highlight the desired meter and press the [enter] key. (If nothing happens then you have not gained the required access to make changes.) Press the [F8] key in order to gain access and refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level .
This will begin the selection process of a tag as described in the section entitled "Select a Parameter". When you have completed the selection process, the selected tag will be assigned to the meter (i.e. V Line). The name of the meter will have been changed to a default string as shown in Figure 3.16 for meter 2.
Figure 3.16 Utility Meter V Line
The text consists of 8 characters. This text is displayed on the Top Level Menu along with the value and units of the tag. Select the meter that you wish to modify via the [cursor up] and [cursor down] keys. To modify the text, press the [cursor right] key. (If nothing happens then you have not gained the required access to make changes. Press the [F8] key in order to gain access and refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level .
The first character position of the string will be in reverse video as shown in Figure 3.17. Refer to the section entitled "Edit Text". Operator Interface 3-19 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 3.17 Edit the Text
When editing is complete, the screen will appear as in Figure 3.18.
Figure 3.18 Editing Completed
The operator interface contains a default set of meters. This default set is selected by pressing the [F2] key any time the 'Meters' screen is displayed. This results in the default text and tags as shown in Figure 3.15.
The changes made do not take affect until you press [F10] and exit the screen. Any time prior to this you may cancel all of the changes made after coming to the screen by pressing the [F7] key.
The result of selecting the V Line tag for meter 2 (in our example) is shown in Figure 3.19 after the METERS screen was exited.
Figure 3.19 Top Level Meter Modified
3-20 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Viewing Revision Levels
For the purpose of maintenance or upgrading of software, the revision levels of all the software contained in the terminal and the drive may be viewed. To access this screen, press the [F9] key.
A screen typical of Figure 3.20 shows: the type of drive a 16-character , user definable string to uniquely identify a drive revision level of the terminal software and its part number revision level of the bootcode contained in the terminal revision level of various boards contained in the drive. These are identified by name.
Figure 3.20 Utility Rev Level
To modify the user definable text string, press the [F8] key. (If nothing happens then you have not gained the required access to make changes. Exit to the Top Level Menu screen and refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level .)
A screen typical of Figure 3.21 will be displayed. To modify the text refer to the section entitled "Edit Text", noting the following exception. When the text has been entered (as in Figure 3.22) the enter key has no effect. Simply press the exit key [F10] to accept the edited string.
Prior to exiting the screen, the string can be returned to its state upon entry to the screen by pressing the [F7] key. Operator Interface 3-21 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 3.21 Edit the Drive Name
Figure 3.22 Editing Completed
Transfer Data in Memory
The operator interface contains long term storage in two forms. Flash memory contained in the operator interface is used to store the firmware and optionally language modules and parameters used in the drive. This information can also be stored on a removable flash card that can be taken to another drive.
In order to transfer information from the two forms of memory, press the [F7] key. This displays a new screen (Figure 3.87) from which all flash memory operations are performed. Refer to the section entitled Flash Memory Transfers for instructions on these features.
Picking an Access Level
Access Levels are used in the drive to protect parameters from unauthorized changes and to filter out the amount of information viewed. Each access level takes on the parameters and permissions of the lower access levels.
The default access level is 'Monitor'. In this level, only a small subset of the parameter database is viewable. No changes are allowed to any configuration information.
3-22 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame The next level is 'Basic'. This level and all levels above it allow changes to be made to any parameter that can be viewed. The number of parameters viewable increases from the previous level. This level will be sufficient for configuring and maintaining the drive for the majority of applications.
The last level intended for normal operation is the 'Advanced' level. From this level, the drive can be configured in its entirety.
Two additional levels are used for trained service personal and are only used when physical hardware changes are made to the drive.
Individual PIN numbers protects all levels, except the first. Use the up/down cursor keys to select the desired access level. Then enter the PIN value for the given access level and press [enter]. If the correct PIN was entered, the access level will change.
Refer to Enter/Modify an Access Level for complete information on the use of Access Levels.
Select a Parameter Various operations require that a parameter be selected. All selection operations are done via one of three methods described in this section. All parameters are organized into groups. Selecting via groups is the default method.
The screens associated with the selection process are called automatically as part of the operation from other screens.
Via Groups
This is the default screen (Figure 3.23) used in the selection of a parameter. It shows all the groups that are accessible for the operation currently being performed. For example: if you are selecting a parameter, any groups that are showing read-only parameters only will not be shown. The current access level will also affect the number of groups that are currently viewable, and can be selected from. If more than one page of groups exist, press the [F8] and [F9] keys to view the other pages.
Press the [cursor up] or [cursor down] keys to select the desired group, (i.e. reverse video the group name). Press the [enter] key. The SELECT screen (Figure 3.24) is displayed showing the members of the selected group. The name of the selected group currently being displayed is shown after the screen name, i.e. Motor Ratings. Again using the [cursor up] or [cursor down] keys, and if required the [F8] and [F9] keys to change the page, select the desired tag. Press the [enter] key and the selected tag will be used to continue the operation for which the selection process was being used.
Operator Interface 3-23 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 3.23 Selecting a Group
Figure 3.24 Selecting a Member of a Group
From the SELECT GROUP screen (Figure 3.23), the tag can also be selected via its name by pressing the [F7] key.
Via Name
When you know the name of the tag that you wish to select but do not know what group it belongs to or are unsure of the full name, this method of selection may be appropriate.
Selecting via a name is initiated from the SELECT GROUP screen (Figure 3.23) by pressing the [F7] key. This displays the SELECT LETTER screen shown in Figure 3.25.
Using the cursor keys, select (i.e. reverse video) the letter with which the desired tag starts with. The [cursor up] and [cursor down] keys move vertically within a column, the [cursor left] and [cursor right] key move laterally within the rows. When the appropriate letter has been selected, press the [enter] key. 3-24 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
All tags which begin with that letter, and are appropriate for the operation on which the selection is being performed, will be displayed as in Figure 3.26. Using the [cursor up] or [cursor down] keys, and if required the [F8] and [F9] keys to change the page, select the desired tag. Press the [enter] key and the selected tag will be used to continue the operation for which the selection process was being used.
From either of these two screens (SELECT LETTER or SELECT LIST) you can return directly to the default selection method via groups by pressing the [F7] key.
Figure 3.25 Selecting via a Letter (Step 1)
Figure 3.26 Selecting Name via List (Step 2)
From the SELECT LETTER screen (Figure 3.25) the tag may also be selected via a code by pressing the [F5] key.
Via Code
This method of selecting a tag is initiated from the SELECT LETTER screen (Figure 3.25) by pressing the [F5] key. It allows you to select the tag, given that you know the tag code associated with the desired tag. Every parameter (i.e. tag) has a unique code associated to identify it to devices incapable of making decisions based on a name, such as a PLC for example.
Operator Interface 3-25 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Use the data entry keys [0]-[9] to enter the desired code on the SELECT CODE screen (Figure 3.27). The entered code may be edited using the [backspace] key. Press the [enter] key.
Figure 3.27 Select via Code (Step 1)
The screen will display one of two formats. If the code you entered was valid, it will show the name of the tag associated with the code (Figure 3.28). This allows you to verify that this was the tag that you intended to select with the code before proceeding. If correct, press the [enter] key. If incorrect, immediately repeat the process by typing in another code. If the tag code was not valid, a message indicating such is displayed as in Figure 3.29.
Figure 3.28 Valid Tag Code
Figure 3.29 Invalid Tag Code
3-26 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
When the [enter] key is pressed for a valid tag code (i.e. Figure 3.28) the selected tag will be used to continue the operation for which the selection process was being used if that tag is appropriate for the operation. For example: if you are performing a parameter modification operation, but have selected a read-only parameter tag code, you will be unable to exit the screen with this read-only parameter. The screen will display this information, along with the tag's current value, such as shown in Figure 3.30. Re-enter a tag code for a parameter or press [F10] to return to the previous screen without making a selection.
Figure 3.30 Selected Tag Inappropriate
Edit Text Various operations require a text string to be entered. Operations requiring this are: - setting external faults - adding text to selected Top Level Menu meters - identifying the drive with a text string - entering a filename
The operator interface's keypad does not contain any alpha keys to allow direct input of the characters. This section will describe the operation for which characters may be entered.
Figure 3.31 Typical Text Edit Screen
Operator Interface 3-27 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
The screen shown in Figure 3.31 is typical of all screens using the edit text operation. All screens have the F3, F4 and F5 keys in common (if applicable). Once in the 'editing field' all operations are performed on the character in reverse video.
Pressing the [cursor left] and [cursor right] keys will move to the next character position in the string. Pressing the [cursor up] and [cursor down] keys will cycle through the characters contained in a set, each time the key is pressed. Note that when the first member of a set is displayed, pressing [cursor down] will wrap around to the last member of the set.
There are four sets of characters available. Press the [F3] key to cycle among the sets. The sets consist of: a) the upper case letters A-Z. b) the lower case letters a-z. c) the numbers 0-9 and the characters '.' and '-'. d) the characters: space _ ( ) [ ] { } < > | @ # $ % & * ! ^ + = ; : ?
Note: these character set may vary depending on the language selected.
A special set consisting of A-Z, 0-9 and the underscore character are used for filenames and cannot be selected via the [F3] key or modified by the [F5] key.
When a letter is in the editing field, pressing the [F5] key may change its case.
To delete the entire string (i.e. fill it with spaces), press the [F4] key.
To abort the changes to the string being edited press the [backspace] key. This will restore the string to its contents when the screen was first entered.
The editing operation is completed by pressing the [enter] key. Changes are not permanently made until the screen is exited via the [F10] key.
Note: The characters entered may only be valid for the currently selected language. Any characters used which are unique for a given language (i.e. other than the four sets defined above) can only be meaningfully displayed in the selected language, because other languages do not contain the appropriate display characters.
3-28 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame Configure the Drive In order to tailor the drive to your motor and application, a number of elements must be defined in the drive. The section describes how you will set or 'configure' these elements of the drive, via this operator interface. You will learn how to: Change a parameter setting. Assign a parameter to an Analog Port. Selectively enable or disable (i.e. Mask) certain faults. Define your own faults attached to external inputs. Configure the XIO Define the information sent to your optional PLC connection. Save and Restore your settings in the drive. Select an alternate language (if previously loaded in operator interface).
There are two methods to configure the drive. This section defines the more complete method to configure the drive for any application. The drive may also be configured for the majority of applications by using the Setup Wizard. The Setup Wizard can be entered from the "SETUP" screen by selecting the 'Setup Wizard' from the list of options and pressing [enter].
Regardless of the method used for configuration, the default factory parameters will be obtained from the Drive Identity Module (DIM) if it exists on the Customer Interface Board. The use of the DIM allows each drive to be customized at the factory to the intended application, using all known information at the time of building the drive.
Enter/Modify an Access Level
The drive is protected from unauthorized changes via passwords consisting of a number between 0 and 65535. These passwords are associated with Access Levels. Each Access Level, (except for the first one 'Monitor') has its own password number (PIN). These values can be unique or all can be set to the same value.
The default level, 'Monitor' does not have a PIN associated with it. With this Access Level, the drive configuration can be viewed, but no changes are allowed to the parameters. In addition to providing the protection, the Access Levels also filter out the amount of information that can be viewed at each level. On any level, other than 'Monitor', any information that can be viewed may also be modified. Operator Interface 3-29 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
The screen shown in Figure 3.32 is accessible from within a number of screens where the Access Level affects the operation of subsequent operations, such as: 1) [F10] key on the Top Level Menu, 2) [F8] key on the Modify Parameter screen, 3) [F8] key on the Setup Screen, 4) [F8] key on the Transfer Screen, 5) [F8] key on the Diagnostic Setup screen.
Figure 3.32 Access Screen
The Current Access level is shown. To select a different access level, use the up/down cursor keys to select the desired the level. Then enter the password value (PIN) for that level using the data entry keys. The value can be any number between 0 and 65535. As the number is entered via the keys [0]-[9], the value will be shown by a placeholder (i.e. * in the editing field), as shown in Figure 3.33.
Figure 3.33 Pin Entry
The value may be edited by using the [backspace] key. When the value has been typed in, press the [enter] key. If the correct PIN was entered, the access level of the operator interface will change as shown in Figure 3.34 . If the incorrect value was entered, the operator interface will remain at the current access level.
3-30 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Figure 3.34 Access Level Changed
When the desired operations have been completed, the operator interface should be placed back to the 'Monitor' level in order to protect against unauthorized modifications. From this screen press the [F8] key. The level will change back to 'Monitor' as shown in Figure 3.32.
The default value for the password (PIN) of the 'Basic' and 'Advanced' levels is zero (0), or simply pressing the [enter] key. This value can be changed from the ACCESS screen. First use the up/down cursor keys to select the level for which you wish to modify the PIN. Press the [F9] key. The typical PASSWORD CHANGE screen shown in Figure 3.35 is displayed, showing the Access Level for which the new PIN will be applied to.
Figure 3.35 PIN Change
Enter the current PIN value via the data keys [0]-[9] and press the [enter] key. As in the ACCESS screen, the entered value is shown via placeholders and may be edited with the [backspace] key.
If you entered the correct PIN, the screen now asks you for the new PIN. Type in the new PIN value using the data entry keys [0]-[9] followed by the [enter] key. The screen now asks you to verify the new PIN. Type in the new PIN again followed by the [enter] key as shown in Figure 3.36.
Operator Interface 3-31 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 3.36 PIN Change Completed
At the end of the operation you will see a status as shown in either Figures 3.36, 3.37 or 3.38 depending on whether you successfully changed the PIN, incorrectly entered the existing PIN or incorrectly verified the new PIN.
Figure 3.37 Invalid PIN
Figure 3.38 Invalid PIN Verification
If you were not successful in changing the password, simply start over again by typing in the current password value. 3-32 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Drive Setup This section describes how to: select an alternate language enter data to a drive parameter assign a tag to an analog port enable and disable a fault via a mask assign text to be associated with optional external fault inputs re-enter Setup Wizard configure the XIO link define the tags to be accessible by a PLC.
You will access the "SETUP" screen from the Top Level Menu by pressing the [F8] key. This will result in the typical screen shown in Figure 3.39 .
The Current Access level is shown. If it states 'Monitor' then you are restricted to only viewing the basic drive setup. You cannot make any changes. You must be in at least the 'Basic' access level in order to modify any of the drive parameters, and you may only modify the parameters for which you can view at the given access level.
At power-up, the operator interface access level is 'Monitor'. If this is the current mode and you wish to change any of the setup data, press the [F8] key now in order to change the access level before proceeding into any of the other setup operations available from this screen (Figure 3.40). Refer to the section Enter/Modify an Access Level .
Figure 3.39 Setup Screen
Operator Interface 3-33 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 3.40 Basic Access Level
Language Selection
The drive is capable of supporting multiple languages. The operator interface supports these languages via language modules which must initially be loaded via the flash card (refer to the section Flash Memory Transfers).
To select an alternate language, press the [F9] key on the SETUP screen. The screen will show all language modules currently loaded as in Figure 3.41. Associated with each language is a module revision level. Use the [cursor up] and [cursor down] keys to select the desired language and press the [enter] key.
The operator interface will switch to the new language selected. It is possible for other devices attached to the drive to request a language change. If this occurs, the operator interface will switch to the new language, if the required language module is loaded.
Figure 3.41 Language Selection
3-34 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Modify Parameters To change a parameter, Use the up/down arrow keys on the SETUP screen to select the 'Parameters' option and press the [enter] key. This will begin the selection process of a parameter as described in the section entitled "Select a Parameter". The selection process to change a parameter can also be initiated while displaying the members of a parameter group on the DISPLAY screen (Figure 3.68) by pressing the [F7] key.
When you have successfully selected a parameter, one of three possible screens will be displayed depending on the type of parameter.
Numerical Value
When the parameter is a numerical value, the MODIFY PARAMETER screen typical of Figure 3.42 will be displayed. This screen shows:
the name of the parameter for which you are making the changes (i.e. Rated motor volt). the tag code for the parameter, (i.e. 22). the minimum and maximum allowable limits to which the parameter must be set, (i.e. 4000 to 4160). the units in which the parameter data is being displayed the actual value of the parameter contained in the drive.
Figure 3.42 Parameter Data Entry
Operator Interface 3-35 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 3.43 Modify Numerical Value
To be allowed to make changes to the parameter, the operator interface must be set to an Access Level other than 'Monitor'. (You will be able to view the screen; however, pressing the data entry keys will have no effect). If you are not in the correct level, press the [F8] key in order to gain access to the parameter. Refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level for further information on the operation to change the level.
Having gained access, use the data entry keys [0]-[9] to enter the new value. The [-] key can be typed at any time to enter a negative value. The [.] key is used to enter a decimal point for fractional values. The entered new value can be edited by pressing the [backspace] key. This key will delete the right most character (i.e. number, decimal point or negative sign) shown on the screen. Press the [enter] key to accept the new value as shown in Figure 3.43. If the new value that you entered is outside the limits defined, the new value will not change. For example: If you entered 900 when the minimum value was 4000, the new value will still show 4100.
Some data must be entered in HEX. To accomplish this, use the cursor up/down keys to scroll through the values 0-F for the right most digit. To accept the digit and enter to the right of the current digit, press the right cursor key. Press the [Enter] key to accept the value.
The value may be edited the same as a value entered from the numeric keypad.
The new value is not sent to the drive until you exit the screen with the [F10] key. Prior to this you can modify the new value by repeating the above procedure, or you can cancel the change by pressing the [F7] key. The CANCEL operation returns the new value to that of the actual value.
3-36 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame Enumerated Value
When the parameter is an enumerated value, the MODIFY PARAMETER screen typical of Figure 3.44 will be displayed. This screen shows: the name of the parameter for which you are make the changes (i.e. Operating Mode) the tag code for the parameter (i.e. 4) the actual value of the parameter contained in the drive.
Figure 3.44 Modify Enumerated Value
Figure 3.45 Option List Viewed on Single Page
To be allowed to make changes to the parameter, the operator interface must be set to an Access Level other than 'Monitor'. (You will be able to view the screen; however, pressing the data entry keys will have no effect). If you are not in the correct level, press the [F8] key in order to gain access to the parameter. Refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level for further information on the operation to change the level.
Having gained access, press the up or down cursor keys to obtain a list of possible options to select from. Use the up/down arrow keys to move the highlighting to the desired option (Figure 3.45). If more options exist then what can be displayed on a single screen, a triangle or inverted triangle symbol will indicate in which direction the list can be expanded (Figure 3.46). Operator Interface 3-37 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Use the up/down cursor keys to scroll onto these additional options. Press the [enter] key to accept the new value as shown in Figure 3.47.
Figure 3.46 Option List Viewed on Multiple Pages
Figure 3.47 Modification Completed
The new value is not sent to the drive until you exit the screen with the [F10] key. Prior to this you can modify the new value by repeating the above procedure, or you can cancel the change by pressing the [F7] key. The CANCEL operation returns the new value to that of the actual value.
Bit Encoded Value
When the parameter is a bit encoded value, the MODIFY PARAMETER screen typical of Figure 3.48 will be displayed. This screen shows: the name of the parameter for which you are make the changes (i.e. Logic Mask) the tag code for the parameter (i.e. 241) the name of the bit currently selected (Adapter 0) the actual value of the parameter bits contained in the drive.
3-38 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Figure 3.48 Modify Bit Encoded Value
To be allowed to make changes to the parameter, the operator interface must be set to an Access Level other than 'Monitor'. (You will be able to view the screen; however, pressing the data entry keys will have no effect). If you are not in the correct level, press the [F8] key in order to gain access to the parameter. Refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level for further information on the operation to change the level.
Having gained access, press the left/right cursor keys to move to the various bits within the parameter. As each bit is selected, the name of the bit is displayed. Use the up/down arrow keys to toggle the state of the bit.
The new value is not sent to the drive until you exit the screen with the [F10] key. Prior to this you can modify the new value by repeating the above procedure, or you can cancel the change by pressing the [F7] key. The CANCEL operation returns the new value to that of the actual value.
Analog Ports
The drive contains a number of external analog ports to which you can assign any parameter. To setup an analog port, use the up/down arrow keys on the SETUP screen to select the 'Analog' option and press the [enter] key.
This will display a screen as shown in Figure 3.49 . The screen shows the current tags and their tag code, which are associated with each of the analog ports. To change the tag attached to a port, use the [cursor up] and [cursor down] keys to highlight the desired port and press the [enter] key. (If nothing happens then you have not gained the required access to make changes. Exit to the SETUP screen and refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level to gain access). Operator Interface 3-39 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 3.49 Analog Setup
This will begin the selection process of a tag as described in the section entitled "Select a Parameter". When you have completed the selection process, the selected tag will be assigned to the port. To remove an assignment to the highlighted port, press the [delete] (Backspace) key.
The changes made do not take affect until you press [F10] and exit the screen. Any time prior to this you may cancel all of the changes made after coming to the screen by pressing the [F7] key.
Fault Masks
A number of the faults within the drive may be selectively enabled or disabled by you. To view or modify the current fault mask settings, use the up/down arrow keys on the SETUP screen to select the 'Fault Masks' option and press the [enter] key.
A typical screen as shown in Figure 3.50 shows all of the user maskable faults. Associated with each fault is the state of the mask. If OFF, it means the fault is disabled and will not occur. The normal state is ON or enabled.
To change the state of the mask, use the [cursor up] or [cursor down] keys to select the desired fault and press the [enter] key. Each press of the [enter] key will toggle the state of the mask as shown in Figure 3.51. (If nothing happens, you do not have proper access to the drive. Exit to the SETUP screen and refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level to gain access). 3-40 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Figure 3.50 Fault Screen
Figure 3.51 Fault Mask OFF
Figures 3.50 and 3.51 show all fault masks regardless of their current state. The fault masks can be viewed according to their state by pressing the [F7] key on the FAULTS SETUP screen. This will display the FAULTS OVERVIEW screen, typical of Figures 3.52 and 3.53.
Figure 3.52 AC O/V, Disabled
Operator Interface 3-41 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 3.53 Fault Overview, Enabled
The state of the fault masks which you are currently viewing is defined to the right of the screen name, i.e. FAULTS OVERVIEW: DISABLED or FAULTS OVERVIEW: ENABLED. To change the state of fault masks currently displayed, press the [F7]. Each press of the [F7] key will toggle the screen to show the masks in the other state.
To change the state of a mask on the FAULTS OVERVIEW screen, use the [cursor up] and [cursor down] keys to select the desired mask and press the [enter] key. In the example of Figure 3.52, the AC O/V is currently disabled and is selected. When [enter] is pressed its mask is enabled, thus removing the fault from this screen as shown in Figure 3.54. Pressing [F7] toggles the screen to show the enabled faults, which the AC O/V is one of (Figure 3.55). (If nothing happens, you do not have proper access to the drive. Exit to the SETUP screen and refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level to gain access).
Figure 3.54 AC O/V Removed From List
3-42 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Figure 3.55 AC O/V Now Enabled The changes to the fault masks do not take affect until the screen is exited via the [F10] key, i.e. exiting the FAULTS OVERVIEW will change the masks in the drive as will exiting the FAULTS SETUP screen. In our example, exiting the FAULTS OVERVIEW screen and returning to the FAULTS SETUP screen now shows the AC O/V mask as being ON (Figure 3.56).
Figure 3.56 AC O/V Mask is ON
User Definable External Text The drive contains a number of external fault inputs. You can custom define the text associated with these inputs, which will be used on the alarm screen and the fault mask screens. To define the text, use the up/down arrow keys on the SETUP screen to select the 'External Text' option and press the [enter] key. A screen typical of Figure 3.57 will be seen.
Figure 3.57 External Setup Text
Operator Interface 3-43 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 To modify the text attached to a particular fault input, use the [cursor up] and [cursor down] keys to select the desired input. To modify the text, press the [cursor right] key. (If nothing happens then you have not gained the required access to make changes. Exit to the SETUP screen and refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level to gain access). The first character position of the string will be in reverse video as shown in Figure 3.58. Refer to the section entitled "Edit Text". When editing is complete, the screen will appear as in Figure 3.59.
Figure 3.58 Modify Text
Figure 3.59 Modification Completed
The changes made do not take affect until you press [F10] and exit the screen. Any time prior to this you may cancel all of the changes made after coming to the screen by pressing the [F7] key.
PLC
The drive can be optionally connected to a PLC via a RIO (Remote Input/Output) adapter. The drive appears to the PLC as a rack of information. The tags that are associated with each of the words within a rack can be defined. To setup the PLC link, use the up/down arrow keys on the SETUP screen to select the 'PLC' option and press the [enter] key.
This will display a screen as shown in Figure 3.60 or 3.61. The PLC setup consists of eight words of input and eight words of output. 3-44 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
These are shown on separate screens. The type of PLC word being viewed is defined to the right of the screen name, i.e. PLC SETUP: INPUTS or PLC SETUP: OUTPUTS. To switch to the other screen, press the [F8] key. Each press of the [F8] key will toggle the screen to show the other set of words.
The layout of the PLC 'rack' is dependent on the DIP switch settings on the RIO adapter, (refer to the appropriate manual for information on the following adapters and their use: 1203-GD1, 1203-GK1, 1203-CN1, 1203-GD2, 1203-GK2, 1203-GK5, 1203-GU6, 1203- SM1 and 1203-SSS). Tags are assigned to rack module locations in pairs. These pairs are referred to as links and consist of two input and two output words. There are a total of four links that can be assigned to the RIO adapter.
The screens show the current tags and their tag code, which are associated with each of the links. To change the tag attached to a link, use the [cursor up] and [cursor down] keys to highlight the desired link and press the [enter] key. (If nothing happens then you have not gained the required access to make changes. Exit to the SETUP screen and refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level to gain access).
Figure 3.60 PLC Input Links
Figure 3.61 PLC Output Links
Operator Interface 3-45 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
This will begin the selection process of a tag as described in the section entitled "Select a Parameter ". When selecting a tag for the output words, only parameters will be allowed. Both parameters and read-only parameters are allowed for the selection of input words. When you have completed the selection process, the selected tag will be assigned to the link. To remove an assignment to the highlighted link, press the [delete] (Backspace) key.
The changes made do not take affect until you press [F10] and exit the screen. Any time prior to this you may cancel all of the changes made after coming to the screen by pressing the [F7] key.
XIO
The drive uses XIO adapters to hardwire to discrete inputs and outputs. Each drive contains one or more of these modules. Each module contains a unique address that is assigned automatically according to where it is attached on the link. This address value can be seen on the LED display of the module. The drive must be configured with these address values to link them to a parameter in the drive. To setup the XIO configuration, use the up/down arrow keys on the SETUP screen to select the 'XIO' option and press the enter key
Note: This feature is currently inactive and is reserved for future enhancements.
Message Prompting
All the changes you made while you were configuring the drive are stored in volatile memory of the drive. This means that when power to the drive is lost, so will be the changes. To permanently store the changes, the contents of the memory must be stored to NVRAM memory.
When you exit a group of screens on which you have changed the drive data, you will be prompted as in Figure 3.62 to save the data. If you wish to save the data, press [F8] 'Yes' and the NVRAM screen (refer to Store/Retrieve Configuration) will be entered (Figure 3.63). If you wish the data to reside as temporary data in RAM only, press [F9] 'No'. Pressing [F10] Exit will return you to the screen from which you previously exited.
Note that the data can still be saved at a later time by accessing the NVRAM screen directly from the Top Level Menu. Refer to Store/Retrieve Configuration.
3-46 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Figure 3.62 Message Prompt Screen
Figure 3.63 NVRAM Screen
Store/Retrieve Configuration (NVRAM)
To access the memory functions, press [F5] on the Top Level Menu. Within this screen it is possible to perform three operations on the memory of the drive. To perform these operations you must have the proper access to the drive. Refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level .
Initialize
The drive contains a default set of parameters and setup information. This can form a basis for configuring the drive. To initialize the drive with the default set of data, press the [F3] key. The screen will appear as in Figure 3.64, indicating the operation you are about to perform.
The screen then will ask you to confirm the operation. Press the [F8] key to proceed, or the [F9] key to abort. Performing an initialization will overwrite the data currently in the drive. Previous changes that were saved to NVRAM will not be affected.
Operator Interface 3-47 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 3.64 Initialize Operation
Save
The changes that you have made to the drive data must be saved if you do not want to lose the data when the drive is powered off. To save the changes, press the [F5] key (Figure 3.65).
Figure 3.65 Save Operation
To confirm the operation, press the [F8] key to proceed, or the [F9] key to abort. Saving the data will overwrite the previously stored data in the NVRAM.
Load
The changes that you stored in NVRAM are automatically used each time the drive is powered up. If you make changes to the data in the drive (without saving) and then wish to use the previously stored data, press the [F4] key (Figure 3.66).
3-48 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Figure 3.66 Load Operation
To confirm the operation, press the [F8] key to proceed, or the [F9] key to abort. Loading the data will overwrite the data currently being used by the drive.
Display Parameters The parameters of the drive can be displayed, continually showing the value contained in the drive. From the Top Level Menu, press the [F4] key. The DISPLAY GROUP screen of Figure 3.67 is displayed.
The screen shows one or more pages of groups that can be displayed. The number of groups displayed depends on the current access level. Using the [cursor up] and [cursor down] keys select the group you wish to display and press the [enter] key (Figure 3.68).
Figure 3.67 Display Screen
Figure 3.68 Feature Select Group Chosen
Operator Interface 3-49 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 3.69 Bit Encoded Parameter
Figure 3.70 Bit Description for Local Outputs
The DISPLAY screen, typical of Figure 3.68, is displayed. The screen shows the name of the group being displayed to the right of the screen name (FEATURE SELECT). One or more pages of the members in the group are displayed along with the value for this tag in the drive and its unit of measurement. Values that are bit encoded will show a hex value for the parameter value. Use the up/down cursor keys to select the parameter which is bit encoded and then press the [enter] key (Figures 3.69 and 3.70). The VIEW PARAMETER screen will then show that parameter as it is decoded per bit as shown in Figure 3.70.
The left side of the pair shows the name of the bit, while the right side shows the current value of the bit within the parameter.
All of these values are updated from the drive on a continual basis.
From the DISPLAY screen, it is possible to modify a parameter. If the group you are currently viewing contains parameters, press the [F7] key. The operator interface then allows you to select the parameter you wish to modify. Refer to the section entitled "Modify Parameters" for further details.
3-50 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame If you have modified any parameters in the drive, you will be prompted to make the changes permanent. This prompt will occur upon exiting the DISPLAY GROUP screen. Refer to "Message Prompting" for further details.
Custom Group
From the DISPLAY GROUP screen (Figure 3.67) you can select a group which you have custom defined by pressing the [F7] key. This custom group contains selected tags from one or more other groups, arranged by you onto a single screen for more convenient viewing (Figure 3.71).
To assign a tag to the display, use the [cursor up] and [cursor down] keys to highlight the desired item position and press the [enter] key. This will begin the selection process of a tag as described in the section entitled "Select a Parameter ". When you have completed the selection process, the selected tag will be assigned to the item, as in Figure 3.72. To remove a tag from the highlighted item, press the [delete] (Backspace) key.
Figure 3.71 Display Custom Screen
Figure 3.72 V Line Assigned
The changes take affect immediately, however are not saved until you press [F10] and exit the screen. Any time prior to this you may cancel all the changes made after coming to the screen by pressing the [F7] key.
Operator Interface 3-51 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 View Drive Status The status of the drive is viewed by pressing the [F7] key from the Top Level Menu. This screen, shown in Figure 3.73, constantly displays the latest status of the drive.
Figure 3.73 Status Screen
View & Reset Alarms All drive faults and warnings are logged to their respective queues. Collectively the faults and warnings are referred to as "Alarms". When a new alarm occurs, the F6 key on any screen will begin to flash in reverse video. Pressing the [F6] key on any screen will bring you to the screen as shown in Figure 3.74.
Figure 3.74 Alarm Summary Screen
The screen shows the current status of the drive, as well as the last active Fault that tripped the drive and any pending warning. (The screen only shows a fault and/or warning if the drive is still in the fault and/or warning state. This is independent of the content of the queues.) Note: Terminal FRN > 4.005.
To aid in troubleshooting, a time and date stamp is also provided, indicating the last time the drive was started and stopped for any reason.
To acknowledge the alarm(s), press the [F6] key. This will cause the F6 key to cease flashing and return to normal video. (If a new alarm were to occur, the F6 key would again flash in reverse video).
3-52 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame To reset the drive, press the [F7] key. This operation will reset any latched faults in the drive. This has no action upon either the Fault or Warning queues. If some faults still exist, they will return as new faults.
Faults and Warnings are stored into separate queues. Both work similar, thus only the fault queue will be discussed. To access the fault queue, press the [F9] softkey from the ALARM SUMMARY screen.
A screen typical of Figure 3.75 will be shown. The screen shows all faults in chronological order as they have occurred. A timestamp gives the date and time that the fault occurred. The most recent fault occurs at the top of the list. Use the [F8] and [F9] keys to shift to other pages if required. Entries are not removed from the queue until the queue is cleared with the [F7] key. If the queue becomes full, the oldest entries are discarded to make room for newer faults.
Figure 3.75 Fault Queue
Help for Alarms
When viewing the fault or warning queue, help text may be associated with the alarm entry. Use the up/down cursor keys to highlight the alarm in question and press the [enter] key. An ALARM HELP screen, typical of that shown in Figure 3.76 will be shown for that alarm. Not all alarms will have this additional help text. For those alarms the screen shown in Figure 3.77 is displayed.
Figure 3.76 Alarm Help
Operator Interface 3-53 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 3.77 No Alarm Help
Request Printouts When the drive contains the optional printer, you can obtain hard copies of the data that you are able to view on the terminal. The printouts are requested from the PRINTER screen. Press [F3] while displaying the Top Level Menu.
The screen typical of Figure 3.78 is displayed. It shows the current status of the printer (A-B part #80025-290-01) and the type of reports that are available. (Refer to the Syntest SP401 Thermal Printer User Manual for information regarding the use of the printer hardware and a description of the various reports available.) Using the [cursor up] and [cursor down] keys, select the desired report and press the [enter] key. The report will be sent to the printer.
The printer can automatically print out the alarms as they occur. This feature is selected as one of the report formats. In the Figure 3.78, the "AUTO - ON" indicates that this feature is currently enabled. To disable the feature, use the [cursor down] key to select the text and press the [enter] key. The text will change to "AUTO - OFF" (if a printer is attached). The automatic alarm printout feature is now disabled. Pressing the [enter] key again while selected will enable the feature.
Figure 3.78 Typical Printer Screen
3-54 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame Perform Diagnostic Trending The diagnostic trending operation of screens allows you to capture the relationships of a number of parameters over a period of time. Within this operation you will: Define the Parameters to which the Trend Apply Define the Trigger Condition to Begin the Trend Define the Sampling Rate and position of the Trigger View the results of the Trend
You will access the Diagnostic Trend operation from the Top Level Menu by pressing the [F9] key. This results in the display of the screen shown in Figure 3.79.
Figure 3.79 Diagnostic Screen
From this screen, additional screens are accessible to perform the diagnostic trending functions. The screen shows the current status of the trend, (Unprogrammed, Running, Triggered, Stopped). If a trigger has been defined, the trigger parameter, its trigger condition and the type of trigger will be displayed.
If data has already been captured, a time stamp indicating the last time the given trigger has occurred. This captured data can be viewed by pressing the [F9] softkey.
When a trigger has been defined, and is currently "Stopped", it can be re-started by pressing the [F7] key. If the status is "Running", the user can force the trigger to occur by pressing the [F2] key. Note that in doing so, that the trigger condition did not actually occur, but all data buffers can be viewed as if the condition had occurred.
To define a trend, press the [F8] key to display the setup screen, shown in Figure 3.80.
Operator Interface 3-55 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 3.80 Diagnostic Setup
Figure 3.81 Assign A Trace
From this screen, the tags to be monitored are assigned to a trace. The tag which you assign to the first trace 'Trace 1' is used as the trigger parameter. By default, when assigning a tag to Trace 1, the trigger value (i.e. data) will be set to the tag's minimum value and the trigger condition will be 'equal to'. A tag must be assigned to Trace 1 before the trigger value or condition can be set. From this screen you may also set the interval between samples (i.e. Rate), and the location of the trigger point within the view buffer. By default, the trigger will occur in the middle of the buffer, however you may change this by indicating the percentage of samples which will follow (i.e. Post) the trigger point.
Assigning a Trace
To assign a tag to a trace, use the [cursor up] and [cursor down] keys. Highlight the desired trace and press the [enter] key. Since there are more traces then can be seen on a single screen, use the up/down arrow keys to extend the list to the additional traces on the screen. (If nothing happens then you have not gained the required access to make changes. Press the [F8] key and refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level to gain access).
3-56 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame This will begin the selection process of a tag as described in the section entitled "Select a Parameter". When you have completed the selection process, the selected tag will be assigned to the trace, as in Figure 3.81. To remove a tag from the highlighted trace, press the [delete] (Backspace) key.
Setting the Trigger
Once you have assigned a tag to Trace 1, you may proceed to set the trigger value. Three items of information are required, the trigger type, the trigger condition and the trigger value. These are selected for modification by pressing the [F9], [F2] and [F3] keys respectively. (If nothing happens then you have not gained the required access to make changes. Press the [F8] key and refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level to gain access).
There are two types of triggers possible. A Single trigger occurs once and stops. The trigger must then be manually re-armed. This is the default type of trigger. A Continuous trigger will re-arm itself and continue to collect new trends until viewing the contents of the captured data stops it. The current type of trigger is shown by either a 'C' or 'S' in front of the Trigger label (refer to Figure 3.81). To switch between the two types, press the [F9] key.
The trigger condition and trigger values are set with the [F2] and [F3] keys respectively. When the respective field is in reverse video, that field may be modified.
The condition is set to one of the conditions listed below by pressing the [cursor up] or [cursor down] keys to scroll through the conditions. Pressing [enter] ends the editing and accepts the shown condition.
Trigger Conditions:
= Equal to N= Not Equal to > Greater than < Less than + Boolean OR N+ Boolean NOR & Boolean AND N& Boolean NAND Operator Interface 3-57 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
The value (data) is set through the use of the numerical keypad. Use the data entry keys [0]-[9] to enter the new value. The [-] key can be typed at any time to enter a negative value. The [.] key is used to enter a decimal point for fractional values. The entered new value can be edited by pressing the [backspace] key. This key will delete the right most character (i.e. number, decimal point or negative sign) shown on the screen. Press the [enter] key to accept the new value as shown in Figure 3.82. If the new value that you entered is outside the limits defined, the new value will be pegged at the closest limit. For example: If you entered 900 when the minimum value was 1000, the new value will show 1000.
Some data must be entered in HEX. To accomplish this, use the cursor up/down keys to scroll through the values 0-F for the right most digit. To accept the digit and enter to the right of the current digit, press the right cursor key. Press the [Enter] key to accept the value.
The value may be edited the same as a value entered from the numeric keypad.
Figure 3.82 Trigger Condition
Defining Sample Rate and Positioning
Pressing the [F4] key sets the rates at which the samples are taken. This data field is then modified in the same manner as the trigger data is entered. Rates can be set from 0 msec (collect as fast as possible) to 20.000 seconds.
When samples are collected, part of the buffer will store values prior to the trigger point and the remainder of the buffer will store values after the trigger. Pressing the [F5] key will allow you to set the percentage of the trend buffer, allocated to values collected, after the trigger has occurred. This data field is modified in the same manner as the trigger data is entered.
3-58 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame Starting the Trace
The changes do not take affect, and the trend is not started until you press [F10] and exit the screen. Any time prior to this you may cancel all the changes made after coming to the screen by pressing the [F7] key.
When you exit the screen, the trend is started and the screen such as Figure 3.83 will show the trigger condition and the status. Pressing the [F7] key on the DIAGNOSTICS screen may also start the trend.
Figure 3.83 Diagnostic Armed
Figure 3.84 Diagnostic Triggered
Once the data has started to be collected, the status will show 'triggered' as in Figure 3.84. When the buffer contains a complete capture, it will show stopped (if a single capture), as shown in Figure 3.85. The time and date at which the trigger occurred is displayed. The trend buffers may only be viewed when their status is stopped. If in continuous mode, the capture will stop when the buffers are viewed. To view the trend buffers, press the [F9] key.
Operator Interface 3-59 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 3.85 Diagnostic Stopped
Figure 3.86 View the Trend Buffer(s)
A screen such as Figure 3.86 will be shown. Upon initial entry, the screen will be positioned to the trigger point, shown by the "T ->". To view data either side of the trigger point, press the [F8] and [F9] keys.
Changes made to the diagnostic list setup are not permanent unless they are saved to the NVRAM in the drive. Upon exiting the DIAGNOSTICS screen (Figure 3.79), you will be prompted to save the changes to NVRAM. Refer to the section "Message Prompting" for further details.
Flash Memory Transfers Flash memory is used to store data in a non-volatile environment that is it is not lost when power is removed. The operator interface contains flash memory in two forms. The first is built into the operator interface. This form of flash is used to store the operator interfaces firmware and parameters from the drive. This information can also be stored on a removable flash memory card.
This second form of flash allows the data from one drive to be physically transferred to another drive for loading. All files on the flash card use a DOS format thus can be read or written by any PC that contains a PCMCIA drive. Flash memory cards which are supported are those that contain the following memory chips from INTEL: 3-60 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame - 28F010 - 28F020 - 28F008SA - 28F016SA.
These chips are used in the following memory cards available from Rockwell Automation: 2711-NM11 2711-NM24 2711-NM12 2711-NM28 2711-NM14. 2711-NM216
This section describes how you will transfer information between these two forms of flash memory and the drive. You will learn how to: Format a flash card. Look at the directory of files on a flash card containing the DOS file format. Select a program (firmware) from the flashcard and load it into the operator interface. Save the parameters from the drive on the flash card or in the operator interface. Download parameters to the drive from a flash card or that previously saved in the operator interface. Load a language module from the flash card.
You will access the Transfer operations from the Utility screen by pressing the [F7] key. This results in the display of the screen shown in Figure 3.87.
Figure 3.87 Transfer Main Menu
From this screen, additional screens are used to perform the various functions involving the flash memory. The screen shows the current access level of the operator interface. Any operation that will alter the contents of the flash memory or of the drive requires the access level to be something other than 'Monitor'. At the 'Monitor' level you may view the contents of the flash card. To change the access level, press the [F8] key. Refer to the section Enter/Modify an Access Level . Operator Interface 3-61 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Format Flash Card
Flash card files have a characteristic unlike normal DOS files. They can not be modified once written. New files can be added to the card, however they cannot be selectively removed.
When a new flash card is to be used or all the files removed from an existing card, the card must first be formatted. Formatting erases all data on the card and creates a DOS file structure.
To format a card press the [F2] key on the TRANSFER screen. The screen will appear as in Figure 3.88, indicating the operation you are about to perform and showing the current status of the operation. (If nothing happens then you have not gained the required access to modify the flash memory. Exit to the TRANSFER screen and refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level to gain access).
Figure 3.88 Format the Flash Card
The screen will then ask you to confirm the operation. Press the [F8] key to proceed, or the [F9] key to abort. Performing a format will overwrite all existing data on the flash card.
Formatting can take up to several minutes depending on the card involved. The status will indicate when the formatting is complete or if an error occurred.
Additional cards may be formatted from this screen by pressing the [F2] key.
3-62 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
View a Directory
The directory of a flashcard is shown by pressing the [F7] key on the TRANSFER screen. The directory shows the filename and extension, along with a date and time stamp of when the file was created. A screen typical of Figure 3.89 will be shown.
Figure 3.89 Typical Directory
Any screen or operation that requires a filename to be entered or picked from the directory uses this DIRECTORY screen. It is always obtainable from the [F7] key on any applicable screen.
When the directory is entered from the TRANSFER screen, all files will be shown. When entered from one of the operations screens, only the files that are relevant to the operation being performed will be shown.
Only the root directory of the card is used, as sub directories are not supported in the operator interface.
Select a filename
When working with existing files on the flash card, it is necessary to pick a file from the directory in order to use in the operation being performed. When the DIRECTORY screen is entered, all files that are relevant to the operation are displayed. The [cursor up] and [cursor down] keys are then used to select the desired file. Pressing [Enter] will select the file and proceed with the operation.
Press the [F10] key to abort the selection operation and return to the previous screen without continuing with the operation. Operator Interface 3-63 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Enter a filename
When a new file is being created, the DIRECTORY screen is used to enter the new filename. Upon entering the screen all existing files relevant to the operation are shown as shown in Figure 3.90.
Figure 3.90 Typical File Selection
An existing filename can be used as a basis for the new filename by first selecting that filename. Press the [F2] key. The filename can now be edited. Refer to the section entitled Edit Text for further details. When complete, pressing the [Enter] key will proceed with the operation.
Firmware is the program that is run in the operator interface to provide all the functionality described in this manual. Firmware is loaded from the flash card in one of two ways.
a) If a operator interface has a memory card inserted when it is powered up or rebooted, and that card has a valid firmware file with the extension of .FMW, the operator interface will automatically load the first .FMW file it encounters on the card. b) The user can select from one or more .FMW files on the card and load the selected firmware into the operator interface. This is the method that will be described here. From the TRANSFER screen, press the [F3] key. The operator interface will enter the DIRECTORY screen from which an existing firmware filename can be selected or entered. Refer to the sections entitled Select a filename and Enter a filename. (If nothing happens then you have not gained the required access to modify the flash memory. Exit to the TRANSFER screen and refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level to gain access). Loading Programs (Firmware) 3-64 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
When the filename has been obtained, the TRANSFER: PROGRAM screen such as that in Figure 3.91 will be displayed, showing the filename, indicating the operation you are about to perform and showing the current status of the operation.
Figure 3.91 Load New Firmware
The screen will then ask you to confirm the operation. Press the [F8] key to proceed, or the [F9] key to abort. Performing a DOWNLOAD FIRMWARE operation will overwrite the existing firmware that is currently running.
Pressing the [F3] key may restart an aborted download or one that failed prior to starting the download. To select or enter a different filename, press the [F7] key.
Due to the nature of this operation, all other operator interface functions will cease during a download. Once the download begins, the operator interfaces screen will be unable to show any status information. For this reason the two LEDs on the back of the operator interface are used as such:
Flashing Green - indicates that all is healthy and the transfer is proceeding. Solid Red - the transfer has failed. Firmware must be loaded via the method described in a) above. This is achieved by cycling power to the operator interface or simultaneously pressing the [cursor left] [cursor right] and [Enter] key at the same time while the flash card is inserted. If more than one firmware file exists on the card, the first one will be loaded and this process will need to be repeated in order to select the firmware file you desire. When the transfer completes successfully, the new firmware will automatically begin operation. Refer to the section Operator Interface Power-up Sequence.
Operator Interface 3-65 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
WARNING: Any time the operator interface is powered up with a flash card inserted which contains a valid firmware *.FMW file, the operator interface will attempt to load new firmware (note item a above). For this reason, it is not advisable to leave a memory card containing a firmware file in the operator interface, after the firmware has been downloaded.
Parameter Transfers The parameters used by the drive are stored within the drive itself. The operator interface is used to review and modify these parameters. When a Drive Control Board is changed, it is necessary to re-enter the parameters into the new board. The operator interface can simplify this process by reading all the parameters from the old Drive Control Board and storing them either in the operator interface or on a flash card. When the new board has been installed, the previously stored parameters are then downloaded to the new board.
The flash card provides an added benefit when more than one drive is using the same set of parameters. Parameters can be entered on the first drive, then uploaded and stored on the flash card. The flash card may then be taken to the remaining drives and the parameters downloaded to those drives.
Note: This feature does not replace the saving of parameters to the Drive NVRAM, refer to section Store/Retrieve Configuration. After downloading parameters, they must still be saved within the drive in order to make them permanent.
To transfer parameters, press the [F4] key from the TRANSFER screen. The screen shown in Figure 3.92 will be displayed. (If nothing happens, then you have not gained the required access to modify the flash memory. Exit to the TRANSFER screen and refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level to gain access). Within this screen it is possible to perform four different parameter transfers.
Figure 3.92 Transfer Parameters Menu
3-66 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame Upload to Operator Interface
The parameters are read from the drive and stored in the operator interface by pressing the [F5] key. The screen will appear as in Figure 3.93, indicating the operation you are about to perform. The screen will then ask you to confirm the operation. Press the [F8] key to proceed, or the [F9] key to abort. Performing a DRIVE TO MEMORY transfer will overwrite any previous parameters stored within the operator interface.
Figure 3.93 Transfer Stored Parameters
Download from Operator Interface
The parameters stored in the operator interface are downloaded to the drive by pressing the [F3] key. A screen similar to that shown in Figure 3.93 will be shown (except the operation will show MEMORY TO DRIVE). To confirm the operation, press the [F8] key to proceed, or the [F9] key to abort. Performing a MEMORY TO DRIVE transfer will overwrite the active parameters in the drive. It will not affect the parameters stored within the drives NVRAM.
After parameters have been downloaded you will be prompted to make the new parameters downloaded to the drive permanent. Refer to section Message Prompting for further details.
Upload to Memory Card
The parameters are read from the drive and stored on a memory card by pressing the [F4] key. The operator interface will enter the DIRECTORY screen in which a parameter filename can be entered. Refer to the section entitled Enter a filename. When the filename has been obtained, the TRANSFER: PARAMETERS screen such as that in Figure 3.94 will be displayed, showing the filename, indicating the operation you are about to perform and showing the current status of the operation.
Operator Interface 3-67 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 3.94 Transfer File Parameters
The screen will then ask you to confirm the operation. Press the [F8] key to proceed, or the [F9] key to abort. Pressing the [F4] key may restart an aborted transfer or one that failed. To select or enter a different filename, press the [F7] key.
Download from Memory Card
The parameters are read from a memory card and written to the drive by pressing the [F2] key. The operator interface will enter the DIRECTORY screen from which an existing parameter filename can be selected or entered. Refer to the sections entitled Select a filename and Enter a filename. When the filename has been obtained, the TRANSFER: PARAMETERS screen similar to that shown in Figure 3.94 (except the operation will show FILE TO DRIVE) will be displayed, showing the filename, indicating the operation you are about to perform and showing the current status of the operation.
The screen will then ask you to confirm the operation. Press the [F8] key to proceed, or the [F9] key to abort. Pressing the [F4] key may restart an aborted transfer or one that failed. To select or enter a different filename, press the [F7] key.
Parameter File Format
The parameter file stored on the flash card is in a DOS file format. This parameter file can be created off-line on a PC using any ASCII text editor and then written to the memory card via a PCMCIA Card Drive.
Information is this section is not needed to operate the operator interface. It is required knowledge if you wish to create a parameter file off-line and then download into a drive. The filename must have the extension of *.PAR in order to be recognized as a parameter file. The format of the file is as follows:
3-68 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame a) First Line: a revision number followed by a semi-colon (;). Number is not important. the date followed by a semi-colon, i.e. 01/01/1996. Date is not important. the time followed by a semi-colon, i.e. 12:01:01. Time is not important.
b) Remaining Lines: each line contains one parameter. The line consists of the linear parameter number followed by a semi-colon, and the parameter value followed by a semi-colon. i.e. 1;0; 2;0; 5;2;
Loading Language Modules In order to use a language in the operator interface, it must first be loaded into the operator interface from the flash card.
From the TRANSFER screen, press the [F5] key. The operator interface will enter the DIRECTORY screen, from which an existing language module filename can be selected or entered, Figure 3.95. Refer to the sections entitled Select a filename and Enter a filename. (If nothing happens then you have not gained the required access to modify the flash memory. Exit to the TRANSFER screen and refer to the section entitled Enter/Modify an Access Level to gain access).
When the filename has been obtained, the TRANSFER: LANGUAGE screen such as that in Figure 3.96 will be displayed, showing the filename, indicating the operation you are about to perform and showing the current status of the operation.
Figure 3.95 Language Directory
Operator Interface 3-69 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 3.96 Transfer Language Module
The screen will then ask you to confirm the operation. Press the [F8] key to proceed, or the [F9] key to abort. If an attempt to download a language module that already exists is made, the transfer will fail.
In order to download a newer version of a language, all languages in the operator interface must first be cleared (this is a characteristic of flash memory) by pressing the [F2] key on the TRANSFER:LANGUAGE screen. The screen as in Figure 3.97 will then ask you to confirm the operation. Press the [F8] key to proceed, or the [F9] key to abort.
Figure 3.97 Clear Languages
Pressing the [F5] key may restart an aborted download or one that failed. To select or enter a different filename, press the [F7] key.
System Programming The firmware for the complete drive system may be updated via serial port #2 on the Customer Interface Board. Pressing the [F9] key from the transfer screen will place the drive system into download mode.
3-70 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame Advanced Screen Operations A number of advanced functions have been incorporated into the operator interface. These operations are not required to operate the drive. They are meant as service tools for trained technicians and have been included here only for completeness.
All operations are accessed via a two key sequence.
Communications Statistics The screen, depicted in Figure 3.98 shows statistics involving the serial communications between the operator interface and the drive as well as the contents of the transmit and receive buffers. It is called from any screen (except the PRINTER screen), by pressing the [F10] key and the [cursor down] key at the same time.
Figure 3.98 Communications Statistics & Buffer
The ERRORS show the number of occurrences of a particular error since the last time the counters were reset. Parity: number of parity errors in characters received. Framing: number of framing errors in the characters received. Overrun: number of characters received that were not read prior to accepting the next character. Resends: number of times the operator interface had to resend data due to a NACK being sent by the drive. Timeouts: number of times the operator interface did not receive data from the drive within a specified time period. Chksum: number of times the operator interface detected a checksum error in the data it received from the drive. Discard: number of characters discarded by the operator interface, as they were not what was anticipated. Control: number of control codes that did not conform to the anticipated ACK or NACK. The operator interface will have assumed ACK, which if wrong will result in a time-out error. Seqnce: number of responses from the drive that did not correspond to the last request sent. Operator Interface 3-71 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
To reset the above counters, press the [F8] key.
The BUFFERS show the current contents (in hexadecimal) of the Transmit (TX) and Receive (RX) buffers contained in the operator interface. These buffers are circular in nature. The Psh (push) and Pop values indicate the location in the buffer where the next character will be loaded or unloaded respectively. If the values are equal, then the buffer is empty. To aid in viewing the buffer locations, the cursor keys can be used to highlight the buffer contents. The current location of the cursor is shown in reverse video in the mid-right screen.
Protocol Analyzer The protocol analyzer is accessed from the COMMUNICATIONS screen by pressing the [F7] key. The screen shows the data and the relationship of the data exchanged between the operator interface and the drive board. This data can be displayed in either one of two formats: the data shown in hexadecimal (Figure 3.99 ) the data shown as a mixture (Figure 3.100) of: a) control characters b) printable ASCII characters c) hexadecimal data.
Figure 3.99 Hexadecimal Displayed
Figure 3.100 Mixed Format Displayed
3-72 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame Pressing the [F7] key changes the format of the displayed data. When data is shown as a mixture, a particular value is displayed based on the priority defined above, (control characters is highest).
The RX row displays data received by the operator interface. The TX row displays the data transmitted by the operator interface.
Print Screen
The print screen operation allows a screen dump of the operator interface's display. This requires the use of a second RS232 port communicating at 9600 Baud to an external computer. Special software is required in the computer to receive the data and to interpret the data.
The operation is initiated from any screen by pressing the [F10] key and the [cursor right] key at the same time. The screen will clear and a message will indicate that the screen is being printed as well as the percentage completed. When complete, the original screen will return.
Memory Dump
The memory dump allows any directly accessible memory (i.e. memory which is directly addressable and does not require access through a port) to be monitored. It is called from any screen (except the PRINTER screen), by pressing the [F10] key and the [cursor left] key at the same time.
Figure 3.101 Data Segment Memory Dump
The initial screen, (Figure 3.101) shows the data segment by default. Each screen shows the segment (in hex) which is being viewed. In the left column is the starting address (in hex) for the row of data. Eight bytes of data are shown in Hex, followed by the equivalent 8 ASCII characters (if relevant). Additional data within the segment is viewed by pressing the [F8] and [F9] keys. Operator Interface 3-73 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
To change the segment and/or offset being viewed, press the [F7] key. A display similar to Figure 3.102 will be shown. Each successive press of the [F7] key toggles between highlighting the segment and offset value. The highlighted value is the field that is currently being edited.
Figure 3.102 Edit the Segment:Offset
The segment:offset address is edited via the numeric keypad and the arrow keys. All values of [0...9] can be entered directly via the numeric keypad. To enter a value of [A...F], the [cursor up] and [cursor down] keys must be used to cycle through the possible values. Note that the value [0...9] can also be entered via this method. Once a digit has been entered via the arrow keys, it must be accepted by means of the [cursor right] key.
The value may be edited via the [cursor left] key, which acts as a backspace to remove the last digit entered. The value is accepted by pressing either the [enter] or [F7] key. The edited segment:offset can be aborted by pressing the [delete] key. To accept the segment:offset value entered, press the [enter] key. The screen will show the data at the entered address, as shown in Figure 3.103.
Figure 3.103 Data at New Address
3-74 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Database Download
The database download operation allows the operator interface to obtain the majority of the information it requires on your command (instead of as needed). The operation is initiated from any screen by pressing the [F10] key and the [cursor up] key at the same time.
Obtaining the entire drive database is a lengthy process. As the operator interface is receiving the database, it will display what portion of the database it is currently obtaining, and the percent done. If the operator interface is successful in obtaining the complete database, it will display a message indicating such and wait for a key press from you. If unsuccessful, it will immediately return to the screen from which this call was made. The download may be aborted at any time by pressing any key on the operator interface. The portion of the database already obtained will be valid. A subsequent request to download the database will continue from where the previous download had terminated.
This screen will always return to the screen from which the download was requested. Operator Interface 3-75 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Operator Interface Menu Hierarchy Chart The screens of the operator interface are used to form a menu driven system to access the various operations in the drive. The hierarchy of this menu system is shown in Figures 3.104 and 3.105.
What does it show?
The chart shows the relationship between screens and a particular operation. It also shows the path to reach a particular screen. This chart does not introduce you to the use of the operator interface, however is useful as a reference to the preceding material.
How do you read it?
Each of the boxes represents a screen and contains the screen name. From a particular screen, a downward arrow shows what other screens can be displayed and which function key is required to move to that screen. Pressing exit [F10] on the screen will move you in the opposite direction, returning you to the screen from which you came.
A lateral arrow shows to which screen you can move by pressing the [enter] key while making a selection. Again pressing exit [F10] on the screen will move you in the opposite lateral direction, returning you to the screen from which you came.
Some of the operations have screens in common. These are shown only once on the diagram. Their use is indicated by symbols inserted into a circle. For example: The ACCESS screen is displayed from the MAINMENU by pressing the [F10] key. In this location (marked by an *), the operation of the screens ACCESS and PASSWORD CHANGE are shown in their entirety. These operations are also available from the MODIFY PARAMETER screen and SETUP screens by pressing the [F8] key. At these locations, the operation of screens is represented by the symbol 'P', which represents the same flow as previously defined.
For sake of clarity, the soft function key calls to the HELP operation and the ALARMS screen have not been shown. It is implied that all screens have this ability via the F1 and F6 keys respectively. 3-76 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Example
As an example of using the chart, we will modify a parameter while displaying it, starting from the Top Level Menu referred to in the chart as the MAINMENU screen. This example assumes you have read the previous sections of this manual. The example will concentrate more on the flow of screens and how it relates to the chart, rather then the actual operations being performed by each screen. The symbols refer to those of the chart. Descriptions of movement, i.e. lateral, refer to flow depicted on the chart.
Displaying the MAINMENU, press the [F4] key. The DISPLAY GROUP screen is now shown. Cursor to a parameter group and press the [enter] key. This laterally moves us to the DISPLAY screen. Since you selected a parameter group, pressing the [F7] key takes us into a selection operation (symbol 'D') in which the SELECT screen is displayed. This allows us to use the cursor keys to select the desired parameter.
Pressing the [enter] key laterally moves us to the symbol T which ends the selection process. For this example, the symbol T laterally moves to the symbol M that defines a new process in which the selected parameter can be modified. The MODIFY PARAMETER screen is now displayed.
To change the parameter, you must have the proper access to it. If required press the [F8] key to display the ACCESS screen, as represented by the symbol P. Obtain the access from this screen and press [F10] to exit. This will return you to the MODIFY PARAMETER screen. When you are finished with this screen, press [F10] exit and you will be returned to the SELECT screen (via symbols M and T). Pressing [F10] again will return you to the DISPLAY screen (via the symbol D). Successive presses of the [F10] key will return you to the DISPLAY GROUP and finally to either the MAINMENU or the MESSAGE screens.
If you have changed any data in the drive, the [F10] Exit key will bring up the MESSAGE screen. The message will remind you that the changes made in the drive are only temporary, unless saved to NVRAM. If you desire the data to be temporary, press [F9] 'No' and you will continue onto the MAINMENU. If you press [F8] 'Yes', the NVRAM screen is entered, from which you can save the data. Exiting the NVRAM screen returns you to the MAINMENU. Pressing the [F10] Exit key on the MESSAGE screen will return you to the DISPLAY GROUP screen. Operator Interface 3-77 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
M a i n M e n u : H e l p : M e t e r s : T r a n s f e r : R e v i s i o n
L e v e l s : F 8 - M e t e r s F 7 - T r a n s f e r F 9 - R e v
L v l F 1 - H e l p S T P F 8 - A c c e s s D r i v e
T e x t : F 8 - T e x t P r i n t e r : F 3 - P r i n t H U t i l i t y : F 2 - U t i l i t y A F 6 - A l a r m s H e l p : H e l p : F 1 - H e l p C o n t i n u e d
o n
P a g e
2 : F o r m a t : P r o g r a m F 2 - F o r m a t F 3 - P r o g r a m F F 3 - P r o g r a m F 7 - D i r D i r e c t o r y : G : P a r a m e t e r s F 4 - P a r a m t r F 2 - C r d > D r v F F 2 - D r v > C r d F F F 7 - D i r G F 8 - A c c e s s P F 7 - D i r F : L a n g u a g e F 5 - L a n g ' g e F F 3 - L a n g ' g e F 7 - D i r G QR F 2 - F o r m a t S t a t u s : F 7 - S t a t u s N V R A M : F 5 - N V R A M E S e l e c t
G r o u p : S e l e c t : S e l e c t
L e t t e r : S e l e c t
C o d e : F 7 - L i s t F 5 - C o d e S e l e c t
L i s t : S D T P F 7 0 0 0
T e r m i n a l
M e n u
T r e e N o t e : A l l
s c r e e n s
h a v e
a c c e s s
t o
t h e
F 1 - H e l p
a n d
F 6 - A l a r m
k e y .
T h e y
a r e
n o t
s h o w n
o n
t h e
d i a g r a m
i n
o r d e r
t o
i m p r o v e
c l a r i t y . P a g e
1
o f
2 F 7 - G r o u p Figure 3.104 Menu Hierarchy 3-78 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame M a i n M e n u : D i a g n o s t i c s : F 9 - D i a g s S e t u p : F 8 - S e t u p P F 8 - A c c e s s D i a g
V i e w : F 9 - V i e w C o n t i n u e d
f r o m
P a g e
1 A c c e s s : F 1 0 - A c c e s s P P F 7 0 0 0
T e r m i n a l
M e n u
T r e e N o t e : A l l
s c r e e n s
h a v e
a c c e s s
t o
t h e
F 1 - H e l p
a n d
F 6 - A l a r m
k e y .
T h e y
a r e
n o t
s h o w n
o n
t h e
d i a g r a m
i n
o r d e r
t o
i m p r o v e
c l a r i t y . P a g e
2
o f
2 D i a g
S e t u p : F 8 - D
S e t u p S T QR P a s s w o r d
C h a n g e F 9 - C h a n g e A l a r m
S u m m a r y : F a u l t s : W a r n i n g s : A F 6 - A l a r m s F 9 - F a u l t s F 8 - W a r n i n g F a u l t
H e l p : D i s p l a y
G r o u p : D i s p l a y : V i e w
P a r a m e t e r : F 4 - D i s p l a y QR D i s p l a y
C u s t o m : F 7 - C u s t o m S T T D M F 7 - M o d i f y L a n g u a g e : F 9 - L a n g ' g e P F 8 - A c c e s s M o d i f y
P a r a m e t e r P F 8 - A c c e s s M S T P a r a m e t e r s E x t e r n a l
S e t u p : E x t e r n a l
T e x t F a u l t
M a s k s P L C A n a l o g M e m o r y O b t a i n
D a t a b a s e C o m m u n i c a t i o n s P r o t o c o l
A n a l y z e r F 7 - A n a l y z e F a u l t s
S e t u p : F a u l t s
O v e r v i e w : F 7 - O v e r v w F 7 - T o g g l e F 1 0
&
< F 1 0
&
^ F 1 0
& P L C
S e t u p : F 8 - T o g g l e T S A n a l o g
S e t u p : T S X I O X I O
S e t u p : S e t u p
W i z a r d QR M e s s a g e : F 1 0 - E x i t E F 9 - N o F 8 - Y e s ^
Figure 3.105 Menu Hierarchy
Operator Interface 3-79 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 PCMCIA Memory Card Description Installation Data The memory card slides into the card slot located on the backside of the PowerFlex 7000 operator interface. These instructions show how to insert the card in the Operator interface.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
The memory card should be kept free from moisture, extreme temperatures, and direct sunlight. Failure to observe this caution could result in damage to the card.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Do not subject memory card to flexing or extreme shock. Failure to observe this caution could result in damage to the card.
Installing the Memory Card
1. Locate the vertical card slot on the back of the operator interface. See Figure 3.106.
COMMUNICATION CABLE CARD SLOT
Figure 3.106 Rear view of Operator Interface 3-80 Operator Interface 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
2. Position the card vertically so the key slot is facing the right side of the operator interface.
KEY SLOT
3. Insert the card into the card slot and push until the card is firmly seated.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Do not force the card into the slot. Forcing the card into the slot may damage the connector pins.
Chapter 4
7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Commissioning
Start-up Commissioning Start-up will be performed at the customer's site. Rockwell Services Automation requests a minimum of four- (4) weeks notice to schedule each start-up.
The standard Rockwell Automation work hours are between 8:00 AM to 5:00 PM EST, (8 hr/day) Monday through Friday, not including observed holidays. Additional working hours are available on a time and material basis.
Rockwell Automation recommends the following:
Drive Commissioning
1. A pre-installation meeting with the customer to review: The Rockwell Automation Start-up Plan The Start-up Schedule The Drive(s) installation requirements 2. Inspect the drives mechanical and electrical devices. 3. Perform a tug test on all internal connections within the drive and verify wiring. 4. Verify critical mechanical connections for proper torque requirements. 5. Verify and adjust mechanical interlocks for permanent location. 6. Confirm all inter-sectional wiring is connected properly. 7. Re-verify control wiring from any external control devices such as PLC5. 8. Confirm cooling system is operational. 9. Verification of proper phasing from isolation transformer to drive. 10. Confirm cabling of drive to motor, isolation transformer and line feed. 11. Collect test reports indicating megger / hipot test has been performed on line and motor cables. 12. Control power checks to verify all system inputs such as starts/stops, faults, and other remote inputs. 4-2 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
13. Apply medium voltage to the drive and perform operational checks. 14. Bump motor and tune drive to the system attributes. (If the load is unable to handle any movement in the reverse direction the load should be uncoupled prior to bumping the motor for directional testing). 15. Run the drive motor system throughout the operational range to verify proper performance.
Please Note: Customer personnel will be required on-site to participate in the start-up of the system.
Commissioning the Drive
Information contained in this chapter will assist in commissioning a PowerFlex air-cooled medium voltage AC drive. This chapter contains reference material with information including: Recommended Tools and Equipment Safety Checks Drive line-up Data Sheets Pre-Power Checks Control Power Checks
Review the information contained in this chapter prior to commissioning the drive. It will be used as a reference while the drive line-up commissioning is performed. Record all the information requested in the data sheets. The information recorded on the data sheets will be useful during future maintenance and troubleshooting exercises.
Perform the commissioning checks illustrated in this chapter in the sequence that they have been presented. Failure to do so may result in equipment failure or personal injury. Commissioning 4-3 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Servicing energized industrial control equipment can be hazardous. Severe injury or death can result from electrical shock, burn, or unintended actuation of control equipment. Hazardous voltages may exist in the cabinet even with the circuit breaker in the off position. Recommended practice is to disconnect or lock out control equipment from power sources, and confirm discharge of stored energy in capacitors. If it is necessary to work in the vicinity of energized equipment, the safety related work practices of NFPA 70E, Electrical Safety requirements for Employee Work places, must be followed.
Notwithstanding the safety references here, all local codes and safety practices are to be utilized when working on this product.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
The CMOS devices used on the control circuit boards can be destroyed or damaged by static charges. If personnel will be working near static sensitive devices, they must be appropriately grounded.
Pre-Commissioning In order to avoid complications during commissioning, it is important Responsibilities to ensure that the drive line-up is ready to be commissioned. Included in this chapter is a seven-point Pre-Commissioning Checklist. It is necessary that the checklist be reviewed to ensure that all points are completed in the order that they have been presented prior to beginning the drive commissioning. Completing the items in the checklist prior to commencing drive commissioning will help to ensure that the start-up is performed in an organized and efficient manner. 4-4 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame Please print the following information:
PowerFlex 7000 B Frame Pre-Commissioning Checklist
Once all points of the checklist are complete, initial each check box and provide the date. Photocopy the checklist and fax the copy to Medium Voltage Support, along with the planned start-up date. Upon receiving this checklist, the MV Support will contact the site to finalize arrangements for a start-up engineer to travel to site if so desired by the end user.
Drive Serial Number: GMS Service Engineer Requested (YES/NO): Scheduled Commissioning Date:
1. Receiving and Unpacking Initials Date The drives have been checked for shipping damage upon receiving. After unpacking, the item(s) received are verified against the bill of materials. Any claims for breakage or damage, whether concealed or obvious, are made to the carrier by the customer as soon as possible after receipt of shipment. All packing material, wedges, or braces are removed from the drive.
2. Installation / Mounting Initials Date The drive is securely fastened in an upright position, on a level surface. Seismic zones require special fastenings. Consult factory. Lifting Angles have been removed. Bolts have been inserted into original location on top of drive (leakage of cooling air). All contactors and relays have been operated manually to verify free movement.
Medium Voltage Support Rockwell Automation Fax: 1 (866) 465-0103 or Fax: 1(519) 740-4756 Name: Company: Phone: Fax: Date:
Pages:
Commissioning 4-5 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
PowerFlex 7000 B Frame Pre-Commissioning Checklist
3. Safety Initials Date All mechanical interlocks and door Ram Interlocks are tested for proper functionality and are not defeated or damaged. All Kirk key interlocks are installed and tested for proper functionality. The grounding of the drive should be in accordance with CEC (Canadian Electrical Code), NEC (National Electrical Code), or IEC regulations. If the drive has an isolation transformer, the transformer enclosure and/or frame must be bonded to system ground at a minimum of two locations. If the drive has an isolation transformer, the wye secondary neutral point must not be grounded. If shipping splits exist in the line-up, the ground bus between cabinets has been installed.
4. Control Wiring Initials Date All low voltage wiring entering the drive is labeled, appropriate wiring diagrams are available, and all customer interconnections are complete. If a tachometer is used, the tachometer must be isolated from the motor frame. The tachometer cables should be routed in grounded steel conduit for electrical noise suppression, and the conduit must be grounded at junction box but left isolated from the tachometer with an insulated bushing. The tachometer cable shield to the drive is connected to the ground bus at the drive end only. All AC and DC circuits are run in separate conduits. All wire sizes used are selected by observing all applicable safety and CEC / NEC / IEC regulations. Remote I/O Interface is properly configured / active. All 3-phase control wiring is with in specified levels and has been verified for proper rotation, UVW. All single-phase control wiring is within specified levels and has grounded neutrals.
4-6 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
PowerFlex 7000 B Frame Pre-Commissioning Checklist
5. Power Wiring Initials Date The power cable connections to the drive, motor and isolation transformer adhere to CEC, NEC, IEC or appropriate local standards. The cable terminations, if stress cones are used, adhere to the appropriate standards. Appropriate cable insulation levels are adhered to, as per Rockwell Automation specifications (refer to tables on page 2-29 of User Manual for Cable Insulation Requirements). All shields for shielded cables must be grounded on the source end only. If shielded cables are spliced, the shield must remain continuous and insulated from ground. All wire sizes used are selected by observing all applicable safety and CEC / NEC / IEC regulations. All power connections are torqued as per Rockwell Automation Specifications. (Refer to information in Appendix B "Torque Requirements") All customer power cabling has been Meggered or Hi-Pot tested before connecting to drive system. Power wiring phase rotation has been verified per the specific electrical diagrams supplied by Rockwell Automation.
6. Drive line-up Status Initials Date The medium voltage and low voltage power is available for startup activities. The motor is uncoupled from the driven load. The load is available for full load testing.
Commissioning 4-7 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
PowerFlex 7000 B Frame Pre-Commissioning Checklist
NOTES OR COMMENTS:
4-8 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Commissioning Preparation The following section identifies all the tools and resources required to successfully commission a PowerFlex 7000 B Frame drive line- up. In addition, it identifies how to obtain the required equipment in the event that it is not readily available prior to commissioning the drive. It is recommended that all items listed below be obtained prior to attempting to commission the drive. Ensure that the contents of this section are reviewed and that the uses of the equipment described within are understood prior to commencing commissioning of the drive. If further support or additional information is required, contact your local Rockwell Automation service office or Medium Voltage Support at (519) 740-4790.
Recommended Tools and Equipment
Hand Tools Metric and Imperial wrenches, sockets, and Hex keys Torque wrench Assortment of screw drivers Assortment of electrical tools (wire strippers, electrical tape, crimpers, etc.)
Electrical Equipment High voltage gloves 10 kV insulation rating (minimum) Approved high voltage potential tester 10 kV rating (minimum) Anti-static strap
Test Equipment 100 MHz oscilloscope with at least 2 channels and memory 600-Volt (1000V rating) digital multimeter with assorted clip leads 5000 Volt megohmmeter
Computer Requirements and Software Laptop computer (486 or higher installed with Microsoft (MS) Windows) Microsoft HyperTerminal (Provided with MS Windows) Rockwell Automation Software (RS) drive tools (Optional) RS Logix ** Required computer cables 9-Pin Null Modem (See Chapter 7 on Troubleshooting) 9-Pin Serial (See Chapter 7 on Troubleshooting) Remote I/O (SCANport DeviceNet) * PLC Communications Cable **
* Only required when Remote I/O has been provided with the drive. ** Only required when PLC has been provided with the drive Commissioning 4-9 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Technical Publications Each drive is shipped with a service binder containing all technical publications required to commission and troubleshoot the drive line- up. This section describes how to determine what technical publications are required and how to obtain them in the event that the service binder is not available at the time of commissioning or additional information is required.
The PowerFlex 7000 B Frame manual will be required during drive commissioning to guide you through each commissioning procedure. Copies of the manual or new revisions of the manual can be requested from your local Rockwell Automation Office.
PowerFlex 7000 Parameters The PowerFlex 7000 Technical Data publication for Parameters is also required for Commissioning and Troubleshooting. Refer to 7000-TD001_-EN-P for the latest firmware revision.
Additional Manuals Any additional manual required to configure the drive line-up can be identified on the Electrical Schematics. The Schematic titled General Notes identifies all required Rockwell Automation Publications by publication number.
Resources Required to Complete Prior to attempting to commission the drive ensure you have the Drive Commissioning following: Self powered gate driver board power supply cable (supplied with SCR rectifier drives only) Rockwell Automation electrical and mechanical diagrams PLC program (if supplied with a PLC) Commissioning data sheets All required manuals
If any of the above information is not available prior to the time of commissioning, please contact the factory.
PowerFlex 7000 B Frame Manual 4-10 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
PowerFlex 7000 B Frame Commissioning Checklist
A commissioning checklist has been provided in this manual as a quick reference to assist in starting up the drive line-up. This checklist should not be used as a detailed instruction or in no way includes all necessary steps to commission every possible drive configuration. Refer to the procedures in the PowerFlex 7000 B Frame manual for detailed commissioning instructions or contact either the local Rockwell Automation office or Medium Voltage Support directly for assistance if necessary.
It is recommended that this checklist be photocopied so as that it is readily available while performing drive commissioning.
Study Rockwell Automation prints provided with Drives System. Study the system one-line diagram and identify all sources of power. Verify one-line diagram. Trace power cables back to their sources and verify that equipment tag ID numbers agree with the customers one- line diagram. Drive Application Review
Inspect the process for hazards. Verify that the load is not turning due to process (A freewheeling motor will generate voltage).
Lock out and tag all sources of power as per OSHA guidelines. Test for voltage potential in cabinet with appropriate safety equipment. Remove step down CPT or PT fuses and place them in a safe place outside of the drive cabinet (To be done with control power off). Safety Tests Check fuse and O/L values and compare them to the values specified on the schematic diagrams.
Examine the drive for shipping damage. Inspect cabinets for debris. Ensure that protective barriers removed for drive commissioning have been re-installed. Verify that the drive line-up and all associated equipment have system power grounding cable installed. Power cabling is appropriately rated and stress-coned, if required. Power cabling has been Hi-potted or Meggered. Power cabling has been torqued per table in Appendix B. Control reactor wiring has been correctly installed as shown on the Rockwell Automation electrical diagram. Control wiring routing has been examined to ensure that AC, DC and fiber optic wiring are separated from each other. All additional control not shown on the prints has been identified, documented and forwarded to the factory for future reference. Verify that all low voltage cables in the medium voltage cabinet have sufficient clearance from power components (3 inch [76.2 mm] minimum for 4160 V) Verify that all connectors, cables and components are secure. Verify tachometer wiring (if supplied with tachometer). Installation Review Verify that fan hood has been assembled and mounted properly. Commissioning 4-11 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
PowerFlex 7000 B Frame Commissioning Checklist
Record customer name, location, date and drive ID number. Record drive nameplate data. Record motor nameplate data and compare it to the dimensional drawings. Record tachometer nameplate data, if applicable. Record harmonic filter nameplate data, if applicable. Record source of control power, auxiliary cooling information, environmental conditions, drive password. Service Data
Record all Dip switch settings, jumper settings and revision levels on printed circuit boards.
Configure mechanical interlocks. Perform a resistance check on all devices and snubber circuits. Verify that the 3-phase control power coming into the control section is within specification. Control Power Off Tests Verify that all additional sources of low voltage power are within specification and have grounded neutrals.
Power Supply Tests Apply control power and verify that AC voltages are within specifications. Verify the AC/DC output is 56 Volts DC at the input of the DC/DC converter and input to gate driver power supplies. Adjust if necessary. Verify the 20V output of SGCT integrated power supplies. Verify that all of the DC outputs in the DC/DC converter are at rated value. Verify that healthy lights are on for all control boards and firing boards (Use wire harness for SCRs). Control Power On Tests
Confirm that SCR and SGCT gating pulse sequence are correct for all devices. Converter Tests
4-12 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
PowerFlex 7000 B Frame Commissioning Checklist
Programming the Operator Interface Verify preliminary parameter settings. Calibrate signal conditioners Set analog outputs Fault masks / External faults Analog I/O PLC In/Out
System Tests Perform a system test with low voltage control/test power. Prove all protection functions as desired. Verify that all emergency stop devices function. Calibrate the analog I/O. Verify that the fan is operating properly.
Pre-Power Tests Inspect cabinets for debris (tools, hardware, metal shavings, etc.). Re-install control fuses (to be done with control power off).
Power Tests Measure input contactor drop out time. (2-cycle advance warning needed if input contactor is not part of drive line-up) Verify that line voltage is at rated value. Verify harmonic by checking voltage and current waveforms at SCBL board (PWM only) Perform a phasing check (18-pulse drives only). Review drive program settings for operating at reduced load. Perform an IDC Test. Autotune Program the drive for operation at full load. Medium Voltage Tests Run drive at rated load and rated speed, and record data. Capture waveforms of voltages and currents on the line and motor sides.
Print DRIVE SETUP, which gives all parameters, firmware revisions, PLC links, etc. Complete the Commissioning Data Sheets. Mark up modified electrical drawings. Add revision notes to modified PLC program. Have the customer sign sign-off document. Provide customer with parameter settings, marked-up drawings, commissioning package, PLC program and Field Report. Paperwork Forward PLC program, modified drawings, Commissioning Package and Field report to Medium Voltage Support group. Commissioning 4-13 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Drive Application Review In order to ensure trouble free commissioning, it is necessary for all involved in the start-up to familiarize themselves with the drive line- up and application. Service on the equipment should not be performed without a clear understanding of how the equipment has been designed to function and how the equipment has been applied. If questions arise that have not been addressed within this manual, they can be addressed by contacting your local GMS office or by contacting Medium Voltage Support directly.
Rockwell Automation Drive line-up Drawings
Prior to performing any service work on the drive line-up, the electrical and dimensional drawings provided with the equipment must be studied and understood. Within these drawings is detailed information and instructions required for commissioning and installation of the equipment including the following:
Dimensional Drawings Power cable termination locations Ground bus locations Shipping split locations Control and medium voltage power ratings Drive options Remote I/O protocol PLC options Motor and load specifications Drive power component selection ratings Heat exchanger ratings, connections
Electrical Drawings Contactor locations (electrically) Drive topology General notes Cable isolation ratings Symbol table Component designations
Device Designations Color Designations Wire No. Designations SGCT Designations Ribbon Cable Designations Location of Relay and Contactor Contacts Location of Relays Drawing Location References
Customer power and control wiring locations (electrically) Control and medium voltage power ratings Fuse ratings and locations (electrically)
4-14 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
If the dimensional and electrical prints are not available, a copy can be sent from the factory. In addition, if the drawings require changes to accurately suit the installation and application of the system, please fax or e-mail them to the factory so they may be revised.
Electrical System One-line Diagram
Once the Rockwell Automation electrical and dimensional drawings are clearly understood, a copy of the electrical system one-line drawing should be obtained. In studying this drawing, all relevant equipment tag Identification names and number should be identified. The system should be studied for sources of power and parallel paths of medium voltage power to the drive. A copy of the one-line diagram should be retained for the drive commissioning and if possible sent to the Medium Voltage division where it will be archived and used in the event that future customer assistance is required.
Verify One-line Diagram on Site
Once all documentation has been reviewed, an on site inspection of the drive line-up is required. While referencing the one-line diagram and Rockwell Automation prints, identify all the locations of the components within the drive line-up by their Tag Identification name or number. Trace the power cables from point to point while following the electrical diagrams. Any discrepancy between the physical installation and the electrical prints should be reviewed prior to commencing the drive commissioning.
Inspect Process
Before commencing commissioning on the drive line-up it is important to inspect the process which the drive has been applied to. This step is not only important as a means of identifying and understanding how the equipment is designed to adapt to the customers application, but it will also be used to identify any potential hazards. Review the process and determine what measures need to be taken to ensure that commissioning the equipment will not expose anyone to hazardous situations or in any way do damage to the equipment involved in the application.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Verify that the load is not turning due to the process. A freewheeling motor can generate voltage that will be back-fed to the equipment being serviced. Take all action necessary to ensure that motor regeneration into the drive does not occur while the equipment is being serviced. Commissioning 4-15 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Safety Tests The information contained in this section of the commissioning chapter must be completed in order to ensure that the commissioning continues in an environment safe to all those involved in servicing the drive line-up. Every point included in this section must be completed prior to continuing with the drive commissioning. Ensure that commissioning of this drive line-up is performed in accordance with local safety standards.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Servicing energized industrial control equipment can be hazardous. Severe injury or death can result from electrical shock, burn, or unintended actuation of control equipment. Hazardous voltages may exist in the cabinet even with the circuit breaker in the off position. Recommended practice is to disconnect or lock out control equipment from power sources, and confirm discharge of stored energy in capacitors. If it is necessary to work in the vicinity of energized equipment, the safety related work practices of NFTA 70E, Electrical Safety requirements for Employee Work places, must be followed.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Before attempting any work, verify the system has been locked out and tested to have no potential.
Lockout Tagout
Prior to opening the doors to the drive line-up cabinets, proper lockout tagout procedures must be performed to ensure that the working environment is safe. In addition, the equipment must be tested for potential prior to servicing the equipment. Even though the input to the drive may be open, it is still possible for potential to be present.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Live capacitors in circuit. Before touching anything, ensure that the drive is isolated from medium voltage and wait five minutes for the capacitors to discharge. Test the circuit for potential before servicing the equipment. Failure to do so can result in severe injury or death.
4-16 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Ensure that the motor is not spinning due to a driven load. A spinning motor can generate a high potential into the drives motor filter capacitors, which can result in severe injury or death.
Refer to local safety guidelines for detailed procedures on how to safely isolate the equipment from hazards.
The door to the medium voltage cabinets can only be opened after the lockout and tagout are successfully completed.
Step Down Transformer Fusing
Transformers are used in the drive to step down medium voltage to low voltage. With all sources of power removed from the drive (Medium Voltage and Control Power), remove the step down transformer fuses from the fuse clips and place them in a safe place outside of the drive cabinet. Removing the control power fuses will prevent a separate source of control power from being stepped up to Medium Voltage in the event that the safety interlocks fail to function.
Fuse and O/L Protection
While referencing the electrical diagrams, locate all fuses and overload relays within the drive line-up. Verify that all installed fuses and overload are the same as indicated by Rockwell Automation. Fuses and overload settings are also identified by stickers located on the cabinet structure in close proximity to the fuse or overload. Ensure the settings match the rating identified on the sticker.
Replacement fuses have been shipped with the drive in the event that a fuse opens during commissioning.
Commissioning 4-17 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Installation Review Prior to commencing the commissioning of the drive line-up it is recommended that the installation of the equipment be re-inspected. Identifying errors in the drive installation prior to commencing the commissioning as opposed to mid way through the commissioning process will greatly reduce the amount of time required to commission the drive line-up.
Inspect for Shipping Damage
Prior to continuing verifying the installation of the equipment, open the cabinets to all equipment supplied by Rockwell Automation and inspect each component installed for signs of damage. Any damage claim should be made back to the Medium Voltage Business as soon is it is identified so the damaged components can be replaced as quickly as possible.
Inspect Cabinets for Debris
Once the safety checks have been completed and the drive line-up has been successfully isolated, inspect all cabinets in the drive line- up for foreign material left behind during the installation. Ensure that no tools, hardware or wiring debris have been left in the drive. Note that some electric components used within the drive create magnetic fields that may attract metal shavings left behind if drilling or metal cutting was required during the installation process. Ensure that all metal shavings have been removed from the cabinet and take care not to get shavings into the cabinets if drilling or cutting is required during drive installation.
Protective Barriers
In confined spaces, it is common for the electricians responsible for the installation to remove protective barriers to allow for more space within the cabinets. Ensure that all protective barriers removed during the installation have been re-installed. Failure to re-install a protective barrier may result in equipment damage or personal injury.
Component Grounding
Verify that the drive and all its associated equipment have system power ground cabling installed and that the cables are terminated at both ends. Power cable shield grounds to be terminated at both ends. Ensure that all grounding hardware is sufficiently torqued (See Appendix B "Torque Requirements"). All drive line-up components (Drives, Switcher, Motors, Transformers and Reactors) must be grounded to the installations ground grid.
In drive line-ups supplied with Isolation Transformers, it is important to leave the secondary of the isolation transformer floating so the drive line-up can reference system ground from the upstream distribution transformer. Failure to do so may result in unreliable drive operation. 4-18 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Information on Splice Kits
The drive line-up may have been shipped in sections. Verify that the bus splice kits provided in this circumstance are installed and properly torqued at shipping split locations.
Power Cabling
All customer power and control wiring required for drive line-up installation have been identified on the electrical drawings by a dashed line (See electrical drawing General Notes, for additional information).
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Power cabling should be installed in accordance with local codes and guidelines. The information in this section is to be used as reference only and is not intended to replace practices outlined in the electrical code.
Trace the power cabling from termination point to termination point while examining the cable and its routing for mechanical damage, sharp bend radiuses and sources of induced noise and heat. Ensure that the power cabling is sufficiently braced so as to contain the cabling in the event of a ground fault situation.
Verify that all cables are terminated on each end and are sufficiently torqued (see Appendix B "Torque Requirements").
Verify that the cable installed meets the recommended power rating outlined in the electrical drawings and installation section of the manual. Ensure that the cable terminations are stress coned if required.
Verify that the customer power cables have been Hi-Potted or Meggered and read a sufficient insulation value. Commissioning 4-19 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Control Wiring
Identify all customer-required control wiring detailed on the electrical diagram and located it within the terminal blocks in the drive. Examine it to verify that the cable insulation has not been tightened into the terminal. Verify that all connections have proper continuity.
Ensure factory jumpers installed and marked with notes to remove if remote equipment installed have been removed.
Inspect the control cable routing to ensure that DC Control wiring and AC control wiring are separated from each other. Routing them together in the same bundle, wire-way or panduit may result in unwanted noise being induced in the drive control. In the overhead cable tray provided at the front of the drive, ensure that the AC Control, DC control and Fiber optic cables remain isolated from each other by the dividers provided.
Inspect for additional control not shown on the electrical diagram. Determine its purpose, mark the changes on the electrical diagram and send the prints to the factory for future reference.
Perform a tug test on all control cables to ensure that they are securely fastened, and check each plug and connector to ensure it is properly seated in its socket.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Ensure that there is sufficient clearance between the installed control wiring to the control cabinet and components carrying medium voltage. Verify that closing the low voltage door does not swing the low voltage cables into the medium voltage cabling section.
4-20 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Service Data This section of the commissioning chapter has been included in this manual so that all of the system nameplate data and variable set points can be captured as commissioned.
Why this Information is Needed
When a PowerFlex 7000 B Frame medium voltage AC drive is commissioned, the start-up sometimes occurs in an artificial environment. Theres usually no actual process being performed, and no load, at least not a full load. Therefore, the application situation is artificial and this isnt an ideal time to establish parameter baselines to signature the drive. After commissioning is complete, the drive is at full capacity and realistic load conditions occur; parameters such as speed regulation may begin to drift and the drive will not perform as designed to meet processing requirements.
It is important that the information required on the following pages is completed in a detailed and accurate manner and that immediately after their completion, the following data sheets are submitted to the customer and to the factory. They will be required to perform modifications on the drive line-up once production commences.
It is common for modifications to be made to the drives program some time during the two-month period following the drive commissioning. This is done to ensure that speed control, direction, starting and stopping functions are all performing with precision.
In addition to system modifications, the factory will use the data sheet as an indication that the system is running. The date on the commissioning data sheets will indicate to the factory the date that the system has been started and will be used to commence the product warranty.
In the unlikely event the system is not operating as designed, it will be possible to trend performance between similar applications and topologies. In the event a product notification or recall is required, the datasheets will be used to identify if the customer falls under the definition for an update.
These data sheets will be archived at the factory for future reference. Commissioning 4-21 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Customer Information COMPANY ADDRESS CITY PROV/STATE/COUNTRY POSTAL/ZIP CODE SERVICE CONTACT TELEPHONE FAX E-MAIL APPLICATION SERIAL NO. DRIVE TAG ID NO. COMMISSIONING ENGINEER COMMISSIONING DATE
4-22 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Drive Nameplate Data CATALOG NO. SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM Control Cell MAX VOLTS Hz Power Cell UNIT SERIES Hz BIL (kV) CURENT (Amps) RECTIFIER TYPE MAX VOLTS MVA NEMA TYPE SERVICE FACTOR Motor Filter Capacitors CONFIGURATION: MANUFACTURER MODEL NO. WYE
VOLTS Hz KVAR Line Filter Capacitors (PWM Rectifier Only) CONFIGURATION: MANUFACTURER MODEL NO. WYE
VOLTS Hz KVAR DC Link MANUFACTURER SERIAL NO. MODEL CURRENT (Amps) INDUCTANCE INSULATION CLASS TEMP RISE Input Reactor CONFIGURATION: LINE REACTOR ISOLATION TRANSFORMER MANUFACTURER MODEL NO. SERIAL NO. VOLTAGE: PRIMARY: SECONDARY: KVA / CURRENT TEMP. RISE IMPEDANCE
Commissioning 4-23 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Motor Nameplate Data Motor MOTOR TYPE: INDUCTION SYNCHRONOUS MANUFACTURER MODEL NO. SERIAL NO. HP/kW VOLTS CURRENT KVA POWER FACTOR CYCLES RPM SERVICE FACTOR EFFICIENCY CODE TYPE FRAME EXCITATION (Synchronous Only) VOLTS: CURRENT: EXCITER TYPE NEMA TYPE RTD TYPE: BEARING STATOR
Tachometer/Encoder Nameplate Data Speed Feedback TACHOMETER
POSITION ENCODER
STATOR FEEDBACK (NONE)
MANUFACTURER MODEL NO. SERIAL NO. PPR GEAR RATIO
4-24 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Miscellaneous Information Auxiliary Cooling Blower Motor (if any) HP/KW: VOLTS: PHASE: FLC: RPM: S.F.: MANUFACTURER: MODEL: FRAME SIZE: Drives Source of Control Power UPS: LIGHTING PANEL NUMBER: OTHERS: (SPECIFY) Environmental conditions AIR CONDITIONED FAN FORCED AIR OTHERS: (SPECIFY) Other Pertinent Information
Commissioning 4-25 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
DRIVE CIRCUIT BOARDS ACRONYM PART NUMBER HARDWARE REVISION SOFTWARE REVISION DCB L 80190-239- DCB M 80190-239- FIO L (A,B,C) 80190-099- --- FIO M (A,B,C) 80190-099- --- SCB L 80190-279- --- SCB M 80190-279- --- CIB 80190-319- XIO 80190-299- --- VSB L 1 81000-199- --- VSB L 2 81000-199- --- VSB M 1 81000-199- --- Operator Interface 2711-KSASL11 PV Firmware
PV Software
TFB L 80190-639- --- TFB M 80190-639- --- SCR SPGDB 80190-219- --- IDGPS L (1-3) 80026-044- --- IDGPS M (1-3) 80026-044- --- PS1 (A-F) [AC/DC Converter] 80026-172- --- PS2 [DC/DC Converter] 80026-173- --- PS4 [24V DC Power supply] 80026-096- --- CPT 80022-069- --- UPS --- PRINTER ---
PV Firmware is located on a sticker on the back of the unit; PV Software is located on the main display screen. The drive can have more than one of this circuit board. 4-26 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
SPARE DRIVE CONTROL BOARDS ACRONYM PART NUMBER HARDWARE REVISION SOFTWARE REVISION DCB L 80190-239- DCB M 80190-239- FIO L or M 80190-099- --- SCB L 80190-379- --- SCB M 80190-379- --- CIB 80190-319- XIO 80190-299- --- VSB L or M 81000-199- --- Operator Interface 2711-KSASL11- PV Firmware
PV Software
TFB L or M 80190-639- --- SCR SPGDB 80190-219- --- IDGPS L or M 80026-044- --- SGCT -- --- SCR -- --- PS1 [AC/DC Converter] 80026-172- --- PS2 [DC/DC Converter] 80026-173- --- PS4 [24V DC Power supply] 80026-096- ---
PV Firmware is located on a sticker on the back of the unit. PV Software is located on the main display screen. The drive can have more than one of this circuit board. Commissioning 4-27 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Control Power Off Tests The following checks listed in this section of the chapter should be performed prior to applying control power to the drive. It is recommended that these checks be completed in the sequence that they have been presented in this chapter.
Interlocking
When the input contactor option is purchased a key interlock is provided to prevent access to the medium voltage compartments of the drive unless the input isolation switch is locked in the open position.
Where the input switching device is provided by others, Rockwell Automation will provide a key interlock on the medium voltage compartment of the drive, and a matching interlock for installation by others on the upstream device. The interlock shall be installed in a manner that ensures the power to the drive is off and the drive is electrically isolated whenever the key is freed.
Although Key interlocks shipped with all medium voltage equipment are aligned in the factory, they often move out of position during shipping or are often misaligned when the cabinet is set down on an uneven floor. The following instructions will assist the field engineers in quickly and accurately aligning the dead-bolt key interlock with its counterpart.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Servicing energized industrial control equipment can be hazardous. Severe injury or death can result from electrical shock, burn, or unintended actuation of control equipment. Hazardous voltages may exist in the cabinet even with the circuit breaker in the off position. Recommended practice is to disconnect or lock out control equipment from power sources, and confirm discharge of stored energy in capacitors. If it is necessary to work in the vicinity of energized equipment, the safety related work practices of NFTA 70E, Electrical Safety requirements for Employee Work places, must be followed.
4-28 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame Adjust dead bolt counterpart so that grease marks from pins hit here. Grease marks from dead bolt pins
Figure 4.1 Dead bolt assembly mounted to door
1. Lock out and isolate the drive from medium voltage. Verify with a hot stick that there is no medium voltage present.
2. Determine that the key interlock is correctly aligned by securely bolting the medium voltage doors of the cabinet closed and removing the key from the lock. The key should turn easily; if any force is required to turn the key, the dead bolt alignment requires adjustment.
3. Open the doors of the cabinet and inspect the key assembly. Place high visibility grease on the pins of the dead-bolt counterpart. The factory recommends using yellow torque sealant, however if it is unavailable almost any grease will do. (See Figure 4.1)
Place grease on dead bolt pins here.
Figure 4.2 Dead bolt counterpart mounted to cabinet
Commissioning 4-29 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 4. Bolt the cabinet door closed so the pins on the dead bolt counterpart make contact with the dead bolt assembly. Doing so should leave two marks of torque sealant or grease on the assembly where the pins made contact (See Figure 4.1 Dead bolt assembly).
5. Slightly loosen the adjustment bolts on the counterpart and make the necessary movements on the counterpart to ensure that the pins align with the landing plates on the dead bolt assembly. As the amount of counterpart movement required is an estimate, it may take a couple attempts to properly align the assembly.
6. Clean the torque seal/grease from the key interlock once finished aligning the counterpart.
Once properly aligned, the key should turn freely when the cabinet door is fully bolted shut. If the key does not function when the door is tightly bolted closed, adjustments will have to be made to the depth of the counterpart. This can be done by adding shims on the landing plate where the counterpart is mounted.
Resistance Checks Prior to applying control power to the drive, power semiconductor and snubber circuit resistance measurements must be taken. Doing so will ensure that no damage has occurred to the converter section during shipment. The instructions provided below detail how to test the following components:
Inverter or PWM Rectifier Bridge - Anode to Cathode Resistance Test (Sharing Resistor and SGCT) - Snubber Resistance Test (Snubber Resistor) - Snubber Capacitance Test (Snubber Capacitor) SCR Rectifier Bridge - Anode to Cathode Resistance Test (Sharing Resistor and SCR) - Gate to Cathode Resistance Test (SCR) - Snubber Resistance Test (Snubber Resistor) - Snubber Capacitance Test (Snubber Capacitor)
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Before attempting any work, verify that the system has been locked out and tested to have no potential.
4-30 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
SGCT Testing
The following steps outline how to verify SGCT semiconductors and all associated snubber components. A quick reference to the expected resistance and capacitance values as well as a simple schematic diagram is located in the table below.
Table 4.A SGCT Snubber Circuit Resistance and Capacitance Values SGCT Rating Sharing Resistor Snubber Resistor Snubber Capacitor 1500 Amp 80 k 7 (PWMR) 0.2 f 1500 Amp 80 k 7.3 (Inverter) 0.2 f 800 Amp 80 k 10 0.1 f 400 Amp 80 k 15 (PWMR) 0.1 f 400 Amp 80 k 17.5 (Inverter) 0.1 f 2300V drives will not have a sharing resistor on devices.
Figure 4.3 SGCT Snubber Circuit Connections
Measured Resistance SGCT Resistance Measurement Inverter Rectifier (PWM only) SGCT Anode-Cathode Resistance (Heatsink to heatsink) __________ __________ k (Lowest) (Highest) __________ __________ k (Lowest) (Highest) Snubber Resistance (Test Point Heatsink above) __________ __________ (Lowest) (Highest) __________ __________ (Lowest) (Highest) Snubber Capacitance (Test Point Heatsink on Right) __________ __________ F (Lowest) (Highest) __________ __________ F (Lowest) (Highest) If a device or snubber component is found to be damaged, it must be replaced using the detailed procedures in Component Definition and Maintenance.
Commissioning 4-31 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 SGCT Anode to Cathode Resistance
Performing an Anode to Cathode resistance test not only tests the integrity of the SGCT but also the integrity of the sharing resistor. An abnormal device resistance measurement will indicate either a shorted device or damaged sharing resistor.
Using an ohmmeter, measure the anode to cathode resistance each SGCT in the inverter bridge, looking for similar resistance values across each device. Easy access from the anode to cathode is available by going from heatsink to heatsink as shown in the diagram below:
Measure anode to cathode resistance by testing from heatsink to heatsink.
Figure 4.4 Anode to Cathode Resistance Test Points
An SGCT when not gated on is an open circuit. A healthy device resistance value should be close to the value-sharing resistor, however due to parallel resistances in the firing card, the resistance value will be slightly lower.
Example: The resistance across the anode to cathode of a 800 amp device may be 57 k even though the sharing resistor is 80 k.
A failure of an SGCT can be detected by measuring a lower than normal resistance value; one device in the converter may read 15 k whereas the rest of the devices in the converter measured close to 60 k. This indicates a partially shorted device. A fully shorted device will read closer to 0 and will be quickly identified. If the SGCT is found to be out of tolerance, refer to Chapter 6 Component Definition and Maintenance for detailed instructions on how to replace the SGCT assembly. 4-32 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Damage to a sharing resistor is easily detected if the SGCT is replaced and the anode to cathode resistance remains abnormal. If the resistor is found to be out of tolerance, refer to Chapter 6 Component Definition and Maintenance for detailed instructions on how to replace the snubber/sharing resistor assembly.
Snubber Resistance (SGCT Device)
Access to the snubber resistor is not required to test the resistance. The snubber circuit test point is located within the PowerCage under the heatsinks. For each device, there is one test point. To verify the resistance, measure the resistance between the test point and the heatsink above.
Measure resistance between heatsink and test point. Snubber test point
Figure 4.5 Snubber Resistor Test
Refer to Table 4.A to determine the appropriate snubber resistance value for the current rating of the SGCT used.
If the resistor is found to be out of tolerance, refer to Chapter 6 Component Definition and Maintenance for detailed instructions on how to replace the snubber resistor assembly.
Commissioning 4-33 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 Snubber Capacitance (SGCT Device)
Turn the multimeter from the resistance to capacitance measurement mode. Proceed to verify the snubber capacitor by measuring from the test point to the heatsink adjacent to the right.
Measure capacitance between heatsink and test point. Snubber test point
Figure 4.6 Snubber Capacitor Test
Refer to Table 4.A to determine the appropriate snubber capacitance value for the current rating of the SGCT used.
The capacitance measured is actually affected by the snubber capacitor and other capacitance in the circuit, including capacitance from the Gate Driver circuit. You are actually looking for a consistent reading for all devices.
If the capacitor is found to be out of tolerance, refer to Chapter 6 Component Definition and Maintenance for detailed instructions on how to replace the snubber capacitor.
SCR Testing
The following steps outline how to verify SCR semiconductors and all associated snubber components. A quick reference to the expected resistance and capacitance values as well as a simple schematic diagram is located in below: 4-34 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Table 4.B SCR Snubber Circuit Resistance and Capacitance Values Drive Rating Sharing Resistance Snubber Resistance Snubber Capacitance 2400V (6P), 6600V 80 k 45 0.5 f 3300V / 4160V 80 k 60 0.5 f 2400V (18P) 80 k 60 0.68 f
If a device or snubber component is found to be damaged, a detailed replacement procedure is a located in Chapter 6 Component Definition and Maintenance.
SCR Resistance Measurement Measured Resistance SCR Anode-Cathode Resistance (Heatsink to Heatsink) __________ __________ k (Lowest) (Highest) SCR Gate-Cathode Resistance (Across SCR Phoenix Connector) __________ __________ (Lowest) (Highest) Snubber Resistance (Test Point Heatsink on Left) __________ __________ (Lowest) (Highest) Snubber Capacitance (Test Point White Wire from Snubber Phoenix connector on Right) __________ __________ F (Lowest) (Highest) Sharing Resistance (Red Wire from Snubber Phoenix connector Heatsink on Left) __________ __________ k (Lowest) (Highest)
Commissioning 4-35 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
SCR Anode to Cathode Resistance
Performing an Anode to Cathode resistance test verifies the integrity of the SCR. Unlike the SGCT, the SCR uses the snubber circuit to power the self-powered gate driver boards. The resistance measurement taken across each SCR should be constant; an inconsistent value may indicate a damaged sharing resistor, self- powered gate driver board or SCR.
Using an ohmmeter, measure the anode to cathode resistance across each SCR in the rectifier bridge, while looking for similar resistance values across each device. Easy access from the anode to cathode is available by going from heatsink to heatsink as shown in the diagram below: Resistance value between 2 heatsinks is Anode to Cathode resistance
Figure 4.8 Anode to Cathode Test
A good SCR and circuit should read between 22 and 24 k.
4-36 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
An SCR that has failed from anode to cathode will commonly produce a resistance value of 0 for a shorted device or for an opened device. Unlike the SGCT, it is highly irregular for an SCR to have a partially shorted device. If an SCR is found to be out of tolerance, refer to Chapter 6 Component Definition and Maintenance for detailed instructions on how to replace the SCR assembly.
SCR Sharing Resistance Test
To test the sharing resistor of an SCR module, disconnect the 2-pole plug of the self-powered gate driver board labeled SHARING and SNUBBER on the circuit board. The red wire of the plug is the sharing resistor. Measure the resistance between the red wire of the plug and the heatsink to the left. A value of 80 k-ohms indicates a healthy sharing resistor.
Resistance between heatsink and red wire at plug is sharing resistance
Figure 4.9 SCR Sharing Resistance Test Commissioning 4-37 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Gate to Cathode Resistance
One test that can be performed on SCRs that cannot be performed on SGCTs is a Gate to Cathode Resistance Test. Performing a Gate to Cathode resistance measurement will identify damage to a SCR by revealing either an open or shorted gate to cathode connection. To test an SCR from gate to cathode, disconnect the SCR gate leads from the self powered gate driver board and measure the gate to cathode resistance on the SCR firing card Phoenix connector as shown below:
Test points for gate to cathode resistance on Phoenix connector. Disconnect SCR Phoenix connector from board.
Figure 4.10 SCR Gate to Cathode Test
The resistance value from gate to cathode should be between 10 to 20 . A value close to 0 indicates that there is an internal short in the SCR. An extremely high value indicates that the gate connection in the device has broken.
If a Gate to Cathode test reveals a damaged SCR, a detailed replacement procedure is located in Chapter 6 Component Definition and Maintenance. 4-38 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame Snubber Resistance (SCR Device)
Access to the snubber resistor is not required to test the resistance. The snubber circuit test point is located within the PowerCage under the heatsinks. For each device, there is one test point. To verify the resistance, measure the resistance between the test point and the heatsink above.
Resistance value between Test Point and heatsink to its left is snubber resistance
Refer to Table 4.B to determine the appropriate snubber resistance value for the current rating of the SCR used.
If the resistor is found to be out of tolerance, refer to Chapter 6 Component Definition and Maintenance for detailed instructions on how to replace the snubber resistor assembly.
Commissioning 4-39 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Snubber Capacitance (SCR Device)
Turn the multimeter from the resistance to capacitance measurement mode. Proceed to verify the snubber capacitor by measuring from the test point and the white wire at the 2-pole device snubber plug (labeled snubber).
Resistance between Test Point and white wire at 2-pole plug is snubber capacitance
To test the snubber capacitance, disconnect the plug of the self- powered gate driver board labeled SHARING and SNUBBER. The resistance between the white wire of the plug and the Test Point to its left is the snubber capacitance.
Refer to Table 4.B to determine the appropriate snubber capacitance value for the current rating of the SCR used. You should read the actual snubber capacitor value shown in the table.
If the capacitor is found to be out of tolerance, refer to Chapter 6 Component Definition and Maintenance for detailed instructions on how to replace the snubber capacitor.
4-40 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Control Power Tests Prior to energizing the drive, verify that the control power being fed into the input breakers are rated as designated on the electrical diagram.
Although there are a variety of options available to customers that will effect the control power distribution within the drive, the input will always be as illustrated below:
+24V - PRINT,I/O Fan DC/DC CONVERTER DC/DC WARN SPGDB P/S FAIL +5V - LOGIC +/-15V - LOGIC +/-24V - LEM +12V - REM I/O +15V - TACH C hold-up DC/DC FAIL 3phase 20V ISOLATED GATE DRIVER POWER SUPPLY 6 20V PV550 & Remote I/O Single phase DC FAIL AC FAIL 3 phase AC/DC converter 56V 1500W 4 Grounded neutral 208 V 120 V CB1 (Optional CPT)
Figure 4.13 Control Power Distribution
Three Phase Input
In the 3 phase input configuration, the customer supplies 3 phase control power into the Fan Disconnect Switch (Labeled FDS1 on the Electrical Schematics). From that point, the power is distributed to all the power supplies and controls within the drive. The 3-phase control should be measured at the input to FDS1. If the rating matches the designation on the electrical schematic, it is acceptable to apply control power to the drive. Take necessary measures to rectify the control power level in the event that it does not meet the design specifications. Commissioning 4-41 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Three Phase Input / Single Phase Input
This configuration has two sources of control power:
Three phase control power for fan operation and drive control Single-phase control power to operate the Interface, I/O and additional auxiliaries.
Similar to the three-phase configuration, the input power for the fan and control must be verified at the primary of FDS1. However, the second source of control power must also be verified against the prints at Circuit Breaker 1 (Labeled CB1 on the Electrical Schematics).
If the ratings match the designation on the electrical schematic, it is acceptable to apply control power to the drive by closing CB1 and FDS1. Take necessary measures to rectify the control power levels in the event that they do not meet the design specifications.
Power Supply Tests
The variety of components installed within the PowerFlex 7000 B Frame requires a versatile control distribution design. As a result there are many power supplies incorporated within the drive design. The following section describes how to verify that all power supplies installed within the drive are functioning as designed.
Circuit Board Healthy Lights
Once all sources of control power have been verified and proven to be within specified levels, close the low voltage input breaker (CB1) and Fan Disconnect Switch (FDIS); doing so will apply control power to the drive.
Observe the healthy lights on all drive control boards to ensure that the unit has passed all power-up self-tests. The following table identifies the LEDs that should be illuminated, assuming the drive passes all self-tests and is in a ready state:
4-42 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Component LED Activated AC/DC Converter Power Supply NO Healthy LEDs Provided DC/DC Converter Power Supply 1 Green LED on Case of Power Supply (No Label) SGCT Power Supplies 1 Green LED per section of Power Supply (No Label) SGCT Integrated Firing Card LED 4 (Green) LED 3 (Green) LED 1 (Red) Drive Control Boards 1 Green LED Healthy Customer Interface Board LED1 (Green) LED 2 (Green) LED 3 (Green) Digital I/O Various RED Surface Mounted LEDs based on I/O status Remote I/O Adapter LED configuration will change based on adapter. Refer to the adapter user's manual to identify the state the adapter is in. Operator Interface Terminal Displays Boot Sequence. Communications Error will occur in a fault situation. A small flashing indicator in bottom right corner indicates good communication. Number of supplies varies based on drive configuration.
Failure of LED to illuminate indicates a problem with the power-up self-test. See the troubleshooting section of the manual (Chapter 7) to identify how to troubleshoot the problem.
Control Power Transformer (CPT)
A control power transformer is supplied only in certain drive configurations. If there is no control transformer supplied in the drive being commissioned, please disregard the following information on setting the control voltage output level.
Measure the control voltage level at the secondary of the control power transformer located in the DC link low voltage cabinet of the drive. Ensure that the output of the transformer matches the specification on the electrical schematics.
The value of the output can be adjusted by changing the taps on the control transformer. Ensure that the power is disconnected at the Disconnect Switch prior to attempting to change the control transformer tap setting.
Input Control Voltage (V L-L) U-V: V-W: W-U: ________ V ________ V ________ V Control Power Transformer Installed? Yes No CPT Secondary Voltage (V L-L) U-V: V-W: W-U: ________ V ________ V ________ V CPT Secondary Voltage (V L-N) or, if no CPT: Input Control Voltage (V L-N) U-N: V-N: W-N: ________ V ________ V ________ V Commissioning 4-43 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
AC/DC Converter (PS1)
Every PowerFlex 7000 B Frame drive will be supplied with at least one AC/DC converter. As the number of devices increases, so will the number of AC/DC converters installed. The electrical schematics provided by Rockwell Automation will identify how many AC/DC Converters have been installed in the application being commissioned.
Ensure the output of the supply is 56V DC. Refer to the Component Definition and Maintenance section (Chapter 6) if adjustment is necessary.
Control signals DC outputs 3-phase inputs TOP VIEW FRONT VIEW
Figure 4.14 Location of AC/DC power supply on low voltage panel
DC/DC Converter (PS2)
The DC/DC converter (refer to Figure 4.15) has no provision for output power adjustments. A green LED on the case of the power supply indicates that the power supply is functioning properly.
Using a digital multimeter, measure each of the outputs of the DC/DC converter to ensure that they meet the values specified on the electrical schematics. 4-44 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Plug 1 (P1) INPUT Terminal Numbers Description Value 1 2 Input Power (+56 V)
Plug 2 (P2) CONTROL Terminal Numbers Description Value 1 2 XIO PWR (+24 V 0.3 A) XIOCOMM 5%
Plug 3 (P3) SPGDB Terminal Numbers Description Value 1 3 SPGDBPWR (+15 V 1 A) SPGDBCOMM 5%
Plug 5 (P5) SCLB Terminal Numbers Description Value 1 2 + LEMPWR (+24 V 1 A) LCOMM 1% 3 2 - LEMPWR (-24 V 1 A) LCOMM 1% 4 5 +15 V PWR (+15 V 1 A) ACOMM 3% 6 5 -15 V PWR (-15 V 1 A) ACOMM 3% 7 8 +5 V PWR (+5 V 1 A) DGND (5.3 5.4) 9 10 +15 V ENC (+15 V 1 A) ENC CONN 1%
Plug 6 (P6) SCMB Terminal Numbers Description Value 1 2 + LEMPWR (+24 V 1 A) LCOMM 1% 3 2 - LEMPWR (-24 V 1 A) LCOMM 1% 4 5 +15 V PWR (+15 V 1 A) ACOMM 3% 6 5 -15 V PWR (-15 V 1 A) ACOMM 3% 7 8 +5 V PWR (+5 V 1 A) DGND (5.3 5.4) 9 10 +15 V ENC (+15 V 1 A) ENC CONN 1%
Plug 7 (P7) CIB Terminal Numbers Description Value 1 2 XIO PWR (+24 V 0.3 A) XIOCOMM 5% 3 4 +15 V PWR (+15 V 1 A) ACOMM 3% 5 4 -15 V PWR (-15 V 1 A) ACOMM 3% 6 7 +5 V PWR (+5 V 0.1 A) DGND (5.3 5.4) 8 9 +SCNPWR (+12 V 0.1 A) SCNCOMM 1% Commissioning 4-45 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
If any values are out of the expected range, a bad DC/DC converter is suspect. For additional information on how to troubleshoot the DC/DC converter, refer to the troubleshooting section of the manual (Chapter 7).
DC Power good indicator light M6 (H.H.T.R.S.) VIEW 1 DC/DC power supply Part ID label VIEW 2 Black insulation Mounting plate M4 (P.H.M.S.) and nylon shoulder washer
Figure 4.15 DC/DC Converter (PS2)
4-46 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
SGCT Power Supplies (IGDPS)
Note: Refer to Figure 4.16 for location of IGDPS.
Figure 4.16 Converter Cabinet Components
The circuitry for the IGDPS is encapsulated in epoxy. As a result the module can not be field repaired and there are no test points or adjustments available on this board. If one of the six isolated 20 V output fails, the entire board must be replaced. Differential Pressure Sensor Inverter Modules Ground bus Rectifier Modules Isolated Gate Driver Power Supplies Temperature Feedback Board (Rectifier) Temperature Feedback Board (Inverter) Commissioning 4-47 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Board LEDs One operational green LED on each of the 6 outputs, visible from the input ends of the unit that detects failed 20V output.
LED ON: output healthy LED OFF: output voltage is below 18Vdc
If the HV IGDPS is healthy, then all six LEDs will be illuminated. If this in not true, this may indicate either a bad connection to the board or a defective output module.
Record the following measurements to ensure all 6 outputs are functioning. They should be within 1% of 20 V.
Measured Value Test Points Expected Value #1 #2 #3 #4 Plug 8 Pin 1 Pin 2 +20 V DC Plug 9 Pin 1 Pin 2 +20 V DC Plug 10 Pin 1 Pin 2 +20 V DC Plug 11 Pin 1 Pin 2 +20 V DC Plug 12 Pin 1 Pin 2 +20 V DC Plug 13 Pin 1 Pin 2 +20 V DC
There may be more than one IGDPS. Record voltages for all of them.
If a channel has failed, refer to the troubleshooting section of the manual for a replacement procedure.
4-48 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Gating Tests Once the drive converters have been tested without Medium Voltage and all the power supply output values have been verified, it is necessary to test the SCRs and SGCTs under low voltage control power.
The following procedures will describe how to perform the next level of device testing: Gating Test Mode SCR Firing Test SGCT Firing Test
If the results of the tests are not as described in the section below, refer to Chapter 6 Component Definition and Maintenance, for detailed information on how to troubleshoot problems in the converter section of the drive.
Gating Test Mode
The following procedure explains how to enter gating test mode. This feature will simulate drive operation by applying gate signals to the SCRs and SGCTs while isolated from medium voltage. Prior to starting the drive for the first time, a gating test should be performed to ensure that each device is functional.
Some drive status I/O will be active while performing tests in Gating Test Mode (Test Mode 1). If the drive I/O is monitored remotely, process control should be notified in advance to avoid confusion.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Ensure that the drive is isolated from medium voltage prior to starting this test.
From the main screen, press the ACCESS [F10[ key and use the down arrow until you highlight ADVANCED. Press Enter and then EXIT [F10].
Commissioning 4-49 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Now press SETUP [F8] to get to Parameters, and then Enter. You should be on Feature Select, the first group.
Press Enter, and then use the down arrow to get to Operating Mode.
Press Enter and use the down arrow to get to Gating Test. Press Enter, and you will now be in gating test mode.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Ensure that the drive is no longer running in test mode prior to applying medium voltage to the drive line-up. Failure to do so may result in equipment damage.
4-50 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
SCR Firing Test
In normal operation, the SCR firing cards derive their power from a voltage divider network that steps down the medium voltage to 20 volts maximum. As it is necessary to perform this test while isolated from medium voltage, a secondary source of power has to be provided to power the firing cards.
Supplied with each drive is a power cable that supplies 20 V DC from the DC/DC Converter power supply to the firing cards (SPGDB). This cable has one input to be connected to the DC/DC converter, and 18 sets of outputs that can be connected to the SCRs. The firmware ensures that this is achieved.
The procedure is as follows:
Plug the 4-pin Phoenix connector on the test cable into the DC/DC converter terminal labeled PB3. The other 3-pin connectors plug into the SCR self powered gate drive board terminals labeled TB3 Test Power (See Figure 4.17 Self-Power Gate Driver Board Test Power Terminal).
Test power connection LED
Figure 4.17 Self-Powered Gate Driver Board Test Power Terminal Commissioning 4-51 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Put the drive in Gating Test Mode and the rectifier will automatically go into Test Pattern gating mode.
LED 1 Gate Pulse (Orange) should light up and pulsate at the frequency that the device is firing. All the other LEDs will light up as the firmware sends a gating signal to every SCR.
There is also a Gating Test that fires the individual devices one at a time, in what is described as a Z-pattern. Basically, for each section, the Top Left device will turn on for 2 seconds, then turn off. The next device to the right will turn on for 2 seconds, and the pattern will continue. When you reach the end of the first stack of devices, the right device in the middle stack down will fire and the pattern continues right to left until the end of the middle stack is reached. Then the left device is the bottom stack will fire and the pattern will continue to the last device, where it will then return to the top.
This is a test to show that the correct fiber optic cables are going to the corresponding devices.
Normal gating test mode should not be attempted for SCR rectifiers as the test power from the power supply to the SPGD boards through the wiring harness does not have sufficient current to drive all of the boards at once.
During commissioning, it is not necessary to use an oscilloscope for SCR firing tests, although it will be required if SCR firing problems occur.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Ensure that the test cable is removed from the drive and that it is taken out of Test Mode prior to applying Medium Voltage. Failure to do so may result in personal injury or equipment damage.
SGCT Firing Test
Unlike the SCR Self-powered gate Driver Board, the SGCT has an integrated firing circuit mounted on the device. The power for this circuit is derived from the SGCT Power Supplies (IGDPS), and preliminary observations are possible by monitoring the healthy lights on the firing circuit without putting the drive into gating test mode. There are 4 LEDs on the firing card. The following diagram illustrates the location of the LEDs:
4-52 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame SGCT SGCT LED 4 (Green) LED 3 (Green) LED 2 (Yellow) LED 1 (Red)
Figure 4.18 SGCT Healthy LEDs
While the drive is sitting idle, without gating LEDs 4 (Green), 3 (Green), and 1 (RED) should be illuminated while LED 2 (Yellow) is off. If any other combinations of LEDs are illuminated, refer to Chapter 6 Component Definition and Maintenance for instructions on how to troubleshoot the SGCT firing cards.
Put the drive in Gating Test Mode the inverter will automatically go into Test Pattern gating mode.
Monitor the SGCT LEDs and ensure that LEDs 4 (Green) and 3 (Green) remain illuminated, while LEDs 1 (Red) and 2 (Yellow) toggle on an off alternately at the frequency that the converter is operating at.
There is also a Gating Test that fires the individual devices one at a time, in what is described as a Z-pattern. Basically, for each section, the Top Left device will turn on for 2 seconds, then turn off. The next device to the right will turn on for 2 seconds, and the pattern will continue. When you reach the end of the first stack of devices, the right device in the middle stack down will fire and the pattern continues right to left until the end of the middle stack is reached. Then the left device is the bottom stack will fire and the pattern will continue to the last device, where it will then return to the top.
This is a test to show that the correct fiber optic cables are going to the corresponding devices.
Normal Gating Test mode will fire the inverter at the output frequency corresponding to the active reference (speed) command. Commissioning 4-53 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
System Test Prior to applying medium voltage, it is necessary to verify the entire low voltage control circuit to ensure the drive operates as desired. Failure to perform this test may result in damage to the drive or process in the event that the control does not operate as expected. This section of the manual provides instruction for the following five tests: System Test Mode Start/Stop Contactor Control Status Indicators Analog I/O Configurable Alarms
System Test Mode
The following procedure explains how to enter System Test Mode. This allows the drive to operate the drives low voltage control circuit without medium voltage present.
Drive status I/O will be active while performing tests in System Test Mode. If the drive I/O is monitored remotely, process control should be notified in advance to avoid confusion.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Ensure that the drive is isolated from medium voltage prior to starting this test.
Ensure you have Advanced access.
Now, from the main screen, press SETUP [F8] to get to Parameters, and then Enter. You should be on Feature Select, the first group.
4-54 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Press Enter, and then use the down arrow to get to Operating Mode.
Press Enter and use the down arrow to get to System Test. Press Enter, and you now will be in system test mode. From this point you can completely check the entire system without medium voltage. As long as you have test power to all your contactors, you can start, stop, E-Stop, trigger faults, check remote IO, check PLC inputs, and verify other functionality.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Ensure that the drive is no longer running in system test mode prior to applying medium voltage to the drive line-up. Failure to do so may result in equipment damage.
Commissioning 4-55 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Start/Stop Control Circuit
Once the drive is in System Test mode, ensure that the stop/start circuit functions as desired. It may be necessary to study the electrical schematic drawings, prior to performing this test, in order to understand the control circuit.
Start the drive in local control while observing the system vacuum contactors or customer supplied circuit breakers. If troubleshooting is required in Rockwell Automation medium voltage switchgear, additional information is available in the following publications: Publication 1500-UM055_-EN-P, Medium Voltage Controller, Bulletin 1512B, Two-High Cabinet, 400 Amp User Manual Publication 1503-IN050_-EN-P, OEM Starter Frame and Components Installation Manual Publication 1502-UM050_-EN-P, Medium Voltage Contactor, Bulletin 1502, 400 Amp (Series D) User Manual Publication 1502-UM052_-EN-P, Medium Voltage Contactor, Bulletin 1502, 400 Amp (Series E) User Manual Publication 1502-UM051_-EN-P, Medium Voltage Contactor, Bulletin 1502, 800 Amp User Manual
If the Medium Voltage contactors or circuit breakers perform as desired, stop the drive and perform the same test while operating in remote control.
Start the drive again and verify that all emergency stops installed in the system function as desired. Ensure that all electrical interlocks installed in the system function as desired. Make any necessary control wiring modifications at this time and re-test the system if necessary.
Status Indicators
Drive status is often feedback to a plants process control either digitally through the PLC input/output feature (see Chapter 3 Operator Interface, PLC page 3-43) or through relay logic. The following relays are provided with the drive as standard:
Relay Name Relay Designation Run Contact Fault Contact Warning Contact Ready Contact RUN FLT WRN RDY
4-56 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
It is necessary to activate each status indicator used by the customer to ensure that they have connected their control to the drive correctly. This can be achieved by changing the drive status (ready, faulted, warning etc.).
Analog I/O
It is possible to configure all of the drives analog inputs and outputs without running the motor. The following information describes how to set up the following drive features:
Analog Inputs Analog Reference Command Input Scaling (Local, Remote) Minimum Setting Maximum Setting Digital Reference Command Input Scaling (Digital) Analog Outputs
All of the Analog I/O connections are made on the CIB.
Analog Inputs
Analog Command Input Scaling
Prior to commencing the reference command input scaling it is necessary to ensure that the reference command input selection has been configured as desired. This requires setting Reference Select [P7] to the appropriate input source.
Set the utilized Reference Command minimum (L, R and D) to the desired value. The minimum reference command input setting on a drive without a tachometer is 6 Hz. Without tachometer control, do not set the reference command minimum parameter below 6 Hz. A control with tachometer feedback will allow a minimum speed of 1 Hz. With tachometer control, do not set the reference command minimum parameter below 1 Hz.
Set the utilized Reference command (L, R and D) Maximum parameters so that with full reference command inputs, the associated Reference command Variables read the desired maximum value.
The various reference command maximums usually have to be increased above the desired maximum value to compensate for the loading down of their 10 volt input rails by the attached potentiometer or isolator.
Commissioning 4-57 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 Example: The customer 4-20mA speed input is coming to the Current Loop Receiver on the Customer Interface Board, and they want the maximum input to represent 60 Hz.
1. Reference Command Remote Maximum (Ref Cmd R Max) should be set for 60 Hz. 2. The Reference Select parameter should be set to Remote 4-20a. 3. Have the source supply 20mA to the drive. This should be verified with a series Multimeter. Ensure that you are in Remote mode with the selector switch, and look at the parameter Speed Command In, which will represent that 20mA signal. 4. Ensure that it reads 60 Hz. If it does not, you can increase the Ref Cmd R Max value until this parameter reads 60 Hz.
Digital Reference command Input Scaling
The maximum value for a digital reference command is 32767; the minimum value is 0. Values that are negative or out of bounds will result in the drive slowing down to minimum speed.
Analog Outputs
Review the electrical schematics to understand which meters or signals the user expects out of the analog output ports on the Customer Interface Board.
To assign a parameter to an analog output, ensure that you are at least in Advanced access. From the main screen, press SETUP (F8), and use the down arrow to highlight Analog. Press Enter.
Use the down arrow to highlight the output you wish to assign. When you press Enter, you will be brought to the entire list of parameters. Use the arrow and enter keys to find the parameter you wish to assign, and press Enter. This will take you back to the Analog screen and you will see the new parameter name beside your selected output.
4-58 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Press EXIT [F10], go up to Parameters. Press Enter, and then scroll down the list until you reach Analog. Press Enter, and you will see the same list of available ports and the assigned parameter number, but not the name.
If you scroll down, you will reach the scaling factors for the 4 Meter Port and the 3 CIB Port outputs. All parameters are scaled to 0- 10V, with 0 representing the minimum value given in Chapter 6 under Parameter Descriptions, and 10V representing the maximum value given in Chapter 6. These Scaling parameters (i.e. Anlg Port2 Scle) can be used to change the scaling.
Note: There are certain parameters whose minimum value is a negative number. In that case, the minimum value of the parameter (-10V) is scaled to 0V output, and the maximum value is scaled to 10V output.
Highlight the appropriate Analog Scale parameter and press Enter. You can enter your new value, and then press Enter, and EXIT (F10). Ensure you save to NVRAM when you are finished.
Commissioning 4-59 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
The analog outputs from the customer interface boards are stated as 0 to 10 volts, but in actual fact their outputs are typically 0.025 to 9.8 or 9.9 V. This is due to the rails being loaded down by an attached speed potentiometer or signal conditioner impedance. Incorporated signal conditioners usually have 0 to 10-volt inputs and 4 to 20 mA outputs. An additional error is incorporated in the signal conditioners, so if they are calibrated for 0 to 10 volts input, there will not be exactly 4 to 20 mA out.
It is now necessary to calibrate the external 4 to 20 mA signal conditioners.
1. Set a digital multimeter to mA and place it in line with the signal conditioners. If the output of the conditioner is terminated, the meter can be used as a load. 2. Assign a parameter to the Analog Output port that we wish to calibrate. This parameter should be one that we can change from minimum to maximum for test purposes only. IDC Command Test is a good example. See previous page on assigning an output. 3. Set IDC Command Test to 0.000 pu. This is the minimum. Adjust the Zero adjustment screw on the isolator to read 4 mA. 4. Set IDC Command Test to 1.500 pu. This is the maximum. Adjust the Span adjustment screw on the isolator to read 20 mA. 5. Repeat the process until no more adjustments are required. 6. Set IDC Command Test to 0.750 pu to ensure you read 12 mA (Half-scale). Set IDC Command Test to 0.000 pu. 7. Assign the required parameter to the Analog Output port we have calibrated. 8. Save all changes to NVRAM. 4-60 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Configurable Alarms
Ensure that the configurable alarms have been programmed in the drive control. Instructions on where to locate the following External Fault related tasks in the manual are listed below:
The external faults can be tested by lifting the wires to all external warning / fault inputs while running in system test mode. These wires are terminated at the Digital I/O boards. Opening the circuit at any point will verify the external faults configuration and functionality. However, it is preferable to actually force the trips from the source. If that is not possible, then an acceptable alternative is to lift the wire at the protective device.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Do not short the lifted wire to ground when testing the circuit or damage will occur to the Digital I/O board and possibly weld the equipments trip contact.
18-pulse Phasing Test Prior to applying medium voltage and running the drive, it is important to verify the phase rotation on the input of all 18-pulse drives. The following tests do not need to be performed on PWM rectifier drives unless they incorporate synchronous transfer:
Line Terminal Resistance Measurements Application of Medium Voltage Power Compare the voltage feedback from all 9 test points in the SCB-L to ensure proper phasing.
Failure to perform the recommended tests will result in poor drive performance and may result in drive converter damage. Commissioning 4-61 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Line Terminal Resistance Measurements
Measuring the resistance between the drive line cable terminals will quickly identify if there is interwiring between the 0, +20, and -20 bridges in the isolation transformer.
There are low resistances between phases through a transformer winding and a high resistance between transformer windings. Therefore, the expected resistance measurements are listed in the table below:
Terminal Measurement Points Expected Resistance 2U 2V 2W Approximately 0 3U 3V 3W Approximately 0 4U 4V 4W Approximately 0 #U #V #W Approximately
If the measurement results are not as described above, the interwiring between the isolation transformer and drive needs to be re-inspected. 4-62 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Application of Medium Voltage
Before running the drive on Medium Voltage, it is a good idea to set up the diagnostic trending feature to capture any information in the event of a fault during commissioning. REMEMBER TO RESET THE TRENDING BEFORE LEAVING THE DRIVE IN PRODUCTION.
The diagnostic trending operation of the drive allows you to capture the relationships of 8 parameters over a period of time. Trending is a valuable tool for trouble shooting the drive.
The length of the trend buffer is 100 samples.
From the main menu, press the Diagnostics Key (Diags [F9]). This key enters the user into the Diagnostics Menu. The Options within the Diagnostics Menu are listed as follows: RE-ARM D_SETUP VIEW
Re-Arm
The re-arm function clears the memory buffer, which contains the data stored from the previous trend. It is necessary to reset the trending feature in order for a second trigger to occur, unless you have continuous trigger enabled.
Diagnostic Setup
The diagnostic setup is used to define the source of the diagnostic trigger. Information that has to be programmed in the diagnostic setup is listed below:
Rate The time delay between sample periods. Any value between 0 and 20,000 msec can be set. Use numeric keypad to enter the value and press the enter key to accept.
Post The percentage of the list which will occur after the trigger point. Any value between 0 and 100% may be used.
Trace The Read-Only Parameter which is assigned to a particular list. The item linked to Trace 1 is used as the trigger value. There are 8 possible traces, although not all have to be active.
Commissioning 4-63 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Trigger Defines whether you want a continuous or a single- shot trigger. Pressing this key will place an S or a C in front of the trigger parameter. You will almost always want a Single-Shot (S) trigger. S = Single shot>>the trigger occurs once and stops, trigger must be manually re-armed C = Continuous capture>>auto re-arm enabled to collect new trends until stopped by viewing contents of captured data Cond Defines the Condition that will cause the trigger. The possible options are: = Equal to + Boolean OR N= Not Equal to N+ Boolean NOR > Greater than & Boolean AND < Less than N& Boolean NAND
Data Defines the trigger value with respect to the Read- Only Parameter in Trace 1.
View
The view feature is used to observe the samples recorded during the last diagnostic trend.
How to Setup Trending
The trending setup is best illustrated through an example:
Trend Read-Only Parameters 1 Status Flags (569) 2 Pressure Value (447) 3 Alpha Line (327) 4 Speed Feedback (289)
The sample rate is to be set at 0 msec. This will default to the fastest sample rate. 20% of the samples should be recorded after the trigger. The single trigger should occur when any fault occurs. 4-64 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
1. Press the Diagnostic Soft Key (DIAGS [F9]). 2. Press the Diagnostic Setup Soft Key (D_SETUP [F8]) to begin programming the diagnostic settings. 3. Cursor the backlit section to Trace 1 and press the enter key to begin programming. Scroll through the parameter list until Feedback Status Flag2 (238) is located. Select this as Trace 1. 4. Select Trace 2 through 8 as described in the step above. Note that when you finish Trace 4, just press the down arrow and you will get to the screen showing traces 5-8. 5. Press the TRIGGER Soft Key until the letter S appears in front of the Trigger parameter. 6. Press the RATE Soft Key to program the trending sampling rate. This will be set to 0 msec in this example. 7. Press the DATA Soft Key to set the trigger level for the fault. This should be set to C. 8. Press the COND Soft Key to program the logic for the trigger level. In this example the COND will be set as an OR condition + 9. Press the POST Soft Key to set up how many samples will be recorded after the trigger. In this example the POST value will be set to 20%. The remaining 80% of the samples will be recorded prior to the trigger.
Once these settings have been programmed, the drive is ready to trend. Now the drive will trend data at the next fault.
The next test required to test phase rotation requires that medium voltage be applied to the drive input. Ensure that the drive is thoroughly inspected for debris and tools prior to energizing the drive. Furthermore, ensure that all protective barriers have been re-installed before continuing. Ensure that you have taken the drive out of System Test mode, and have returned to Normal operating mode. Commissioning 4-65 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Input Phasing Check
There are 9 voltage test points on the Line Signal Conditioning Board that will allow you to look at each voltage connection individually.
These test points are labeled as follows:
Table 4.C SCBL Test Points and Associated Voltage Signals Test Point Description Isolation Transformer: Secondary Phasing and Bridge Phase Relationship with respect to Vab1-Out (2U) Vab1-Out 2U Master Vbc1-Out 2V Master -120 Vca1-Out 2W Master -240 Vab2-Out 3U Slave 1 -20 Vbc2-Out 3V Slave 1 -140 Vca2-Out 3W Slave 1 -260 Vab3-Out 4U Slave 2 +20 Vbc3-Out 4V Slave 2 -100 Vca3-Out 4W Slave 2 -220 All of these test points can be measured to either the Analog Ground on the board or the TE ground in the low voltage section. You can use Vab1-Out as your reference (trigger on this waveform) and verify all the other test points using the table above. It is easier to use zero crossings on your oscilloscope as the reference points when checking the phase shifts.
Essentially, you are verifying the following relationships:
1. V and W in each bridge should be lagging U by 120 and 240, respectively. 2. 3U, 3V, and 3W should be lagging 2U, 2V, and 2W by 20 (-20), respectively. 3. 4U, 4V, and 4W should be leading 2U, 2V, and 2W by 20 (+20), respectively.
1 > 2 > 1) Ref A: 5 Volt 2 ms 2) Ref B: 5 Volt 2 ms V BCX-OUT V ABX-OUT
For 60 Hz systems, 360 = 16.7 ms. For 50 Hz systems, 360 = 20 ms. 4-66 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Refer to Figure 4.19 for a visual representation of the phasing checks.
0 -20 +20 2U 2V 2W 3W 3V 3U 4W 4V 4U 240 120
Figure 4.19 18-pulse phase sequence
Commissioning 4-67 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
DC Current Test The following test will assist in verifying the isolation transformer phasing, as well as verifying DC Link connections. It involves putting the drive in DC Current Test and monitoring variable Alpha Line and IDCP test point while increasing the DC current through the drive rectifier. The following instructions detail how to DC current test:
Ensure that you have Advanced access. From the main screen press SETUP [F8], then press Enter, and press Enter again to access the Feature Select parameter group.
Scroll down until you highlight Operating Mode and press Enter. Scroll down to the DC Current option, highlight it, and press Enter. Then press EXIT [F10], until you make it out to the main screen. There is no need to save to NVRAM when the prompt appears.
Press DISPLAY [F4] and scroll down until you reach the group Current Control. Press Enter and then press MODIFY [F7]. Scroll down to IDC Command Test and press Enter. Enter the number 0.1 pu and then press Enter. Press EXIT [F10] twice, scroll up to Feedback, and press Enter. The top parameter should be Alpha Line.
4-68 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Press the start button and the drive should start running, pumping 0.1 pu (10%) of rated current through the DC link. Alpha Line should be approximately 90-92.
We can also check the Idc Reference and Feedback. Press EXIT [F10], and scroll back down to Current Control and press Enter. Idc reference should be at 0.100 pu and Idc Feedback should be around that same number. Ensure that Idc error stays around 0.
You can see the Idc waveform on the IDCP test point on the SCBL. This is not the test point in the center of the board, but the one on the left. This test point should be have 18 ripples per cycle for an 18P drive, should not have the ripples drop down to 0, and should have approximately 0.5V offset for each 0.1 pu IDC. See the Troubleshooting chapter for sample waveforms.
Press MODIFY [F7], and increase Idc to .2 pu, and repeat the process. Go as high as 0.7 pu in .1 steps for 18P, and 0.3 pu in .1 steps for PWM, verifying each level as you increase the current. If there is a current meter somewhere on the input to the transformer/drive, check the current to ensure that it matches up with what you think we are pumping.
When we are satisfied everything is OK, bring the IDC current down in steps of .1 pu to 0, and then stop the drive. Return to the Feature Select parameter group and change Operating Mode back to Normal.
Commissioning 4-69 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Tuning Procedure The PowerFlex 7000 B Frame medium voltage drive must be tuned to the motor and load to which it is connected. There are six drive functions that require tuning. These are listed below in the order in which they are usually performed:
1. Commutation Inductance 2. Current Regulator 3. Motor stator resistance 4. Motor leakage inductance 5. Flux Regulator 6. Speed Regulator
The first four functions can be tuned with the motor stationary, but the tuning of the flux and speed regulators requires the motor to rotate.
NOTE: You will need to have a minimum of SERVICE level access to complete manual tuning. If you do not have SERVICE level access, please contact the factory.
1. Commutation Inductance
(Required for all drives with 3.004 Firmware or later. On earlier revisions, it is required only for 6-pulse and 18-pulse drives. Skip this test for PWM drives.)
The commutation inductance is used in the hardware reconstruction of the line voltage to compensate for commutation notches. It is also used in the calculation of the line converter retard limit to ensure proper operation under all conditions of line voltage and load current when regenerating. If the commutation inductance parameter is not correctly adjusted, the resulting distortion in the reconstructed line voltage may cause line synchronization faults.
The commutation inductance parameter is tuned with the drive operating in the dc current test mode. Although the commutation inductance was tuned during factory test, it must be retuned during commissioning because its value is determined by the impedance of the input transformer and harmonic filter (if present). The following autotune procedure can be used:
Commutation Inductance Autotuning
1. Set parameter "Autotune Select" in the Autotuning parameter group to Comm Induct. The drive will go into dc current test mode.
2. Start the drive. The dc current will increase in steps up to approximately rated current in about 2 seconds. When the current reaches its maximum value, the drive shuts off. 4-70 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Parameter "Autotune Lc" in "Autotuning" is set to the measured value of commutation inductance, and parameter "Autotune select" is set to Off. If the test is successful, parameter "L commutation" in "Current Control" is set equal to "Autotune Lc". If the test fails, then parameter "L commutation" is not changed and a warning is issued indicating the cause of the failure:
L comm low - indicates that the measured commutation inductance is less than 0.02 pu. The commutation inductance must be tuned using the manual method described below.
L comm high - indicates that the measured commutation inductance is greater than 0.15 pu. The commutation inductance must be tuned using the manual method described below.
1. Set parameter "Operating mode" in Feature Select to DC Current to enter dc current test mode.
Current Control Parameter Screen
2. Set parameter "Idc command test" in Current Control to 0.400 pu.
3. Set parameter "L commutation" in Current Control to an initial value of 0.05 pu.
4. Connect an oscilloscope to the test points labeled VABI-OUT and FAB1 on the SCBL board. Two sine waves of approximately equal amplitude should be seen, with the reconstructed line voltage FAB1 lagging the unfiltered voltage VABI-OUT by 90 degrees. Adjust the triggering and time base to display the positive half cycle of VABI-OUT with a scale of 20 degrees per major division. Commissioning 4-71 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
5. Start the drive. The dc link current will rise to 0.4 pu. Commutation notches will appear in the unfiltered line voltage VABI-OUT as shown in the figure. Some distortion will appear in the reconstructed voltage FAB1 around the zero crossings.
6. Measure the average width in degrees of the commutation notch nearest the peak of the VABI-OUT waveform as seen in the following figures.
7. Record the values of the parameters "V line average", and "Idc reference in Current control
8. Calculate the commutation inductance using the following formula:
L commutation = V line x sin (notch width) / Idc reference
9. Set parameter "L commutation" to the calculated value. If there was visible distortion in the reconstructed voltage FAB1, the distortion should decrease. If the distortion increases, it is possible that the polarity of the line current feedback is backwards.
10. Set parameter "Idc command test" to 0.800 pu. The dc current will increase and the commutation notches will become much larger.
11. Repeat steps 6 to 9. The higher current will produce a more accurate measurement of the commutation inductance. 4-72 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
12. Confirm that the commutation inductance is set to the correct value by increasing the horizontal and vertical magnification and observing the zero crossing of reconstructed voltage FAB1. Because the line converter firing angle is about 90 degrees, the commutation notch occurs near the zero crossing of the reconstructed voltage. The signal should be a straight line through the zero crossing with almost no visible distortion. Either increasing or decreasing parameter L Commutation should cause the distortion to increase.
13. Stop the drive. Set parameters Operating mode to normal and "Idc command test" to zero.
2. Current Regulator
The tuning of the current regulator is controlled by three parameters two in the Current Control" group, and one in the Drive Hardware group:
1. Curreg bandwidth 2. "T dc link" 3. "L dc link
Of these three parameters, inductance L dc link is calculated from its nameplate rating, the current regulator bandwidth should be set to its default value of 200 rad/sec, and only T dc link is unknown and must be measured. Although the current regulator was tuned during factory test, it should be retuned during commissioning because the dc link time constant is affected by the impedance of the drive input transformer.
Current Regulator Autotuning
The current regulator can be tuned automatically using the following procedure:
1. Ensure that the parameters in the "Drive Hardware" and "Motor Ratings" groups have been set to the correct values. Otherwise, the calculated value of parameter "L dc link" in "Current Control" will not be correct.
2. Set parameter "Autotune select" in "Autotuning" to Current Reg. The drive will go into dc current test mode. The current regulator bandwidth is temporarily set to the value specified by parameter "Autotune Idc BW. The dc current command is set to the value specified by parameter "Autotune Idc cmd". The dc current step is set to the value specified by parameter "Autotune Idc stp". Commissioning 4-73 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
3. Start the drive. The step response of the current regulator is measured and the dc link time constant is adjusted to produce a critically damped response. This test may take up to two minutes to perform. When the desired response has been achieved, the drive shuts off.
The current regulator bandwidth is set back to its normal value and parameter "Autotune select" is set to Off. Parameter "Autotune Tdc" indicates the results of the test. If the test is successful, parameter "T dc link" in "Current Control" is set equal to "Autotune Tdc". If the test fails, then parameter "T dc link" is not changed and a warning is issued indicating the cause of the failure:
T dc low - indicates that the measured dc link time constant is less than 0.020 second. The step response of the current regulator should be checked using the manual method described below.
T dc high - indicates that the measured dc link time constant is greater than 0.100 second. The step response of the current regulator should be checked using the manual method described below.
Current Regulator Manual Tuning
An appropriate value for the T dc link parameter can be determined from the current regulator step response while operating in dc current test mode. The following procedure should be followed:
1. Be sure that all the parameters in the "Drive Hardware" and "Motor Ratings" groups have been set to the correct values. Otherwise, the calculated value of parameter "L DC link" in "Current Control" will not be correct.
2. Set parameter "Operating mode" in the "Feature Select" to DC Current to enter dc current test mode.
Current Control Parameter Screen 4-74 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
3. Set parameter "Idc command test" in "Current Control" to 0.400 pu.
4. Set parameter "Curreg Bandwidth" in Current Control to 100 rad/sec. A lower than the normal bandwidth makes the step response easier to measure.
5. Set parameter "T dc link" in Current Control to 0.020 sec, which is at the low end of the normal range of values and should produce an underdamped response.
6. Assign parameters "Idc Reference" and "Idc Feedback" in the Current Control group to 2 SCBL test points (Rect TP1 and 2). This can be done similarly to the way that the meter assignments were described earlier in the chapter. Then they can be displayed on your oscilloscope.
7. Start the drive. The dc link current will rise to 0.4 pu.
8. Set parameter "Idc ref step" in Current Control to 0.200 pu. The dc link current will step up and down by this amount at regular intervals.
9. Adjust the scope to trigger on the rising edge of the dc current reference and observe the dc current feedback on the other channel. The step response will probably have noticeable overshoot, indicating that the dc link time constant is set too low.
10. Adjust parameter "T dc link" until the current feedback rises to about 63% of its final value in 10 ms as shown in the figure. The overshoot should now be quite small. Increasing T dc link causes the rise time to increase. Since the desired step response is slightly underdamped, T dc link should not be increased beyond the value at which the overshoot disappears.
CURRENT REGULATOR TUNED CORRECTLY
Commissioning 4-75 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
CURRENT REGULATOR TUNED INCORRECTLY
CURRENT REGULATOR TUNED INCORRECTLY
11. Set parameter "Curreg bandwidth" to the normal value of 200 rad/sec. Confirm that the rise time of the current feedback is now approximately 5 ms and that the overshoot is not excessive.
12. Set parameter "Idc ref step" to zero. The dc link current will return to a steady level of 0.4 pu.
13. Stop the drive. Set parameters Operating Mode to Normal, and Idc Command Test to 0.
4-76 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
3. Stator Resistance
Parameter R stator is used in the hardware reconstruction of the rotor flux. If this parameter is not adjusted correctly, the resulting distortion in the flux feedback may cause speed feedback or motor synchronization errors. Stator resistance must be tuned during commissioning because it is affected not only by motor parameters, but also by cable length. Stator resistance can be measured with the motor stationary. The following Autotune procedure can be used
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
In the following steps, the rotation of the motor in an undesirable direction may occur. To guard against possible equipment damage, it is recommended that the motor is disconnected from the load and tested for direction prior to proceeding, should the equipment be sensitive to reverse direction rotation.
1. Ensure that the motor is stationary. If the motor is turning, the results of the test may be invalid. It is not necessary to lock the rotor.
2. Set parameter "Autotune select" in "Autotuning" to Stator Rest.
3. Start the drive. The output frequency ramps up to 2 Hz with the motor current remaining at zero.
The motor current then jumps up to approximately 0.10 pu for less than a second and the drive shuts off. This test produces a small amount of motor torque and some rotation may occur.
Parameter "Autotune Rs" is set to the measured Stator resistance and parameter "Autotune select" is set to Off. If the test is successful, parameter "Stator resistance" in "Motor Model" is set equal to "Autotune Rs". If the test fails, then parameter "Stator resistance" is not changed and a warning is issued indicating the cause of the failure:
R stator hi - this is probably caused by extremely long motor cables increasing the apparent stator resistance of the motor. The drive cannot operate with stator resistance greater than 0.20 pu. Commissioning 4-77 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 4. Leakage Inductance
Parameter "L total leakage" is used in the hardware reconstruction of the rotor flux. If this parameter is not adjusted correctly, the resulting distortion in the flux feedback may cause speed feedback or motor synchronization errors. Leakage inductance must be tuned during commissioning because it is affected not only by motor parameters, but also by cable length. Leakage inductance can be measured with the motor being stationary. The following Autotune procedure can be used.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N In the following steps, the rotation of the motor in an undesirable direction may occur. To guard against possible equipment damage, it is recommended that the motor is disconnected from the load and tested for direction prior to proceeding, should the equipment be sensitive to reverse direction rotation.
1. Ensure that the motor is stationary. If the motor is turning, the results of the test may be invalid. It is not necessary to lock the rotor.
2. Set parameter "Autotune select" in "Autotuning" to Leakage Ind.
3. Start the drive. The output frequency ramps up to rated frequency in 2-3 seconds with the motor current remaining at zero. The motor current then jumps up to approximately rated current for less than a second and the drive shuts off. This test produces a small amount of motor torque and some rotation may occur.
Parameter "Autotune Ls" is set to the measured leakage inductance, and parameter "Autotune select" is set to Off. If the test is successful, parameter "L total leakage" in "Motor Model" is set equal to "Autotune Ls". If the test fails, then parameter "L total leakage" is not changed and a warning is issued indicating the cause of the failure:
L leakage lo - indicates that the measured leakage inductance is less than 0.15 pu. Possible causes are:
1. The motor is much larger than the drive and the motor nameplate parameters do not correspond to the actual motor ratings. In this case, the measured leakage inductance is probably correct and parameter "L total leakage" should manually be set equal to "Autotune Ls". 4-78 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
2. Because of the design of the motor, this method of measuring leakage inductance does not produce a valid result. The leakage inductance will have to be obtained from the motor data sheet, or if this is not possible, parameter "L total leakage" should be set to its default value of 0.20 pu.
L leakage hi - indicates that the measured leakage inductance is greater than 0.30 pu. Possible causes are:
1. The inductance of long motor cables is increasing the apparent leakage inductance of the motor. In this case, the measured leakage inductance is probably correct and parameter "L total leakage" should manually be set equal to "Autotune Ls".
2. The motor is very small (leakage inductance generally increases with decreasing motor size).
3 Because of the design of the motor, this method of measuring leakage inductance does not produce a valid result. The leakage inductance will have to be obtained from the motor data sheet. If this is not possible, parameter L total leakage should be set to its default value of 0.20 pu.
5. Flux Regulator
Induction Motor Flux Regulator
The tuning of the flux regulator for an induction motor is determined by three parameters: 1. Flxreg bandwidth in "Flux Control" 2. L magnetizing in "Motor Model" 3. T rotor in "Motor Model"
"Flxreg bandwidth" should be set to the default value of 10 r/s for almost all applications. "L magnetizing" and "T rotor" are usually unknown and must be measured. Both of these motor parameters change substantially with different operating conditions, but the variations do not significantly affect the operation of the flux regulator.
The other aspect of flux control is the variation of motor flux with speed. This is determined by two parameters: 1. Base speed in "Flux Control" 2. Flux command base speed in "Flux Command"
Commissioning 4-79 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
In most applications, the motor runs at constant flux below rated speed and constant voltage above rated speed. The motor flux is normally set to a level that provides rated voltage at rated speed and full load. The flux level required to achieve this is a function of the motor parameters. The flux regulator Autotuning determines a value of rotor flux that should provide rated motor voltage at full load and rated speed, and sets the flux command parameter to this value.
Flux Regulator Autotuning
The flux regulator is tuned with the motor running at constant speed using the following procedure:
1. Ensure that parameters "Rated motor rpm" in "Motor Rating" and "L total leakage" in "Motor Model" are set to the correct value.
2. Set parameter "Autotune select" in "Autotuning" to Flux Reg.
3. Start the drive. The motor accelerates normally up to the speed specified by parameter "Autotune spd cmd". The motor magnetizing inductance is calculated from the measured current and flux feedback and parameter "Autotune Lm" is set to this value. The flux command is then set to a value that should produce rated voltage at rated speed and load. The resulting change in the flux level may cause the magnetizing inductance to change. This process is repeated until the magnetizing inductance and flux commands stabilise. The drive then performs a normal stop.
Parameter "Autotune Lm" is set to the measured magnetizing inductance and parameter "Autotune select" is set to Off. Parameter "Flux Command Base Speed" in "Flux Command" is set to a value which is intended to produce rated voltage at rated speed and load. The value of parameter "Autotune T rotor" is calculated from parameters "L magnetizing" and "Rated Motor rpm" (which gives the rated slip).
If the flux regulator Autotuning is successful, then parameter "L magnetizing" in "Motor Model" is set equal to "Autotune Lm", parameter "T rotor" in "Motor Model" is set equal to "Autotune T rotor", and the flux regulator gains are recalculated. If the flux regulator Autotuning fails then parameters "L magnetizing" and "T rotor" are not changed and a warning is issued indicating the cause of the failure.
L magn low - indicates that the measured value of magnetizing inductance is less than 1.0 pu. This warning is intended to draw attention to an unusually low value of magnetizing inductance. This may occur if the motor is much larger than the drive and the nameplate parameters do not correspond to the actual motor ratings. In this case, the measured magnetizing inductance is probably correct and parameter "L magnetizing" should manually be set equal to "Autotune Lm". 4-80 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
L magn high - indicates that the measured value of magnetizing inductance is greater than 10.0 pu. This warning is intended to draw attention to an unusually high value of magnetizing inductance. This may occur if the motor is much smaller than the drive, and the nameplate parameters do not correspond to the actual motor ratings. The flux regulator should be tuned using the manual method described below.
T rotor low - indicates that the calculated value of rotor time constant is less than 0.2 seconds. This is caused by a value of "L magnetizing" or "Rated motor rpm" which is too low.
T rotor high - indicates that the calculated value of rotor time constant is greater than 5.0 seconds. This is caused by a value of "L magnetizing" or "Rated motor rpm" which is too high.
Flux Regulator Manual Tuning 1. Adjust the reference command to a value between 20 and 30 Hz. 2. Start the drive and wait for it to accelerate to the commanded speed. 3. Record the value of parameter "L magn measured" in "Motor Model". 4. Stop the drive. 5. Set parameter "L magnetizing" in "Motor Model" to the recorded value of "L magn measured" 6. Calculate an approximate value of the rotor time constant using the following formula:
L magnetizing T rotor = Rated slip in rad/sec
Where, (synchronous speed in rpm rated speed in rpm) Rated slip in rads/sec = 2f X Synchronous speed in rpm
Set the parameter "T rotor" in "Motor Model" to the calculated value.
Commissioning 4-81 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Synchronous Motor Flux Regulator
This section applies only to firmware revision 3.001 and higher.
Before the flux regulator can be tuned, the analog output for the field current reference must be set up.
Configuring the Field Current Reference
Excitation for the synchronous motor is provided by a current regulated field supply, either a dc supply for a slip ring or dc brushless machine, or a three phase ac supply for an ac brushless machine. The drive provides an analog current reference as an input to the field supply. The analog current reference has a range of 0-10V, where 0V corresponds to zero field current and 10V corresponds to maximum field current. The scaling of the analog current reference must be adjusted to achieve a linear relationship between the current reference and the actual field current. If this is not done, the flux regulator may be unstable. The scaling of the analog output can be adjusted using the following procedure:
1. Temporarily assign variable Autotune Lmd in Autotuning to the analog output used to control the field supply (e.g. CIB Port 1).
2. Set the analog output scale parameter (e.g. Analog CIB Port 1 Scale) in Analog Parameters to:
Analog Scale = maximum analog input of field supply / 10V
3. Set Autotune Lmd to a value of 10.00. Confirm that the reference input of the field supply is at its maximum value. Adjust the analog output scaling parameter if necessary.
4. Start the field supply and confirm that the field current goes to its maximum value. If necessary, adjust the field supply to achieve a field current slightly above rated.
CAUTION: Applying maximum field current to a stationary machine for an extended period may damage the exciter. Adjust the current as quickly as possible.
5. Stop the field supply. Assign variable I Field Command in Flux Control to the analog output used to control the field supply (e.g. CIB Port 1). The setup of the field current reference is complete and you can proceed with the tuning of the flux regulator.
4-82 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Tuning the Flux Regulator
The tuning of the flux regulator for a synchronous machine is determined by four parameters: 1. Flxreg Bandwidth in "Flux Control" 2. L magnetizing in "Motor Model" 3. T rotor in "Motor Model" 4. Lmd in Motor Model
"Flux Regulator Bandwidth" should be set to the default value for almost all applications. "L magnetizing", Lmd, and "T rotor" are usually unknown and must be measured. Although these motor parameters change with different operating conditions, the variations do not significantly affect the operation of the flux regulator.
The other aspect of flux control is the variation of motor flux with speed. This is determined by two parameters: 1. Base speed in Flux Control 2. Flux Command Base Speed in "Flux Command"
In most applications, the motor runs at constant flux below rated speed and constant voltage above rated speed. The motor flux is normally set to a level that provides rated voltage at rated speed and full load. The flux level required to achieve this is a function of the motor parameters. The flux regulator autotuning determines a value of rotor flux that should provide rated motor voltage at full load and rated speed and sets the flux command parameter to this value.
Flux Regulator Autotuning
Note: If a position encoder is fitted to the motor, the flux regulator autotuning is performed with the encoder feedback turned off because it is assumed that the encoder has not been aligned with the rotor axis yet. Since less starting torque is produced with the encoder feedback off, this test should be performed with reduced load. The encoder offset measurement is also most accurate with no load on the motor.
The flux regulator is tuned with the motor running at constant speed using the following procedure:
1. Ensure that the analog reference for the field current has been set up as described previously, and that parameter L total leakage has been set to the correct value.
2. Set parameter "Autotune Select" in "Autotuning" to Flux Reg.
Commissioning 4-83 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
3. Start the drive. The motor accelerates normally up to the speed specified by parameter "Autotune Spd Cmd". The motor magnetizing inductance is calculated from the magnetizing current reference and the flux feedback and parameter "Autotune Lm" is set to this value. The flux command is then set to a value that should produce rated voltage at rated speed and load. The resulting change in the flux level may cause the magnetizing inductance to change. This process is repeated until the magnetizing inductance and flux command stabilize. If a position encoder is fitted to the motor, the angle between the measured flux and the encoder zero is measured and parameter Encoder offset is adjusted to align the encoder with the motor flux.
4. The field current reference is then held constant and the response of the flux to changes in stator magnetizing current is measured by stepping Ix command up and down at regular intervals. The size of the step in the stator current is specified by parameter Autotune Isd Step. The step response measurement takes about 3 minutes. When the measurement is complete, the drive performs a normal stop.
Parameter "Autotune Lm" is set to the measured magnetizing inductance and parameter "Autotune Select" is set to Off. Parameter "Flux Command Base Speed" in "Flux Command" is set to a value calculated to produce rated voltage at rated speed and load. The value of parameters "Autotune T rotor and Autotune Lmd are calculated from the step response data.
If the flux regulator autotuning is successful, then parameter "L magnetizing" in "Motor Model" is set equal to "Autotune Lm", parameter "T rotor" in "Motor Model" is set equal to "Autotune T rotor", and parameter Lmd in Motor Model is set equal to Autotune Lmd. If the flux regulator autotuning fails then parameters "L magnetizing", Lmd, and "T rotor" are not changed and a warning is issued indicating the cause of the failure.
L magn low indicates that the measured value of magnetizing inductance is less then 1.0 pu. This warning is intended to draw attention to an unusually low value of magnetizing inductance. The most likely cause is incorrect scaling of the analog field current reference.
L magn high indicates that the measured value of magnetizing inductance is greater then 15.0 pu. This warning is intended to draw attention to an unusually high value of magnetizing inductance. The most likely cause is incorrect scaling of the analog field current reference. 4-84 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
T rotor low indicates that the calculated value of rotor time constant is less than 0.1 seconds
T rotor high indicates that the calculated value of rotor time constant is greater than 5.0 seconds.
6. Speed Regulator
The tuning of the speed regulator is determined by two parameters in the "Speed Control" group: 1. Spdreg bandwidth 2. Total inertia
Parameter "Spdreg bandwidth" is set to a value determined by the requirements of the application, but parameter "Total inertia" is usually unknown and must be measured.
Speed Regulator Autotuning
The Autotuning determines the total inertia by measuring the change in speed that occurs when a low frequency sinusoidal torque perturbation is applied to the motor. The inertia measurement is not affected by the load torque as long as the drive does not hit torque limit. Do not disconnect the driven load from the motor, as it is the total inertia of motor and load that is being measured. The following procedure should be used:
1. Ensure that parameters "Autotune spd cmd and "Autotune trq stp" in "Autotune" are set to default values.
2. Set parameter "Autotune select" in "Autotuning" to "Speed Reg".
3. Start the drive. The motor accelerates normally up to the speed specified by parameter "Autotune spd cmd". When the motor speed has settled at the commanded value, a sinusoidal perturbation specified by parameter "Autotune trq stp" is added to the torque command, causing the speed to vary. After the initial transient has decayed (this usually takes a few seconds), the variation in torque and speed are measured and used to calculate the total inertia. The torque perturbation is then removed and the drive performs a normal stop. Commissioning 4-85 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Parameter "Autotune inertia" is set to the measured inertia and parameter "Autotune select" is set to Off. If the test is successful, parameter "Total inertia" in "Speed Control" is set equal to "Autotune inertia", and the speed regulator gains are recalculated. If the test fails, then parameter "Total inertia" is not changed and a warning is issued indicating the cause of the failure:
Reg in limit - indicates that the torque command was greater than "Torque limit motoring" or "Torque limit braking". The measured inertia value is invalid. Parameter "Autotune trq stp" or parameter "Autotune spd cmd" must be set to a lower value and the test repeated.
Tuning abort - indicates that the deviation in motor speed was greater than 10 Hz. The measured inertia value is invalid. Parameter "Autotune trq stp" must be set to a lower value and the test repeated.
Inertia high - indicates that the measured total inertia is greater than 5 seconds. This warning is intended to draw attention to an unusually high inertia value. For a very high inertia load such as a large fan, this may be a valid result and parameter "Total inertia" should be manually set equal to "Autotune inertia". However, a high inertia measurement could also be produced by a value of "Autotune trq stp" which is too low.
Speed Regulator Manual Tuning
If it is not possible to tune the speed regulator using the autotune function, then the step response of the speed regulator can be tuned manually using the following procedure. To obtain accurate results, the load torque must be steady.
1. Set parameter "Spdreg bandwidth in "Speed Control" to 1.0 rad/sec.
Speed Control Parameter Screen
2. Set parameter "Total inertia" in "Speed Control" to an initial value of 1.0 sec. 4-86 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
3. Assign parameter Speed Error in the "Current Control" group to a SCBL test point (Rect TP1 or 2). This can be done similarly to the way that the meter assignments were described earlier in the chapter. Then it can be displayed on your oscilloscope. Use the settings 2V/division and 1 sec/division.
4. Adjust the reference command to a value around the middle of the operating speed range.
5. Start the drive and wait for it to accelerate to the commanded speed.
6. Set parameter "Speed ref step" in "Speed Control" to 0.8 Hz. The drive speed will step up and down by this amount at regular intervals. The step of 0.8 Hz corresponds to 4 V on the test point. Since the speed error signal has a range of only 4 Hz in order to achieve the required resolution for small changes in speed, the signal may sometimes rollover (jump from +10V to -10V) during the speed step. If this occurs, it can be eliminated by adjusting the reference command up or down slightly.
7. Adjust the value of parameter "Total inertia " until the speed rises to approximately 63% of its final value in 1 second as shown in the figure. If the response time is too fast, it indicates that Total inertia is set too high and should be decreased. If the response is too slow, then Total inertia is set too low and should be increased.
CORRECTLY TUNED SPEED REGULATOR
8. Set parameter "Spdreg bandwidth" to the normal operating value. Confirm that the response time is equal to the inverse of the speed regulator bandwidth and that there is minimal overshoot. For example, if the speed regulator bandwidth is set to 2 rad/sec, the speed should rise to 63% of its final value in 0.5 second.
9. Set parameter "Speed ref step" to zero and stop the drive.
Commissioning 4-87 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Calculating Total Inertia
If the system inertia cannot be measured, it can be calculated if the moment of inertia of the motor and load are known. The value of parameter "Total inertia" is defined as the time required to accelerate the motor and load to rated speed when rated torque is applied. It can be calculated using the following formula:
Total inertia = total inertia of motor & load in kg-m 2 X ( rated speed in rad/ sec) 2
rated power in watts or
Total inertia = 6.21 x 10 -7 total inertia of motor and load in lb-ft 2 X ( rated speed in rpm) 2
rated power in hp
If there is a gearbox between the motor and load, the inertia of the load must be referred to the motor side of the gearbox.
Running the Load Motor Starting Torque
When starting without a tachometer or encoder, the drive operates in an open loop mode below approx. 3 Hz at which point the drive switches to closed loop speed control. The starting currents are set by three parameters; Torque Commands 0 (P86), 1 (P87), and Minimum (P101). Torque Command 0 sets the breakaway torque and Torque Command 1 is the torque at the transition point from open to closed loop. Torque Command Minimum operates in conjunction with Torque Command 1 to minimize speed overshoot at the transition point. If you are starting an uncoupled motor, or simply autotuning, the default starting torque values may be sufficient to run the motor. But the defaults are generally not high enough to start a loaded motor.
Be prepared to have to increase starting torque and endure Motor Stall faults during initial operation.
Reaching Specific Load Points
Verify the drive can reach rated speed and load. Monitor the Torque Reference (P291) and the displayed value of the motor current. If you are running into a torque limit the Torque Reference will be running near the Torque Limit Motoring (P84) limit. If you are not realizing rated motor current you may increase the Torque Limit Motoring slightly. If increasing the Torque Limit Motoring does not help to increase the motor amps and speed then the drive is most likely running out of input voltage. 4-88 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Monitor the V Line Average (P135), and increase the tap setting on the drive feed if the measured value is less than 1.03 pu. It is desirable to have V Line Average read in the 1.03 to 1.07 pu range. Alpha Line (P327) should be greater than 15 while running at rated speed and load, indicating how far forward the rectifier is phased. The input voltage should be increased by tapping up the transformer.
Fill in the following table with data from the various load points. If possible, capture the running parameters with the printer, DriveTools, or Hyperterminal as a substitute for recording the data in the table below. This should be forwarded with all commissioning data back to Product Support for future reference.
It is also an excellent practice to capture and save critical drive waveforms at rated speed, rated load. A good list of waveforms to capture is indicated below:
a) SCB-L unfiltered voltages (Vab1-out, Vbc1-out, Vca1-out, etc.) b) SCB-L unfiltered currents (In1-out, Ic1-out) c) SCB-L DC link current (Idcp) d) SCB-M unfiltered voltages (Vab1-out, Vbc1-out, Vca1-out) e) SCB-M unfiltered currents (In1-out, Ic1-out)
18-pulse rectifiers have six additional voltage test points.
Capturing each waveform at 2 ms, 5 ms and 10 ms yields best results.
Below are examples of various waveforms taken from actual drives installed in the field. Please note that 18-pulse rectifier currents are on the secondary side of the isolation transformer.
Figures 4.20 to 4.23: PWM Rectifier, 4160V, 2000 HP, 249A
Figure 4.20 DC Current Test @ .3 pu: Idcp (1) vs. Vdc_Avg (2)
Commissioning 4-89 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 4.21 Running Full Speed/Full Load: Line Side; Vab1_out (1) vs. Ia1_out (2)
Figure 4.22 Running Full Speed/Full Load: Line Side; Vab1_out (1) vs. Idcp (2) 4-90 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Figure 4.23 Running Full Speed/Full Load: Motor Side; Vab1_out (1) vs. Ia3_out (2)
Figures 4.24 to 4.28: 18-pulse Rectifier, 6600V, 600 HP, 49A
Figure 4.24 Running DC Current Test Mode: .80 pu: Idcp (1) vs. Vdc_Avg (2)
Commissioning 4-91 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 4.25 Running Full Speed, 90% Load: Line Side; Vab1_out (1) vs. Ia1_out (2)
Figure 4.26 Running Full Speed, 90% Load: Line Side; Vab1_out (1) vs. Ia1_out (2)
4-92 Commissioning 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Figure 4.27 Running Full Speed, 90% Load: Line Side; Vab1_out (1) vs. Idcp (2)
Figure 4.28 Running Full Speed, 90% Load: Motor Side; Vab1_out (1) vs. Ia3_out (2)
Commissioning 4-93 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Capturing Data When all of the final commissioning procedures are completed and the drive is running, it is VERY IMPORTANT TO CAPTURE ALL THE DRIVE DATA for future reference.
The last step should be to PRINT --> DRIVE SETUP. This will print all the parameters (regardless of the user access level), the various firmware revisions, the exploded fault masks, the PLC links, and the Analog configuration.
All of this information is required to address future customer issues.
Introduction The PowerFlex 7000 is an adjustable speed ac drive in which motor speed control is achieved through control of the motor torque. The motor speed is calculated or measured and the torque is adjusted as required to make the speed equal to the speed command. The motor and load determine the stator frequency and the drive synchronizes itself to the motor. This is in contrast to the volts/hertz ac drive in which the drive determines the stator frequency and does not attempt to synchronize its output to the motor.
The method of control used in PF7000 is known as direct rotor flux oriented vector control. The term rotor flux vector control indicates that the position of the stator current vector is controlled relative to the motor flux vector. Direct vector control means that the motor flux is measured, in contrast to the indirect vector control in which the motor flux is predicted. In both control methods, the stator current (I s ) is split into flux producing component (I sd ) and an orthogonal torque producing component (I sq ) which are controlled independently. The aim of vector control is to allow a complex ac motor to be controlled as if it were a simple dc motor with independent, decoupled field and armature currents. This allows the motor torque to be changed quickly without affecting the flux. For typical Medium Voltage motors the rotor time constant is in the range of seconds and therefore the flux cannot be changed quickly.
The PowerFlex 7000 drive can be used with either induction (asynchronous) or synchronous motors. Synchronous motor drives are identical to induction motor drives except for the addition of a current regulated field supply to the synchronous drive. The features that are unique to a synchronous motor drive are confined to the flux control function and the encoder option.
5-2 Functional Description
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Description of Operation A complete block diagram of the PF7000 control circuit is shown below. The major blocks are described in the following sections.
M o t o r M o t o r M o d e l L i n e P r o t e c t i o n M a c h i n e C o n v e r t e r L i n e C o n v e r t e r D C
L i n k i n d u c t o r M o t o r
f i l t e r c a p M a c h i n e
s i d e f e e d b a c k
a n d g a t i n g L i n e
s i d e
f e e d b a c k a n d
g a t i n g F l u x a n g l e A l p h a m a c h i n e I x c o m m a n d I y c o m m a n d L i n e
f i l t e r c a p A C
L i n e r e a c t o r I d c F e e d b a c k L i n e
v o l t a g e S o u r c e T a c h F e e d b a c k S l i p
f r e q S t a t o r
f r e q S p e e d C o n t r o l S y n c T r a n s f e r F l u x C o n t r o l C u r r e n t C o n t r o l A l p h a l i n e M a c h i n e P r o t e c t i o n L i n e c u r r e n t M o t o r v o l t a g e M o t o r c u r r e n t S p e e d
f e e d b a c k F l u x
f e e d b a c k F a u l t s F a u l t s S p e e d R e f e r e n c e S p e e d C o m m a n d M o t o r M o t o r M o d e l L i n e P r o t e c t i o n M a c h i n e C o n v e r t e r L i n e C o n v e r t e r D C
L i n k i n d u c t o r M o t o r
f i l t e r c a p M a c h i n e
s i d e f e e d b a c k
a n d g a t i n g L i n e
s i d e
f e e d b a c k a n d
g a t i n g F l u x a n g l e A l p h a m a c h i n e I x c o m m a n d I y c o m m a n d L i n e
f i l t e r c a p A C
L i n e r e a c t o r I d c F e e d b a c k L i n e
v o l t a g e S o u r c e T a c h F e e d b a c k S l i p
f r e q S t a t o r
f r e q S p e e d C o n t r o l S y n c T r a n s f e r F l u x C o n t r o l C u r r e n t C o n t r o l A l p h a l i n e M a c h i n e P r o t e c t i o n L i n e c u r r e n t M o t o r v o l t a g e M o t o r c u r r e n t S p e e d
f e e d b a c k F l u x
f e e d b a c k F a u l t s F a u l t s S p e e d R e f e r e n c e S p e e d C o m m a n d
Figure 5.1 Functional Block Diagram of PF 7000 control system Functional Description 5-3 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Speed Command The function of Speed Command block is to select one of the 13 possible speed command inputs. Parameter Reference Select (2) in conjunction with Local/Remote selector switch is used to define the speed command input Speed Command In (276). When the selector switch is in Local position, the default speed command is the Analog Speed Potentiometer typically mounted on the LV panel. When the selector switch is in Remote position, the parameter Reference Select defines the source of speed command. The options available are: 3 analog inputs (Speed Pot, Remote 0-10V, Current Loop: 4-20mA or 0-20mA) 3 Preset speed commands 6 DPI/SCANport commands 1 Preset jog speed command
The above speed commands are used when the drive is in Normal mode of operation. However PF7000 has many special modes of operation e.g. test modes or auto-tuning for which different speed commands are selected. Table 5.A summarizes the speed command during these special modes.
Table 5.A Speed Commands for special operating modes of PF7000 Special operating modes of PF7000 Speed Command In(276) DC test mode 60Hz Open Circuit Rated Line Freq(17) Open Loop 0.1*Rated Line Freq(17) Rs autotune 2Hz Ls autotune Rated Line Freq(17) Flux Reg autotune Autotune Spd Cmd(213) Speed Reg autotune Autotune Spd Cmd(213) Demagnetize Rated Motor Freq(29) Sync transfer requested Bypass Freq(159)
The selected Speed Command In is clamped to a minimum and a maximum level by parameter Spd Cmd Max (290) and Spd Cmd Min (293) to give Speed Command (277). The maximum value of Speed Command cannot be greater than 125% of Base Speed (98).
Note: Contact the factory for applications that require output frequencies greater than 125% of the motor base speed. 5-4 Functional Description
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Speed Command (cont.) Three skip speeds Skip Speed 1(50), Skip Speed 2 (51), Skip Speed 3 (52) are provided to prevent the drive from continuously operating at a certain speed. This feature is sometimes needed to avoid mechanical vibrations occurring in a drive system at certain speeds. The skip speed zone around each Skip Speed is specified by the parameter Skip Spd Band1 (53), Skip Spd Band2 (54), Skip Spd Band3 (55) If the desired Speed Command lies in a given skip speed zone, the Speed Command is clamped to the lowest value in the zone. E.g. if Skip Speed 1 is 45 Hz with Skip Spd Band1 as 1 Hz, then the skip speed range extends from 44.5Hz to 45.5Hz. If the desired speed command is set to 45 Hz, then the drive will avoid this speed and run at 44.5Hz.
The final stage in processing the command is the whether the drive has been requested to run forward or reverse. The sign is changed if reverse rotation is selected or is set to zero if there is no run request.
Speed Reference The function of the Speed Reference block is to determine the Speed Reference (278) from the desired Speed Command (277). PF7000 provides two options: S-curve Linear Ramp
To select, S-curve a non-zero value of S-curve Percent (475) is selected. Using parameter S curve Acc1 (481), the drive automatically calculates the linear and the non-linear portions of the S-curve as shown in Figure 5.2. Following example shows how to use S-curve parameters:
Example
If S curve Acc1 is set for 20sec with 20% in S-curve Percent, then the total acceleration time is increased by 0.2 x 20 = 4 seconds. The total acceleration time will now be 24 seconds with 4 seconds in the non-linear portion of the S-curve. Since the curve is symmetrical, each of the segments will be of 2 seconds duration.
The parameters for deceleration are calculated using parameter S curve Dec1 (479) and S-curve Percent (475) and shown in Figure 5.2.
Linear Ramp is enabled if the S-curve Percent is set to zero. Independent four section ramps are provided for acceleration and deceleration. The ramp is specified by 4 Ramp Speeds, 4 Accel and Decel times and is shown in Figure 5.3.
Functional Description 5-5 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Linear Portion Non-Linear Portion Non-Linear Portion S Curve Acc1 (481) 0.005* S Curve Acc1 *S Curve Percent S Curve Dec1 (479) Linear Portion Non-Linear Portion Non-Linear Portion 0.005* S Curve Acc1 *S Curve Percent 0.005* S Curve Dec1 *S Curve Percent 0.005* S Curve Dec1 *S Curve Percent Linear Portion Non-Linear Portion Non-Linear Portion S Curve Acc1 (481) 0.005* S Curve Acc1 *S Curve Percent S Curve Dec1 (479) Linear Portion Non-Linear Portion Non-Linear Portion 0.005* S Curve Acc1 *S Curve Percent 0.005* S Curve Dec1 *S Curve Percent 0.005* S Curve Dec1 *S Curve Percent
Speed Control The function of the speed control block is to determine the torque- producing component (I sq ) of the stator current (I s ). The inputs to the block are the Speed Reference (278) from the speed ramp and the Stator Freq (448) and Slip Frequency (343) from the motor model. If drive is installed with an optional tachometer, then the motor speed is determined by counting the tach pulses.
In Sensorless operation, the Slip Frequency is subtracted from the Stator Freq and filtered to determine the Speed Feedback (289). In Pulse Tach mode, the speed is determined directly by using Tach Feedback (348). The Speed Feedback is subtracted from the Speed Reference to determine the Speed Error (472) which is processed by the speed PI regulator. The gains of the regulator are based on the Total Inertia (82) of the system and the desired Spdreg Bandwidth (81). The output of the speed regulator is the Torque Reference (291) whose rate of change is limited by Trq Rate Limit (83). The calculated Torque Reference is divided by the Flux Reference (305) to determine the torque component of the stator current Isq Command (292). To calculate the torque producing current supplied by the inverter Iy Command (294), the current supplied by the motor filter capacitor in torque production (orthogonal to motor flux) is calculated and subtracted from Isq Command.
In Sensorless mode, the drive uses Trq Command 0 (86) and Trq Command 1 (87) for an open loop start up. At frequencies greater than 3Hz, the drive closes the speed loop and disables the open loop start mode. In Pulse Tach mode, the drive is always in closed loop. The maximum torque a drive can deliver in motoring mode is determined by Trq Lmt Motoring (84). In regenerative mode the torque is limited to Trq Lmt Braking (85). It should be noted that at speeds above the Base Speed (98), the motor torque capability is de- rated and varies in inverse proportion to the speed.
Depending open the application, a drive can be configured in different torque control modes by setting the parameter Trq Control Mode (90). E.g. in stand-alone drives the parameter is set as Speed Reg allowing the drive to be in speed control mode. In Master-Slave or torque follower applications, the master drive is set in Speed Reg mode which enables the speed regulator. The torque reference produced by the Master drive is then passed on to the slave drive which is operating in Ext Torq Cmd mode. The slave drive then follows the torque command. Figure 5.4 shows other various modes of operation.
Functional Description 5-7 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
S t a t o r
F r e q
( 4 4 8 ) S p e e d
F d b k M o d e
( 8 9 ) T R Q
R A T E L I M I T S p e e d
E r r o r ( 4 7 2 ) T r q R a t e L i m i t ( 8 3 ) I s q C o m m a n d ( 2 9 2 ) T o r q u e
R e f e r e n c e ( 2 9 1 ) S P E E D F E E D B A C K F I L T E R S p d F d b k F i l t e r ( 1 1 0 ) T r q C o m m a n d
1 ( 8 7 ) T r q C o m m a n d
0 ( 8 6 ) F r e q
C l o s e
L o o p O P E N
L O O P
S T A R T + - + S P E E D M O D E S E L E C T T a c h F e e d b a c k ( 3 4 8 ) S l i p
F r e q u e n c y ( 3 4 3 ) S y n c h
R e g O u t p u t
( 2 9 8 ) S P E E D R E G U L A T O R S p d r e g B a n d w i d t h ( 8 1 ) T o t a l
I n e r t i a ( 8 2 ) T r q C o m m a n d
E x t ( 9 1 ) T r q L m t M o t o r i n g ( 8 4 ) T r q C o n t r o l M o d e ( 9 0 ) T O R Q U E C O N T R O L M O D E T r q C o n t r o l M o d e
( 9 0 ) S p e e d
F d b k M o d e ( 8 9 ) M o t o r
F i l t e r
C a p
( 1 2 8 ) L
T o t a l
L e a k a g e
( 1 3 0 ) I y C o m m a n d ( 2 9 4 ) R
S t a t o r
( 1 2 9 ) I s d C o m m a n d ( 3 1 0 ) S p e e d F e e d b a c k ( 2 8 9 ) 1 , 5 , S , T 2 ,
5 3 4 S S T O R Q U E L I M I T S p e e d
C o m m a n d
I n ( 2 7 6 ) S p e e d
R e f e r e n c e ( 2 7 8 ) S p d r e g B a n d w i d t h ( 8 1 ) T M O T O R M O D E L I s q C o m m a n d ( 2 9 2 ) F l u x
R e f e r e n c e ( 3 0 5 ) + - S P E E D R E F E R E N C E S p d C m d M i n ( 2 9 3 ) S c u r v e P e r c e n t ( 4 7 5 ) S p d C m d M a x ( 2 9 0 ) S p e e d
F d b k M o d e
( 8 9 ) S :
S e n s o r l e s s T :
P u l s e
T a c h T r q C o n t r o l
M o d e
( 9 0 ) 0 :
Z e r o
T o r q u e 1 :
S p e e d
R e g 2 : E x t
T r q C m d 3 : S p d
T r q P o s 4 :
S p d T r q N e g 5 :
S p d S u m F l u x
R e f e r e n c e ( 3 0 5 ) T r q L m t B r a k i n g ( 8 5 ) C A P C U R R E N T C A L C U L A T O R S t a t o r
F r e q
( 4 4 8 ) S p e e d
F d b k M o d e
( 8 9 ) T R Q
R A T E L I M I T S p e e d
E r r o r ( 4 7 2 ) T r q R a t e L i m i t ( 8 3 ) I s q C o m m a n d ( 2 9 2 ) T o r q u e
R e f e r e n c e ( 2 9 1 ) S P E E D F E E D B A C K F I L T E R S p d F d b k F i l t e r ( 1 1 0 ) T r q C o m m a n d
1 ( 8 7 ) T r q C o m m a n d
0 ( 8 6 ) F r e q
C l o s e
L o o p O P E N
L O O P
S T A R T + - + S P E E D M O D E S E L E C T T a c h F e e d b a c k ( 3 4 8 ) S l i p
F r e q u e n c y ( 3 4 3 ) S y n c h
R e g O u t p u t
( 2 9 8 ) S P E E D R E G U L A T O R S p d r e g B a n d w i d t h ( 8 1 ) T o t a l
I n e r t i a ( 8 2 ) T r q C o m m a n d
E x t ( 9 1 ) T r q L m t M o t o r i n g ( 8 4 ) T r q C o n t r o l M o d e ( 9 0 ) T O R Q U E C O N T R O L M O D E T r q C o n t r o l M o d e
( 9 0 ) S p e e d
F d b k M o d e ( 8 9 ) M o t o r
F i l t e r
C a p
( 1 2 8 ) L
T o t a l
L e a k a g e
( 1 3 0 ) I y C o m m a n d ( 2 9 4 ) R
S t a t o r
( 1 2 9 ) I s d C o m m a n d ( 3 1 0 ) S p e e d F e e d b a c k ( 2 8 9 ) 1 , 5 , S , T 2 ,
5 3 4 S S T O R Q U E L I M I T S p e e d
C o m m a n d
I n ( 2 7 6 ) S p e e d
R e f e r e n c e ( 2 7 8 ) S p d r e g B a n d w i d t h ( 8 1 ) T M O T O R M O D E L I s q C o m m a n d ( 2 9 2 ) F l u x
R e f e r e n c e ( 3 0 5 ) + - S P E E D R E F E R E N C E S p d C m d M i n ( 2 9 3 ) S c u r v e P e r c e n t ( 4 7 5 ) S p d C m d M a x ( 2 9 0 ) S p e e d
F d b k M o d e
( 8 9 ) S :
S e n s o r l e s s T :
P u l s e
T a c h T r q C o n t r o l
M o d e
( 9 0 ) 0 :
Z e r o
T o r q u e 1 :
S p e e d
R e g 2 : E x t
T r q C m d 3 : S p d
T r q P o s 4 :
S p d T r q N e g 5 :
S p d S u m F l u x
R e f e r e n c e ( 3 0 5 ) T r q L m t B r a k i n g ( 8 5 ) C A P C U R R E N T C A L C U L A T O R
Figure 5.4 Speed Control 5-8 Functional Description
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Flux Control The function of the flux control block (Figure 5.5) is to determine the magnetizing component (I sd ) of the stator current (I s ) needed to maintain the desired flux profile in the motor. The inputs are Flux Feedback (306) and Stator Freq (448) from the motor model, Speed Feedback (289) and Torque Reference (291) from the speed control block and the measured voltage at the input of the bridge Vline Bridge (696).
The Flux Feedback is subtracted from the Flux Reference (305) to determine the Flux Error (307), which is the input to the flux PI regulator. The gains are determined from desired Flxreg Bandwidth (97) and motor parameters T Rotor (132) and L Magnetizing (131). The output of the flux regulator is Isd Command 1(309). An open loop estimate of the magnetizing current, Isd Command 0 (308) is determined by dividing the Flux Reference by parameter L Magnetizing. Isd Command 0 and Isd Command 1 are added to produce Isd Command (310) which is the magnetizing component of the stator current command. To calculate the magnetizing current supplied by the inverter Ix Command (312), the current supplied by the motor filter capacitor in magnetizing is calculated and subtracted from Isd Command. It should be noted that as the motor speed increases, Ix Command decreases. This is because as the motor voltage increases more of the magnetizing current requirement of the motor is met by the capacitor. At resonant point, Ix Command is nearly zero and becomes negative at speeds above resonance. Iy Command (from Speed Control block) and Ix Command are then passed to the Current Control block to determine the dc link current reference (Idc Reference) and the firing angles of the two converters (Alpha Line and Alpha Machine).
The flux profile in the drive is adjusted by the parameters Flx Cmd No Load (103) and Flx Cmd Base Spd (100). Using these parameters, Flux Reference is adjusted linearly with the desired Torque Reference. At light loads motor flux is decreased allowing reduction in losses while full flux is produced at rated load. The maximum flux reference is limited to Flux Cmd Limit (623). This limit is dependent on the input voltage Vline Bridge and the motor speed (Speed Feedback). If the drive operates at reduced line voltage, then Flux Reference is reduced. Also if the motor is running above the Base Speed, the flux profile is made inversely proportional to the speed of the motor resulting in the field weakening or the constant power mode of operation of the drive. This is accompanied by a decrease in the motor torque capability.
Functional Description 5-9 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
V L i n e B r i d g e ( 6 9 6 ) S p e e d
F e e d b a c k ( 2 8 9 ) B a s e
S p e e d ( 9 8 ) L
M a g n e t i z i n g ( 1 3 1 ) I s d C o m m a n d
0 ( 3 0 8 ) - F l x C m d B a s e
S p d ( 1 0 0 ) F l x C m d N o
L o a d
( 1 0 3 ) T o r q u e
R e f e r e n c e
2 9 1 ) F L U X L I M I T F l u x
E r r o r ( 3 0 7 ) F L U X R E G U L A T O R + F l u x R e f e r e n c e ( 3 0 5 ) + + F l u x
C m d L i m i t ( 6 2 3 ) F l x r e g B a n d w i d t h ( 9 7 ) F l u x
F e e d b a c k ( 3 0 6 ) S t a t o r
F r e q ( 4 4 8 ) F L U X C O M M A N D L I M I T R a t e d
M o t o r
V o l t ( 2 2 ) R a t e d
L i n e
V o l t s ( 1 8 ) I s d C o m m a n d
1 ( 3 0 9 ) L
M a g n e t i z i n g ( 1 3 1 ) T
R o t o r
( 1 3 2 ) I s d C o m m a n d ( 3 1 0 ) I s q C o m m a n d ( 2 9 2 ) M o t o r
F i l t e r
C a p
( 1 2 8 ) L
T o t a l
L e a k a g e
( 1 3 0 ) I x
C o m m a n d ( 3 1 2 ) R
S t a t o r
( 1 2 9 ) C A P C U R R E N T C A L C U L A T O R 1 . 0 - 1 . 0 E X C I T A T I O N C U R R E N T L I M I T V L i n e B r i d g e ( 6 9 6 ) S p e e d
F e e d b a c k ( 2 8 9 ) B a s e
S p e e d ( 9 8 ) L
M a g n e t i z i n g ( 1 3 1 ) I s d C o m m a n d
0 ( 3 0 8 ) - F l x C m d B a s e
S p d ( 1 0 0 ) F l x C m d N o
L o a d
( 1 0 3 ) T o r q u e
R e f e r e n c e
2 9 1 ) F L U X L I M I T F l u x
E r r o r ( 3 0 7 ) F L U X R E G U L A T O R + F l u x R e f e r e n c e ( 3 0 5 ) + + F l u x
C m d L i m i t ( 6 2 3 ) F l x r e g B a n d w i d t h ( 9 7 ) F l u x
F e e d b a c k ( 3 0 6 ) S t a t o r
F r e q ( 4 4 8 ) F L U X C O M M A N D L I M I T R a t e d
M o t o r
V o l t ( 2 2 ) R a t e d
L i n e
V o l t s ( 1 8 ) I s d C o m m a n d
1 ( 3 0 9 ) L
M a g n e t i z i n g ( 1 3 1 ) T
R o t o r
( 1 3 2 ) I s d C o m m a n d ( 3 1 0 ) I s q C o m m a n d ( 2 9 2 ) M o t o r
F i l t e r
C a p
( 1 2 8 ) L
T o t a l
L e a k a g e
( 1 3 0 ) I x
C o m m a n d ( 3 1 2 ) R
S t a t o r
( 1 2 9 ) C A P C U R R E N T C A L C U L A T O R 1 . 0 - 1 . 0 E X C I T A T I O N C U R R E N T L I M I T
Figure 5.5 Flux Control
5-10 Functional Description
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame Flux Control for Synchronous Motor
Most of the magnetization for a synchronous motor is supplied by the rotor field winding, unlike an induction motor where all of the magnetizing current is supplied through the stator. However, control of the motor flux through the field current is very slow because of the large time constant of the dc field winding and the current and voltage limitations of the field supply. To obtain sufficiently fast response from the flux regulator the magnetizing current is split into transient and steady state components, with the steady state component supplied through the rotor and the transient component through the stator. The additions to the flux control required for synchronous machines are shown in the block diagram (Figure 5.6). The portion of the motor filter capacitor current supplied by the drive is then added to determine Ix Command, which is the magnetizing component of the dc link current command.
Parameter Icd Command Gain (107) determines how the motor filter capacitor current is split between the motor and the drive. When this parameter is set to its minimum value of 0.0, all the capacitor current is supplied by the drive. The line current is higher than the motor current and the motor operates at approximately unity power factor. When this parameter is set to its maximum value of 1.0, the motor supplies all the capacitor current. The line current is less than the motor current and the motor operates at a lagging power factor with reduced field current. Functional Description 5-11 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
- I c d C o m m a n d
G a i n ( 1 0 7 ) I s d c o m m a n d
( 3 1 0 ) I f
C m d B a n d w i d t h ( 1 0 6 ) L O W
P A S S F I L T E R L
m a g n e t i z i n g ( 1 3 1 ) L m d ( 4 1 8 ) I x
c o m m a n d ( 3 1 2 ) I
F i e l d
C o m m a n d
( 3 1 4 ) + + + - + M o t o r
F i l t e r
C a p ( 1 2 8 ) L
T o t a l
L e a k a g e ( 1 3 0 ) L
M a g n e t i z i n g ( 1 3 0 ) C A P
C U R R E N T C A L C U L A T O R S t a t o r
F r e q ( 4 4 8 ) F l u x
R e f e r e n c e ( 3 0 5 ) - I c d C o m m a n d
G a i n ( 1 0 7 ) I s d c o m m a n d
( 3 1 0 ) I f
C m d B a n d w i d t h ( 1 0 6 ) L O W
P A S S F I L T E R L
m a g n e t i z i n g ( 1 3 1 ) L m d ( 4 1 8 ) I x
c o m m a n d ( 3 1 2 ) I
F i e l d
C o m m a n d
( 3 1 4 ) + + + - + M o t o r
F i l t e r
C a p ( 1 2 8 ) L
T o t a l
L e a k a g e ( 1 3 0 ) L
M a g n e t i z i n g ( 1 3 0 ) C A P
C U R R E N T C A L C U L A T O R S t a t o r
F r e q ( 4 4 8 ) F l u x
R e f e r e n c e ( 3 0 5 )
Figure 5.6 Flux Control for Synchronous Motor 5-12 Functional Description
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Current Control The function of the current control block (Figure 5.7) is to determine the firing angles for the converters Alpha Line (327) and Alpha Machine (328). The inputs are the torque (Iy Command) and flux producing (Ix Command) components of the dc link current command from the speed control and flux control blocks respectively, and the measured dc link current Idc Feedback (322).
The square root of the sum of the squares of Ix Command and Iy Command determines the dc link current reference Idc Reference (321). This is subtracted from the measured dc current feedback is subtracted to determine Idc Error (323). This is processed by the current regulator to produce Vdc Error (332). To effectively control the dc link current an estimate of the motor side dc link voltage is done to calculate Vdc Feedforward (333) which is added to Vdc Error to produce the reference voltage for the line side converter Vdc Reference (326). The line converter firing angle is the inverse cosine of Vdc Reference. The machine converter firing angle is determined by taking the inverse tangent of the ratio of Iy Command to the Ix Command. The quadrant of operation is adjusted based on the signs of the current commands.
Functional Description 5-13 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
I x
C o m m a n d ( 3 1 2 ) A l p h a
M a c h i n e
( 3 2 8 ) C u r r e g B a n d w i d t h ( 1 1 3 ) L i n k
I n d u c t a n c e ( 2 7 ) D C
L I N K C U R R E N T R E G U L A T O R T
D C
l i n k ( 1 1 5 ) I d c R e f e r e n c e ( 3 2 1 ) V d c R e f e r e n c e ( 3 2 6 ) A l p h a
L i n e ( 3 2 7 ) I y C o m m a n d ( 2 9 4 ) I d c f e e d b a c k ( 3 2 2 ) + - I d c E r r o r ( 3 2 3 ) V
S t a t o r ( 3 4 4 ) V
l i n e
A v e r a g e ( 1 3 5 ) A l p h a
M a c h i n e ( 3 2 8 ) + + V d c E r r o r ( 3 3 2 ) F E E D F O R W A R D F I L T E R A d v a n c e
L i m i t = 0 . 9 9 R e t a r d L i m i t ( 3 2 5 ) A d v a n c e
R a t e L i m i t ( 1 2 1 ) L I M I T E R F e e d f o r w a r d F i l ( 5 0 2 ) V d c F e e d f o r w a r d ( 3 3 3 ) t a n - 1 c o s -1 c o s - 1 x 2 + y 2 I x
C o m m a n d ( 3 1 2 ) A l p h a
M a c h i n e
( 3 2 8 ) C u r r e g B a n d w i d t h ( 1 1 3 ) L i n k
I n d u c t a n c e ( 2 7 ) D C
L I N K C U R R E N T R E G U L A T O R T
D C
l i n k ( 1 1 5 ) I d c R e f e r e n c e ( 3 2 1 ) V d c R e f e r e n c e ( 3 2 6 ) A l p h a
L i n e ( 3 2 7 ) I y C o m m a n d ( 2 9 4 ) I d c f e e d b a c k ( 3 2 2 ) + - I d c E r r o r ( 3 2 3 ) V
S t a t o r ( 3 4 4 ) V
l i n e
A v e r a g e ( 1 3 5 ) A l p h a
M a c h i n e ( 3 2 8 ) + + V d c E r r o r ( 3 3 2 ) F E E D F O R W A R D F I L T E R A d v a n c e
L i m i t = 0 . 9 9 R e t a r d L i m i t ( 3 2 5 ) A d v a n c e
R a t e L i m i t ( 1 2 1 ) L I M I T E R F e e d f o r w a r d F i l ( 5 0 2 ) V d c F e e d f o r w a r d ( 3 3 3 ) t a n - 1 c o s -1 c o s - 1 x 2 + y 2
Figure 5.7 Current Control 5-14 Functional Description
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Line Converter Feedback The function of the line converter feedback block is to process (scale and filter) the line side voltage and current feedback signals before being sampled by the drive control software. It represents most of the analog portion of the line side Signal Conditioning Board (SCBL) and the Drive Control Board. The line converter Voltage Feedback Board (VFB) provides a total of six voltage feedback signals representing the three ac (V a1 , V b1 , V c1 ), two dc (V dc+ , V dc- ) and one line side filter capacitor voltages referenced to ground. The three line-to-ground voltages are subtracted from each other to produce the three line to line voltages (V ab1-out , V bc1-out , V ca1-out ). These line voltages are filtered (V ab1 , V bc1 , V ca1 ) and sampled by software for synchronization and protection. The two dc voltages are subtracted to determine the line side dc link voltage (V dc ), which is used for hardware dc link over-voltage protection. In PWM drives, the neutral point of the line filter capacitor is measured (V n ) and used for line side neutral over-voltage protection.
Current transformers (CT) in two of the ac input lines provide the input line current feedback (I a1-out , I c1-out ). These currents are then filtered and processed by a variable gain stage (I a1 , I c1 ,). Inverting and adding the two current feedback signals reproduces the current in the remaining phase (I b1 ). A Hall Effect Current Sensor (HECS) is used for monitoring the dc link current and used for hardware over- current protection. In addition the average value of the dc link current feedback is measured using a V-f converter and used by the dc link current controller to calculate the firing angle for the rectifier.
The preceding description applies to 6-SCR and PWM rectifier options. For drives with the 18 pulse front-end, another VFB is daisy chained with the first one providing additional six line-to-ground voltages from the slave bridges. The slave 1 voltages are monitored using (V ab2 , V bc2 , V ca2 ) while slave 2 voltage are monitored using (V ab3 , V bc3 , V ca3 ). In addition current feedback from slave bridges I a2 , I c2 and I a3 , I c3 are also brought in for protection. As in 6-pulse drives, inverting and adding the two current feedback signals reproduces the current in the remaining phase (I b1, I b2 ). Also for 18 pulse drives, the three ac line to ground voltages are summed together to determine the neutral to ground voltage (V ng ) on the input transformer.
Functional Description 5-15 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Machine Converter Feedback The function of the machine converter feedback block is to process (scale and filter) the raw voltage and current feedback signals to the form required by the drive control software. It represents most of the analog portion of the machine side Signal Conditioning Board (SCBM) and the Drive Control Board. The machine converter VFB provides a total of six voltage feedback signals representing the three ac (V a1 , V b1 , V c1 ), two dc (V dc+ , V dc- ) and one machine side filter capacitor neutral voltage referenced to ground. The motor line to ground voltages are subtracted from each other and filtered to produce the three motor line to line voltages (V ab1 , V bc1 , V ca1 ).
The two dc voltages are subtracted to determine the machine side dc link voltage (V dc ), which is used for hardware dc link over-voltage protection. The motor line to ground voltages are summed to determine the motor neutral to ground voltage (V ng ) and is used for motor neutral over-voltage protection.
Hall Effect Current Sensor (HECS) provide stator current feedback in two of the motor phases (I a3-out , I c3-out ). These currents are then filtered and processed by a variable gain stage (I a3 , I c3 ) before being sampled for protection. Inverting and adding the two current feedback signals reproduces the current in the remaining phase (I b3 ).
The motor line voltages and currents are further used to calculate the motor flux (F ab , F bc , F ca ) using a hardware analog model. The measured flux (V d and V q ) is then used in the motor model block (described in the next section) for synchronization and drive control.
For drives with Synchronous Transfer option, an additional VFB is used for sensing three line-to-ground bypass voltages. These line-to- ground voltages are subtracted from each other to yield two line-to- line voltages (V abxfer-out , V bcxfer-out ). These are further filtered (V abxfer , V bcxfer ) and sampled by the software for synchronizing the drive output voltage to the bypass voltage.
If drive is installed with an optional tachometer, the feedback cable is plugged into the SCBM. The motor speed is then determined by counting the tach pulses in the FPGA on the machine side Drive Control Board.
5-16 Functional Description
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Motor Model The function of the motor model block (Figure 5.8) is to determine the rotor flux position (Flux Angle), flux feedback (Flux Feedback), applied stator frequency (Stator Freq), slip frequency (Slip Frequency) and motor operating variables like stator current (I Stator), stator voltage (V Stator), torque (Torque), power (Motor Power) and power factor (Mtr Pwr Factor).
The PowerFlex 7000 uses Rotor Flux oriented control to achieve independent control of motor flux and torque. This is achieved by synchronizing the machine converter gating to Flux Angle. To determine the flux feedback, stator frequency and the synchronizing reference frame the drive uses either the Voltage or the Current model. For speeds greater than 3Hz, the drive uses the voltage model (hardware analog flux model) to calculate the Flux from Voltage, Flux Angle V and Stator Freq V. Below 3Hz, the drive uses the current model to calculate Flux from Current, Flux Angle C and Stator Freq C. The current model is based on indirect vector control and uses the d-q components of stator current along with motor parameters T Rotor and L Magnetizing. Based on the operating speed of the drive and the speed feedback mode (Sensorless or Pulse Tach), a flux select algorithm determines the model to be used. Motor model also calculates the Slip Frequency which is used in the calculation of the motor speed (Speed Control) in Sensorless mode and for determining the rotor flux position in Pulse Tach mode.
The synchronously rotating frame (Flux Angle) is used in transforming the measured motor currents and voltages into d-q components. The direct axis components (I sd and V sd ) are in phase with the rotor flux, while the quadrature axis components (I sq and V sq ) are displaced 90 degrees from the rotor flux. The stator current (I Stator) and voltage magnitudes (V Stator) are calculated by taking the square root of the sum of the squares of the respective d-q components. The motor Torque is calculated by multiplying the Flux Feedback and I sq with motor torque constant. Torque multiplied by the motor speed gives the Motor Power. Mtr Power Factor is determined as the ratio of motor active power and the apparent power.
Functional Description 5-17 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
T a c h F e e d b a c k
( 3 4 8 ) V E C T O R R O T A T O R I s d C o m m a n d
( 3 1 0 ) F L U X
S E L E C T C U R R E N T
F L U X M O D E L F l u x
F e e d b a c k
( 3 0 6 ) F l u x
A n g l e
( 3 0 4 ) S t a t o r
F r e q
( 4 4 8 ) F l u x
A n g l e
( 3 0 4 ) M o t o r
C u r r e n t s I
S t a t o r
( 3 4 0 ) M O T O R O P E R A T I N G V A R I A B L E S V
S t a t o r
( 3 4 4 ) M o t o r
P o w e r
( 3 4 6 ) T o r q u e
( 3 4 5 ) M o t o r
V o l t a g e s R o t o r
A n g l e ( 3 0 2 ) M t r P o w e r
F a c t o r
( 6 9 2 ) V
s q ( 6 9 1 ) 33 F l x f r o m
V o l t a g e
( 3 4 2 ) S t a t o r
F r e q
V
( 4 8 5 ) F l u x
A n g l e
V
( 4 8 9 ) F l x f r o m
C u r r e n t
( 3 4 1 ) F l u x
A n g l e
C
( 4 9 2 ) S t a t o r
F r e q
C
( 4 8 6 ) V O L T A G E
F L U X M O D E L T
R o t o r
( 1 3 2 ) S p e e d
R e f e r e n c e
( 2 7 8 ) I s q C o m m a n d
( 2 9 2 ) F l u x
R e f e r e n c e ( 3 0 5 ) S l i p
F r e q u e n c y
( 3 4 3 ) M o t o r
C u r r e n t s M o t o r
V o l t a g e s 33 V
s d ( 6 9 0 ) I
s q ( 3 3 9 ) I
s d ( 3 3 8 ) T a c h F e e d b a c k
( 3 4 8 ) V E C T O R R O T A T O R I s d C o m m a n d
( 3 1 0 ) F L U X
S E L E C T C U R R E N T
F L U X M O D E L F l u x
F e e d b a c k
( 3 0 6 ) F l u x
A n g l e
( 3 0 4 ) S t a t o r
F r e q
( 4 4 8 ) F l u x
A n g l e
( 3 0 4 ) M o t o r
C u r r e n t s I
S t a t o r
( 3 4 0 ) M O T O R O P E R A T I N G V A R I A B L E S V
S t a t o r
( 3 4 4 ) M o t o r
P o w e r
( 3 4 6 ) T o r q u e
( 3 4 5 ) M o t o r
V o l t a g e s R o t o r
A n g l e ( 3 0 2 ) M t r P o w e r
F a c t o r
( 6 9 2 ) V
s q ( 6 9 1 ) 33 F l x f r o m
V o l t a g e
( 3 4 2 ) S t a t o r
F r e q
V
( 4 8 5 ) F l u x
A n g l e
V
( 4 8 9 ) F l x f r o m
C u r r e n t
( 3 4 1 ) F l u x
A n g l e
C
( 4 9 2 ) S t a t o r
F r e q
C
( 4 8 6 ) V O L T A G E
F L U X M O D E L T
R o t o r
( 1 3 2 ) S p e e d
R e f e r e n c e
( 2 7 8 ) I s q C o m m a n d
( 2 9 2 ) F l u x
R e f e r e n c e ( 3 0 5 ) S l i p
F r e q u e n c y
( 3 4 3 ) M o t o r
C u r r e n t s M o t o r
V o l t a g e s 33 V
s d ( 6 9 0 ) I
s q ( 3 3 9 ) I
s d ( 3 3 8 )
Figure 5.8 Motor Model 5-18 Functional Description
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Except for the dc link over-current, line side dc link over-voltage and machine side dc link over voltage, the drive protection is customer configurable in the software. Adjustable parameters specifying the trip level and time delay are provided for each fault (see Medium Voltage AC Drive Parameters, Publication 7000-TD001_-EN-P). A detailed list of all the faults and warnings (alarms) is provided in Chapter 7 (Troubleshooting).
The response to a drive alarm falls into three categories:
For Class 1 faults (with the exception of dc link over-current, line side dc link over-voltage and machine side dc link over-voltage), the line converter is immediately phased back to retard limit until the dc link current drops to zero. The gating for both converters is disabled and the contactors (if installed) are opened. At this point the motor will coast and its speed will depend on the characteristics of the load. For some high inertia loads, the motor may coast for a long time.
The dc link over-current and dc link over-voltage (line and machine) are special cases in that the fault detection is performed by hardware because a very fast response is required. The hardware fault detection responds to instantaneous values. Also the drive response to these faults is different from other Class1 faults because it freezes the SGCT gating (both converters if a PWM rectifier based drive and only the inverter side if a 6P/18P SCR drive) until the dc link current has dropped to zero. The gating is then disabled and contactors are opened.
For Class 2 faults the motor is brought to a normal stop before the gating is disabled and the contactors opened. Typical examples of Class2 faults are motor overload, drive overload and loss of load. Line/Machine Converter Protection Functional Description 5-19 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
For most Warnings no action is taken and drive maintains its normal operation. A warning could be an indication of a problem in drive e.g. an Air Filter warning is an indication of a blocked air filter. In addition there are a few warnings in the drive that may cause momentary interruption in the operation of the drive e.g. Master UV, Line Loss or Bus Transient. The action taken is similar to a Class1 fault and the normal operation is resumed once the transient condition has disappeared. If a drive experiences Master UV or Line Loss, then Auto Restart Dly (3) should be set to a non-zero value in order to resume normal operation.
It is important to understand how contactors (input and output) behave in an event of fault. If the input contactor is set for Not Running or All Faults via parameter Input ContCfg (1), then the contactor opens on any fault (Class1, Critical or Class2) in the drive. This happens after the dc link current has been brought to zero and the gating for all converters disabled. If the contactor is set for Critical Flt, then the contactor will open only when a critical fault (explained above) happens in the drive. For all other faults (Class1 or Class2) the input contactor will remain closed after the drive has been shut off.
An output contactor, whose configuration is specified by Output ContCfg (5), opens for any fault in the drive. This happens after the dc link current has been brought to zero and the gating for all converters disabled.
The PowerFlex 7000 drive tests for the failure of the power semiconductors (SCRs or SGCTs) before running and while running. The method used to detect failed devices is different for starting (offline diagnostics) and for running (on-line diagnostics), but the same hardware is used in both situations. The drive control receives a feedback signal via a fiber-optic cable from each device gate driver, which can indicate whether or not it is healthy. SCR diagnostics are based on sensing the voltage across the device while SGCT has smart diagnostics built in the gate driver board. The feedback and the gating have a certain relationship when the device is healthy or failed. This is shown in Figure 5.10. The following section describes the diagnostics in detail. The description applies to all 6P, 18P and PWM PowerFlex 7000 drives.
Power Semiconductor Diagnostics 5-20 Functional Description
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Off line Detection of Failed SCRs/SGCTs
Line Converter 6P-SCR, 18P-SCR and PWM
The rectifier diagnostics are performed when medium voltage is first applied by closing the input contactor and when the drive receives a start command. From 4.001 onwards, the drive also performs off line diagnostics when a drive reset command is issued. These diagnostics are capable of detecting a bad device, loss of feedback fiber optic and loss of gating fiber optic. The diagnostics consist of two stages. A passive diagnostic test followed by an active diagnostic test. In the passive diagnostics test no devices are gated.
SCR Rectifier Passive Off-Line Diagnostics For SCR rectifiers, when the line voltage is applied to the drive but the drive is not running, the voltage across the line converter thyristors is high and positive for half cycle except during intervals around the zero of the line voltage. The gate driver transmits light whenever the device is forward biased with a large enough voltage as shown in Figure 5.9. Since the drive is not gating (no light) the feedback normally toggles state every cycle of the utility voltage. However the feedback will not toggle state if the device is shorted, or if the feedback fiber-optic path is incomplete. If this occurs, the drive faults and issues an Offline SC fault for the device.
PWM Rectifier Passive Off-Line Diagnostics For PWM rectifiers the feedback for these devices should always be high. However a high feedback level will not be received if a device is shorted or if the feedback fiber-optic path is incomplete. The drive presumes the device has failed and determines which devices would be safe to gate for the more detailed active offline diagnostic test. Power Semiconductor Diagnostics (cont.) Functional Description 5-21 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Diagnostic feedback high Diagnostic feedback low Voltage across a thyristor when medium voltage is applied Diagnostic feedback for a healthy SCR Diagnostic feedback for a shorted SCR Diagnostic feedback high Diagnostic feedback low Voltage across a thyristor when medium voltage is applied Diagnostic feedback for a healthy SCR Diagnostic feedback for a shorted SCR
Figure 5.9 Voltage across a thyristor when MV is applied
Typical SGCT Gating pattern Healthy Diagnostic Feedback Gate Cathode shorted or PS problem 1 0 0 0 0 0 LIGHT NO LIGHT NO LIGHT LIGHT LIGHT NO LIGHT LIGHT NO LIGHT No gating received No diagnostic feedback 1 1 1 1 Typical SGCT Gating pattern Healthy Diagnostic Feedback Gate Cathode shorted or PS problem 1 0 0 0 0 0 LIGHT NO LIGHT NO LIGHT LIGHT LIGHT NO LIGHT LIGHT NO LIGHT No gating received No diagnostic feedback 1 1 1 1
SCR Rectifier Active Off-Line Diagnostics In the active diagnostic test, each device is gated at maximum blocking voltage. For a healthy SCR, the feedback will normally change from high to low when gated. However the drive will receive a high state both before and after gating if the device is open-circuited, there is an incomplete gating fiber-optic path or a damaged gate driver. When this occurs the drive will issue an Offline OC fault for the device. If the drive receives a low signal in both states, there may be shorted device or an incomplete feedback fiber optic. If this occurs drive will issue an Offline SC fault for the device. Failed or open-circuited snubber connections will shift the device blocking voltage (when not running) which may case either fault to appear. It should be noted that during the active diagnostics stage a dc link voltage which is close to rated voltage will appear due to interaction with the snubber circuit.
PWM Rectifier Active Off-Line Diagnostics For the PWM rectifier, the active diagnostic test can differentiate between a failed device and a broken fiber-optic path because the gate driver toggles the feedback differently when gated as shown in Figure 5.10. As in the SCR rectifier active offline diagnostics, each device is gated at peak blocking voltage (if MV is available). Devices which could cause a line to line short circuit are not gated. If the drive detects a failed device a Device Flt is issued for the device. A weak gate power supply may also cause a device fault. If the drive receives no light signal both before and after gating, then there may be an incomplete feedback fiber- optic and an Fbk FO Loss fault will be issued. A completely failed or unplugged power supply will also cause this fault. If the drive always receives feedback both before and after gating, the device may not have received the gating signal and a Gat FO Loss fault will be issued. From 4.001 onwards, the drive will not allow the contactor to be closed if it detects enough failed devices to cause a line to line short circuit.
Machine Converter off line diagnostics
The inverter diagnostics are performed when the drive control is powered up and when the drive receives a start command. From 4.001 onwards, the drive also performs off line diagnostics when a drive reset command is issued. These diagnostics are capable of detecting a bad device, loss of feedback fiber optic and loss of gating fiber optic.
The inverter off-line diagnostics are similar to the PWM rectifier diagnostics except that: no passive diagnostic is done, no consideration is given to line-to-line short-circuits and the input contactor is not involved. The inverter off-line diagnostics will generate Device Flt Fbk FO Loss and Gat FO Loss faults.
Power Semiconductor Diagnostics (cont.) Functional Description 5-23 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
On-line detection of Failed SCRs/SGCTs
When the gating is enabled for both converters, the feedback from the gate drivers is constantly switching on and off, usually several times per cycle. The diagnostics feedback signals from each device are monitored and the protective measures are performed.
SCR On-Line Diagnostics For SCR rectifier drives, the drive detects both open and shorted devices while running. Due to notching and interaction with the other phases, the SCR feedback diagnostic changes state many times per cycle, although it is only valid just before and after firing the device. Just before firing a device, the drive takes several samples of the diagnostic feedback from the SCR. If every sample indicates that the device was on before it was fired, the drive considers that the device may be shorted, and starts a timer. When this timer exceeds the number of line cycles specified by the parameter Rec Dvc Diag Dly (266) the drive generates an Online SC fault. Each device has its own timer. A delay of zero will generate a fault immediately. A delay of 2 will generate a fault after 2 cycles which indicates that the fault has been seen three times in a row.
Shortly after the drive fires an SCR it checks the feedback from the gate driver boards. If the feedback shows that the device did not fire the drive considers that the device may be open-circuited and starts a timer. If the fault persists for 6 cycles, the drive generates an Online OC fault. As with the short circuit fault, each device has its own timer, however the delay is not adjustable.
Both on-line device diagnostics are not available at all modes of operation due to the nature of the feedback from the gate driver. No diagnostics are done when the rectifier firing angle is less than 15 degrees. No diagnostics are done when the dc current is discontinuous.
SGCT on-line diagnostics The PWM rectifier and inverter generate only one type of on-line diagnostic fault. Due to the intelligent gate driver board the drive is able to check the status of every SGCT in a bridge any time a device in the bridge is fired. The drive takes a sample of every devices feedback before and after firing the bridge. If both samples indicate that the device is not functioning correctly the drive starts a timer for that device. When this timer reaches the value specified by parameter Rec Dvc Diag Dly (266) for the PWM rectifier, or Inv Dvc Diag Dly (268) for the inverter the drive generates an Online Flt. The actual time to trip will vary with the switching frequency of the bridge in question. A bridge changes state at three times the switching frequency. For a PWM rectifier switching at 420 Hz (7pulse at 60 Hz), the bridge changes state at 1260 Hz. This means the delay is in multiples of around 0.8 ms. 5-24 Functional Description
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Test Modes The PowerFlex 7000 AC drive is provided with test modes to check the functionality of the drive during commissioning. These test modes are selected using the parameter Operating Mode in the Feature Select group. When Test Mode is set to the default value of Normal, the drive is in the normal operating mode. The parameter cannot be changed while the drive is running.
Setting Operating Mode to Gate Test allows the gating checks to be performed on the rectifier and the inverter. Both the input and output contactors must be open and medium voltage must not be applied to the drive. This test is carried out in conjunction with two additional parameters Inv Gating Test and Rect Gating Test. Upon selecting Gate Test, both the parameters are automatically set to Test Pattern. A brief description follows in this section.
Setting Inv Gating Test to Test Pattern will fire the inverter devices in a sequential Z pattern at a low frequency (1Hz) and is verified by observing the LEDs on the SGCT gate driver board. Setting Inv Gating Test to Time Pattern or Normal Gate will result in the inverter devices firing as in normal mode of operation. The frequency of the gating is controlled by parameter Speed Command In (276). Setting Inv Gating Test to Off stops the inverter test gating sequence.
In 6 or 18 pulse SCR PowerFlex drives, the gate driver boards derive power from medium voltage. Hence to check the line converter gating in Gate Test mode where there is no MV available, a special power harness is required. The line converter gating is quickly checked by setting the Rect Gating Test to Test Pattern. This will fire the rectifier devices in a sequential Z pattern at a low frequency (1Hz) with only one device on at a time and is verified by observing the LEDs on the SCR gate driver boards. For 6 pulse SCR drives with series devices, selecting Time Pattern will fire two series devices at a time. The relative timing between the gating pulses can be verified by observing at the test points. To set the rectifier gating in normal operation select Normal Gate. The SCR firing is at the input line frequency. In this mode, ensure that for 6 and 18 pulse SCR drives only two devices are connected to the power harness. For 6 pulse PWM drives no power harness is required as the SGCTs are powered by the Gate Power Supply.
S H O C K H A Z A R D S H O C K H A Z A R D Disconnect all ends of cable before applying medium voltage power. Failure to disconnect cable before applying medium voltage can result in damage to equipment, serious personal injury or death.
Functional Description 5-25 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Application of medium voltage to the drive input or output when it is operating in gate test mode may cause severe damage to the drive.
To test the line converter and to tune the dc link current regulator and the line commutating impedance, the drive Operating Mode is selected as DC Current. In this test mode, the line converter operates normally, but the machine converter gating is modified to gate both the positive and negative legs in the same phase in order to short-circuit the dc link current through the machine converter. The short circuit current is slowly rotated among the three phases with overlap between phases to ensure that an open circuit does not occur during commutation. There is no current in the motor and the output contactor (if installed in the drive) is opened). The dc current command is set equal to the value specified by parameter Idc Command Test (119) in the Current Control group. In this test mode the line converter firing angle Alpha Line (327) will be close to 90 degrees. This is because it takes very small dc voltage to build current in a shorted dc link.
Setting Operating Mode to System Test selects the system test mode. This mode is used to test the drive as a system, including interfaces with external devices such as programmable controllers, without applying power to the drive or motor. The drive behaves as if it was running normally but device gating disabled. Since the input, output, and bypass contactors operate normally in this mode, it must be ensured that the drive and motor are isolated from medium voltage. If the drive detects medium voltage in this test mode, a fault MV in SystemTest is issued and the input contactor is opened.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
It is the responsibility of the operator to ensure that the drive and motor are isolated from medium voltage when the drive is operating in system test mode with the input, output, and bypass contactors closed.
Setting Operating Mode to Open Circuit, selects the open circuit test mode. This mode is used to test the drives at rated output voltage and frequency without connecting it to a motor. In open circuit test mode, ac current sufficient to produce rated voltage at the drive output is forced through the output filter capacitors. When the drive is started in this mode, it ramps up to rated frequency and synchronizes its output voltage with the line voltage. The current reference is set to a value that will produce voltage at the drive output set by the parameter Flx Cmd Base Spd (100).
5-26 Functional Description
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Open circuit test mode should not be used when the drive is connected to a load unless an output contactor is provided.
Setting Operating Mode to Open Loop selects a diagnostic mode in which the drive is run in an open loop manner without closing any of the feedback loops on the motor side (Speed and Flux regulators). Parameters Trq Command 0 and Trq Command 1 are used to inject motor current at a small stator frequency (typically 10% of Rated Line Frequency). Motor will be turning in this mode and drive analog flux feedback variables Flux from Voltage (342) and Stator Freq V (485) are used to ensure the reliability of the analog feedback.
This feature is available in firmware release 4.001 and higher for drives running induction motors only.
Flying Start (Induction Motor) Using this feature, the PowerFlex 7000 AC drive is capable of restarting a motor that is not stationary but is already rotating. In normal operation, the output of the drive is synchronized with the motor flux, which is derived from the stator voltage and current feedback. If there is no motor current, then whether the motor is rotating or stationary, it does not generate any significant voltage and it is not possible to determine the stator frequency. If there is no detectable stator voltage, the drive assumes that the motor is stationary, because this is the most likely case. Therefore, when the drive is started, the frequency starts from an initial value of zero and ramps up until motor flux is detected. Significant flux is created in the motor only when the slip frequency (i.e. the difference between the applied stator frequency and rotor frequency) is small. When the drive is started with the motor stationary, the initial slip frequency is small and the motor flux builds up fairly quickly. But, if the motor is already spinning, then very little flux will be induced until the stator frequency is quite close to the rotor frequency, at which time the motor flux will suddenly rise to a level sufficient for the drive to detect and synchronize to. If the drive reaches the commanded speed without detecting any motor flux, then it will trip on a motor stall fault. There are four possible causes of a motor stall when starting: Functional Description 5-27 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
1. The motor has pulled out and stalled during starting due to insufficient torque. The remedy for this is to increase the value of some or all of the parameters Trq Command 0, Trq Command 1 and Accel Time 1.
2. The motor was already rotating but the flying start failed because the drive passed through the low slip region too quickly to allow the motor flux to build up. The solution to this problem is to increase the value of parameter Accel Time 1. Most medium voltage motors have a rotor time constant in the range of 1 to 5 seconds, and it can take a few seconds for the flux to rise to a detectable level. Until flux is detected, the drive does not use the normal speed ramp but continues to accelerate at the rate defined by parameters Accel Time 1 and Ramp speed 1.
3. The motor is rotating in the direction opposite to the commanded direction of rotation. The slip frequency will increase instead of decreasing as the drive accelerates and no flux will be induced in the motor.
4. The motor is rotating in the commanded direction but at a speed higher than the commanded speed. The drive will reach the commanded speed and trip before the slip frequency is low enough to induce flux in the motor.
If the motor is coasting at a high enough speed (above about 40 Hz) and the output contactor is closed, then the motor will self excite with the drive motor filter capacitors and generate a high stator voltage that the drive can detect. With software release 4.001, the drive will re-synchronize to this voltage and drive will quickly restart.
If the optional tachometer feedback is installed, then the drive knows the speed of the motor at all times and can perform a flying start for any speed or direction of rotation. 5-28 Functional Description
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Flying Start (Synch Motor) With a synchronous motor, flying start is much quicker and more reliable because a detectable stator voltage is produced whenever the field is applied and the motor is rotating, even with zero stator current. When the drive is started, rated field current is applied to the motor but the stator current remains at zero until the end of the ramp start delay to allow the rotor flux to build up. If the stator frequency is greater than about 2 Hz, sufficient stator voltage is generated to allow the drive to detect the speed and direction of the motor and synchronize itself to the motor flux. If the flux feedback does not reach the level specified by parameter Flux minimum (156) the drive assumes that the motor is stationary and starts from zero frequency.
If an optional position encoder is installed, a flying start can be performed for any speed or direction of rotation.
Tachometer/Encoder Option The optional tachometer/encoder provides two significant enhancements to the drive control:
1. Provides an accurate measurement of motor speed at all times 2. Extends closed loop speed and torque control down to nearly zero speed.
A pulse tachometer, also called a pulse generator or incremental encoder, produces a pulse train output with a frequency proportional to shaft speed. The machine side Signal Conditioning Board (SCBM) provides optically isolated inputs for a quadrature pulse tachometer. Single-phase tachometer can be also be used if reverse rotation never occurs. Parameter Tach Type (233) specifies which type is used.
Dividing the number of tach pulses by the sampling period yields the tach output frequency, from which the shaft speed can be calculated using the tach pulses per revolution (ppr) specified by parameter Tach pulse/rev (234). The tach resolution determines the minimum motor speed that can be measured. If high starting torque or very low speed operation is required, a high resolution such as 1024 or 2048 ppr must be provided. Otherwise, a low resolution such as 240 or 360 ppr is adequate.
The analog flux signal is not usable for stator frequencies less than about 3 Hz. To control flux and torque at low speeds, the PowerFlex 7000 drive switches to current model based on indirect vector control. With indirect control, the position of the rotor flux is not directly measured but is indirectly predicted by adding the calculated slip angle to the measured rotor angle. The rotor angle is obtained by integrating the output of the pulse tach (the zero position is arbitrary). Functional Description 5-29 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
The slip frequency required to provide the desired flux and torque is calculated by the motor model. The slip frequency is integrated to get the slip angle and added to the measured rotor angle to obtain the flux angle. Indirect control can be used at any speed, but its weakness is that the calculated slip is sensitive to errors in the motor parameters. Errors in slip frequency increase the coupling between flux and torque which adversely affects the stability of the flux control. Since large motors generally have lower magnetizing current and lower slip than small motors, they are more sensitive to parameter errors (i.e. a small error in slip produces a large error in torque and flux).
Because of its salient pole construction, the position of the rotor flux in a synchronous machine is not arbitrary but is determined by the physical position of the rotor. A synchronous machine therefore requires an absolute position encoder instead of an incremental encoder for indirect vector control. The encoder must also be aligned with the direct axis of the rotor. To avoid having to physically align the encoder, an offset angle specified by parameter Encoder Offset (644) is added to the encoder output to compensate for the difference between the encoder zero and the direct axis of the rotor. Parameter Enc Direction (643) is provided to reverse the encoder rotation in software if it does not match the rotation of the motor. There is no parameter to specify the encoder resolution; it is inferred from the number of motor poles.
Synchronous Transfer Synchronous transfer is an optional feature of the PowerFlex 7000 drive which allows either a single or multi-motors to be transferred between the drive and a fixed frequency supply in either direction without stopping and with a very short interruption of power. Compared to a simple non-synchronous transfer in which power to the motor is interrupted for a significant length of time, the transient drop in motor speed is much less with synchronous transfer.
In order to perform a synchronous transfer, a drive output contactor and a bypass contactor are required as shown in Figure 5.11. The name bypass indicates that the function of this contactor is to connect the motor directly to the fixed frequency supply, bypassing the drive. An additional Voltage Feedback Board (VFB) is used to measure the bypass voltage on the line side of the bypass contactor. These inputs are brought in through the machine side Signal Conditioning Board (SCBM) and used in synchronizing the motor voltage directly to the bypass voltage resulting in a reliable synchronous transfer. In addition the measurement of bypass voltage allows certain protection features to be built in. The synchronous transfer is automatically aborted if the drive detects an over-voltage or under-voltage or reverse sequence in the bypass voltage. 5-30 Functional Description
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
PF7000 MOTOR Input contactor Output contactor Bypass contactor Bypass bus Input bus PF7000 CONTROL PF7000 MOTOR Input contactor Output contactor Bypass contactor Bypass bus Input bus PF7000 CONTROL
Figure 5.11 A typical synchronous transfer set up using PF7000
For single motor applications, the drive is capable of performing synchronous transfer without the need for a Programmable Logic Controller (PLC). The command to close the bypass contactor and the status of the bypass contactor are realized using the digital IO on machine side SCB while the command to close the drive output contactor and the status of the drive output (DO) contactor are realized using the digital IO on the line side SCB. In addition to a DO contactor, an application may require an output (OP) contactor. This is controlled via machine side SCB. The run time commands Request to Bypass (Synch) and Transfer to drive (De-synch) are wired to the standard XIO board. Synchronous transfer will not be performed if the phase sequence of the bypass voltage is not positive.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
If the phase rotation and phase angle of the bypass voltage compared to the drive input voltage are not correct, damage may occur to the drive, motor, couplings and driven equipment if a transfer to bypass is attempted.
Functional Description 5-31 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
For all multiple motor synchronizing applications, a PLC is used for overall control of the synchronous transfer operation. Typically, the PLC gives control of the bypass contactor to the drive before performing the transfer, and takes back control after the transfer is completed.
Note: The following note applies only to applications using PLCs.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Since the programmable controller and not the drive controls the output and bypass contactors, the transfer command must always go via the PLC and never directly to the drive from another controlling device (e.g. a Remote I/O adapter).
The following section will describe the sequence of operation on single motor synchronous transfer without using a PLC.
Transfer to Bypass
When the motor is running on the drive and a synchronous transfer is required, the transfer takes place in the following sequence:
1. The drive is given a Request to Bypass command, which must remain active until the synchronous transfer is complete. If the transfer command is removed before the bypass contactor is requested to close, the drive will abort the transfer and return to normal running. When the drive receives the transfer command, it accelerates the motor up to the measured Bypass Freq (159). If the drive is unable to achieve synchronous speed, it may be necessary to increase parameter Trq Lmt Motoring (84).
2. When the motor reaches synchronous speed, the synchronizing regulator is activated whose response is controlled by parameter Sync Reg Gain (225). It adjusts the drive Speed Reference as required, to synchronize the motor to the bypass with the motor voltage leading the bypass voltage by an angle specified by parameter Sync Lead Angle (226). This parameter is used to compensate for the drifts in the motor and bypass voltage before the bypass contactor closes. If the phase error tends to oscillate, it may be necessary to adjust parameters Sync Reg Gain or Spdreg Bandwidth. 5-32 Functional Description
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
3. When the phase error between the motor voltage and bypass voltage has remained less than the value specified by parameter Sync Error Max (228) for the time interval specified by parameter Sync Time (229) the drive activates its bp contactor close output.
4. After a time delay specified by Sync Off Delay (227) the drive shuts off. It is important that this parameter is set to the correct value. This should be at least 1 cycle less than the contactor closing time. If this time delay is set too short, the motor voltage could drift out of phase with the bypass voltage. If the time delay is set too long, a drive overcurrent fault may occur because the drive is unable to control its output voltage and frequency once the bypass contactor has closed.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
If parameter Sync Off Delay is set incorrectly, damage may occur to the drive, motor, couplings, and driven load if a transfer to bypass is attempted.
5. When the bp contactor status input indicates that the bypass contactor has closed, the drive deactivates the do contactor close output. When the output contactor opens, the drive is disconnected from the motor, leaving the output filter capacitors charged to bypass voltage.
6. The synchronous transfer is now complete and the motor is running on bypass.
7. If in (3), the drive is unable to synchronize within the time specified by parameter Sync Xfer Time (230) the synchronous transfer is aborted. At this point the drive can either fault or issue a warning. This is controlled by the parameter Sync Xfer Option (419). If selected as Enable Fault the drive faults and ramps the motor down to a stop, else if it is selected as Enable Warn, the drive keeps running at the last commanded speed.
Synchronous Transfer (cont.) Functional Description 5-33 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
T I M E D E L A Y M o t o r
v o l t a g e
a n g l e S y n c
L e a d
A n g l e ( 2 2 6 ) _ B y p a s s
v o l t a g e
a n g l e S y n c
R e g G a i n ( 2 2 5 ) S Y N C X F E R R E G U L A T O R 0 S y n c
X f e r O p t i o n
( 4 1 9 ) S y n c
R e g O u t p u t
( 2 9 8 ) T o
S p e e d
C o n t r o l C l o s e
B y p a s s
C o n t a c t o r S y n c
O f f
D e l a y ( 2 2 7 ) S y n c
T i m e ( 2 2 9 ) S y n c
E r r o r
m a x ( 2 2 8 ) - 3
H z 3
H z ++ T I M E D E L A Y S h u t
o f f
d r i v e S y n c
R e g E r r o r
( 2 9 7 ) D i s a b l e d E n a b l e
W a r n o r E n a b l e
F a u l t T I M E D E L A Y M o t o r
v o l t a g e
a n g l e S y n c
L e a d
A n g l e ( 2 2 6 ) _ B y p a s s
v o l t a g e
a n g l e S y n c
R e g G a i n ( 2 2 5 ) S Y N C X F E R R E G U L A T O R 0 S y n c
X f e r O p t i o n
( 4 1 9 ) S y n c
R e g O u t p u t
( 2 9 8 ) T o
S p e e d
C o n t r o l C l o s e
B y p a s s
C o n t a c t o r S y n c
O f f
D e l a y ( 2 2 7 ) S y n c
T i m e ( 2 2 9 ) S y n c
E r r o r
m a x ( 2 2 8 ) - 3
H z 3
H z ++ T I M E D E L A Y S h u t
o f f
d r i v e S y n c
R e g E r r o r
( 2 9 7 ) D i s a b l e d E n a b l e
W a r n o r E n a b l e
F a u l t
Figure 5.12 Transfer to Bypass
5-34 Functional Description
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Transfer to Drive
To transfer a motor running on the bypass back to the drive a Transfer to Drive command is requested. Following sequence of events take place:
1. The drive is given a Transfer to Drive command. After a normal start command is given, the drive closes the output contactor. After the do contactor close input indicates that the output contactor has closed, there is a short delay (~1second) to allow the output filter capacitors to charge to the bypass voltage. Within this time, the drive synchronizes to the capacitor voltage with the motor still running on bypass. The drive then deactivates its bp contactor close output.
2. When the bp contactor status input indicates that the bypass contactor has opened, the drive goes to run mode. As the drive brings the motor torque up to the level required by the load, the motor speed will drop slightly before returning to the commanded speed.
3. The Transfer to Drive command is removed. The transfer is now complete and the motor is running on the drive. Synchronous Transfer (cont.) Functional Description 5-35 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Analog Outputs A total of thirteen programmable analog outputs are provided on various boards. There are two analog outputs on each SCB and 1 on the CIB, which are intended for diagnostic purposes and are available as test points for connection to an oscilloscope or chart recorder. These analog outputs are 8-bit, non-isolated, with a range of -10V to +10V. The CIB has one isolated 4-20mA or 0-20mA analog output and 7 non-isolated analog outputs for connection to external devices such as meters or isolation modules. The allocation of the analog outputs is shown below: No. Output Board Description 1 Rect_TP1 SCBL DAC_TP1 2 Rect_TP2 SCBL DAC_TP2 3 Inv_TP1 SCBM DAC_TP1 4 Inv_TP2 SCBM DAC_TP2 5 Cib_TP4 CIB CIB_TP4 6 4-20mA CIB Connector J4b 7 CIB_Port1 CIB Connector J5b 8 CIB_Port2 CIB Connector J5b 9 CIB_Port3 CIB Connector J5b 10 Meter Port 1 CIB Connector J9 11 Meter Port 2 CIB Connector J9 12 Meter Port 3 CIB Connector J9 13 Meter Port 4 CIB Connector J9 Any parameter or variable can be assigned to any analog output. The variables are scaled by using the corresponding scaling factor.
5-36 Functional Description
7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Chapter 6 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Component Definition and Maintenance
Control / Cabling Cabinet Components
Motor Terminals Transient Suppression Networks (TSN) Line Terminals Current Transformers (CT) Hall-Effect Current Sensor (HECS) Voltage Sensing Hall-Effect Current Sensor (HECS) Motor Terminals Transient Suppression Networks (TSN) Line Terminals Current Transformers (CT) Hall-Effect Current Sensor (HECS) Voltage Sensing Hall-Effect Current Sensor (HECS)
Figure 6.1 Control and Cabling Cabinet (18-pulse Rectifier version shown)
6-2 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Grounding Network (For use with Isolation Transformers) or Ground Filter (For use with Line Reactors) Motor Filter Capacitors (MFC) Power Terminals Voltage Sensing Hall Effect Current Sensors (HECS) Current Transformers (CT) Transient Suppression Network (TSN) Grounding Network (For use with Isolation Transformers) or Ground Filter (For use with Line Reactors) Motor Filter Capacitors (MFC) Power Terminals Voltage Sensing Hall Effect Current Sensors (HECS) Current Transformers (CT) Transient Suppression Network (TSN)
Figure 6.2 Cabling Cabinet for 6-pulse/PWM Rectifier
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-3 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Line Capacitors Line Reactor Motor Terminals Motor Filter Capacitors Line Terminals Zero Sequence Current Transformer (if supplied) Line Filter Capacitors (LFC) (MFC) Line Capacitors Line Reactor Motor Terminals Motor Filter Capacitors Line Terminals Zero Sequence Current Transformer (if supplied) Line Filter Capacitors (LFC) (MFC)
Figure 6.3 AC Line Reactor Cabinet with Connection Cabinet
6-4 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Voltage-Sensing Assembly The voltage-sensing assembly consists of the voltage sensing board and the mounting plate. The voltage sensing board has six independent channels which convert voltages up to 10800V (7.2kV x 1.5 pu) down to low voltage levels which can be used by the PowerFlex 7000 control logic (i.e. Signal Conditioning Board - SCB). Two of these assemblies can be linked together where one assembly acts as the master assembly, and the second assembly acts as the slave assembly. In this manner, up to twelve independent voltage channels can be measured. When two assemblies are linked together, the master assembly is used to send the twelve voltage signals to the SCB board. For drives that require the synchronous transfer option, one additional module is used. This assembly uses a separate connector to output the transfer voltages directly to the SCB board.
Below is a table of the input voltage ranges for each of the input terminals on the voltage-sensing board. There are four separate inputs taps for each of the six independent channels. This assembly has been designed to operate at a nominal input voltage of up to 7200V with a continuous 40% overvoltage. The output voltages are scaled to provide close to 10V peak for a 140% input voltage at the high end of each of the voltage ranges.
Each of the channels has only four taps, thus they must be used to provide a range of input voltages and software will be used to provide a given amount of gain so that 140% will correspond to the maximum numerical value of the analogue to digital converter.
Table 6.A Input Voltage Ranges Tap Voltage Range D 800 - 1449V C 1450 - 2499V B 2500 - 4799V A 4800 - 7200V
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N Grounds must be reconnected on the voltage sensing boards. Failure to do so may result in injury, death or damage to equipment. Component Definition and Maintenance 6-5 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
The number of sensing boards is dependent upon the drive rectifier configuration.
1. Ensure there is no power to the equipment.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N To prevent electrical shock, ensure the main power has been disconnected before working on the sensing board. Verify that all circuits are voltage free using a hot stick or appropriate high voltage-measuring device. Failure to do so may result in injury or death. 2. Mark the position of the ribbon cables and wires. 3. Remove the screws and lift the ring lugs from the terminals to remove the wires. 4. Release the locking mechanism located on each side of the ribbon cable connector and pull the ribbon cable straight out to prevent bending the pins. 5. Remove the four nuts and washers that secure the assembly to the studs welded to the frame. 6. Remove the old VSB and replace with the new VSB on the studs, using the existing hardware to secure the assembly. Do not overtorque the connections or you may break the studs. 7. Replace ring lugs on terminals. Plug in ribbon cables making sure that cables are positioned properly and fitting is secure (locking mechanism is engaged). 8. For personnel and equipment safety, ensure both grounding connections are re-connected to the sensing board.
Figure 6.4 Sensing Board with mounting hardware placement Voltage-Sensing Assembly Replacement 6-6 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Transient Suppression Network TSN Description The Transient Suppression Network Module consists of an assembly of suppressors that are connected to each of the three phase input lines and the structures ground bus. There is a separate assembly for each set of three phase input voltages: three assemblies for an 18-pulse drive.
A transient voltage spike in excess of the semiconductor rating will destroy or shorten the lifespan of the device. The Transient Suppression Network Module provides suppresion of transient overvoltages appearing on the input of the drive and is a standard feature of the drive. The two basic blocks of the TSN module are the MOV suppressor and the MOV fuse.
MOV Suppressor
The transient suppressors used in the module are heavy-duty metal oxide varistors or MOVs. Varistors are voltage dependent, nonlinear resistors. They have symmetrical voltage/current characteristics similar to back-to-back connected Zener Diodes. The varistor has very high resistance below its voltage rating and appears as an open circuit.
The leakage current through the device would be very small in this region. When a voltage transient occurs in which the voltage exceeds the knee in the curve, the varistor resistance changes from its high state by several orders of magnitude to a very low level. The voltage will be essentially clamped for a change in current of several orders of magnitude. This can be seen in Figure 6.5. 10 -7 10 -6 10 -5 10 -4 10 -3 10 -2 10 -1 10 0 10 10 2 10 3 10 4 10 5 CURRENT (AMPERES) - VOLTAGE (VOLTS) 10 -8 log scale l o g
s c a l e High Resistance Region Voltage Clamping Region Short Circuit Region
Figure 6.5 Typical MOV V-I Characteristic Curve Component Definition and Maintenance 6-7 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
When the MOV is clipping the voltage transient, the energy of the transient is being absorbed by the MOV. The varistor has a limited energy absorbing capability and generally there is not enough time for the heat generated to be conducted out of the device. The MOV is sized based on the steady-state voltage rating, the energy in the transient, and the repetition rate of the transients. A critical element in the MOV selection and protection offered is the impedance in the line supplying the transient. This impedance will be mainly that provided by the Isolation Transformer or the AC Line Reactor on the input of the drive. That is why an impedance level is specified for these input devices.
MOV Fuse
In series with each of the Phase MOVs is a medium voltage fuse. As seen in Figure 6.7, these fuses may be located on the assembly or remote from the assembly (on the Line Terminal Module). Check the part number on your module and the information in this documentation to determine which assembly you should have in your case.
The fuses provide overload protection for the conductors feeding the suppression network (and overcurrent protection if a short circuit occurs on the downstream side of the fuse.) These conductors will normally have a much smaller current carrying capacity than the drive input conductors and thus will not be protected by the drive input fuses. The fuses also serve to isolate a failed MOV. Varistors initially fail in a short-circuited condition. The high follow-through current will open the fuse and remove the MOV from the circuit.
The fuses used are E-rated current limiting fuses with a high interrupting rating. Because they are current limiting, they will limit both the magintude and duration of fault currents. They are small dimension, ferrule-type fuses with a fiberglass body, and mount in standard fuse clips.
I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T
The fuses sent with the Transient Suppression Network have been selected based on their characteristics (including internal resistance). This is necessary for optimum MOV performance and protection. Do not substitute other fuses without contacting the factory first.
Note: Voltage sensing occurs after the MOV fuse, and as a result open fuses will be detected in drive control as a Master or Slave Undervoltage or Unbalance.
6-8 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
U V W Drive Input Power from Line Terminals Transient Suppression Network Medium Voltage Input Fuses Phase MOV Suppressor Ground MOV Suppressor
Figure 6.6 Simplified Wiring Diagram
Two sizes of fuses (5 kV, 7.2 kV) are available within the Transient Suppression Network (TSN) located inside the connection cabinet. The 18-pulse drive contains three TSNs.
1. Ensure there is no power to the equipment.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N To prevent electrical shock, ensure the main power has been disconnected before working on the drive. Verify that all circuits are voltage free using a hot stick or appropriate voltage- measuring device. Failure to do so may result in injury or death.
Transient Suppression Network Fuse Replacement Component Definition and Maintenance 6-9 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
2. Fuses are held in a place with a fuse clip. To remove the fuse pull firmly.
3. To replace the fuse, hold it in position and push firmly until the fuse is seated within the fuse clip. Install fuses so that the rating is visible.
I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T
Make sure to replace the fuse with another of the same rating. (See Figure 6.7 for location.)
7.2 kV fuses 5 kV fuses Varistors Location of ground Connecting links Varistors Location for 7.2 kV fuses Location for 5 kV fuses 7.2 kV fuses 5 kV fuses Varistors Location of ground Connecting links Varistors Location for 7.2 kV fuses Location for 5 kV fuses
Figure 6.7 Transient Suppression Network 6-10 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Metal-oxide varistors (MOV) are part of the Transient Suppression Network located within the connection cabinet. The PWMR drive contains one varistor panel while the 18-pulse drive contains three.
1. Ensure there is no power to the equipment.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
To prevent electrical shock, ensure the main power has been disconnected before working on the transient suppression network. Verify that all circuits are voltage free using a hot stick or appropriate voltage-measuring device. Failure to do so may result in injury or death.
2. Observe the locations of the connecting links. 3. Detach the connecting links by removing the screws. 4. Using a screwdriver remove the screws at the base. 5. Replace the MOV (polarity is not an issue). 6. Continue by replacing the screws and connecting links.
I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T
Each MOV panel is grounded. Ensure that one MOV (see Figure 6.7 for location) is connected to the grounding lead.
PowerFlex 7000 18-pulse, some 6-pulse and some PWM-R drives will come with a grounding network installed. All other 6-pulse/PWM-R drives will have a notch filter in place of the grounding network.
The number of capacitors will vary depending on the system voltage. 1. Ensure there is no power to the equipment.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N To prevent electrical shock, ensure the main power has been disconnected before working on the capacitor. Verify that all circuits are voltage free using a hot stick or appropriate voltage-measuring device. Failure to do so may result in injury or death. 2. Note the position of the leads. 3. Remove the 6.4-mm ( inch) hardware and disconnect the leads connected to the terminals. 4. Four brackets are used to secure the capacitor. Loosen the four screws at the base of the brackets and lift the capacitor out. 5. Place the new capacitor and tighten the screws securely. Metal-Oxide Varistor Replacement Output Grounding Network Capacitor Replacement Component Definition and Maintenance 6-11 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 6. Replace the ring lugs and 6.4-mm ( inch) hardware. (See Figure 6.9)
I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T
The maximum torque for the capacitor terminal is 3.4 Nm (30 lb-in).
Capacitors Resistor Bank Reactor Transformer Capacitors Resistor Bank Reactor Transformer
Figure 6.8 Location of Notch Filter in B Frame Drive
Important: Torque on capacitor terminals 3.4 Nm (30 lb-in) Loosen screws to release capacitor Important: Torque on capacitor terminals 3.4 Nm (30 lb-in) Loosen screws to release capacitor Important: Torque on capacitor terminals 3.4 Nm (30 lb-in) Loosen screws to release capacitor Important: Torque on capacitor terminals 3.4 Nm (30 lb-in) Loosen screws to release capacitor Important: Torque on capacitor terminals 3.4 Nm (30 lb-in) Loosen screws to release capacitor Important: Torque on capacitor terminals 3.4 Nm (30 lb-in) Loosen screws to release capacitor
Figure 6.9 Capacitor in Grounding Network 6-12 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
The number of capacitors will vary depending on the system voltage. 1. Ensure there is no power to the equipment.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N To prevent electrical shock, ensure the main power has been disconnected before working on the capacitor. Verify that all circuits are voltage free using a hot stick or appropriate voltage-measuring device. Failure to do so may result in injury or death. 2. Note the position of the leads. 3. Disconnect the leads connected to the failed capacitor/resistor bank. 4. Loosen and remove mounting screws as indicated in Figure 6.10 and remove the failed component. 5. Assemble the new component in the reverse order of disassembly. 6. Reattach the leads strictly adhering to the torque requirements outlined in Figure 6.10)
I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T
The maximum torque for the capacitor terminal is 3.4 Nm (30 lb-in).
Important! Torque on Resistor Bank Assembly 1,2 Nm (11.0 lb-in) maximum Loosen screws to release capacitors Remove screws for replacing resistor bank. Important! Torque on capacitor terminals 3,4 Nm (30 lb-in) maximum
Figure 6.10 Notch Filter Capacitor Resistor Ground Filter Component Replacement Component Definition and Maintenance 6-13 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
1. Ensure there is no power to the equipment.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
To prevent electrical shock, ensure the main power has been disconnected before working on the Hall Effect current sensor. Verify that all circuits are voltage free using a hot stick or appropriate voltage-measuring device. Failure to do so may result in injury or death.
2. Note the location of all wires and the orientation of the Hall Effect current sensor. For quick reference when checking the orientation of the Hall Effect current sensor, look for the white arrow. I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T
The Hall Effect current sensor and wires must be in the proper orientation. Note the position before disassembly. 3. The round bus bar must be removed. Remove the M10 hardware and slide the bar out. 4. Remove the screws from the three terminals to allow removal of the ring lugs. 5. Remove the four screws on the base of the Hall Effect current sensor. 6. Replace the Hall Effect current sensor. Note the arrow must be oriented as shown in the illustration below. 7. Slide the bus bar back into place and secure with the M10 hardware. 8. Fasten the ring lugs on the wires back into place in the correct position. Do not overtighten or you will break the threaded stud.
Detail: LEM Base hardware M10 hardware Bus Bar Arrow must be oriented properly Arrows must be oriented properly. Hall Effect Sensor Hall Effect Current Sensor
Figure 6.11 Hall Effect Current Sensor located within cabinet with detail Hall Effect Current Sensor Replacement 6-14 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
1. Ensure there is no power to the equipment.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N To prevent electrical shock, ensure the main power has been disconnected before working on the current transformer. Verify that all circuits are voltage free using a hot stick or appropriate voltage-measuring device. Failure to do so may result in injury or death.
2. Note the location of all wires and the orientation of the CT. For quick reference when checking the orientation of the CT, look for the white dot. I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T
The CT and wires must be in the proper orientation. Note the position before disassembly. 3. Disconnect the wires. 4. The bus bar must be disassembled to allow removal of the CT. Remove the M10 hardware to allow the bus bar to slide out. 5. Remove the four screws located in the base of the CT and remove. 6. Replace the CT, ensuring the proper orientation. Fasten the CT securely with the four screws in the base 7. Reconnect the ring lugs. 8. Replace the bus bar and tighten into place.
Detail: Current Transformers (CT) Bus Bar Note the proper positioning of the leads and CT before disassembly.
Figure 6.12 Replacement of Current Transformer
Current Transformer Replacement Component Definition and Maintenance 6-15 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Filter Capacitors
Filter capacitors are used on the motor side for all 18-pulse and PWM rectifier drive options. The PWM rectifier option also includes filter capacitors on the line side. Refer to Figure 2.6 (Cabling Cabinet for 18-pulse Rectifier) and Figure 2.7 (Cabling Cabinet for 6-pulse/PWM Rectifier).
The filter capacitors are three-phase four-bushing units and oil- filled. The three-phase capacitors are comprised of internal single- phase units that are connected in an Y configuration. The neutral point of the Y is connected to the fourth bushing, which is accessible and can be used for neutral point voltage measurement or other protection/diagnostics purposes. Depending on the drive configuration, the fourth bushing may or may not be connected to a circuitry. The metal cases of the capacitors are grounded through a stud on the capacitor housing.
The capacitors are equipped with internal bleeding resistors to discharge the capacitor and reduce its voltage below 50V in 5 minutes when left disconnected. A typical three-phase capacitor is shown below:
Figure 6.13 Motor Filter Capacitor
W A R N I N G W A R N I N G
Allow 5-10 minutes for motor capacitors to safely discharge voltage prior to opening cabinet doors.
Filter Capacitor Cabinet 6-16 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame Filter Capacitor Replacement
1. Ensure there is no power to the equipment.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
To prevent electrical shock, ensure the main power has been disconnected before working on the current transformer. Verify that all circuits are voltage free using a hot stick or appropriate voltage-measuring device. Failure to do so may result in injury or death.
2. Note the location of all the cables and mark them accordingly.
3. Remove the 4 power connections to the terminals, and the single ground connector from the drive to the capacitor frame. This is located at the back top right corner of the capacitor.
4. Remove the front bracket that holds the capacitor in place. At the rear of the capacitor, there is no hardware securing the capacitor; it fits into a slot in the assembly.
5. Remove the capacitor from the drive. THESE CAPACITORS CAN WEIGH AS MUCH AS 100 kg (200 lbs), SO YOU WILL REQUIRE TWO PEOPLE TO REMOVE A CAPACITOR.
6. Install the new capacitor, sliding it back until it fits into the slot. Fasten the front bracket.
7. Reconnect all the power cables and the ground connection. These use M14 hardware, but should only be tightened to 30 Nm (22 ft-lbs.) due to capacitor mechanical constraints. You may want to fasten these connections before fully sliding the capacitor into place depending on the available space.
8. There are instruction labels on each capacitor detailing how to tighten the terminal connections. Please refer to these labels.
9. Reinstall the sheet metal that was removed, and complete one final check to ensure connections are secure and correct.
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-17 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 Converter Cabinet Components
Figure 6.14 Converter Cabinet Components
Differential Pressure Sensor Inverter Modules Ground bus Rectifier Modules Isolated Gate Driver Power Supplies Temperature Feedback Board (Rectifier) Temperature Feedback Board (Inverter) 6-18 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Converter Cabinet The converter cabinet contains three rectifier modules and three inverter modules. Figure 6.14 shows a 2300-volt converter with a Pulse Width Modulation Rectifier (PWMR).
Isolated Gate Driver Power Supplies (IGDPS) are mounted on the cabinets right side sheet.
Thermal sensors are installed on the top module of the inverter and rectifier. The exact location depends on the drive configuration. These sensors are connected to Temperature Feedback Boards, which bring the signals back to the drive control.
PowerCage A PowerCage is a converter module, consisting of the following elements: epoxy resin housing power semi-conductors with gate driver circuit boards heatsinks clamp snubber resistors snubber capacitors sharing resistors
All drives have six PowerCages: three rectifier modules and three inverter modules. There are three types of rectifiers: 6-pulse PWMR, 6-pulse SCR, and 18-pulse SCR.
6-pulse PWMR type rectifiers use SGCTs as semi-conductors.
6-pulse SCR, and 18-pulse SCR rectifiers use SCRs as semi-conductors.
All inverter modules use SGCTs as semi-conductors.
The size of the PowerCage will vary depending on the system voltage, and the components will also vary in the system current.
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-19 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
The power semi-conductor usage in the converter section is as follows:
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N To prevent electrical shock, ensure the main power has been disconnected before working on the converter cabinet. Verify that all circuits are voltage free using a hot stick or appropriate voltage-measuring device. Failure to do so may result in injury or death.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
The PowerCage can house either SCRs or Silicon Gate Commutated Thyristors (SGCT). The SGCT circuit board is sensitive to static charges. It is important that these boards should not be handled without proper grounding.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Some circuit boards can be destroyed by static charges. Use of damaged circuit boards may also damage related components. A grounding wrist strap is recommended for handling sensitive circuit boards.
6-20 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
SGCT SGCT Heatsink Module housing Temperature Feedback Board Clamp head Clamp Base SGCT SGCT Heatsink Module housing Temperature Feedback Board Clamp head Clamp Base Clamp Base
Figure 6.15 2-Device PowerCage
Matched set 2 SGCTs Matched set 2 SGCTs Module housing Temperature Feedback board Clamp head Clamp Base Matched set 2 SGCTs Matched set 2 SGCTs Module housing Temperature Feedback board Clamp head Clamp Base
Figure 6.16 4-Device PowerCage
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-21 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 Matched set 3 SGCTs Module housing Temperature sensing board Clamp head Matched set 3 SGCTs Clamp Base Temperature Feedback board Matched set 3 SGCTs Module housing Temperature sensing board Clamp head Matched set 3 SGCTs Clamp Base Temperature Feedback board
Figure 6.17 6-Device PowerCage
SGCT and Snubber Circuit With all power semi-conductor or thyristors, the SGCT must have a snubber circuit. The snubber circuit for the SGCT is comprised of a snubber resistor in series with a snubber capacitor.
Figure 6.18 SGCT and snubber circuit 6-22 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
In addition to the snubber circuit, a sharing resistor is connected in parallel with the SGCT. The function of the sharing resistor is to ensure the voltage is shared equally among the SGCTs when connected in series. SGCTs are connected in series to increase the total reverse voltage blocking (PIV) capacity as seen by the electrical circuit. A single SGCT has a PIV rating of 6.5 kV. This single device will provide sufficient design margin for electrical systems with 2.3 kV medium voltage supply. At 4.16 kV, 2 SGCTs must be connected in series to provide a net PIV of 13 kV to achieve the necessary design margin. Similarly, three SGCTs must be connected in series at 6.6 kV.
The cooling requirements of the SGCT are achieved by placing the SGCT between two forced air-cooled heatsinks, one heatsink on the anode and the other heatsink on the cathode. The force placed on the SGCTs differs with the size of the device. The clamp assembly on the right hand side of the inverter module generates these forces.
Pressure on the SGCTs must be uniform to prevent damage and to ensure low thermal resistance. Uniform pressure can be achieved by loosening the heatsink mounting bolts, tightening the clamp and then tightening the heatsink bolts. See section Uniform Clamping Pressure for instructions.
External filtered air will be directed through the slots of the heatsinks to carry away the generated heat from the SGCTs. The door filter is necessary to ensure the slots on the heatsinks do not get plugged.
Uniform Clamping Pressure It is very important to maintain proper pressure on the thyristors. Follow this procedure whenever changing devices, or whenever the clamp is loosened completely.
1. Apply a thin layer of Electrical Joint Compound (Alcoa EJC No. 2 or approved equivalent) to the clamp head pressure pad face.
2. Torque the heatsink bolts to 13.5 N-m (10 ft-lb.) and then loosen each bolt two complete turns.
3. Tighten the clamp to the proper force until the indicating washers can just be turned by the fingers with some resistance.
4. Torque the heatsink bolts to 13.5 N-m (10 ft-lb.) starting with the center heatsink and moving outward alternating left to right.
5. Check clamp indicating washer.
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-23 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Checking Clamping Pressure Periodically, the clamping force in the PowerCage should be inspected. Ensure there is no power to the equipment.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
To prevent electrical shock, ensure the main power has been disconnected before working on the drive. Verify that all circuits are voltage free using a hot stick or appropriate voltage-measuring device. Failure to do so may result in injury or death.
Calibration nut DO NOT ADJUST Indicating washer Clamp bar Adjusting nut Disc springs Pressure pad
Figure 6.19 Clamp Head Illustration
If proper force (as designated on the clamp head block) is applied to the clamping assembly, the indicating washer should just be able to rotate with fingertip touch. The disc should not rotate freely. Some force will need to be applied with your fingertips.
Clamping Pressure Adjustment
1. Ensure that all power to the drive is off. 2. Do not loosen the adjustment nut. If the clamping pressure is let off, the assembly procedure must be carried out to ensure uniform pressure on the thyristors. 3. Tighten with a 21-mm wrench on the adjustment nut (upward motion) until the indicating washer can be turned by fingers with some resistance. IT SHOULD NOT SPIN FREELY. 6-24 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T
Never rotate the lock nut located outside the indicating washer at the end of the threaded rod. The rotation of the outer nut will affect the torque calibration, which is factory set. Only adjust the inside nut. (See Figure 6.20.)
SGCT captive screws Inside nut used for loosening and applying load to assembly DO NOT ADJUST outside nut. Disc springs Clamp head block
Figure 6.20 Detail of the clamping assembly
Temperature Sensing Thermal sensors are located on one heatsink in the rectifier and one heatsink in the inverter. The thermal sensors are mounted on the heatsink with the temperature feedback circuit board.
1. Ensure there is no power to the equipment.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
To prevent electrical shock, ensure the main power has been disconnected before working on the drive. Verify that all circuits are voltage free using a hot stick or appropriate voltage- measuring device. Failure to do so may result in injury or death.
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-25 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
2. To replace a thermal sensor, refer to page P-2 regarding electrostatic discharge. 3. The heatsink with the thermal sensor must be removed from the PowerCage. Remove clamp load (refer to Figure 6.19). 4. Remove the device (SGCT or SCR) that is secured to the heatsink with the thermal sensor. (Refer to Figure 6.15., 6.16 or 6.17). 5. Disconnect the fiber optic cable to the temperature feedback board. 6. Remove two M8 screws holding the heatsink in place. 7. Remove the heatsink with the temperature feedback board from the PowerCage. 8. Disconnect the plug that connects the thermal sensor to the circuit board. 9. Remove the screw that attaches the thermal sensor to the heatsink. 10. Replace with the new thermal sensor and cable assembly. 11. Note there is a small voltage difference between the thermal sensor and its heatsink. For proper function, it is essential to mount the small insulating pad between the thermal sensor and the heatsink and the insulating bushing between the thermal sensor mounting screw and the thermal sensor (see Figure 6.21). 12. Replacement of the heatsink with the new thermal sensor is in the reverse order of removal. 13. Follow procedure Uniform Clamping Pressure to ensure the heatsinks are clamped to a uniform pressure.
Insulating bushing Mounting pad Temperature feedback circuit board Thermal sensor and cable assembly Mounting screw
Figure 6.21 Replacing the Heat Sensor 6-26 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
The Symmetrical Gate Commutated Thyristor (SGCT or device) with attached circuit board is located within the PowerCage assembly.
SGCTs must be replaced in matched sets: 4160V systems use sets of 2 6600V systems use sets of 3
The SGCT and associated control board are a single component. There will never be a time when the device or the circuit board will be changed individually. There are 4 LEDs on the SGCT, and the following table describes their functions:
LED 4 Green Solid Green indicates that the Power Supply to the Card is OK LED 3 Green Solid Green indicates that the Gate-Cathode resistance is OK LED 2 Yellow LED ON indicates the gate is ON, and Flashes alternately with LED 4 while gating LED 1 Red LED ON indicates the gate is OFF, and Flashes alternately with LED 3 while gating
Do not adjust outside nut. SGCT captive screws Inside nut used for loosening and applying load to assembly
Figure 6.22 Replacing the SGCT
Symmetrical Gate Commutated Thyristor Replacement Component Definition and Maintenance 6-27 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
1. Ensure there is no power to the equipment.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
To prevent electrical shock, ensure the main power has been disconnected before working on the drive. Verify that all circuits are voltage free using a hot stick or appropriate voltage- measuring device. Failure to do so may result in injury or death.
2. Note the position of the fiber optic cables for assembly. 3. To remove the SGCT, it is necessary to remove the gate driver power cable and fiber optic cables. Exceeding the minimum bend radius (50 mm [2 in.] ) of the fiber optic cables may result in damage.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
The fiber optic cables can be damaged if struck or bent sharply. The minimum bend radius is 50 mm (2 inches). The connector has a locking feature that requires pinching the tab and gently pulling straight out. The component on the printed circuit board should be held to prevent damage.
4. Remove the load on the clamp head assembly as described under Checking Clamping Pressure on page 6-23. 5. Two brackets secure the board to the heatsink. Loosen the captive screws until the circuit board is free. It may be necessary to adjust the position of the heatsinks to allow free movement of the SGCT. 6. Slide the circuit board straight out.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
The SGCT can be destroyed or damaged by static charges. Personnel must be properly grounded before removing the replacement SGCT from the protective anti-static bag that it is supplied in. Use of damaged circuit boards may also damage related components. A grounding wrist strap is recommended for handling sensitive circuit boards.
6-28 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T
SGCTs come in matched sets in systems with more than one device per leg. When replacing the device, it is necessary to replace both SGCTs in the pair even if only one has failed. The devices are arranged from left to right in pairs (i.e. pairs 1+2, 3+4, 5+6).
7. While grounded, remove the SGCT from the anti-static bag it is supplied in. 8. Clean the heatsink with a soft cloth and rubbing alcohol. 9. Apply a thin layer of Electrical Joint Compound (Alcoa EJC No. 2 or approved equivalent) to the contact faces of the new SGCTs to be installed. The recommended procedure is to apply the compound to the pole faces using a small brush, and then gently wipe the pole face with an industrial wipe so that a thin film remains. Examine the pole face before proceeding to ensure that no brush bristles remain.
I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T
Too much joint compound may result in contamination of other surfaces leading to system damage. 10. Slide the SGCT into place until the mounting brackets contact the surface of the heatsink. 11. Tighten the captive screws located in the brackets. 12. Follow procedure Uniform Clamping Pressure to ensure the heatsinks are clamped to a uniform pressure. 13. Connect the power cable and fiber optic cables (ensure the bend radius is not exceeded).
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-29 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 The method for replacing the Silicon Controlled Rectifier (SCR) is almost identical to that of the SGCT. The one exception is that the SCR and circuit board can be replaced independently of one another.
1. Ensure there is no power to the equipment.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
To prevent electrical shock, ensure the main power has been disconnected before working on the drive. Verify that all circuits are voltage free using a hot stick or appropriate voltage- measuring device. Failure to do so may result in injury or death.
2. Note the position of the Fiber Optic Cables for reassembly. 3. To Remove the SCR and SCR SPGD Board, it is necessary to remove the Gate Driver Power Supply connector (from snubber circuit), the fiber optic cable, and the SCR gate-cathode connection. Exceeding the minimum bend radius (50 mm/2 in.) of the fiber optic cables may result in damage.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
The fiber optic cables can be damaged if struck or bent sharply. The minimum bend radius is 50 mm (2 inches). The connector has a locking feature that requires pinching the tab and gently pulling straight out. The component on the printed circuit board should be held to prevent damage.
4. Remove the load on the clamp head assembly as described under Checking Clamping Pressure on page 6-23.
5. Loosen the 2 captive screws with a long Phillips screwdriver until the circuit board is free. It may be necessary to adjust the position of the heatsinks to allow free movement of the SCR.
6. Slide the SCR and SCR SPGD Board straight out.
7. While grounded, unplug the Gate-Cathode phoenix connector from the SCR SPGD Board.
Silicon Controlled Rectifier and SCR Self-Powered Gate Driver Board Replacement 6-30 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
The SCR and SCR SPGD Board can be destroyed or damaged by static charges. Personnel must be properly grounded before removing the replacement SCR and SCR SPGD Board from the protective anti-static bag that it is supplied in. Use of damaged circuit boards may also damage related components. A grounding wrist strap is recommended for handling sensitive circuit boards.
I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T
Never adjust the orientation of the SCR using the Gate and Cathode Leads. These connections are sensitive and the device orientation should only be adjusted by turning the device itself.
TO REPLACE THE SCR, FOLLOW STEPS 8-11, and 16-18.
TO REPLACE THE SCR SPGD BOARD, FOLLOW STEPS 12-15, and 16-18.
8. Loosen the tie wrap holding the G-C wire in place, and remove the device from the assembly. 9. Install the new device in the same position and using the same orientation as the original SCR, and firmly secure the G-C wires with the same tie wrap. 10. Connect the Gate-Cathode phoenix connector to the Gate Driver Board 11. Apply a thin layer of Electrical Joint Compound ( Alcoa EJC No.2 or approved equivalent ) to the contact faces of the new SCRs to be installed. The recommended procedure is to apply the compound to the pole faces using a small brush and then gently wiping the pole face with an industrial wipe so that a thin film remains. Examine the pole face before proceeding to ensure that no brush bristles remain.
I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T
Too much joint compound may result in contamination of other surfaces leading to system damage.
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-31 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
12. While grounded, use a long Phillips screwdriver to remove the 2 screws that hold the SCR SPGD Board to the metal bracket on the red glastic assembly. Retain the hardware. 13. Pull the 4 plastic clips that secure the SCR SPGD Board to the glastic assembly. Retain the hardware. 14. Install the new SCR SPGD Board in the assembly with the 4 plastic clips and use the screws to secure the board to the metal bracket. 15. Clean the heatsink with a soft cloth and rubbing alcohol. 16. Slide the SCR and SCRGD Board back into place until the mounting bracket makes contact with the heatsink. Use the Phillips screwdriver to tighten the assembly to the heatsink. 17. Reapply the clamping load as described in Uniform Clamping Pressure above. 18. Connect the control power cable and the fiber optic cables, ensuring that the bend radius is not exceeded.
Figure 6.23 SCR and SPGDB assembly
6-32 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Heatsink Replacement There are 2 different styles of heatsinks used in the PowerFlex drive depending on current ratings and thermal requirements. The lighter aluminum heatsink has a very fine ventilation pattern through the heatsink. The heavier copper heatsink has a basic ventilation pattern with larger openings for airflow, and will often have a grill mounted on the front of the heatsink to help restrict the flow.
Aluminum Heatsink Copper Heatsink
The copper heatsinks can weigh about 9kg (20 lbs.), while the aluminum heatsinks will only weigh approximately 4kg (9 lbs.)
1. Ensure there is no power to the equipment.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
To prevent electrical shock, ensure the main power has been disconnected before working on the drive. Verify that all circuits are voltage free using a hot stick or appropriate voltage- measuring device. Failure to do so may result in injury or death.
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-33 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
2. Remove the load from the clamp head per the procedure on page 6-23 under Checking Clamping Pressure.
3. Completely remove the SGCT or SCR from the heatsink that is being replaced per the instructions on pages 6-24 to 6-27.
4. There are 2 bolts that secure the heatsink to the PowerCage. They are 13-mm bolts, and should be removed using several extenders to get the socket wrench out past all the sensitive gate driver boards.
5. Loosen the two bolts and carefully remove the heatsink from the PowerCage.
6. Install the new heatsink and hand-tighten the bolts.
7. Replace the SGCT or SCR per the instructions on pages 6-24 to 6-27.
8. Follow procedure Uniform Clamping Pressure to ensure the heatsinks are clamped to a uniform pressure.
6-34 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
PowerCage Gasket To ensure all air movement is through the slots of the heatsinks, all possible air leaks have been sealed with a rubber gasket. This gasket is placed between the surface of the PowerCage and heatsink module. It is necessary to have the gasket in place to ensure proper cooling of the SGCTs or SCRs are maintained.
Power Connection Gasket Power Connection PowerCage Housing Resistors Power Connection Gasket Power Connection PowerCage Housing Resistors
Figure 6.24 PowerCage Gasket Location
Replacement of PowerCage Gaskets
The gaskets do not normally require replacement, but in the event that they become damaged, they may require replacement.
Removal of old Gasket Material
Pull all the material possible off by hand. Scrape off as much material as possible with a sharp knife. Do not score the PowerCage with the knife. All the material will not come off! Remove as much as possible to leave an even surface to bond to. Clean away any loose pieces of gasket. Then proceed with installation of the gasket.
The PowerCage must be cleaned with Spray Nine (another all purpose household cleaner could be used). Do not spray onto the PowerCage as it promotes electrical tracking. Apply the cleaner to a paper towel and wipe the surface of the PowerCage where the gasket will be applied. Liberally spray the surface with distilled water. Wipe the surface with a clean paper towel.
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-35 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 Apply a thin bead of Loctite 454 adhesive to the PowerCage surface in a zigzag pattern using the original nozzle size. Use the tip to spread the adhesive around to cover at least 50% of the area. There should be sufficient quantity of adhesive to remain wet long enough for the gasket to be applied. The adhesive uses the moisture in the air as it cures. The higher the humidity the faster the adhesive will cure.
I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T
This adhesive will bond anything quickly, including fingers!
Position the gaskets ensuring the gasket is oriented correctly. The gasket should be centered over the opening for the heatsinks with the narrow end positioned closest to the test points. The porous surface of the gasket should be applied to the PowerCage. The gasket will bond almost immediately. Apply some pressure to the gasket for 15-30 seconds.
After all the gaskets have been placed check to see that the gasket has bonded properly. Repair any loose areas.
PowerCage Removal 1. Ensure there is no power to the equipment.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N To prevent electrical shock, ensure the main power has been disconnected before working on the sensing board. Verify that all circuits are voltage free using a hot stick or appropriate voltage-measuring device. Failure to do so may result in injury or death.
2. Before removing the PowerCage, all the components located within the PowerCage need to be removed to avoid any damage to the components. Consult the required sections to remove clamping pressure, as well as remove the SGCT or SCR, circuit boards, and thermal sensor.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N The SGCT and SCR can be destroyed or damaged by static charges. Personnel must be properly grounded before removing circuit boards from the PowerCage. Use of damaged circuit boards may also damage related components. A grounding wrist strap is recommended for handling.
6-36 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
3. Remove the 13-mm bolts in the two flanges that connect the heatsink to the PowerCage, then remove the heatsink from the PowerCage. This will reduce the weight of the PowerCage making it easier to handle. 4. To detach the PowerCage itself, the bolts on the outer flange need to be removed. Carefully lift the PowerCage down, placing the forward face down. Do not overtorque these bolts when replacing the PowerCage.
I M P O R T A N T I M P O R T A N T
The PowerCage can be heavy and it is preferred that two people should extract the PowerCage from the drive to prevent injury or damage to the module.
5. Refer to appropriate section for component replacement.
6. When replacing the PowerCage, it is important to place the bolts on the outer flange in loosely. Torque bolts alternately on one flange and then the opposite flange to ensure even tightening of the module. A suggested sequence for torquing PowerCage bolts is shown in Figure 6.25.
Note: The PowerCage is shown with switching components, heatsinks and clamps removed for ease of lifting.
Figure 6.25 Typical Torque sequence
7. Replace interior assembly in the reverse order of removal.
PowerCage Removal (cont.) Component Definition and Maintenance 6-37 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 Snubber Resistors Snubber resistors are connected in series with the snubber capacitors. Together they form a simple RC snubber that is connected across each thyristor (SCR or SGCT). The purpose of the snubber circuit is to reduce the dv/dt stress on the thyristors and to reduce the switching losses. The snubber resistors are connected as sets of various wire- wound resistors connected in parallel. The number of resistors in parallel depends on the type of the thyristor and the configuration and frame size of the drive.
Testing Snubber Resistors
Access to the snubber resistor is not required to test the resistance. There is a snubber circuit test point located under the heatsink within the PowerCage. There is one test point for each device. To verify the resistance, follow the procedures outlined in Chapter 4 Commissioning.
Measure resistance between heatsink and test point Snubber resistor test point
Figure 6.26 Testing the Snubber Resistor
6-38 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
The snubber and sharing resistors are part of the resistor assembly located behind the PowerCage. 1. Remove the PowerCage as outlined in PowerCage Removal. 2. Note the connection of the leads for correct replacement. 3. Detach the leads located on the bottom of the resistor assembly.
Figure 6.27 Removal of Power Cage (SGCT Type PowerCage shown)
4. Remove the push nuts on the end of the retaining rod. Pinch the clip together and pull off. Pull out the retaining rod.
Snubber and Sharing Resistor Replacement Component Definition and Maintenance 6-39 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Retaining Rod Detach the leads of the resistor assembly Retaining Rod Detach the leads of the resistor assembly
Pinch and remove clips at ends of retaining rods Extract retaining rod Pinch and remove clips at ends of retaining rods Extract retaining rod
Figure 6.28 Snubber and sharing resistor replacement
6-40 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
5. Silicon gel is used to secure the snubber resistor assembly to the PowerCage. It is also used to minimize possible damages to the resistor bank during transportation from the factory. It does not need to be re-applied when inserting the new resistor bank. Remove the resistor bank from the PowerCage.
Push Nut Resistor Bank Retaining Rod Push Nut Resistor Bank Retaining Rod
Figure 6.29 Removing resistor bank from PowerCage
6. Place the new resistor bank assembly back into the PowerCage. 7. Slide the retaining rod into place and push the clips back into place. 8. Connect the leads to the resistor bank 9. Install the PowerCage as outlined in PowerCage Removal.
Sharing Resistors Sharing resistors provide equal sharing of the voltage when matched devices are used in series. SGCT PowerCages for 2300V systems do not need matched devices and have no sharing resistor.
SCR PowerCages always have sharing resistors even if matched devices are not required. Sharing resistors in SCR PowerCages provide a diagnostic function.
Testing Sharing Resistors
It is possible to verify the resistance value of the sharing resistors without removing the PowerCage from the cabinet. Follow the procedures in Chapter 4 Commissioning. Snubber and Sharing Resistor Replacement (cont.) Component Definition and Maintenance 6-41 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
SGCT PowerCages
The snubber circuit is shown in Figure 6.30. Measure the resistance across two adjacent heatsinks. A value between 60 k and 75 k indicates a good sharing resistor.
Rsh Rsn-2 Cs-1 Cs-2 Anode Rsn-1 Cathode Cs-1 Cs-2 Anode Rsn -2 Rsh Rsn -1 Snubber Resistor Test Point Cathode Rsh Rsn-2 Cs-1 Cs-2 Anode Rsn-1 Cathode Rsh Rsn-2 Cs-1 Cs-2 Anode Rsn-1 Cathode Cs-1 Cs-2 Anode Rsn -2 Rsh Rsn -1 Snubber Resistor Test Point Cathode Cs-1 Cs-2 Anode Rsn -2 Rsh Rsn -1 Snubber Resistor Test Point Cathode
Figure 6.30 Snubber Circuit for SGCT module 6-42 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Replacing Sharing Resistor
Normally the sharing resistor is part of the snubber resistor assembly. Replacement of the sharing resistor will require replacing the snubber resistor also.
The sharing and snubber resistors are normally located on the backside of the PowerCage. See the instructions for removing and replacing snubber resistors.
SCR PowerCages
The snubber circuit is shown in Figure 6.31. Disconnect the 2-pole plug to the Gate Driver Board that is marked TB1 on the circuit board. Measure the resistance from the point of the plug that connects to the point labeled V.SENSE on the Gate Driver Board to the anode side heatsink. A value of 80 k indicates a good sharing resistor.
Figure 6.31 Snubber Circuit for SCR Rectifier Module
Sharing Resistors (cont.) Component Definition and Maintenance 6-43 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Resistance measurements
The anode-cathode resistance check will measure the parallel combination of the sharing resistor and SGCT anode-cathode resistance. The sharing resistor has a resistance much lower than a good SGCT, thus the measurement will be slightly less than the resistance of the sharing resistor. A measurement between 60 k and 75 k indicates the SGCT is in good condition and that wiring to the SGCT is correct. If the SGCT fails, it will be in the shorted mode, 0 . The anode to cathode resistance check will be 0 .
A test point is provided inside the PowerCage to measure the resistance of the snubber resistor and capacitance of the snubber capacitor. The test point is the electrical connection between the snubber resistor and snubber capacitor. The procedure is to place one probe of the multi-meter on the test point and the other probe on the appropriate heatsink to determine the value of the resistor or capacitor. See Figure 6.32.
Resistance value between heatsink and test point is snubber resistance Resistance value between 2 heatsinks is sharing resistance parallel with anode-cathode resistance .
Figure 6.32 Resistance Measurements SGCT PowerCage 6-44 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Description
This board is used in drives where SCRs are used as the rectifying device on the input of the drive. The SCRs require a gating pulse in order to turn on, and this is achieved by using the SPGDB.
The SPGDB receives its command from the drive processor, via a light signal, which is transmitted through a fiber optic cable. The power source for the SPGDB is from the snubber network of the SCR, a patent pending design of Rockwell Automation. This unique design gives the SPGDB the ability to conserve the amount of energy that it supplies to the SCR. This reduces the amount of energy required by the drive to operate, thus making the drive more efficient.
Also, this board will determine the health of the SCR. It has the hardware necessary to diagnose the condition of the SCR. This status is relayed to the processor via a fail-safe light signal transmitted through a fiber optic cable.
Board Calibration
No field calibration is required for this board.
Self-Powered Gate Driver Board SPGDB Component Definition and Maintenance 6-45 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Test points description
TP1 SCR gate output (attach oscilloscope between TP1 and TP2 to see gating pulses) TP2 SCR cathode output TP3 Common reference point for all other test point measurements, except for TP1, which uses TP2 as its reference point TP4 The positive 20 V rail used for the SPGDB operation TP5 The positive 5 V rail used for the SPGDB operation TP6 The sense voltage taken from the sense resistor across the SCR being controlled TP7 Trigger signal, which remains active for a fixed period of time after the SCR being controlled, has turned on and the voltage across it has collapsed TP8 Internal gating signal that indirectly turns on the SCR that is being controlled TP9 Gating signal received from the commanding drive control board, through the appropriate fiber optic cable
The yellow LED (LED 1) on the SGPDB indicates that the SCR being controlled has a gating current flowing which is used to turn the SCR on.
Test power connection Fiber optic transmitter and receiver Thermal sensing power connection TP9 TP8 TP7 TP6 TP3 TP4 TP5 Gate and cathode thyristor connection LED Snubber connection TP1 TP2 TB3: TB2: TB4: TB1: Test power connection Fiber optic transmitter and receiver Thermal sensing power connection TP9 TP8 TP7 TP6 TP3 TP4 TP5 Gate and cathode thyristor connection LED Snubber connection TP1 TP2 Test power connection Fiber optic transmitter and receiver Thermal sensing power connection TP9 TP8 TP7 TP6 TP3 TP4 TP5 Gate and cathode thyristor connection LED Snubber connection TP1 TP2 TB3: TB2: TB4: TB1:
Figure 6.33 Self-Powered Gate Driver Board
6-46 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Terminal/connections description
TB1-1 Connection to SCR snubber circuit used to extract energy from the snubber for SPGDB operation TB1-2 Connection to SCR sensing resistor which indicates conduction status of SCR being operated TB2-1 Positive 20V power supply connection to temperature sensor board. Provides power to temperature sensor board. TB2-2 Common connection of positive 20V power supply to temperature sensor board TB3-1 Positive 15V power supply connection for test power used when commissioning drive or testing SPGDB TB3-2 Provides artificial sense voltage signal to allow SPGDB to gate the SCR when in test mode. When the appropriate test power cable is used, P/N 81001-262-51, this input is shorted to TB3-1 to obtain the sense voltage. TB3-3 Common connection of positive 15V power supply used for test power TB4-2 Cathode connection to SCR being controlled TB4-1 Gate connection to SCR being controlled OP1 Blue fiber optic cable receptacle Firing pulse command from the processor OT1 Grey fiber optic cable receptacle Diagnostic status of the SCR Component Definition and Maintenance 6-47 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Equipment needed:
Digital oscilloscope Function generator w/duty cycle control DC power supply (+15V @ 300 mA required) Digital multimeter Temperature sensor board (80190-639-02)
Procedure: 1. Connect a clamped ABB #5STP03D6500 SCR to the gate-cathode leads of the SPGDB board (TB4-1/TB4-2). 2. Attach a temperature sensor board to the TB2-1/TB2-2 terminals. 3. Apply +15V test power to terminals TB3-1 and TB3-3 (TB3-1 is at +15V while TB3-3 is the +15V return). Leave TB3-2 open. 4. Measure TP4 to TP3, which should be +14.4V, +/-100mV. 5. Measure TP5 to TP3, which should be +5.0V, +/- 250mV. 6. Measure TB2-1 to TB2-2, which should be +14.4V, +/-100mV. 7. Measure the voltage at U4-pin2 to COM, which should be +1.0V, +/- 100mV. 8. Measure the voltage at U4-pin3 to COM, which should be 0V. 9. Measure the voltage at U4-pin7 to COM, which should be +3.6V, +/- 100mV. 10. Verify that the OT1 LED is off. 11. Measure TP7 to TP3, which should be 0V. 12. Measure TP9 to TP3, which should be +5.0V, +/- 250mV. 13. Measure TP8 to TP3, which should be 0V. 14. Measure TP1 to TP2, which should be 0V. 15. Connect a jumper between TB3-1 and TB3-2 and verify that the voltage at TP6 is +2.2V, +/-100mV. 16. Apply a 60Hz, 33% duty cycle signal to the OP1 fiber optic input. 17. Verify that the diagnostics transmitter LED, OT1, is on. 18. Verify that the signals at TP9 and TP8 are as shown in Fig. 6.34. 19. Verify that the signal between TP1 and TP2 is as shown in Figures 6.35 and 6.36. 20. Remove the jumper between TB3-1 and TB3-2. 21. Apply a constant fiber optic signal to the OP1 input. 22. Apply a 60 Hz, 33% duty cycle signal, at a 0 to +2V level, between the TB1-2 input and COM. Verify the signals in Figures 6.37 and 6.38. Note that in Figure 6.38 there should be a 220 S, +/-20 S time between the rising edge of the U4-pin7 pulse and the falling edge of the TP7 signal.
Testing procedure for SCR self-powered gate driver board 6-48 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Figure 6.34 Gating pulses
Figure 6.35 SCR gating pulse
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-49 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 6.36 Expanded SCR gating pulse
Figure 6.37 V Sense Trigger to SCR gating pulse
6-50 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Figure 6.38 Expansion of V Sense Trigger to SCR gating pulse
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-51 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Fiber Optic Cabling The equipment is provided with fiber optic cabling as a means of interfacing the low voltage control to the medium voltage circuits. The user of the equipment should never need to change the routing of the fiber optic cables.
Each end of a fiber optic cable is provided with a connector that plugs and latches into its respective location on a circuit board. To disconnect a fiber optic cable, depress the ridged plastic tab at the end connector and pull. To install a fiber optic cable insert the fiber optic port of the circuit board so that the plastic tab latches into place.
If the user finds it necessary to replace fiber optic cables, great care must be taken to prevent the cables from becoming strained or crimped as a resulting loss in light transmission will result in loss in performance.
The minimum bend radius permitted for the fiber optic cables is 50 mm (2.0 inches).
When installing the fiber optic cable, the colour of the connector at the end of the cable must match the colour of the connector socket on the circuit board.
Lengths of fiber optic cables used in the product include:
Duplex Simplex 5.0 meter 5.0 meter 5.5 meter 6.0 meter 6.0 meter 10.0 meter 6.5 meter 7.0 meter
There is one duplex fiber optic for each thyristor, which manages gating and diagnostic functions. The healthy status of the thyristor is determined by the circuitry on the respective driver boards. This information is then sent to the main processor via a fail-safe light signal in the fiber optic. The firing command for the thyristor is initiated by the main processor and transmitted to the appropriate gate driver board via the gating fiber optic.
The color code of the connectors are: BLACK or GREY is the transmitting end of the fiber optic. BLUE is the receiving end of the fiber optic.
6-52 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Air Pressure Sensor An air pressure sensor is located in the converter cabinet. It is located in the upper left area near the uppermost inverter module.
Flexible tube for low pressure port High pressure port Mounting screw Wire terminals
Figure 6.39 Air Pressure Sensor
The air pressure sensor compares the air pressure in front of the converter modules with the air pressure behind the converter modules. A small direct current voltage signal is transmitted to the control circuits.
There have been two different air pressure sensor manufacturers Ashcroft and Greystone. Ashcroft is our current pressure transducer manufacturer.
In the event of reduced fan performance or air blockage, the measured differential pressure will be reduced and a warning message will appear on the console. A likely cause of the warning message would be laden filters at the air inlet.
If airflow becomes reduced so that there is risk of thermal damage, a fault signal will cause drive shutdown. Also, in the event of fan failure, the sensor will detect the pressure change and the drive will be stopped.
Air Pressure Sensor Replacement
1. Remove the wires at the sensor and note their designation. 2. Disconnect the clear tube on the low pressure port. Remove the two mounting screws of the sensor. 3. Check the integrity of the sealant that has been applied where the clear tubing passed through the sheet metal barrier. 4. Installation of the replacement airflow sensor is in the reverse order of its removal. Component Definition and Maintenance 6-53 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
D.C. Link and Fan Cabinet Components
AC/AC Converters 3-phase fan power transformer Ground Bus Hold up Capacitor DC Link Inductor (Barrier removed) Fan Power Cable Entry (bottom) Impeller Access Panel Fan Inlet Ring
Figure 6.40 DC Link and Fan cabinet with control panel shown Figure 6.41 DC Link and Fan Cabinet with fan control panel removed
The door of the cabinet is interlocked such that it cannot be opened unless the fan power is disconnected. The fan power disconnect handle is mounted on the right-hand side of the cabinet.
When the door is opened, fan control components are accessible. Behind the fixed fan control panels is the medium voltage compartment where the DC link and fan are located.
The D.C. link is mounted on the floor plate of the cabinet. Airflow barriers are assembled around the coils of the inductor to direct a portion of the cooling air through the inductor.
Power connections are made to the inductor via its flexible leads. There are four power connection points labeled L+, L-, M+, and M-.
The iron core of the D.C. link is equipped with thermal protection.
6-54 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
There is a current sensor on the M+ conductor.
Above the D.C. link is the main drive cooling fan.
The primary elements of the fan are the inlet ring, impeller and motor.
The inlet ring is stationary and must not contact the rotating impeller.
Mounted on top of the cabinet is an air exhaust hood. The exhaust hood must be installed to prevent foreign objects entering the drive.
If there is a redundant fan option, it is mounted on the top of this cabinet, inside an enlarged exhaust hood.
DC Link Reactor The DC Link maintains a ripple-free current between the rectifier and the inverter.
The DC link reactor does not normally require service. In the event of its replacement, it must be ensured that Rockwell Automation approves its replacement link.
The link has been constructed to ensure that it is cooled by air drawn through its coils.
To service the DC link, see Figure 6.42.
1) Ensure that source power to the drive is locked out.
2) Access to the DC link is gained by opening the door to the DC link cabinet and removing screws that retain the vertical sheet metal barrier in front of the DC link.
3) Disconnect the 4 power connections. The DC link is equipped with flexible power leads.
4) Remove the horizontal barrier around the DC link.
5) Remove the hardware that secures the DC link to the floor channel.
6) Disconnect the ground connection.
The DC link is heavy and has provision for lifting with forks of a lift truck.
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-55 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Step 2: Unfasten DC links leads. Remove DC link hardware and slide DC link forward. Remove hardware Step 3: Step 1: and DC link barrier. Step 2: Unfasten DC links leads. Remove DC link hardware and slide DC link forward. Remove hardware Step 3: Step 1: and DC link barrier.
Figure 6.42 DC link removal
Installation of the replacement DC link is performed in the reverse order of its removal.
The installer must ensure that the flexible DC link leads are connected to the appropriate terminal and routed so that electrical clearances are maintained. You must also verify that the nameplate ratings are the same or appropriate for the drive system. A different DC link will require different parameter settings.
The DC link maintains a ripple-free current between the line converter and the machine converter. Thermal protection of the DC link reactor is provided by two normally closed contacts wired to the I/O module. These contacts will open at 190C and cause a fault/alarm message to be displayed.
6-56 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Fan Removal and Replacement The fan consists of a motor and impeller assembly. To replace the fan it is necessary to remove the fan exhaust hood and top plate of its cabinet.
Safety notes
Fan replacement requires working at a significant height from the floor. Care should be taken to make a suitable platform from which to work.
The fan motor is heavy and will require suitable lifting provision. Ensure that fan power is locked out during fan maintenance.
Remove the eight nuts that secure the motor frame to the sidesheets of the cabinet. Disconnect the power leads to the motor. Note the terminal locations so that proper fan rotation is maintained.
To extract the fan, lifting hooks are placed in the holes of the motor mounting brackets and the assembly is withdrawn vertically from the cabinet. Do not support the assembly on the impeller or damage may result.
Fan motor Fan impeller Mounting holes Inlet ring Mounting bracket
Figure 6.43 Fan removal
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-57 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Fan Installation
Care must be taken in handling of the fan as its balance could be affected by poor handling.
Fan installation is performed in the reverse order of its removal. Upon completion of installation, rotate the impeller by hand to ensure that there is no contact with the inlet ring.
Impeller Maintenance Impeller Removal from Motor Shaft
The fan impeller is held onto the motor shaft with a split tapered bushing. This bushing is positioned on the motor shaft and through the center of the impeller. Two capscrews, when tightened to 10.2 N-m (7.5 ft-lbs.), lock the bushing onto the motor shaft and the impeller to the bushing.
Safety notes
The impeller is fragile. Do not allow the impeller to support the weight of the motor.
If vertical, the impeller and bushing may fall when loosening capscrews. Physical injury or component damage may result.
A B C D E A Taper surfaces B Capscrews C Split in Taper Bushing D Key E Threaded Hole for Separating Tapers DO NOT LUBRICATE CAPSCREWS, BORE OR BUSHING BARREL A B C D E A B C D E A Taper surfaces B Capscrews C Split in Taper Bushing D Key E Threaded Hole for Separating Tapers DO NOT LUBRICATE CAPSCREWS, BORE OR BUSHING BARREL
Figure 6.44 Impeller Removal
6-58 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Impeller Maintenance (cont.) 1. Record the distance from the end of the motor shaft to the bushing. The new impeller must be installed in the same location. Failure to do so will result in gaps between the impeller and the intake ring resulting in loss of air flow, or rubbing of the impeller against the inlet ring or motor assembly during operation.
2. Remove both capscrews from the bushing. The impeller or bushing may fall as screws are loosened.
3. Thread the capscrews by hand into the two threaded holes in the bushing flange.
4. Tighten each bolt part of a turn successively, to push the impeller off the bushing. Screwing down the capscrews into these holes will force the bushing away from the impeller hub, releasing the compression on the shaft. Be careful that the impeller does not fall as the clamping force is released.
5. Pull the bushing off the shaft and remove the impeller. If the assembly has been in place for some time, it may be necessary to use a wheel puller to remove the bushing. Never use a wheel puller on the impeller.
NOTE: DO NOT LUBRICATE CAPSCREWS, BORE, OR BUSHING BARREL, AS THIS WILL HINDER CLAMPING FORCE OF THE BUSHING ON THE SHAFT AND THE IMPELLER BORE
Installation of Impeller Assembly onto Motor Shaft
The fan impeller is held onto the motor shaft with a split tapered bushing. This bushing is positioned on the motor shaft and through the center of the impeller. Capscrews, when tightened to 10.2 N-m (7.5 ft-lbs.), lock the bushing onto the motor shaft and the impeller to the bushing.
The bushing barrel and the bore of the impeller are tapered which assures concentric mounting and keeps the impeller running evenly. The capscrews, when tightened, lock the bushing in the impeller and over the motor shaft.
The bushing is split down the middle, so that when the locking capscrews force the bushing into the tapered bore in the impeller assembly, the bushing will grip the shaft with a positive clamping fit. The impeller and bushing assembly have keyways that line up with the shaft and are held in place with compression.
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-59 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
To Assemble:
1. Make sure the shaft and keyway are clean and smooth. Clean the shaft and bore with rubbing alcohol or non oily solvent. Check the key size with both the shaft and bushing keyways.
2. Put the capscrews through the clearance holes in the bushing and put the bushing loosely into the impeller, lining up the screws with the threaded holes on the impeller hub. Do not press, drive or hammer the bushing into the bore.
3. Start the capscrews by hand, turning them just enough to engage the threads. Do not use a wrench at this time. The bushing should be loose enough in the impeller to move freely.
4. Slide the impeller and bushing assembly onto the motor shaft, ensuring the same distance from the end of the shaft to the bushing as in step 1 of impeller removal.
5. Fit the key into keyway. Do not force impeller and bushing onto shaft. If they do not fit easily, check the shaft, bushing and key sizes.
6. Tighten the capscrews progressively with a wrench. Do this evenly as though mounting an automobile wheel. Turn one a quarter turn, then the next a quarter turn, then go back and turn the other a quarter turn and so on. Torque to 10.2 N-m (7.5 ft-lbs.)
7. Peen the end of the motor shaft at the keyway with a chisel or center punch to prevent the key from falling out of position.
Fan Balance
Fan impellers are statically and dynamically balanced within acceptable tolerances at the factory. Damage in shipping or from poor handling or installation may upset the units balance. An impeller that is not properly balanced can lead to excessive vibration causing undue wear on the entire unit. If vibration is excessive, shut down the fan and determine the cause.
Common causes of excessive vibration:
Support structure not sufficiently rigid or level. Vibration amplified by resonance in duct work or support structure. Bearing locking collar or mounting bolts loose. Impeller or bushing loose. Material accumulation on impeller. Wheel rubbing on inlet ring.
6-60 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame The inlet ring is the large circular part located on the underside of a horizontal barrier beneath the fan impeller. It is positioned such that the impeller sits inside but does not touch the ring. The ring sits inside the impeller 10 mm (0.40 inches).
Safety Notes
This procedure will require coming in contact with the internal electrical connectors and devices. It is EXTREMELY important that ALL POWER BE REMOVED FROM THE DRIVE! Failing to do so may result in serious injury or death.
Precautions must be taken to prevent the inlet ring from falling after all of the bolts have been removed
Procedure
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
To prevent electrical shock, ensure the main power has been disconnected before working within the DC Link and Fan Area. Verify that all circuits are voltage free using a hot stick or appropriate high voltage-measuring device. Failure to do so may result in injury or death.
NOTE: If rear panel access is possible, remove rear middle panel of the DC link / fan portion of the cabinet and remove the inlet ring from the back.
If rear panel access is not possible, follow this procedure:
1. Remove DC Link Barrier and Impeller Access Panel (see Fig. 6.40). Remove electrical components in front of the inlet ring access panel.
2. Remove bolts from the inlet ring being careful not to allow the ring to fall.
3. Remove inlet ring via the bottom access panel by moving it around the DC link and diagonally out the door. Shifting of the DC link may be required.
4. To install the new ring, reverse the above procedure. Rotate the fan impeller by hand to ensure that there is no contact with the inlet ring. Move the ring and retighten bolts to eliminate interference.
5. Replace access panels and electrical components. Inlet Ring Removal and Replacement Component Definition and Maintenance 6-61 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Replacement of Air Filters Air filters are located at the cooling air intake grille mounted on the door in front of the converter, line reactor and transformer cabinets.
It is necessary to periodically remove and clean, or remove and replace the filter material. The frequency with which the filters are renewed depends on the cleanliness of the supplied cooling air.
It is possible to renew the filters while the drive is running, but the procedure is easier to perform while the drive is shut down.
Procedure (see Figure 6.45):
Using a 5/16 Hex key, loosen the turn fasteners and swing open the hinged grill assembly. Remove filter material.
Note that if the drive is running, the filter must be replaced as soon as possible so that foreign material is not drawn into the drive.
Care must be taken in removing the filter, to prevent dirt that has accumulated on the inlet side of the filter from being sucked into the drive. It may be difficult to remove the filter material without tearing it due to the suction at the air inlet.
Recommended cleaning method of filters:
1. Vacuum Clean A few passes of a vacuum cleaner on the inlet side of the filter will remove accumulated dust and dirt in seconds. 2. Blow with Compressed Air point compressed air nozzle in opposite direction of operating air flow (Blow from exhaust side toward intake side) 3. Cold Water Rinse Under normal conditions the foam media used in the filters, require no oily adhesives. Collected dirt is washed away quickly and easily using just a standard hose nozzle with plain water. (Ensure filter is completely dry before reinstalling) 4. Immersion in Warm Soapy Water Where stubborn air-borne dirt is present, the filter may be dipped in a solution of warm water and mild detergent. Then simply rinse in clear clean water, let stand until completely dry and free of moisture, and return to service. 6-62 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
When replacing with a new filter, the filter must be provided by Rockwell Automation or approved for use by Rockwell Automation. Replacement of the filters is performed in the reverse order of its removal. Check that there are no openings that would allow foreign matter to enter the drive.
Replacement of Air Filters (cont.) Component Definition and Maintenance 6-63 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Figure 6.46 Air Flow Pattern for Snubber Cooling
Figure 6.47 Air flow through PowerCage 6-64 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Control Power Components There are two configurations in which control power will be distributed for the drive. The different methods are dependent on what drive option the customer has chosen: 1. Standard control with 5 cycle ride-through, or 2. Standard control with extended ride-through capabilities.
Ride-Through
Standard controls with 5 cycle ride-through The drive main control boards will remain energized for a total of 5 cycles after control power is interrupted. If control power is not restored during the 5 cycles, a controlled shutdown will occur.
Standard controls with extended ride-through capabilities The drive controls will remain energized for an extended period time greater than 5 cycles after control power is interrupted. The length of time the boards will remain energized is dependent on the capacity of the UPS and power consumption of loads connected to the UPS.
Figure 6.48 illustrates the control design with standard offering and 5 cycle ride-through. The ride-through is provided by the hold-up capacitors on the output of the AC/DC converter. The stored energy in the capacitors is sufficient to maintain 56 V supply to the DC/DC and IGDPS loads for 5 cycles. Other loads such as the printer, PV550, pilot lights, relays, etc. will remain in the same state prior to interruption of control power.
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-65 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
+15V - SPGDB TEST 3 phase, 4 wire XXXVAC +24V I/O 3phase TX, XXXV/208V XXX = 380, 480, 600 DC FAIL AC FAIL C hold-up DC/DC WARN SPGDB P/S FAIL +5V - LOGIC +/-15V - LOGIC +/-24V - LEM +12V - SCANport +15V - TACH 6 20V AC/DC Converter 56 V DC 1500 W DC/DC FAIL Fan 120V, single phase Fan supply is XXXV, 3 phase DC/DC Converter Printer Terminal relays 20 V Isolated Gate Driver Power Supply (Optional) +15V - SPGDB TEST 3 phase, 4 wire XXXVAC +24V I/O 3phase TX, XXXV/208V XXX = 380, 480, 600 DC FAIL AC FAIL C hold-up DC/DC WARN SPGDB P/S FAIL +5V - LOGIC +/-15V - LOGIC +/-24V - LEM +12V - SCANport +15V - TACH 6 20V AC/DC Converter 56 V DC 1500 W DC/DC FAIL Fan 120V, single phase Fan supply is XXXV, 3 phase DC/DC Converter Printer Terminal relays 20 V Isolated Gate Driver Power Supply (Optional)
Figure 6.48 Standard PowerFlex 7000 B Frame control power distribution (without UPS option)
Figure 6.49 illustrates the extended ride-through capabilities of the control circuit. An UPS must be installed to provide the energy to supply the AC/DC converter for an extended period of time in case of a loss of control power. It is assumed that if control power is interrupted, the medium voltage will also be interrupted and the drive will not be required to operate the motor until both control and medium voltage is re-applied.
6-66 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
120V, single phase AC FAIL 6 20V UPS 2kVA UPS on bypass batt low on batt AC FAIL DC FAIL Fan Printer Terminal Relays/contactor DC/DC CONVERTER C hold-up +24V - I/O +5V - LOGIC +/-15V - LOGIC +/-24V - LEM +12V - SCANPORT +15V - TACH +15V - SPGDB TEST Fan supply is XXXV, 3 phase 3 phase transformer XXXV/208V 3 phase,4 wire XXXVAC AC/DC CONVERTER 56 VDC @ 300W AC/DC CONVERTER 56V DC @ 1500W 20 V ISOLATED GATE DRIVER POWER SUPPLY DC/DC FAIL DC/DC WARN SPGDB P/S FAIL DC FAIL (Optional) 120V, single phase AC FAIL 6 20V UPS 2kVA UPS on bypass batt low on batt AC FAIL DC FAIL Fan Printer Terminal Relays/contactor DC/DC CONVERTER C hold-up +24V - I/O +5V - LOGIC +/-15V - LOGIC +/-24V - LEM +12V - SCANPORT +15V - TACH +15V - SPGDB TEST Fan supply is XXXV, 3 phase 3 phase transformer XXXV/208V 3 phase,4 wire XXXVAC AC/DC CONVERTER 56 VDC @ 300W AC/DC CONVERTER 56V DC @ 1500W 20 V ISOLATED GATE DRIVER POWER SUPPLY DC/DC FAIL DC/DC WARN SPGDB P/S FAIL DC FAIL (Optional)
Figure 6.49 Standard PowerFlex 7000 B Frame control power distribution (with UPS option)
To reduce the size of UPS needed, the loads on the AC/DC converters are separated into two distinct loads: the IGDPS boards and the DC/DC power supply.
The IGDPS load is only needed when the drive is in the normal operating mode and running the motor. During interruption of control and medium voltage, the IGDPS load demand on the AC/DC will be not be required. Only the DC/DC will remain energized for an extended period of time after loss of control power. The DC/DC converter will power the main control boards and keeps them fully functional.
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-67 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
AC/DC Power Supply Each AC/DC converter is rated for 1500W at 50C and 1525 m (5000 feet). Above these two limits, de-rating factors are used to reduce the capacity of the converter. The converter must always have a minimum 20% margin; that is, its power output must not exceed 80% of its maximum rating. The load demands on the AC/DC converters are the DC/DC converter and up to six IGDPS modules. The DC/DC is a fixed load; however, the quantity of IGDPS modules will vary depending upon the drive configuration. These factors are used in determining the quantity of AC/DC converters needed per drive.
If more than one module is needed, the modules are connected in parallel and operate in a current sharing mode. In parallel operation, there will be just one AC Fail signal, and each module DC Fail signal will be individually monitored.
Description
The AC/DC power supply accepts 3 voltage and produces a regulated 56Vdc output for the DC/DC power supply and the HV IGDPS modules for the SGCTs. The input and output voltages are monitored and fail signals are annunciated upon either voltage going below a pre-set level.
3 phase 95-265V ac 47-63 Hz 2%V unbalance DC FAIL AC FAIL AC/DC Power Supply 56V, 1500 W 4 DC/DC Power Supply HV IGDPS Power Supply
Figure 6.50 AC/DC converter power supply
AC FAIL: Upon loss of AC line (V input 90 VAC), this open collector output goes from low to high before loss of output regulation.
DC FAIL: Upon loss of DC output (50.4VDC V output 53.8 VDC, -7%, 3%) this output goes from low to high.
6-68 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
AC/DC Power Supply (cont.) Location
The AC/DC power supply is located on the low voltage incoming compartment. A typical low voltage compartment is shown in Figure 6.51. Fan Disconnect Control Power Transformer Contactor / Overload Fan Power Fuses AC/DC Power Supply Fan Disconnect Control Power Transformer Contactor / Overload Fan Power Fuses AC/DC Power Supply
Figure 6.51 Location of AC/DC power supply on low voltage panel
Terminal / Connections descriptions
The terminal connections are shown in Figure 6.52.
Control signals DC outputs 3-phase inputs Front View
Figure 6.52 Terminal locations on AC/DC power supply Component Definition and Maintenance 6-69 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
P1-AC input PIN# LABEL 1 EARTH 2 LINE 1 3 LINE 2 4 LINE 3
P2-DC output PIN# LABEL 1 +56V 2 +56V COMM 3 +56V 4 +56V COMM
P3-FAIL output PIN# LABEL 3 DC POWER FAIL (OUTPUT POWER GOOD) 14 AC/DC FAIL COMM (LOGIC RETURN) 15 CURRENT SHARING 16 AC POWER FAIL (POWER FAIL)
Ensure the output of the supply is 56V DC.
There is a potentiometer on the top of the power supply that adjusts the 56 Volt DC output for the power supply. Isolate the output of the power supplies; multiple supplies in parallel will affect your measurements. With the control power on and the output of the AC/DC Converter isolated from the drive control, adjust the potentiometer until the output equals 56 volts DC. Perform this test on each power supply. When all adjustments are complete, re- connect the power supply to the circuit and re-measure the output. Adjust if necessary.
If it is not possible to maintain 56 V DC, the power supply may be faulty.
6-70 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
AC/DC Power Supply (cont.) Replacement procedure 1. Ensure 3-phase control power has been isolated and locked out. 2. Disconnect the terminals at the top of the unit. 3. Remove the two M6 bolts per Figure 6.53. 4. Extract the power supply complete with left-side mounting bracket from the drive. 5. Remove the mounting bracket from the failed power supply (four M4 screws). Retain the insulation sheet. 6. Attach mounting bracket to replacement power supply. Ensure that the insulating sheet between the bracket and power supply is installed. 7. Install new power supply in drive; install M6 bolts. 8. Re-connect terminals at the top of the unit. 9. Reapply control power and verify voltage levels.
Insulation Sheet Power Supply Mounting Bracket M4 screw Insulation Sheet Power Supply Mounting Bracket Insulation Sheet Power Supply Mounting Bracket M4 screw
Figure 6.53 Replacement of AC/DC Power Supply
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-71 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
UPS Option The PowerFlex 7000 B Frame drive has the option for internal and external UPS power to keep the control power active within the drive in the event of a control power loss. The following diagram shows the current configuration of the internal UPS option:
Hold-up Capacitor Holding Bracket UPS 300WAC/DC Power Supply Hold-up Capacitor Holding Bracket UPS 300WAC/DC Power Supply
Figure 6.54 300W AC/DC Power Supply
The UPS is installed in the incoming cabling section, below the LV control section.
The UPS will keep control power to all the critical 120VAC loads and an extra AC/DC Power Supply that feeds the DC/DC Power Supply for powering all the drive control components. The main drive cooling fan, and the AC/DC Power Supply that feeds the IGDPS boards are not powered from this UPS.
The UPS is programmed for the AS400 communication protocol, and has several status signals that are fed back to the Customer Interface Board to allow the control to respond to various conditions including low batteries, loss of input power, UPS on bypass, etc.
6-72 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
UPS Option (cont.) If the customer has an external UPS, the firmware will essentially not expect any of the signals mentioned in the above section, and will not display any information relating to the UPS status. The firmware will operate in the same manner with respect to the operation of the drive with an internal or external UPS.
The output of the UPS feeds a 300W AC/DC Power Supply. This is 20% of the standard AC/DC Power Supply used in the drive because the load represented by the DC/DC Power Supply is much smaller than the load of the IGDPS boards, and we are able to reduce the size accordingly. We still use the standard AC/DC Power Supply to feed the IGDPS boards. The 300W AC/DC Power Supply also has AC and DC fail signals that are fed back to the Customer Interface Board for processing.
There is also a hold-up capacitor on the output of the 300W AC/DC Power Supply to keep the 56VDC up in the event of a failure of the power supply.
UPS Replacement Procedure
1. Ensure 3-Phase Control Power has been isolated and locked-out 2. Remove the hardware that fastens the holding bracket to the cabinet assembly and remove the holding bracket. 3. Disconnect the input and output wiring connected to and from the UPS. 4. Disconnect the 25 pin status plug from the UPS 5. Remove the UPS, and install the new UPS. 6. Reconnect all the connections removed in the previous steps. 7. Before reconnecting the mounting bracket, apply control power to the unit and ensure the UPS is programmed for AS400 communication protocol. Refer to the manual that comes with the UPS for instructions. 8. Once this has been confirmed, install the mounting bracket.
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-73 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Low Voltage Control Section The low voltage control section panel houses all of the control circuit boards, relays, Operator Interface Terminal, DC/DC power supply, and most other low voltage control components. Refer to Figure 6.55 for a generic representation of a low voltage tub arrangement.
Figure 6.55 Low Voltage Tub Compartment
Signal Conditioning Boards Drive Control Board (Machine) Fiber Optic Interface Boards Drive Control Board (Line) Customer Interface Board (Control Board Panel Closed) (Control Board Panel Opened) 6-74 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
DC/DC Power Supply Description
The DC/DC power supply is used as a source of regulated DC voltage for various logic control boards and circuits. The input to this power supply is from a regulated 56Vdc source.
+24V - PRINTER,I/O DC/DC Power Supply C hold-up DC/DC WARN SPGDB TEST POWER ON +5V - DCB LOGIC +/-15V - DCB LOGIC +/-24V - LEM +12V - REM I/O +15V - TACH DC/DC FAIL +15V - SPGDB TEST 56 Vdc - +
Figure 6.56 DC/DC converter power supply
The capacitor at the input terminals is for power dip ride-through purposes. Upon loss of the 56V input, the capacitors (C hold-up) will maintain the voltage level.
Due to the critical nature of the DCB Logic power source, the DC/DC power supply has been designed to provide redundancy for these voltages. Each of the DCB Logic outputs is supplied internally with two separate sources of power. In the event of one failing, the other power supply will be automatically switched in to provide the output power.
DC FAIL Each output to be internally monitored with a single output fail. This output goes from low to high when any of the non- redundant outputs fail or both of the redundant outputs of one particular voltage fails (output voltage is < 95%).
DC WARNING Each redundant output to be internally monitored with a single output warning. This output goes from low to high before loss of output regulation of any one of the redundant outputs (output voltage is <95%).
SPGDB TEST POWER ON The +15V output on COM4 will have its load current monitored. This open collector output goes from low to high when the load current exceeds 20 mA. The purpose of this signal is to inform the user that the test harness for the SCRs is still attached to the DC/DC converter. Component Definition and Maintenance 6-75 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
LEDs
Green operational LED on front of unit detects DC FAIL output. LED ON: outputs good LED OFF: outputs bad
Terminal/connections descriptions
P1-DC input PIN# LABEL DESCRIPTION ONLY 1 +56V +56V input 2 +56V COMM +56V common 3 EARTH earth ground
1. With the drive energized, check to see if the indicator light is ON or OFF. If it is OFF, replacement is necessary. (View 1)
2. De-energize the drive, isolate and lock out the 3-phase control power, and remove all wire connections from the top of the unit. (View 1)
3. Remove quantity of (4) M6 (H.H.T.R.S.) that will allow the DC/DC Power Supply Assembly to be removed from the Low Voltage Panel. (View 1)
4 Remove quantity of (4) M4 (P.H.M.S.) and Nylon Shoulder Washers from the back of the Mounting Plate. (View 2)
5. Replace old DC/DC Power Supply with the new one. NOTE: Make sure the Black Insulation is between the DC/DC Power Supply and the Mounting Plate. Repeat Steps 4, 3, 2, 1 in this order to replace unit. (View 2) Component Definition and Maintenance 6-77 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
DC Power good indicator light M6 (H.H.T.R.S.) VIEW 1 DC/DC power supply Part ID label VIEW 2 Black insulation Mounting plate M4 (P.H.M.S.) and nylon shoulder washer
Figure 6.57 Replacement of DC/DC power supply
The replacement of printed circuit boards should be handled in a careful and deliberate manner.
There are some basic precautions that should be taken. They include the following: Remove all power to the drive. Do not remove the replacement board from the anti-static bag until necessary. Use anti-static wrist strap, grounded in the Low Voltage Control Section
There are no direct screw/terminal connections on any of the Low Voltage circuit boards. All wire/terminal connections are made on plugs that plug into the circuit boards. This means that changing boards only requires the removal of the plugs, minimizing the chance of mistakes when reconnecting all of the wiring. Printed Circuit Board Replacement 6-78 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Drive Control Boards There are two Drive Control Boards (DCBs) in the Low Voltage Control Section. There is one board to control the Rectifier or Line- Side devices (DCB-L) and one board to control the Inverter or Machine-Side devices (DCB-M). These boards in their unprogrammed state are the same and are interchangeable. The DCB-M is the top board. The DCB-L is the middle board, directly connected to the Customer Interface Board (CIB).
Figure 6.58 DCB Board
These boards are responsible for all of the drive control processing and store all of the parameters used for the drive control. They are programmed at the same time that the CIB is programmed, through a null-modem cable and the CIB (J8) port.
There is a Status LED on the DCB, labeled D1. The following Table illustrates the states of the LED. Except where specific boards are mentioned in the Condition description, this table is applicable to all Circuit Boards in the Control Section.
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-79 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
LED STATUS CONDITION Solid Green Application Firmware Running Flashing Green @0.25 Hz Download Mode Flashing Green @0.50 Hz Download Mode Currently being Programmed Flashing Green @1.0 Hz Ready Flashing Green @2.0 Hz Testing Flash Memory 1 Green Pulse Waiting for Release upon Startup 2 Green Pulses DCB-L Waiting for DCB-M Status 3 Green Pulses DCB-L Waiting for CIB Status 10 Green Pulses Tests Passed Off DCB in Test Mode Solid Red POST Failure DSP Flashing Red @0.25 Hz Waiting for CIB Flashing Red @0.50 Hz Waiting for DCB Flashing Red @1.0 Hz Waiting for Adjacent Board 2 Red Pulses POST failure - RAM 3 Red Pulses POST failure NVRAM 4 Red Pulses POST failure DPRAM 5 Red Pulses POST failure Application Flash 6 Red Pulses POST failure Text Flash 7 Red Pulses POST failure External DPRAM 8 Red Pulses Failed FPGA Loading 9 Red Pulses POST failure USART 1 Green Flash = Port 1 POST failure USART 2 Green Flashes = Port 2 10 Red Pulses Returned from Application and Halted 11 Red Pulses Programming Error - CRC 12 Red Pulses Programming Error Connection 13 Red Pulses Programming Error Feedback 14 Red Pulses Programming Error Overflow
There is also a healthy LED labeled D2 on each DCB. This LED is an indication of several things, including a healthy watchdog between the adjacent board, and healthy DC voltages. The light will go out if either of the DC voltages (except the 5V) drops too low, or if the watchdog is absent for 10 consecutive samples. The watchdog is annunciated every 1 ms. The DCB OK contact on the SCB operates in parallel to the D2 LED. When D2 is on, DCB OK is closed. 6-80 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Drive Control Boards (cont.) Drive Control Board Replacement
Before replacing the DCB-L or the DCB-M, it is important to record all of the programmed drive parameters and settings. Specifically, the parameters, fault masks, fault descriptions, and PLC links are critical. This information is stored in NVRAM on each, and as a result you may lose your settings with a new board. The best method to record parameters is to use the memory on the terminal. Other options include a flashcard, HyperTerminal, the door-mounted printer, Drive Executive or DriveTools TM to record the parameters to a file. The printer and HyperTerminal options allow you to print all of the drive setup information. Otherwise, recording information by hand is the only option left.
In the situation where a board has failed, you probably will not be able to save parameters after the failure. That is why it is important to save all parameters when you are finished commissioning or servicing the drive. In this case you should contact the customer to see if they have a copy of the last parameters, or contact Product Support to check if they have a copy.
The DCB-L, DCB-M, and CIB are all connected together using solid plug connections. This means that the best way to change any of the boards without physically stressing the connections and boards is to remove all 3 from the drive and change the board externally.
Instructions to replace the Drive Control Boards
1. Record all drive setup information using any of the options above, if possible.
2. Ensure that all medium voltage and control voltage power to the drive is isolated and locked out.
3. Loosen the two metal tabs on the top and bottom right of the panel on which the SCB-L and SCB-M are mounted. The panel is hinged on the right side, and should swing open to allow access to the DCB-L, DCB-M and CIB boards. There is no need to remove any connections from the SCB.
4. Note and mark the location and orientation of all the ribbon cables, plugs and connectors into the DCB-L, DCB-M and CIB. Use the electrical drawing as a reference.
5. Using your static strap, disconnect the fiber optic cables from the sheet metal by cutting the tie-wraps. The purpose is to create enough slack to allow the FOI Boards to be moved slightly out of the way, allowing access to remove the boards. Use great care when handling Fiber Optics, as any damage can affect transmission capabilities. Component Definition and Maintenance 6-81 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Drive Control Board (Machine) Fiber Optic Interface Boards Drive Control Board (Line) Customer Interface Board
6-82 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
6. Remove the Fiber Optic Interface (FOI) Boards from the DCBs. There are standoffs and pins from the DCB that slide into the FOI boards, but they are physically attached only using the standoff connectors, and you have to be firm, but CAREFUL, in freeing the FOI boards.
7. There are numerous plastic clips holding all 3 boards to the plate. Loosen the connectors and remove all 3 boards as one unit. If you need to place the boards on a surface, ensure you have a static pad to protect the boards.
8. Separate the boards and replace the damaged DCB with the new part. Verify the part number is the same, and note the revision letters.
9. Follow Steps 7-3 in reverse to re-install the boards back into the low voltage control cabinet.
10. Apply control power to the drive. The DCBs are shipped with no firmware installed, so the drive will automatically go into download mode. Install firmware in the drive following the guidelines in Installing Firmware.
11. Program the drive. Refer to Technical Data Medium Voltage AC Drive Parameters Publication 7000-TD001_-EN-P. The parameters should also be saved to NVRAM and then externally to the drive using the options described earlier in this section. Drive Control Boards (cont.) Component Definition and Maintenance 6-83 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 Customer Interface Board The Customer Interface Board (CIB) is the hub for all control-level signals external to the drive. Analog I/O, External Fault signals (through the XIO board), SCANport/DPI communication modules, Remote I/O, terminal interface, printers, modem, Drive Identity Module, and other external communication devices are routed through this board. LEDs
Figure 6.60 CIB Board 6-84 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Analog Inputs and Outputs
The PowerFlex 7000 B Frame offers one isolated process current loop transmitter and one isolated process current loop receiver, embedded into the control. These are accessible on the CIB. Each of these can be configured independently as either 0-20mA or 4-20mA. (Refer to Programming Manual). The following information will show the connections for each.
Current Loop Transmitter
The current loop transmitter will transmit either 0-20mA or 4-20mA output to an external receiver. The loop compliance on the transmitter is 12.5V. Loop compliance is the maximum voltage at which a transmitter can generate to achieve the maximum current and is usually a function of the power supply voltage. Therefore, the transmitter can drive a receiver with an input resistance up to 625 ohms. The figure below shows a block diagram of the transmitter.
Figure 6.61 Process Loop Transmitter Block Diagram
This type of transmitter is known as a 4-wire transmitter, and will sink current from a receiver. The receiver is connected by two wires only from pins 1 (+ connection) and either pins 2, 3, 4 (- connection).
The recommended connection is shown below. The type of shielded cable used is application specific and is determined by the length of the run, the characteristic impedance and the frequency content of the signal.
Customer Interface Board (cont.) Component Definition and Maintenance 6-85 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
CIB J 4A Process Loop Receiver Shielded Twisted Pair SHLD 1 2 3 4 Ia CIB J 4A Process Loop Receiver Shielded Twisted Pair SHLD 1 2 3 4 Ia
Figure 6.62 Recommended Connection to CIB Transmitter
Current Loop Receiver
The receiver can accept either 0-20mA or 4-20mA inputs from an external transmitter. The transmitter must have a minimum loop compliance of 5V to satisfy the input impedance of 250 ohms.
6-86 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
The receiver can accept either 2-wire or 4-wire transmitters, and therefore the connections to this port are dependent on the type of external transmitter used. The figure below shows the recommended connections. Again, the type of shielded cable used is application specific as per the transmitter.
CIB J 4B 1 2 3 4 CIB J 4B 1 2 3 4 2-Wire Transmitter CIB Supplied Power (Sourcing) RTN Out Out VPP GND RTN DC 4-Wire Transmitter User supplied power (Sinking) VPP CIB J 4B 1 2 3 4 CIB J 4B 1 2 3 4 2-Wire Transmitter CIB Supplied Power (Sourcing) RTN Out Out VPP GND RTN DC 4-Wire Transmitter User supplied power (Sinking) VPP
Figure 6.64 Process Loop Receiver Connections
LEDs
There are 5 LEDs on the CIB, labeled D1 to D5. They are designated as follows: LED Designation Description D1 OBP1 This LED is similar in function to D1 on the DCB. It is the On-Board Programming LED, and the DCB table should be used to evaluate the status of the LED D2 MOD A SCANport Communication Status LED - Flashing Red All valid adapters are Lost - Flashing Red/Green At least one, but not all, of the valid adapters are lost - Green All valid adapters are OK - Off No adapters are connected or active D3 MOD B DPI Communication Status LED - Flashing Red All valid adapters are Lost - Flashing Red/Green At least one, but not all, of the valid adapters are lost - Green All valid adapters are OK - Off No adapters are connected or active D4 XIO LINK XIO Link Status LED - Solid Green XIO #1 has been configured and detected - Off XIO #1 either is not configured or not detected D5 HEALTHY The healthy LED will be green as long as all control voltages on the CIB are OK, and the CIB Watchdog is operating correctly Customer Interface Board (cont.) Component Definition and Maintenance 6-87 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Customer Interface Board Replacement
The DCB-L, DCB-M, and CIB are all connected together using solid plug connections. This means that the best way to change any of the boards without physically stressing the connections and boards is to remove all 3 from the drive and change the board externally.
Instructions to replace the Customer Interface Board
1. Record all drive setup information using any of the options above, if possible.
2. Ensure that all medium voltage and control voltage power to the drive is isolated and locked out.
3. Loosen the two metal tabs on the top and bottom right of the panel on which the SCB-L and SCB-M are mounted. The panel is hinged on the right side, and should swing open to allow access to the DCB-L, DCB-M and CIB boards. There is no need to remove any connections from the SCB.
4. Note and mark the location and orientation of all the ribbon cables, plugs and connectors into the DCB-L, DCB-M and CIB. Use the electrical drawing as a reference.
5. Using your static strap, disconnect the fiber optic cables from the sheet metal by cutting the tie-wraps. The purpose is to create enough slack to allow the FOI Boards to be moved slightly out of the way, allowing access to remove the boards. Use great care when handling Fiber Optics, as any damage can affect transmission capabilities.
6. Remove the Fiber Optic Interface (FOI) Boards from the DCBs. There are standoffs and pins from the DCB that slide into the FOI boards, but they are physically attached only using the standoff connectors, and you have to be firm, but CAREFUL, in freeing the FOI boards.
7. There are numerous plastic clips holding all 3 boards to the plate. Loosen the connectors and remove all 3 boards as one unit. If you need to place the boards on a surface, ensure you have a static pad to protect the boards.
8. Separate the boards and replace the damaged CIB with the new part. Verify the part number is the same, and note the revision letters.
9. Follow Steps 7-3 in reverse to re-install the boards back into the low voltage control cabinet. 6-88 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
10. Apply control power to the drive. The CIBs are shipped with no firmware installed, so the drive will automatically go into download mode. Install firmware in the drive following the guidelines in Installing Firmware.
11. Program the drive. Refer to Technical Data Medium Voltage AC Drive Parameters publication 7000-TD001_-EN-P. The parameters should also be saved to NVRAM and then externally to the drive using the options described earlier in this section.
Signal Conditioning Boards The Signal Conditioning Boards (SCB) receive all of the Analog Signals from the drives internal components. This includes the current and voltage feedback signals. The boards also have isolated Digital I/O for e-stops, and contactor control and status feedback. All of the test points for the currents, system voltages, control voltages, and flux are on these boards.
Figure 6.65 SCB Board
Customer Interface Board (cont.) Component Definition and Maintenance 6-89 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
The following table illustrates the most commonly used test points.
New SCB Board (80190-378-xx) Old SCB Board (80190-278-xx) TP # Label TP # Label Description 3 VBCXFR_OUT 1 VBCXFR_OUT Voltage BC on Line Side of Bypass Contactor, unfiltered 4 VABXFR_OUT 2 VABXFR_OUT Voltage AB on Line Side of Bypass contactor, unfiltered 5 VAB2_OUT 3 VAB2_OUT Voltage AB on Slave 1 input winding, unfiltered 6 VBC2_OUT 4 VBC2_OUT Voltage BC on Slave 1 input winding, unfiltered 7 VCA2_OUT 5 VCA2_OUT Voltage CA on Slave 1 input winding, unfiltered 8 VAB3_OUT 6 VAB3_OUT Voltage AB on Slave 2 input winding, unfiltered 9 VBC3_OUT 7 VBC3_OUT Voltage BC on Slave 2 input winding, unfiltered 10 VCA3_OUT 8 VCA3_OUT Voltage CA on Slave 2 input winding, unfiltered 11 VAB1_OUT 9 VAB1_OUT Voltage AB on Master input winding (SCBL) or Motor (SCMB), unfiltered 12 VBC1_OUT 10 VBC1_OUT Voltage BC on Master input winding (SCBL) or Motor (SCBM), unfiltered 13 VCA1_OUT 11 VCA1_OUT Voltage CA on Master input winding (SCBL) or Motor (SCBM), unfiltered 14 VDC_AVG 12 VDC_AVG DC Link Average Voltage across Inverter Side (SCBL only), calculated 28 -15V 24 -15V -15V DC Analog Power 29 AGND 25 AGND Analog Power Common 30 +15V 26 +15V +15V DC Analog Power 31 -24V 27 -24V -24V DC Hall-Effect Transducer Power 32 LEMGND 28 LEMGND Hall-Effect Transducer Power Common 33 +24V 29 +24V +24V DC Hall-Effect Transducer Power 34 +5V 30 +5V +5V DC Digital Power 35 DGND 31 DGND Digital Power Common 36 VN 32 VN Voltage from Filter Capacitor Neutral Point, unfiltered 38 VNG 35 VNG Converter Neutral-Ground Voltage, calculated 64 IDCP 42 IDCP DC Link Current Feedback, filtered 66 IFIELD 45 IFIELD Synchronous Motor Field Current Feedback, filtered 74 DAC_TP1 76 DAC_TP1 Assignable Test Point (Rect_TP1 [SCBL] or INV_TP1 [SCMB] parameters) 75 DAC_TP1 77 DAC_TP1 Assignable Test Point (Rect_TP2 [SCBL] or INV_TP2 [SCMB] parameters) 1 IA1_OUT N/A Across R17 Current Phase A, Master Bridge, unfiltered 2 IC1_OUT N/A Across R29 Current Phase C, Master Bridge, unfiltered 15 IA2_OUT N/A Across R33 Current Phase A, Slave 1 Bridge, unfiltered 27 IC2_OUT N/A Across R66 Current Phase C, Slave 1 Bridge, unfiltered 40 IA3_OUT N/A Across R75 Current Phase A, Slave 2 Bridge (SCBL) or Motor (SCBM), unfiltered 41 IC3_OUT N/A Across R89 Current Phase C, Slave 2 Bridge (SCBL) or Motor (SCBM), unfiltered 62 IDCP_OUT N/A Across R138 DC Link Feedback Current (SCBL), unfiltered 70 IGND_OUT N/A Across R140 Zero Sequence Feedback Current (SCBL), unfiltered 75 IFIELD_OUT N/A Across R156 Field Current Feedback (SCBL), unfiltered 67 DOUT0 63 DOUT0 Digital Output command for DI Contactor (SCBL) or Bypass Contactor (SCBM) 65 DOUT1 62 DOUT1 Digital Output Command for Bypass Enable (SCBM) 60 DOUT3 69 DOUT3 Digital Output Command for DO Contactor (SCBL) or OP Contactor (SCBM) 55 DIN0 N/A Digital Input Status for DI Contactor (SCBL) or Bypass Ctctr (SCBM) 53 DIN1 N/A Digital Input Status for DI Isolation Switch (SCBL) or Bypass Isol. Sw. (SCBM) 50 DIN2 N/A Digital Input Status for OP Contactor (SCBL) or OP Contactor (SCBM) 47 DIN3 N/A Digital Input Status for OP Isolation Switch (SCBL) or OP Isol. Sw. (SCBM) 44 ENCA N/A Pulse Train from the Input of the Encoder Signal, Channel A 45 ENCB N/A Pulse Train from the Input of the Encoder Signal, Channel B Requires the usage of isolated probes or isolation channels on the oscilloscope to avoid damaging the PF7000 Drive. 6-90 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
There is a separate SCB for each DCB, and they are labeled SCB-L and SCB-M. These boards are NOT the same and therefore not interchangeable. They are separate part numbers. The main reasoning for the difference is that Current Feedback from the Line-Side Current Transformers and Current Feedback from the Machine-Side Hall Effect sensors requires different scaling resistors. These resistors are mounted directly on the boards for drives with lower current requirements. A drive with higher current requirements may require an external parallel resistor connected across the CT/Hall Effect sensor input plug connector.
There are two LEDs on the SCB labeled D2 and D3. D2 is the 15VDC voltage-OK signal, and D3 is the +5VDC voltage-OK signal.
Signal Conditioning Board Replacement
To replace the Signal Conditioning Boards,
1. Ensure that all medium voltage and control voltage power to the drive is isolated and locked out. 2. Note and Mark the location and orientation of all the ribbon cables, plugs, and connectors into the SCB-L or SCB-M. Use the electrical drawing as a reference. 3. Using your static strap, disconnect all of the connections. 4. Remove the SCB from the low voltage control cabinet. Verify that the new part number matches the part number on the old SCB. Installing the SCB-L in the place of the SCB-M (or the opposite) can result in serious damage to the drive as the feedback scaling will be wrong. 5. Install the new SCB in the low voltage control cabinet. 6. Reconnect all plug connections and verify the locations. 7. Apply Low Voltage power and complete a System Test and Medium Voltage tests to ensure the new board functions properly.
Signal Conditioning Boards (cont.) Component Definition and Maintenance 6-91 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
External Input/Output Boards The External Input/Output (XIO) Boards are connected through a network cable (CAN Link) to the Customer Interface Board. This cable should be connected to XIO Link A (J4). The XIO board handles all external Digital Input and Output signals and sends them to the CIB through the cable. There are 16 Isolated Inputs and 16 Isolated Outputs on the card, and they are used for Runtime I/O including Start, Stop, Run, Fault, Warning, Jog, and External Reset signals. The boards also handle the standard drive fault signals (Transformer/Line Reactor Overtemperature, DC Link Overtemperature, etc.) and several spare configurable fault inputs. There is an option in software to assign each XIO a specific function (General IO, External IO or Liquid Cooling).
Figure 6.66 XIO Board 6-92 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
The standard drive comes with one XIO board, although additional boards can be paralleled through the same type of CAN Link connection, from XIO Link B (J5) on the first board to XIO Link A (J4) on the second board, and so on. Specific applications may require the additional inputs and outputs. There is a component on the XIO board that will display the XIO board number. There is also an LED on the XIO board labeled D1 that indicates the status of the board. The following table illustrates the possible states.
LED Status Description Solid Green Communication to CIB OK Solid Red Board Failure Alternate Flashing of Red and Green No Communication Available to CIB board (Normal during boot up or when unprogrammed)
External Input/Output Board Replacement
To replace the External Input/Output Boards:
1. Ensure that all medium voltage and control voltage power to the drive is isolated and locked out. 2. Note and Mark the location and orientation of all the plugs, cables, and connectors into the XIO board. Use the electrical drawing as a reference. 3. Using your static strap, disconnect all of the connections. 4. Remove the XIO board assembly from the low voltage control cabinet. The XIO board mounts on a DIN rail, so a special 3-piece assembly is used to secure the board. The assembly does not come with the new board, so the old board needs to be removed from the assembly and the new board installed in its place. 5. Install the new XIO board assembly in the low voltage control cabinet. 6. Reconnect all connections and verify the locations. 7. Apply Low Voltage power and complete a System Test and Medium Voltage tests to ensure the new board functions properly.
External Input/Output Board (cont.) Component Definition and Maintenance 6-93 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Fiber Optic Interface Boards The Fiber Optic Interface (FOI) Boards are the interface between the Drive Control Boards and the Gate Driver circuitry. The drive control decides which device to fire, and sends an electrical signal to the FOI boards. The FOI board converts that electrical signal to an optical signal, which is transmitted via fiber optics to the gate driver cards. Typically, the Transmit ports are Black and the Receive ports are Blue. The gate driver accepts that signal and turns the device on and off accordingly. The diagnostic fiber optic signals work the same way, but the source is the gate driver boards and the destination is the drive control boards.
Figure 6.67 Fiber Optic Interface Board
The FOI boards are mounted directly on the DCBs using two parallel 14-pin connectors for the electrical connection, and plastic clips to provide the mechanical strength. Each FOI board can handle the Firing and Diagnostic duplex fiber optic connector for 6 devices, whether they are SCRs or SGCTs. Physically, on the Drive Control Boards, there is provision for 18 devices for the inverter and the rectifier. This is enough capacity to handle the highest rated drive that we currently produce. The top FOI board on the DCB is for the A devices, the middle FOI board on the DCB is for the B devices, and the bottom FOI board on the DCB is for the C devices. 6-94 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Each FOI board also has an input for a signal from a Thermistor Feedback Board. On the standard offering, there is one thermistor from the Line Converter and one thermistor from the Machine Converter, each going into the respective FOI board in the A position. There is capability in the control for 2 thermistors per converter. The alarm and trip setpoints for each of these signals is programmable in software.
There are 3 LEDs on the FOI board, and the following table illustrates the status and description for the LED states:
LED Status Description D1 Red On Run The FOI board has received the Enable signal from DCB, and is enabled to send and receive signals D2 Yellow On Ready The FOI board has received sufficient power for all transmit ports D3 Green On Power the FOI board has received a voltage signal greater than 2V
Fiber Optic Interface Board Replacement
To replace the Fiber Optic Interface Boards:
1. Ensure that all medium voltage and control voltage power to the drive is isolated and locked out. 2. Note and mark the location and orientation of all the fiber optic cables. Use the electrical drawing for reference. 3. Using your static strap, disconnect all of the connections. 4. Remove the FOI board from the DCB. There are four standoffs that snap into place on the FOI, and they need to be carefully handled when disconnecting the boards. There is also the 28-pin connection between the boards, and this connection should be handled carefully as you do not want to bend the pins. 5. Install the new FOI on the DCB. Ensure the standoffs snap into place. 6. Reconnect all fiber optic connections and verify the locations. 7. Apply Low Voltage power and complete a System Test and Medium Voltage tests to ensure the new board functions properly.
Fiber Optic Interface Boards (cont.) Component Definition and Maintenance 6-95 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Downloading Firmware The following illustrates how to download firmware on the PF7000 Drive. The procedure requires you to have a PC with Hyperterminal (Windows based communication program), and a Null-Modem serial cable with a 9-pin female connection for the PC serial port, and a 9- pin male connection for the CIB Communication Port (J8).
Optional equipment includes an 8MB Allen-Bradley Flash ATA Card, Catalog Number 2711-NM28, which will allow you to move parameters from Drive to Drive or Drive to PC.
If you are working from an unprogrammed drive, the drive should already be in download mode and once you set up Hyperterminal, the drive is ready for downloading. If the drive already has been programmed and you are upgrading firmware, follow the full procedure outlined below.
Introduction
With the introduction of the PowerFlex 7000 Medium Voltage Drive, all drive control functions are loaded on the Drive Control Boards (DCBs) with firmware via a serial connection on the Customer Interface Board (CIB). The firmware for all participating boards in the system is packaged into a single file (with the extension .XFW) and downloaded to the drive using the XMODEM protocol. This protocol is readily available on Windows based PC systems in the form of HyperTerminal.
The latest firmware and the associated release notes are available on the Medium Voltage intranet site, or can be obtained from Medium Voltage Product Support.
This document describes how to download new or updated firmware to the drive using the HyperTerminal program. All firmware downloaded via this means is stored in non-volatile Flash memory.
Overview
From the point of view of OBP (On Board Programming) or downloading firmware to the drive boards, there are currently three devices which can participate:
Communications Board Rectifier DCB (Drive Control Board - Line) Inverter DCB (Drive Control Board Machine)
6-96 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
When the system is powered up, the three control boards communicate amongst themselves and execute the Application Code contained in the on-board flash memory. If any single board does not have valid firmware, then the entire system will drop into a download mode. In the download mode the system is waiting to receive a firmware download via the serial port (J8) on the CIB. This port is normally used by the printer, if supplied.
The system may also be placed into download mode from the Drive Terminal. This can only be accomplished if you have obtained a minimum of ADVANCED level access. Once that has been obtained, from the main screen selecting UTILITY-TRANSFER- SYSTEM will place the drive into download mode.
Ensure the parameters are saved to NVRAM, and saved to the Operator Interface Terminal, and saved to any other external source such as the Flash Card, DriveTools, or printed to a hardcopy.
Hit F10 (Access), and highlight Advanced. Press Enter and you should have Advanced level access.
Hit F10 to Exit, and then F5 for NVRAM. Press F5 for SAVE, and F8 for YES. The parameters should now be saved to NVRAM. Press F10 again to EXIT.
Preparation for Downloading Firmware Component Definition and Maintenance 6-97 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
To save to the Operator Interface Terminal and Flash Card, Press F2 (UTILITY), F7 (TRANSFER), and F4 (PARAMETERS). You should now be on the following screen:
In order to save parameters to the Operator Interface Terminal, press F5 (DRV>MEM). To save to the Flash Card, you must first insert the card in the terminal. Remove the back cover and insert the card in the slot on the terminal. It can only go in one way. Then press F4 (DRV>CRD).
Saving to the card means that you will have to choose a file name. Use the Up and Down arrows to select the character, and then use the Right arrow to go to the next character. Press the Enter key when finished.
Press F8 for YES, and the parameters will be transferred to the card. Press F10 to EXIT.
6-98 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Setting Up Hyperterminal
Start HyperTerminal on the PC. Open a New 'Connection' in HyperTerminal. Choose any name and hit the OK button. In the "Connect Using" list, select one of your valid serial ports. Most laptops use serial port 1 (Direct to Com 1). Then click the OK button
Next press the Configure button.
The following port settings are required: Baud Rate: 38.4KB Data Bits: 8 Stop Bits: 1 Parity: None Flow Control: Xon/Xoff Preparation for Downloading Firmware (cont.) Component Definition and Maintenance 6-99 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Next select the "Advanced" button and de-select the "Use FIFO Buffers".
Now select OK all the way back to the main HyperTerminal screen.
Connect a null modem serial cable between your computer's serial port and the serial port marked 'J8' on the CIB. Only pins 2,3 and 5 are used in the connection. Typically 2 and 3 are reversed on a null modem connection. 6-100 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Here is a typical pin out of a complete null-modem cable.
9-Pin Female 9-Pin Male Connector Connector Pin # Pin #
1 DCD RED RTS 7 CTS 8 2 TXD BRN TXD 3 3 RXD BLK RXD 2 4 DTR GRN DSR 6 5 COM BLU COM 5 6 DSR WHT DTR 4 7 COM YEL DCD 1 8 CTS NC SHLD Case
PF7000 in Download Mode
To place the drive in download mode, you should be in the UTILITY TRANSFER screen. You will not be able to do this if the drive is running. Ensure the drive is stopped, and the E-Stop is pressed. This is just a precaution, as all versions of firmware 2.xxx and later will not allow you to attempt a download while running.
This time press F9 for SYSTEM, and a screen will appear telling you that you are in download mode, and to recycle control power once the download is complete. On the Hyperterminal Screen, you should now see the letter C appear every 3 seconds, indicating that your cable is good and you are communicating.
There is also a status LED labeled D1 on the DCB, which provides indication of the programming process. The following illustrates the states of the LED:
Solid Green the Application firmware is running. The system is not in Download mode. Green .25Hz the board is in download mode. Green .5Hz the board is in download mode and is currently being flashed with new firmware. Preparation for Downloading Firmware (cont.) Component Definition and Maintenance 6-101 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
From Hyperterminal, on the top menu bar, select Transfer, then File. The following screen will appear:
Ensure you choose XModem as the protocol, and then click the Browse button. Find the appropriate location of the firmware file, which will be a file with the .XFW extension. Then to download, press the Send button.
As the firmware downloads, you may see a retry error each time the system switches from one board to the next. This only occurs on older versions of firmware. You will also note the number of packets will stop incrementing during this time. This is normal. When the download is complete, the Xmodem file send screen will disappear and a status message will be displayed. This should be "Download Successful". Then the Cs will continue.
6-102 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame At this point the PF7000 drive system is still in download mode. Cycle power to the drive control boards using the isolation switch for the Fan Power on the right side of the drive. Wait approximately 10 seconds before reapplying power.
NOTE: While the system is powered down, the system should be inspected for a DIM module. This is an external memory module mounted on the CIB, in P50-40. If this module is installed and at an earlier major database revision than the new firmware installed, it should be removed. The drive will give you an INVALID DIM fault when you repower the drive with the module still installed.
Reloading the Parameters Once power is reapplied, the drive may come up will all the parameters from NVRAM. But if you have upgraded the firmware from one main revision level to another (i.e. 2.002 to 3.001), the NVRAM will be cleared. All other information such as operating hours, external fault messages, specific drive name, trending setup, etc. are also cleared. If you have upgraded the firmware from one minor revision level to another (i.e. 3.002 to 3.004), the NVRAM will still be intact.
For major revision level upgrades, the majority of the parameters that were stored in the Operator Interface or other external means can still be used, but there may be things such as new parameters, changed scaling on an existing parameter, or added functionality to existing parameters that may have to be addressed. IT IS IMPORTANT TO REFER TO THE RELEASE NOTES BEFORE UPGRADING FIRMWARE.
To reload the parameters from the Operator Interface, once again obtain ADVANCED level access.
Then follow the same steps to get to the UTILITIES TRANSFER PARAMETERS screen. Then choose F3 (MEM>DRV). This will prompt you for confirmation, and you can press F8 for YES.
The parameters will then be transferred. There are differences between parameters for different revision levels, so you may get some errors, and a Transfer Incomplete message. This is normal when going from 2.002 to 3.002 or backwards.
You can also transfer from the Card to the Drive using F2 (CRD>DRV), and the difference is that you will first get a screen asking you to choose from all the available parameter listings on the card. Select the one you want using the arrow keys, and press Enter. Then you can press F8 for Yes and transfer the parameters. Once the parameters are transferred, press the F10 (EXIT) key to get back to the main screen. Preparation for Downloading Firmware (cont.) Component Definition and Maintenance 6-103 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
It is important to go through the parameters and ensure the settings are proper for the drive. New parameters may need to be changed for the specific drive application, and this should be understood from reviewing the release notes beforehand. You should also correct any information such as the drive name, the operating hours, or the external fault text, if present.
You should then press F5 (NVRAM), and save the parameters to NVRAM.
Then cycle control power one more time, and the drive should come up with no faults or warnings, and the drive will be ready to run. At this point you may also want to save the parameters to the Operator Interface terminal, the Flash Card, via Hyperterminal, via software, or as a hardcopy. This will provide a record of the new settings.
Loading Additional Languages
HyperTerminal can also be used to load new languages into the drive system. This is accomplished by connecting a serial cable between the PC and the serial port J46 on the DCB, which is adjacent to the CIB. The use of HyperTerminal and the Configuration settings are the same as that used to download new firmware.
The language module has an extension of .LFW. 6-104 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Programming the Terminal The terminal used on the PowerFlex7000 B Frame drive is capable of participating in the firmware download using HyperTerminal only if it already has previous drive terminal software loaded. If it lacks the software, it does not have the necessary information to communicate with the CIB and must be programmed first.
In this case, the appropriate firmware file with the extension .FMW must either be copied to a PCMCIA Flash Memory Card (ATA) or downloaded serially using the DOSFWDL.exe program. All the necessary files and instructions are available on the Product Support Intranet site.
Flash Memory Card
If using a Flash Memory Card (2711-NM4, 2711-NM8, 2711- NM16), copy the appropriate file to the Flash Card in the root directory. Ensure that there are no other files on the card containing the .FMW extension.
Power off the Terminal and insert the memory card. Apply power to the terminal. The terminal on power-up will sense new firmware and download it from the card. You will see a series of codes on the screen (2 20 21) and then the drive application firmware will start. This process may take several minutes. When the download is finished, remove the card from the terminal. (If you leave the card in the terminal, it will reload the firmware each time the terminal is powered up).
DOSFWDL
This is a program that copies the .FMW file out the serial port of the PC to the serial port of the terminal. Disconnect the terminal's cable from the CIB and connect it to your PC. Make sure the terminal is powered off.
Start the DOSFWDL program and select the appropriate COM port and the applicable .FMW file. When the program displays the "Sending Request" message, turn on the power for the terminal. (Note: the terminal must be off before starting the DOSFWDL program).
The program will then indicate the status of the download. When complete, remove the serial cable from the PC and reconnect it to the CIB board port J7.
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-105 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
The trending setup is best illustrated through an example:
Trend Read-Only Parameters: 1 Status Flag (569) 2 Alpha Line (327) 3 Speed Feedback (289) 4 Torque Reference (291) 5 IDC Reference (321) 6 IDC Feedback (322) 7 I Stator (340) 8 V Stator (344)
The sample rate is to be set at 0 msec. This will default to the fastest sample rate. 20% of the samples should be recorded after the trigger. The single trigger should occur when any fault or warning occurs. 1. Press the Diagnostic Soft Key (DIAGS [F9]). 2. Press the Diagnostic Setup Soft Key to (D_SETUP [F8]) begin programming the diagnostic settings. 3. Cursor the back-lit section to Trace 1 and press the enter key to begin programming. Scroll through the parameter list until Feedback Status Flag (569) is located. Select this as Trace 1. 4. Select Trace 2 through 8 as described in the step above. Note that when you finish Trace 4, just press the down arrow and you will get to the screen showing traces 5-8. 5. Press the TRIGGER Soft Key until the letter S appears in front of the Trigger parameter. 6. Press the RATE Soft Key to program the trending sampling rate. This will be set to 0 msec in this example. 7. Press the DATA Soft Key to set the trigger level for fault or warning. This should be set to 18. 8. Press the COND Soft Key to program the logic for the trigger level. In this example the COND will be set as an OR condition + 9. Press the POST Soft Key to set up how many samples will be recorded after the trigger. In this example the POST value will be set to 20%. The remaining 80% of the samples will be recorded prior to the trigger.
Once these settings have been programmed the drive is ready to trend. Now the drive will trend data at the next fault. Setting up the PowerFlex 7000 B Frame Trending Feature 6-106 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Hazardous materials
Environmental protection is a top priority for Rockwell Automation. The facility that manufactured this medium voltage drive operates an environmental management system that is certified to the requirements of ISO 14001. As part of this system, this product was reviewed in detail throughout the development process to ensure that environmentally inert materials were used wherever feasible. A final review has found this product to be substantially free of hazardous material.
Please be assured that Rockwell Automation is actively seeking alternatives to potentially hazardous materials for which no feasible alternatives exist today in the industry. In the interim, the following precautionary information is provided for your protection and for the protection of the environment. Please contact the factory for any environmental information on any material in the drive or with any general questions regarding environmental impact.
Capacitor Dielectric Fluid
The fluids used in the filter capacitors and the snubber capacitors are generally considered very safe and are fully sealed within the capacitor housings. Shipping and handling of this fluid is typically not restricted by environmental regulations. In the unlikely event that capacitor fluid leaks out, avoid ingestion or contact with skin or eyes as slight irritation could result. Rubber gloves are recommended for handling.
To clean up, soak into an absorbent material and discard into an emergency container, or, if significant leakage occurs, pump fluid directly into the container. Do not dispose into any drain or into the environment in general or into general landfill refuse. Dispose of according to local regulations. If disposing of an entire capacitor, the same disposal precautions should be taken.
Printed Circuit Boards
Printed circuit boards may contain lead in components and materials. Circuit boards must be disposed of according to local regulations and must not be disposed of with general landfill refuse.
Environmental Considerations Component Definition and Maintenance 6-107 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Lithium Batteries
This drive contains 4 small lithium batteries. 3 are mounted to printed circuit boards and 1 is located in the PanelView user interface. Each battery contains less than 0.05g of lithium, which is fully sealed within the batteries. Shipping and handling of these batteries is typically not restricted by environmental regulations, however, lithium is considered a hazardous substance. Lithium batteries must be disposed of according to local regulations and must not be disposed of with general landfill refuse.
Chromate Plating
Some sheet steel and fasteners are plated with zinc and sealed with a chromate-based dip (gold-colored finish). Shipping and handling of the chromate plating parts is typically not restricted by environmental regulations, however, chromate is considered a hazardous substance. Chromate plated parts must be disposed of according to local regulations and must not be disposed of with general landfill refuse.
In Case Of Fire
This drive is highly protected against arcing faults and therefore it is very unlikely the drive would be the cause of a fire. In addition, the materials in the drive are self-extinguishing (i.e. they will not burn without a sustained external flame). If, however, the drive is subjected to a sustained fire from some other source, some of the polymer materials in the drive will produce toxic gases. As with any fire, individuals involved in extinguishing the fire or anyone in close proximity should wear a self-contained breathing apparatus to protect against any inhalation of toxic gases.
Disposal
When disposing of the drive, it should be disassembled and separated into groups of recyclable material as much as possible (i.e. steel, copper, plastic, wire, etc.). These materials should then be sent to local recycling facilities. In addition, all disposal precautions mentioned above must also be taken for those particular materials.
6-108 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
The preventive maintenance activities on the PF7000 Air-Cooled Drive (A-Frame or B-Frame) can be broken down into two categories: Operational Maintenance can be completed while the drive is running. Annual Maintenance should be completed during scheduled downtime.
Refer to the Tools/Parts/Information Requirements at the end of this section for a list of documentation and materials needed to properly complete the preventive maintenance documents.
Operational Maintenance This process really involves only one task: Changing or Cleaning the Air Filters. The PF7000 drives require consistent, unrestricted airflow to keep the power devices cool. The air filter is the main source of blockage in the air path.
The drive will provide an air filter alarm whenever the pressure differential across the devices drops to a drive-specific level. Referring to the Air Filter Block parameter, this can be anywhere from 7% to 17% blocked, depending on the heatsink and device configuration. This may seem like a small number, but it takes significant blockage to begin to lower the voltage from the pressure sensor. The percentage is a measure of voltage drop, and should not be viewed as a percentage of the opening that is covered. They are not related linearly.
Once you receive an Air Filter Warning, you should immediately make plans to change or clean the filter. You should still have days or weeks until the drive reaches an Air Filter Fault, but this is dependent on site-specific particle conditions.
This can be done while the drive is running. Refer to User Manual, Chapter 6 Component Definition and Maintenance for a detailed description of the process.
Preventive Maintenance Check List
Component Definition and Maintenance 6-109 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Annual Maintenance As the name implies, these maintenance tasks should be performed on an annual basis. These are recommended tasks, and depending on the installation conditions and operating conditions, you may find that the interval can be lengthened. For example, we do not expect that torqued power connections will require tightening every year. Due to the critical nature of the applications run on MV drives, the key word is preventive. Investing approximately 8.0 hours per year on these tasks is time well spent in adding insurance against unexpected downtime.
Initial Information Gathering
Some of the important information to be recorded includes: Print Drive Setup Print Fault/Warning Queues Save Parameters to NVRAM Save Parameters to Operator Interface Circuit Board Part Numbers / Serial Numbers / Revision Letters* (* This only needs to recorded if parts have been modified/changed since the last PM activities)
W A R N I N G W A R N I N G
To prevent electrical shock, ensure the main power has been disconnected before working on the drive. Verify that all circuits are voltage free using a hot stick or appropriate voltage-measuring device. Failure to do so may result in injury or death.
Physical Checks (NO Medium Voltage and NO Control Power)
Power Connection Inspection Inspect PF7000 drive, input/output/bypass contactor sections, and all associated drive components for loose power cable connections and ground cable connections: torque them to the required torque specifications. Inspect the bus bars and check for any signs of overheating / discoloration and tighten the bus connections to the required torque specifications. Clean all cables and bus bars that exhibit dust build-up. Use torque sealer on all connections.
Carry out the integrity checks on the signal ground and safety grounds. 6-110 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Check for any visual/physical evidence of damage and/or degradation of components in the low voltage compartments. This includes Relays, Contactors, Timers, Terminal connectors, Circuit breakers, Ribbon cables, Control Wires, etc.; Causes could be corrosion, excessive temperature, or contamination. Clean all contaminated components using a vacuum cleaner (DO NOT use a blower), and wipe clean components where appropriate. Check for any visual/physical evidence of damage and/or degradation of components in the medium voltage compartments (inverter/rectifier, cabling, DC Link, contactor, load break, harmonic filter, etc). This includes main cooling fan, power devices, heatsinks, circuit boards, insulators, cables, capacitors, resistors, current transformers, potential transformers, fuses, wiring, etc.; Causes could be corrosion, excessive temperature, or contamination. Verify that torque on heatsink bolts (electrical connections to bullet assemblies) is within specifications (13.5 N-m). Clean all contaminated components using a vacuum cleaner (DO NOT use a blower), and wipe clean components where appropriate. NOTE: An important component to check for contamination is the heatsink. The fine grooves in the aluminum heatsinks can capture dust and debris.
Carry out the physical inspection and verification for the proper operation of the contactor/isolator interlocks, and door interlocks. Carry out the physical inspection and verification for the proper operation of the key interlocks. Physical verification of the additional cooling fans mounted in the AC Line Reactor cabinet, Harmonic Filter cabinet for mounting and connections. Carry out the cleaning of the fans and ensure that the ventilation passages are not blocked and the impellers are freely rotating without any obstruction. Carry out the insulation meggering of the drive, motor, isolation transformer/line reactor, and the associated cabling. Refer to User Manual, Appendix D Meggering, for meggering procedure. Check clamp head indicator washers for proper clamp pressure, and adjust as necessary. Refer to User Manual, Chapter 6 Component Definition and Maintenance for details on proper clamp pressure.
Annual Maintenance (cont.) Component Definition and Maintenance 6-111 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 Control Power Checks (No Medium Voltage)
Apply 3 Phase Control power to the PF7000 drive, and test power to all of the vacuum contactors (input, output, and bypass) in the system, verifying all contactors can close and seal in. Refer to Publication 1502-UM050_-EN-P for a detailed description of all contactor maintenance
Verify all single-phase cooling fans for operation. This includes the cooling fans in the AC/DC Power supplies and the DC/DC converter.
Verify the proper voltage levels at the CPT (if installed), AC/DC Power Supplies, DC/DC converter, isolated gate power supply boards. Refer to User Manual, Chapter 4 Commissioning for appropriate procedures/voltage levels for the above checks.
Verify the proper gate pulse patterns using Gate Test Operating Mode.
If there have been any changes to the system during the outage, place the drive in System Test Operating Mode and verify all functional changes.
Final Power Checks before Restarting
Ensure all cabinets are cleared of tools, and all component connections are back in place and in the running state. Put all equipment in the normal operating mode, and apply medium voltage. If there were any input or output cables removed, verify the input phasing, and bump the motor for rotation. If there were any changes to the motor, input transformer, or associated cabling, you will have to retune the drive to the new configuration using autotuning. Save all parameter changes (if any) to NVRAM. Run the application up to full speed/full load, or to customer satisfaction. Capture the drive variables while running, in the highest access level if possible.
6-112 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Additional Tasks During Preventive Maintenance
Investigation of customers concerns relating to drive performance Relate any problems found during above procedures to customer issues. Informal instruction on drive operation and maintenance for plant maintenance personnel Reminder of safety practices and interlocks on MV equipment, and on specific operating concerns Reminder of the need to properly identify operating conditions Recommendation for critical spare parts which should be stocked in-plant to reduce production downtime Gather information on all spare parts on site, and compare that with factory-recommended critical spares to evaluate whether levels are sufficient. Contact MV Spare Parts group for more information. Vacuum Bottle Integrity Testing using a Vacuum Checker or AC Hipot Refer to Publications 1502-UM050_EN-P (Series D) and 1502-UM052_-EN-P (Series E) for a detailed description of all 400A contactor maintenance.
Final Reporting
A complete, detailed report on all steps in the Preventive Maintenance procedures should be recorded to identify changes. A completed copy of this checklist should be included. A detailed description of ALL ADJUSTMENTS AND MEASUREMENTS that were taken during the process should be included in an addendum (Interlock Adjustments, Loose Connections, Voltage Readings, Megger Results, Parameters, etc.) THIS INFORMATION SHOULD BE COMMUNICATED TO MV PRODUCT SUPPORT SO THAT FUTURE SUPPORT ACTIVITIES WILL HAVE THE LATEST SITE INFORMATION AVAILABLE. This can be faxed to (519) 740-4756
Annual Maintenance (cont.) Component Definition and Maintenance 6-113 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Time Estimations
Operational Maintenance 0.5 hours per filter Annual Maintenance Initial Information Gathering 0.5 hours Physical Checks Torque Checks 2.0 hours Inspection 2.0 hours Cleaning ** 2.5 hours ** Meggering 1.5 hours Control Power Checks Contactor Adjustments ** 2.0 hours ** Voltage Level Checks 1.0 hours Firing Check 0.5 hours System Test ** 2.0 hours ** Medium Voltage Checks Final Inspection 0.5 hours Phasing Check ** 1.5 hours ** Autotuning** 2.0 hours ** Operation to Maximum Load Site Dependent Additional Tasks Investigation ** Depends on Nature of the Problem ** Informal Training/Refresher ** 2.0 hours ** Spare Parts Analysis ** 1.0 hours ** Vacuum Bottle Integrity Check ** 3.0 hours ** Final Report 3.0 hours
Note: ** indicates that the time may not be required depending on the nature of the maintenance and the condition of the drive system. These times are only estimations. 6-114 Component Definition and Maintenance 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Tool / Parts / Information Requirements
The following is a list of the tools recommended for proper maintenance of the PF7000 drives. Not all of the tools may be required for a specific drive preventive procedure, but if we were to complete all of the tasks listed above the following tools would be required.
Tools 100 MHz Oscilloscope with minimum 2 Channels and memory 5kV DC Megger Digital Multimeter Torque Wrench Laptop Computer with Relevant Software and Cables Assorted Hand Tools (Screwdrivers, Open Ended Metric Wrenches, Metric Sockets, etc.) 5/16 Allen Keys Speed Wrench Feeler Gauge Vacuum Bottle Checker or AC-Hipot Minimum of 7.5 kV Hotstick / Potential Indicator Minimum of 10 kV Safety Gloves Vacuum Cleaner with Anti-static Hose Anti-static Cleaning Cloth No. 30 Torx Driver
Documentation PF7000 User Manual Publication 7000-UM150_-EN-P PF7000 Parameters Manual Publication 7000-TD001_-EN-P MV 400A Vacuum Contactor, Series D User Manual Publication 1502-UM050_-EN-P MV 400A Vacuum Contactor, Series E User Manual Publication 1502-UM052_-EN-P Drive-Specific Electrical and Mechanical Prints Drive-Specific Spare Parts List
Materials Torque Sealer (Yellow) Part number --- RU6048 Electrical Joint Compound ALCOA EJC no. 2 or approved equivalent (for Power Devices) Aeroshell no. 7 Part number 40025-198-01 (for Vacuum Contactors)
Annual Maintenance (cont.) Chapter 7
7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Troubleshooting (Firmware 5.xxx)
Documenting Shutdowns All faults, warnings, or messages displayed on the Operator Interface should be thoroughly documented by the user prior to resetting those messages. This will assist maintenance personnel in correcting problems and ensuring they do not recur.
7-2 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame Acronyms and Abbreviations Used in this Manual Acronym/ Abbreviation Description Acronym/ Abbreviation Description A/D Analog/Digital Lo Low AC Alternating Current LV Low Voltage ADC Analog to Digital Converter M Machine Cap Capacitor Magntz Magnetizing Ch Channel Max Maximum Chn Channel Min Minimum CIB Customer Interface Board Mstr Master Cmd Command MTR Motor CT Current Transformer NVRAM Non-Volatile Random Access Memory Ctctr Contactor OC Overcurrent Cur Current OL Overload DAC Digital to Analog Converter OP Output DC Direct Current OT Overtemperature DCB Drive Control Board OV Overvoltage DD Dimensional Drawings PLL Phase Lock Loop DIM Drive Identity Module PS Power Supply DO Drive Output Pu Per Unit DPI Drive Peripheral Interface PWM Pulse-Width Modulation DrvIn Drive Input Rect Rectifier ED Electrical Drawings Rotn Rotation Fbk Feedback SCB Signal Conditioning Board Flt Fault SCR Silicon-Controlled Rectifier Fltr Filter SGCT Symmetrical-Gate Commutated Thyristor FO Fiber-Optic Slv Slave FOB Fiber-Optic Interface Board Spd Speed FOI Fiber-Optic Interface SPGD Self-Powered Gate Driver FPGA Field-Programmable Gate Array SW Software GND Ground Sync Synchronous Gnrl General Tach Tachometer HCS Hall Effect Current Sensor TFB Temperature Feedback Board Hi High Trp Trip HW Hardware TSN Transient Suppression Network I Current UB Unbalance Init Initialize UPS Uninterrupted Power Supply Inv Inverter USART Universal Synchronous/Asynchronous Transmitter/Receiver IO Input/Output V Volt Isoltn Sw Isolation Switch VSB Volt Sensing Board L Inductance Wrn Warning L Line Xfer Transfer LED Light-emitting diode XIO External Input/Output Liq Liquid
Troubleshooting 7-3 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
FAULT MESSAGES
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS AC/DC#1 DC Fail 143 AC/DC#2 DC Fail 144 AC/DC#3 DC Fail 145 AC/DC#4 DC Fail 146 AC/DC#5 DC Fail 147 AC/DC#6 DC Fail 148 The output of the specified AC/DC Power Supply has seen the 56VDC output voltage drop below the hardwired trip level. The trip level is fixed in hardware as 52VDC 1.7VDC, depending on hardware tolerances.. All of the outputs of the optional multiple AC/DC power supplies are individually monitored and displayed separately. Measure the input voltage and verify it is within limits Measure the output voltage and confirm whether the output level indeed falls below the trip level Verify fault detection wiring is per the drawings, and measure the voltage on the trip signals back to the CIB. The 5VDC is supplied from the CIB to the fault circuit, and is pulled low on the power supply when healthy. Verify the internal cooling fan is operational Replace the Power Supply if required AC300 DC Fail 153 Optional for drives with an internal or external UPS option The 300W AC/DC converter specially fed by the UPS has seen the 56VDC output voltage drop below the hardwired trip level. The trip level is fixed in hardware as 51.5VDC 1.4VDC, depending on hardware tolerances. Measure the input voltage and verify it is within limits Measure the output voltage and confirm whether the output level indeed falls below the trip level Verify fault detection wiring is per the drawings, and measure the voltage on the trip signals back to the CIB. The 5VDC is supplied from the CIB to the fault circuit, and is pulled low on the power supply when healthy. Replace the Power Supply if required Adapter 1 Loss 309 Adapter 2 Loss 310 Adapter 3 Loss 311 Adapter 4 Loss 312 Adapter 5 Loss 313 Adapter 6 Loss 314 There has been a loss of communication between the CIB and the identified SCANport Adapter (Polled Communication). The drive will configure the specific Adapter Loss 1-6 as a fault when the associated bits in Adapter Loss Mask (P175) is set to a 1. Ensure that the SCANport device is powered Verify the SCANport light status and ensure the device is operating properly Verify the customer SCANport network is properly communicated with the device Check CIB LED MOD A status Cycle control power to the drive Change the Adapter and/or CIB if all attempts to restore communication fail Adaptr1 ForceFlt 129 Adaptr2 ForceFlt 130 Adaptr3 ForceFlt 131 Adaptr4 ForceFlt 132 Adaptr5 ForceFlt 133 Adaptr6 ForceFlt 134 There has been a loss of communication between the identified DPI adapter and the customers communication network. The communication between the drive and the DPI adapter may still be active. This is a requirement for DPI communications. If the loss of communication from the network to the adapter is required to be a warning, this must be set in the adapter itself, not within the drive. Verify the adapter LED status and ensure the device is operating properly Verify the customer network is properly communicated with the device Check CIB LED status and compare to the information in Chapter 6 of the Users Manual Change the Adapter if all attempts to restore communication fail 7-4 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Air Filter 73 The Pressure drop at the input to the converter section sensed by the pressure transducer (as a voltage) has dropped below the value set in Pressure Value Trip (P319). This is dependent on the operation of the Main Cooling Fan. Verify fan rotation Check for blocked airflow in the filters/ heatsinks/ ducting (if installed) Clean as required Improper Trip settings Verify Pressure Value voltage level when running with clear air flow, and compare to expected values for that specific drive type Verify Alarm and Trip set-up procedure was completed adequately and adjust as necessary Verify for drives with external ducting that there is sufficient air to the drive input Verify supply voltage to differential pressure transducer, and confirm output is stable Auxiliary Protn 141 Standard External Fault/Warning Input included to allow the end-user to install a protective relay/system status contact that can activate a drive fault or warning, depending on configuration of Aux Prot Class (P445) Check device responsible for the auxiliary contact to this input, and investigate cause of the open contact status Check the 120V signal through the external device Check the XIO board inputs and parameter status bits Bad Reference 246 The CIB verifies a 2.5VDC reference in the A-D converters during initial power up. If this is missing, the A-D converters will not respond as expected, and could cause problems with functions including reference commands Cycle control power to see if fault still exists (Note: It can be reset, as it is only checked on initial power up: Resetting the fault is NOT an indication the problem is cleared Replace CIB if fault persists Cab Temp High (C-Frame Only) 229 The drive has a temperature switch in several cabinets, and all the N/C switches are connected in series and fed back to the XIO input. The levels are set differently for different cabinets. Identify which switch has opened, and focus on that cabinet Check for proper air flow within the identified section Verify muffin fans are operating correctly Verify ambient temperature is within tolerances CIB A/Ds 240 CIB Hardware Fault CIB Time Base 239 CIB Hardware Fault CIB Hardware Problem Cycle control voltage to the drive, and if the problem still exists the CIB board should be replaced CIB Heartbeat 197 The heartbeat link between the CIB and the DCB-L has been lost. Possible Failed CIB or DCB-L Check LED status and compare with table in the manual Cycle control voltage to the boards, and if the problem still exists replace the CIB/DCB-L boards as necessary Troubleshooting 7-5 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Conductivity Hi (C-Frame Only) 227 The measured coolant conductivity is greater than 2 S/cm 3 .
Verify that no foreign debris has entered the system (iron piping, non-deionized water, etc.) Change the de-ionizing cartridge and run the system, verifying that the conductivity is decreasing Coolant Level Lo (C-Frame Only) 228 The measured coolant level within the reservoir has dropped below the second (lowest) level sensor and the drive has faulted. This sensor is set for the minimum level required to ensure there will be no air drawn into the system through the reservoir. Verify that the drive cooling system does not have any coolant leaks repair if found Add the proper amount of de-ionized water to get the level above the warning sensor (de-ionized water will evaporate, not the glycol) Coolant Temp Hi (C-Frame Only) 226 The measured coolant temperature has exceeded 54C (129F).
Verify the heat exchanger fans are operating Verify that the thermostatic valve is fully opened Check that all valves are in the normal operating position Verify that the drive is operating within specified load and ambient conditions Coolant Temp Lo (C-Frame Only) 225 The measured coolant temperature has dropped below 4C (40F). It will not clear until the coolant temperature reaches 10C (50F). This fault will only occur if the drive is not running, to stop you from starting with a low coolant temperature. If you are already running when the coolant level drops, you will only get a warning. Verify that the thermostatic bypass valve (V10) was not left open Verify that the ambient temperature within the drive control room is not below specification Warm up the control room ambient to get the drive to an operational level 7-6 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Current Sens 178 Current Sensor fault If you have the Line HECS/CT code, the line current measurement is not what is expected at this level of dc current. Either of the CT DC HECS and there burden resistors may be damaged or programmed incorrectly. For example, the DC HECS may actually be 2500:1, the drawings and parameters indicate 4000:1. Another cause would be an unplugged DC HECS.
If you have the CT Phs Seqn code, the CTs are likely swapped. For example the CT/wiring for 2U has been switched with 2W.
If you have the CT Phs/Alpha code, the rectifier is firing with the wrong firing angle relative to the angle measured from the line current. This can occur when the CTs on an 18-pulse rectifier are switched between master and slaves.
If you have the Cap/CT Error code, this only occurs for PWM rectifiers when energized and not running. The line current measured by the CTs does not match the expected line current based on the capacitor parameters and measured voltage. Possible causes are incorrect capacitor, CT or burden resistor parameters, and in some cases, blown TSN fuses.
If you have the Motor HECS code, this only occurs when running on the motor in open loop mode. The drive compares the motor current to the dc current, and flags this fault if there is a significant difference. If there were no Line HECS/CT codes, then the likely cause of this fault in an incorrectly programmed motor HECS value or burden resistor. Other causes could be a defective or unplugged motor HECS. DAN Comm 45 Drive Area network communication fault. This is applicable to parallel drive only Check RS485/RS232 converter. Red LED should be steady, and green and yellow transmit and receive LEDs should be flashing. Check RS485 cable between drives Check RS232 cable between Inverter Drive Control Board and serial converter Troubleshooting 7-7 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS DC Link Flow Low (C-Frame Only) 231 The flow switch in the DC Link coolant path has detected the flow is less than optimal, indicating a problem with the flow path. This is not designed to specifically measure flow. This is a switch that differentiates between flow and no flow. Verify pressure values in the cooling system are nominal Verify the cooling path is not restricted because of tube crimping Check flow switch for proper operation It may be required to disconnect cooling path and complete a check on the DC Link for blockages DC Link OC HW 170 The measured I DC Link Feedback (P322) has exceeded DC Overcurrent Trip (P169) or 75% of the device rating, whichever is lower. The drive faults instantaneously. DC Link OC SW 171 The Measured I DC Link Feedback (P322) has exceeded DC Overcurrent Trip (P169) for the duration set in DC Overcurrent Delay (P170). This fault should never occur on its own, but only after a DC Link OC HW fault. Verify that the parameters for drive and device ratings, and installed current sensing components are set accordingly Verify that the DC Link LEM is wired properly and properly powered Verify the Burden Resistor value Complete a DC Current Test to verify the feedback corresponds to the IDC Command Setup trending to capture DC Link Feedback and other related read-only parameters (Contact factory if you require assistance) Check Alpha Line, and verify that the value is not too low (15) and the current regulator is not in limit; Decrease Flux Command Base Speed or increase incoming Line Voltage Restart the drive to allow the start up diagnostics to detect any shorted thyristors, but only attempt this once if shorted SCRs are detected DC Link OT 137 The thermal switch in the drive DC Link Reactor has detected an over-temperature and has opened. There is a thermal switch in each DC Link winding, and they are connected in series. Verify operating conditions (ambient/ altitude/ load levels/ ventilation and fans) and verify that the DC Link Reactor is within ratings Check the 120V signal through the thermal switch Verify the drive cooling circuit is operating correctly (Air Pressure value or liquid-cooling path) Check the XIO board inputs and parameter status bits Determine through elimination whether there is a faulty switch and replace if necessary 7-8 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS DC/DC Fail 155 The last of the 5VDC or the 15VDC supplies from the DC/DC power supply to the drive control logic has failed, or any of the other voltages that are non-redundant have failed. This fault means that you will have no voltage on a required output. Measure the input voltage to the DC/DC power supply and verify it is at 56VDC Measure the output voltage and compare to expected values listed in Chapter 4 of the Users Manual Verify fault detection wiring is per the drawings, and measure the voltage on the trip signals back to the CIB. The 5VDC is supplied from the CIB to the fault circuit, and is pulled low on the power supply when healthy. Verify the output from the alarm signal is wired correctly. This signal is a Replace Power Supply DPI Interface 243 This fault typically occurs when you have the Communication Type (P147) set for 500k (DPI only), and you have a SCANPort adapter connected to the CIB. SCANPort operates at 125k, and the DPI can operate at both speeds. This can also occur if the SCANPort network attempts to access Port 5, which is internally assigned to DPI.
Note: MOD A LED on the CIB indicates a healthy SCANPort Adapter when Green. MOD B LED on the CIB indicates a healthy DPI Adapter when Green. Ensure Communication Type is set for 125k for any drive with SCANPort connections Ensure you are not using a SCANPort splitter with Port 5 active as the drive internally has assigned Port 5 to DPI, and this conflict will create a fault Cycle power to ensure you Communication Type change takes effect The final cause could be a CIB Hardware problem, and the board should be replaced if the above actions are unsuccessful DI Contactor 18 The Drive Input Contactor has opened without command from the PF7000 drive. DO Contactor 19 The Drive Output Contactor has opened without command from the PF7000 drive. OP Contactor 34 The system output contactor has opened without command from the PF7000 drive. BP Contactor 20 The Bypass Contactor has opened without command from the PF7000 drive. The drive system needs to have complete control over all contactors, so investigation of the specific contactor fault is required Verify contactor feedback Verify the control power circuit for the contactor Check permissive string to the contactor control relay (refer to drawing) -Check contactor/breaker for physical malfunction (auxiliaries) Check SCB inputs and outputs Troubleshooting 7-9 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS DI Iso Switch 29 The Drive Input Isolation Switch is in the opposite state than expected, or the state has changed during operation. DO Iso Switch 30 The Drive Output Isolation Switch is in the opposite state than expected, or the state has changed during operation. OP Iso Switch 32 The System Output Isolation Switch is in the opposite state than expected, or the state has changed during operation. BP Iso Switch 31 The Bypass Isolation Switch is in the opposite state than expected, or the state has changed during operation. Depending on the mode of operation (Normal, System Test, Open-Circuit Test, DC Current Test, or Open-Loop), there are specific states for all the possible system isolation switches (Refer to the description of the Parameter 192 IsolSw/Ctctr Cfg in the parameters manual) Ensure the isolation switches are in the proper position Verify wiring feedback Verify isolation switch mechanical auxiliary setup Drive OL 191 A Drive Overload condition has been detected, where the overload condition is calculated using DC Current Feedback (P322) and an algorithm based on Drive Overload Trip (P163) as the absolute trip level, Drive Overload Delay (P164) as the base trip delay, and Drive Overload Min (P269) as initial detection level. Transient Loading Check torque limit and overload settings and compare loading to torque settings and trip settings Open Burden Resistor Check Current feedback and check the burden resistors Dvc AK/Snubb 195 Device Anode-Cathode or Snubber fault NOT USED IN 5.xxxx External 1-16 1-16 These are the optional additional External Faults available when there is an additional XIO board installed. This is configured with XIO Ext Faults (P593), and this message will appear if the specific input (1-16) is configured in Fault Config as a Class 1 or Class 2 fault. Review XIO Board Drawing: Identify source of Input from External Fault XIO Board print and investigate the cause of the fault Verify voltage signals from external sources Ext Cooling Loss (C-Frame only) 224 The drive has detected the loss of the ability to provide cooling for the drive. This is detected through feedback from the Heat Exchanger Cooling fans contactors and overloads. Review the inputs to the drive Liquid Cooling XIO and determine the source of the missing signals Investigate the Heat Exchanger fans and control for a cause Field Loss 35 This fault indicates that the field current is either missing or insufficient. This is done through an indirect method by checking if the drive is in Flux Regulator limit for the delay set in Field Loss Delay (P559). This means your exciter reference I Field Command (P314) is at 100% for the time of the delay. Verify the field current from the exciter is present Verify the analog output from the drive is reaching the field exciter control circuit 7-10 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Gate Test Pwr On 196 The temporary power supply harness used for Gating Tests on the SCR rectifiers has not been removed from the DC/DC Power Supply, and you have attempted to start the drive. Remove the test harness from the drive immediately after Gate Test is finished Verify fault detection wiring is per the drawings, and measure the voltage on the trip signals back to the CIB. The 5VDC is supplied from the CIB to the fault circuit, and is pulled low on the power supply when healthy. Replace the DC/DC Power Supply if the harness is removed and the fault can not be cleared GND Offset 245 CIB Hardware Fault CIB Hardware Problem Cycle control Power to the drive, and if the problem still exists the board should be replaced Ground OC 173 The Ground Current measured on the Ground Fault CT has exceeded the value in Ground Fault Overcurrent Trip (P171) for the duration set in Ground Fault Overcurrent Delay (P172). The GFCT (Zero-Sequence CT) is not installed in all drives. Verify the Burden resistor has not opened Verify parameters are set properly Megger the drive and motor and input transformer/AC line reactor to search for a ground fault in the system Input Protn #1 135 Standard External Fault/Warning Input included to allow the end-user to install a protective relay (IE Input Feed Protection Relay) auxiliary contact that can activate a drive fault or warning, depending on configuration of InputProt1 Class (P440). Check device responsible for the auxiliary contact to this input and investigate the fault indicated by the devices fault message Investigate internal and external causes for this fault code Check the 120V signal through the external device Check the XIO board inputs and parameter status bits InputProtn #2 140 Standard External Fault/Warning Input included to allow the end-user to install a protective relay (IE Input Feed Protection Relay) auxiliary contact that can activate a drive fault or warning, depending on configuration of InputProt2 Class (P444). Check device responsible for the auxiliary contact to this input and investigate the fault indicated by the devices fault message Investigate internal and external causes for this fault code Check the 120V signal through the external device Check the XIO board inputs and parameter status bits Troubleshooting 7-11 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Input Xfmr/LR OT 136 The temperature switch in the drive Input Isolation Transformer or Line Reactor has detected an over-temperature and opened. There is a thermal switch in each phase winding, and they are connected in series. Verify operating conditions (ambient/ altitude/ current levels/ ventilation and fans/ cooling oil) and verify that the Rectifier Transformer/Reactor is within ratings Check the 120V signal through the thermal switch Verify that it is not a faulty switch Check the XIO board inputs and parameter status bits Determine through elimination whether there is a faulty switch and replace if necessary Inv HeatSink FO 76 While Not Running, the Fiber Optic signal from the TFB on the Inverter Heatsink, connected to Channel A fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-M-A is not present. This is only a fault while not running. If this occurs while running it will appear as a warning. Inv Temp Ch B FO 77 Not Normally Used: While Not Running, the Fiber Optic signal from the optional TFB connected to Channel B fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-M-B is not present. This is only a fault while not running. If this occurs while running it will appear as a warning. Check TFB and FOI board for power Check the Fiber Optic cables are properly seated in the transmitters and receivers Check the fiber optic cable for kinks, bends, breaks that could be blocking the signal This can occur if the sensor is not connected to the TFB Inv HS Low Temp 40 If the measured temperature IHeatsink Temp C (P253) is less than 2C, and the drive is not running, the drive will display this fault. Inv ChB Low Temp 41 If the measured temperature Temp I Ch B C (P552) is less than 2C, and the drive is not running, the drive will display this fault. This is not enabled on most drives, and the parameter is a high-level parameter. Verify that the ambient in the control room is not below 2C Verify power to the TFB There could be a mechanical problem with the temperature sensor or with the cable feeding the signal back to the TFB Swap with the rectifier hardware to identify the bad component Inv Heatsink OT 69 The temperature detection on the Inverter Heatsink, connected to Channel A fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-M-A, has exceeded Inverter Heatsink Temperature Trip (P315). Inv ChannelB OT 70 Not Normally Used - The temperature detection on an Inverter Heatsink, connected to fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-M-B, has exceeded Inverter Temperature Trip Channel B (P570) Confirm actual temperature in parameters is not higher than the trip value If so, investigate the conditions of the drive (ambient/ loading/ elevation / ventilation/ filter status /heatsink clogging) Check the sensor and temperature offline (ambient) for accuracy 7-12 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Inv HS Sensor 38 While Not Running, The drive has detected a missing temperature sensor connected to the TFB on the inverter heatsink. A missing sensor can result in either a Fiber Optic Loss fault or a Sensor fault because a missing sensor can be interpreted as either 0C or over 100C, and both are unrealistic values. Inv ChB Sensor 39 While Not Running, Not normally used: The drive has detected a missing temperature sensor connected to the optional TFB connected to the fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-M-B. A missing sensor can result in either a Fiber Optic Loss fault or a Sensor fault because a missing sensor can be interpreted as either 0C or over 100C, and both are unrealistic values. Verify sensor is completely seated properly on TFB. Measure sensor resistance. Replace if necessary. Inv HCS Power 28 The power supplied to the Motor Hall-Effect Current Sensors (24VDC) is monitored on the control board and will fault the drive if the voltage is out of tolerance. Verify the DC voltage on the DC/DC supply, at the SCB-M terminals, and at the Current Sensors Check the Current Sensor wiring and ensure all connections are per the Electrical Drawing IsoTx Air Filter (A-Frame Only) 71 The Pressure sensed by the pressure transducer in the Integral Isolation Transformer section (as a voltage) has dropped below the value set in Pressure Value Transformer Trip (P654). Verify fan rotation Check for blocked airflow in the filters / ducting (if installed) Clean as required Improper Trip settings Verify Pressure Value voltage level when running with clear air flow Verify Alarm and Trip set-up procedure was completed adequately and adjust as necessary, and compare with expected values for that specific drive type Verify for drives with external ducting that there is sufficient air to the drive input Verify supply voltage to pressure transducer, and confirm output is stable Line DC Link OV 172 The DC Link Voltage measured on the Line side of the DC Link has exceeded Line DC Overvoltage Trip (P173) for the duration set in Line DC Overvoltage Delay (P174). Verify that the parameters are set properly Verify that there is no problems with steady-state overvoltages on the input to the drive Ensure all SGCTs are powered Verify VSB resistors, grounds, connections, and tap settings Complete a Gating Test on the rectifier and inverter to confirm devices are firing Verify that the waveforms measured on the SCB-L are as expected Troubleshooting 7-13 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Line Fltr Cap OV 176 The measured line voltage Vline Bridge (P696) has exceeded Line Overvoltage Trip (P165) for the duration set in Line Overvoltage Delay (P166). This is the only uncompensated voltage, representing the voltage on the input to the bridge. All other voltages in the line-side are compensated using L commutation. Verify the parameters are set properly Verify VSB connections and tap settings, resistor values, and grounds This is less likely to be caused by a true Line Overvoltage and more likely to be due to the effects of capacitive leading VARs on a high-impedance system Tap down the input if possible Line Harmonic OV 200 The drive has detected a steady-state resonance-induced overvoltage on the line. This is defined at the level set in Harmonic OV Trip (P675) for the delay Harmonic OV Delay (P676) (on top of normal line voltage) for 1 second. The drive only detects the 5 th
harmonic to eliminate nuisance faults from capacitor charging events. Verify waveforms show excessive harmonics using oscilloscope on SCBL unfiltered voltage testpoints Investigate sources for excessive harmonics on customer power system Contact factory for possible re-tuning of input filter Line HCS Power 175 The power supplied to the DC Link Hall- Effect Current Sensor (24VDC) is monitored on the control board and will fault the drive if the voltage is out of tolerance. Verify the DC voltage on the DC/DC supply, at the SCB-L terminals, and at the Current Sensor Check the Current Sensor wiring and ensure all connections are per the Electrical Drawing Line Heartbeat 25 The DCB-M has detected the loss of the heartbeat signal from the DCB-L
Verify DC Control voltages to both DCBs Possible Failed DCB Check LED status of both boards and compare with table in the manual Recycle power and replace board if necessary Line Neutral OV 192 For SCR rectifiers, the Neutral-to-Ground voltage calculated from the measured line voltages has exceeded Ground Fault Overvoltage Trip (P587) for the duration set in Ground Fault Overvoltage Delay (P588). For PWM rectifier, the Neutral-to-Ground voltage is measured directly from the Line Filter Capacitor Neutral. In both cases, the actual value is displayed in V Neutral Line (P589)
DESIGNED FOR PWM-Rectifier ONLY: Insulation Failure Megger the motor insulation/motor cables/drive insulation to ground Verify the integrity of the input grounding network if applicable Megger the input Isolation Transformer Secondary/Input Cables to ground Verify Parameter settings are appropriate for AC Line Reactor or Isolation Transformer drives Line OC 166 The measured Line Current has exceeded Line Overcurrent Trip (P161) for the duration set in Line Overcurrent Delay (P162). CHECK FOR SHORTED SCRs DO NOT ATTEMPT TO RESET THIS FAULT UNTIL YOU HAVE VERIFIED THE SCRS ARE NOT SHORTED Investigate Possible damage to the input isolation transformer if there have been several aborted starts with Line OC faults Verify that the drive sizing is not too small for the Rated Motor Current Verify Parameters are set properly Verify the Burden resistors are not opened and there are no loose grounds 7-14 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Line OV 159 The calculated Line Voltage has exceeded Line Overvoltage Trip (P165) for the duration set in Line Overvoltage Delay (P166). This is calculated by looking at the compensated individual bridge voltages Master, Slave1 and Slave2 (P136-138), and comparing them to 1/3 of Line Overvoltage Trip. Verify the parameters are set properly Verify VSB connections and tap settings, resistor values, and grounds Verify that the parameter L Commutation (P140) was tuned properly. If voltage is too high, change tap settings on the input source to lower voltage to an acceptable level Line ADC_DAC 210 Line DCB Internal Hardware Fault Line DMA Overrun 217 Line DCB Internal Hardware Fault Line Timer0 208 Line DCB Internal Hardware Fault Line Timer1 209 Line DCB Internal Hardware Fault Line FPGA 207 Line DCB Internal Hardware Fault Board Malfunction Cycle Control Power, to see if the Fault condition remains and Replace DCB-L if necessary Line FOB ChA 211 This fault occurs if the Line Fiber Optic Interface Board A is not connected, but is required based on the number of devices specified (Drive Type and Line Voltage Dependent). Line FOB ChB 212 This fault occurs if the Line Fiber Optic Interface Board B is not connected, but is required based on the number of devices specified (Drive Type and Line Voltage Dependent). Line FOB ChC 213 This fault occurs if the Line Fiber Optic Interface Board C is not connected, but is required based on the number of devices specified (Drive Type and Line Voltage Dependent). Improper parameter settings for Rectifier Series Devices or Rectifier Type Verify parameters Damaged FOI Board Check the LED status on the FOI board replace if necessary DCB-L pin damage Inspect the pins on the DCB-L and ensure there is no damage Replace the DCB-L if necessary
Line FOB ChA PS 214 The 5VDC power supply to the Line Fiber Optic Interface Board A from the Line DCB is not present. Line FOB ChB PS 215 The 5VDC power supply to the Line Fiber Optic Interface Board B from the Line DCB is not present. Line FOB ChC PS 216 The 5VDC power supply to the Line Fiber Optic Interface Board C from the Line DCB is not present. Bad 5VDC supply Check the 5VDC test point on the DCB-L Verify LED status on the FOI Board Check all the pins that mount the FOI board to the DCB and ensure none are bent/broken Troubleshooting 7-15 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Master CurrentUB 163 The measured and calculated phase currents in the Master Bridge have exceeded the value set in Line Current Unbalance Trip (P108) for the duration set in Line Current Unbalance Delay (P109). Verify that all Current Transformer connections are connected properly and that no wires are reversed Ring-out wires to verify connections Check grounding on CTs Ensure that all plugs are firmly connected in the SCBL Check that all input voltages are balanced Verify Parameter settings Check the burden resistors Verify the Input Capacitor values if installed Verity that there are no open sharing resistors. Verify all Line Thyristors are firing in Gating Test Mode Master VoltageUB 160 The measured phase voltages in the Master Bridge have exceeded the value set in Line Voltage Unbalance Trip (P271) for the duration set in Line Voltage Unbalance Delay (P272). CHECK TSN FUSING Verify the VSB connections and tap settings, and check resistance of VSB board Megger board to confirm integrity Check actual voltage values on the Operator Interface terminal for each bridge and the total line voltage Check for possible source voltage supply problems Use Multimeter and Oscilloscope to check voltages on the drive voltage test points Motor Current UB 33 The measured current unbalance on the drive output has exceeded Mtr I UB Trip (P208) for the duration set in Mtr I UB Delay (P214). Verify the current sensor wiring and Burden Resistors from the Motor current sensors Verify the HCS power Check the Output Filter Capacitors for balanced loading on all 3 phases Investigate the possibility of Motor winding or cabling problems Motor DC Link OV 17 DC Link Voltage on the motor side, measured through the Voltage Sensing Board, has exceeded Motor DC Overvoltage Trip (P193) for the duration set in Motor DC Overvoltage Delay (P194). Verify the motor is connected and the Output Contactor is not open Verify there is no open SGCTs Complete a Resistance and Firing check Check VSB circuit (grounds) through to SCB-M Check Burden resistor values Check the trip parameter setting Motor Flux UB 24 The measured Motor Flux has exceeded Motor Flux Unbalance Trip (P585) for the duration set in Motor Flux Unbalance Delay (P586). Verify the VSB resistors are not open and that they are balanced Check for Shorted Motor Output Filter Capacitors Check for a grounded phase on the drive system using a megger test 7-16 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Motor FOB ChA 53 This fault occurs if the Motor Fiber Optic Interface Board A is not connected, but is required based on the number of devices specified (Motor Voltage Dependent). Motor FOB ChB 54 This fault occurs if the Motor Fiber Optic Interface Board B is not connected, but is required based on the number of devices specified (Motor Voltage Dependent). Motor FOB ChC 55 This fault occurs if the Motor Fiber Optic Interface Board C is not connected, but is required based on the number of devices specified (Motor Voltage Dependent). Motor FOB ChA PS 56 The 5VDC power supply to the Motor Fiber Optic Interface Board A from the Motor DCB is not present. Motor FOB ChB PS 57 The 5VDC power supply to the Motor Fiber Optic Interface Board B from the Motor DCB is not present. Motor FOB ChC PS 58 The 5VDC power supply to the Motor Fiber Optic Interface Board C from the Motor DCB is not present. Improper parameter settings for Inverter Series Devices Verify parameters Damaged FOI Board - Check the LED status on the FOI board replace if necessary DCB-M pin damage Inspect the pins on the DCB-M and ensure there is no damage Replace the DCB-M if necessary
Motor Heartbeat 167 The DCB-L has detected the loss of the heartbeat signal from the DCB-M. Verify DC Control voltages to both DCBs Possible Failed DCB Check LED status of both boards and compare with table in the manual Recycle power and replace board if necessary Motor Load Loss 74 The drive has detected a loss of load condition. This is activated as a fault using the parameter Load Loss Detect (P199), and the necessary setpoints are Load Loss Level (P246), Load Loss Delay (P231), and Load Loss Speed (P259). Verify the parameter settings Ensure that the load should not normally be in an unloaded condition This is designed for applications likely to lose the load (downhole pump hollow- shaft motor) and we do not want to run with the loss of load
Motor Neutral OV 67 The Neutral-to-Ground voltage measured from the Output Filter Capacitor Neutral point has exceeded Ground Fault Overvoltage Trip (P189) for the duration set in Ground Fault Overvoltage (P190). This value is displayed in V Motor Neutral (P347). Insulation Failure Megger the motor insulation/motor cables/drive insulation to ground Verify the integrity of the output grounding network if applicable Megger the input Isolation Transformer Secondaries/Input Cables to ground Verify Parameter settings are appropriate for AC Line Reactor or Isolation Transformer drives Verify the integrity of the Output Filter Capacitors, looking for shorts or signs of physical damage Troubleshooting 7-17 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Motor OC 21 The measured motor current I Stator (P340) has exceeded Motor Overcurrent Trip (P177) for the duration set in Motor Overcurrent Delay (P178). Possible Causes: Real OC/Transients Bad Burden resistor/Current Sensor Circuit Failure Check components Parameter settings too low compared to torque limit Verify Parameter settings Current regulator in limit (check line voltage and Alpha line while running) Motor OL 65 A Motor Overload condition has been detected, where the overload condition is calculated using I Stator(P340) and an algorithm based on Motor Overload Trip (P179) as the absolute trip level, Motor Overload Delay (P180) as the base trip delay, and Motor Overload Min (P351) as the point where the overload calculation begins. Transient Loading - Check torque limit and overload settings and Compare loading to torque settings and trip settings Burden Resistor Check LEM feedback and Check the burden resistors Motor OV 22 The measured Motor AC Voltage has exceeded Motor Overvoltage Trip (P181) for the duration set in Motor Overvoltage Delay (P182). Possible Causes: Parameter setting incorrect (flux command/trip values) VSB damage Check VSB resistors, grounds, and verify tap settings are correct Self-Excitation Check for flying start/induced motor rotation Motor Overspeed 66 The motor Speed Feedback (P289) has exceeded Motor Overspeed Trip (P185) for the duration set in Motor Overspeed Delay (P186). Check for unbalance on the motor and line feedback voltages Improper Settings Check parameter settings for Reference Command Maximum and Ensure it is not too close to Overspeed Trip increase Adjust Speed Regulator Bandwidth to control overshoot, and ensure acceleration rate near maximum speed is not too great Check for load transients For Tachometers, ensure the ppr is set properly and the feedback is valid Check tachometer pulse train with an oscilloscope Motor Protection 138 Standard External Fault/Warning Input included to allow the end-user to install a protective relay (IE Bulletin 825 Motor Protection Relay) auxiliary contact that can activate a drive fault or warning, depending on configuration of Motor Prot Class (P443). Check device responsible for the auxiliary contact to this input and investigate the fault indicated by the devices fault message Investigate internal and external causes for this fault code Check the 120V signal through the external device Check the XIO board inputs and parameter status bits 7-18 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Motor Stall 23 The drive has detected a motor stall condition, with a delay set by Motor Stall Delay (P191). The different methods of Motor Stall detection depend on whether a tachometer/encoder is installed or not. Sensorless faults involve the motor not building up enough flux feedback to be detected by the drive, while tachometer feedback methods look at the difference between the tachometer/encoder feedback and the speed command.
Possible Causes: Insufficient torque on starting Increase Torque Command 0 and 1 to avoid motor stalls when starting if Speed Feedback Mode is Sensorless Insufficient torque Increase Torque Limit Motoring to avoid motor stalls while running Reverse Load Rotation Ensure the load is not rotating in the opposite direction Increase motor stall delay Ensure Tachometer Feedback is functional where applicable Ensure the motor is not spinning forward at a speed greater than Reference Command Motor ADC_DAC 52 Motor DCB Internal Hardware Fault Motor DMA Overrun 59 Motor DCB Internal Hardware Fault Motor FPGA 49 Motor DCB Internal Hardware Fault Motor Timer0 50 Motor DCB Internal Hardware Fault Motor Timer1 51 Motor DCB Internal Hardware Fault Board Malfunction Cycle Control Power to see if the Fault remains, and Replace DCB-M if necessary Mstr Xfr Err 46 Master transfer Error This is applicable to parallel drive only The master drive cannot find a slave drive able to take over as master Possible causes are: slave drive not ready, or slave drive masked off Mtr Cap OV 44 Motor filter capacitor Over Voltage fault. This is for ESP application This is drive output Voltage [Surface voltage terminology used in ESP application]. The drive gives this fault in an ESP application only. The protection uses P#181 setting but drive calculates the motor filter cap voltage [Surface V] which is different from motor voltage in ESP application. Check the voltage sensing board for any resistor failure Check for any open circuit at the drive output. Check the devices at the inverter. MV in Gate Test 26 The drive has Medium Voltage applied and the user attempted to place the drive in Gating Test mode. Check input contactor control and Status Ensure that the isolation switch is in the open position and locked out Confirm with hot-stick and status parameters MV in System Test 27 The drive has Medium Voltage applied and the user attempted to place the drive in System Test mode. Check input contactor control and Status Ensure that the isolation switch is in the open position and locked out Confirm with hot-stick and status parameters Troubleshooting 7-19 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS No DO/OP Ctctr 37 This fault is specifically used for Open Circuit Test Mode, which demands that an Output Contactor be specified in IsoSw/Ctctr Cfg (P192). If the contactor is not specified, you will get this fault in Open Circuit Test Mode. This is to help avoid inexperienced people putting the drive in open circuit test mode without actually open circuiting the output with either a contactor or by disconnecting the cable. If there truly is no Output Contactor in the system, then you can mask the fault. Then there will be a No DO/OP Ctctr warning, and you can continue with the test. Open Cct UV 36 Under Voltage during open circuit test During open circuit test mode the drive trips on this fault if difference between flux command base speed value and drive output voltage is more than 40%, and speed ramped to 95% of the line frequency. Check if any short circuit at the drive output Make sure motor is not connected OutPut Open 43 DO or OP open fault Drive sees DO or OP contactor open. Check for open circuit at the drive output PD Capcty Lo 47 Parallel Drive Capacity Low. This is applicable to parallel drive only The available drive capacity is less than 50% of the motor rated current. The drive cannot run. Pressure Loss (C-Frame Only)
223 The measured system pressure has dropped below a preset trip level. The standard operating pressure is around 50psi. The pressure switch is not designed to be an accurate measure of pressure, but is designed as a Pressure/No Pressure indication. Typically anything less than 20psi will activate this switch. Check that the pumps are operating Verify that there are no leaks in the system Verify that there is no blockage in the system Printer USART 242 CIB Hardware Fault CIB Hardware Problem Cycle control Power to the drive, and if the problem still exists the board should be replaced Pump/Fan Pwr Off (C-Frame Only)
230 The control power to the pumping system and the heat exchanger fans is not present. Verify the disconnect switch is closed and that there are no blown fuses Measure the voltage at the pump and fan inputs to ensure voltage is present Trace the feedback to the drive from the circuit, looking for loose wiring or incorrect auxiliaries R Neutral OC 206 Neutral Resistor Over Current. This is applicable to Direct to Drive only Check the neutral R for open Check devices on rectifier and inverter for shorts Check the Line and Motor filter cap for short between Phase to Neutral or Phase to Phase. 7-20 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Rect Heatsink FO 198 While Not Running, the Fiber Optic signal from the TFB on the Rectifier Heatsink, connected to Channel A fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-L-A is not present. This is only a fault while not running. If this occurs while running it will appear as a warning. Rect Temp ChB FO 199 Not Normally Used: While Not Running, the Fiber Optic signal from the optional TFB connected to Channel B fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-L-B is not present. This is only a fault while not running. If this occurs while running it will appear as a warning. Check TFB and FOI board for power Check the Fiber Optic cables are properly seated in the transmitters and receivers Check the fiber optic cable for kinks/bends/breaks that could be blocking the signal Rec HS Low Temp 204 If the measured temperature RHeatsink Temp C (P254) is less than 2C, and the drive is not running, the drive will display this fault. Rec ChB Low Temp 205 If the measured temperature Temp R Ch B C (P556) is less than 2C, and the drive is not running, the drive will display this fault. This is not enabled on most drives, and the parameter is a high-level parameter. Verify that the ambient in the control room is not below 2C Verify power to the TFB There could be a mechanical problem with the temperature sensor or with the cable feeding the signal back to the TFB Swap with the inverter hardware to identify the bad component Rect HeatSink OT 193 The temperature detection on the Rectifier Heatsink, connected to Channel A fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-L-A, has exceeded Rectifier Heatsink Temperature Trip (P315). Rect ChannelB OT 194 Not Normally Used - The temperature detection on a Rectifier Heatsink, connected to fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-L-B, has exceeded Rectifier Temperature Trip Channel B (P525). Confirm actual temperature in parameters is not higher than the trip value If so, investigate the conditions of the drive (ambient/ loading/ elevation / ventilation/ filter status /heatsink clogging) Check TFB and FOI board for power and fiber optic integrity Check the sensor and temperature offline (ambient) for accuracy Rec HS Sensor 201 The drive has detected a missing temperature sensor connected to the TFB on the rectifier heatsink. A missing sensor can result in either a Fiber Optic Loss fault or a Sensor fault because a missing sensor can be interpreted as either 0C or over 100C, and both are unrealistic values. Rec ChB Sensor 202 Not normally used: The drive has detected a missing temperature sensor connected to the optional TFB connected to the fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-L-B. A missing sensor can result in either a Fiber Optic Loss fault or a Sensor fault because a missing sensor can be interpreted as either 0C or over 100C, and both are unrealistic values. Verify sensor is completely seated properly on TFB. Measure sensor resistance. Replace if necessary. Troubleshooting 7-21 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS RNeutral OL 203 The neutral resistor required for Direct-to- Drive technology has reached an overload condition. This is determined from parameters R Neutral (P680), R Neutral Rating (P681). The current through the neutral resistor is calculated by measuring the voltage across the resistor and knowing the resistance. I Common Mode (P697) displays that current, and R Neutral OL (P682) shows the overload accumulator. The resistor is allowed 500% for 10 seconds every 5 minutes, and P682 is normalized to fault whenever the value reaches 1.00. Verify the resistor ratings Verify that the drive Voltage Feedback Splitter board is operating properly Investigate the possibility of voltage unbalances on the input or output of the drive that would create a voltage differential across the resistor Contact the factory for further instructions SCB Incompat 177 Signal Conditioning Board Incompatible This is for DTD drive only The SCB -280 and 380 are used in DTD drive. The boards have different filter that cause this fault. Use -380 board on SCBL and SCBM Slave1 CurrentUB 164 The measured and calculated phase currents in the Slave 1 Bridge have exceeded the value set in Line Current Unbalance Trip (P108) for the duration set in Line Current Unbalance Delay (P109). Slave2 CurrentUB 165 The measured and calculated phase currents in the Slave2 Bridge have exceeded the value set in Line Current Unbalance Trip (P108) for the duration set in Line Current Unbalance Delay (P109). Verify that all Current Transformer connections are connected properly and that no wires are reversed Ring-out wires to verify connections Check grounding on CTs Ensure that all plugs are firmly connected in the SCBL Check that all input voltages are balanced Verify Parameter settings Check the burden resistors Verify the Input Capacitor values if installed Verify that there are no open sharing resistors Verify all Line Thyristors are firing in Gating Test Mode Slave1 Phasing 168 The voltage phasing on the Slave1 bridge is not phased the same as the voltages on the Master bridge. Slave2 Phasing 169 The voltage phasing on the Slave 2 bridge is not phased the same as the voltages in the Master Bridge. Verify cables are terminated correctly Verify the feedback wires from the terminals to the VSB is terminated correctly The faults can be masked, and then the voltages and phasing can be checked using the test points on the SCB-L, being aware that there will be phase differences between the master and secondary bridges depending on the drive configuration. Refer to Manual. 7-22 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Slave1 VoltageUB 161 The measured phase voltages in the Slave 1 Bridge have exceeded the value set in Line Voltage Unbalance Trip (P271) for the duration set in Line Voltage Unbalance Delay (P272). Slave2 VoltageUB 162 The measured phase voltages in the Slave2 Bridge have exceeded the value set in Line Voltage Unbalance Trip (P271) for the duration set in Line Voltage Unbalance Delay (P272). CHECK TSN FUSING Verify the VSB connections and tap settings, and check resistance of VSB board Megger board to confirm integrity Check actual voltage values on the Operator Interface terminal for each bridge and the total line voltage Check for possible source voltage supply problems Use Multimeter and Oscilloscope to check voltages on the drive voltage test points Spd Cmd Loss 317 The drive has lost communication with the device responsible for providing the speed command to the drive. This has been set to annunciate as a fault. The drive will configure the Speed Command Loss as a fault when the associated bit in Adapter Loss Mask (P175) is set to a 1. Setting the bit to 0 will cause the drive to indicate a warning and run at the last commanded speed. Ensure that the SCANport device is powered Verify the SCANport light status and ensure the device is operating properly Verify the customer SCANport network is properly communicated with the device Check CIB LED status Cycle control power to the drive Change the Adapter and/or CIB if all attempts to restore communication fail Sync Xfer Failed 75 A Synchronous Transfer was not completed in the time specified in Synchronous Transfer Time (P230) and the drive has faulted. This fault will only occur if the parameter Sync Xfer Option (P419) is configured as Enable Fault. If the parameter is set as Enable Warn, the drive will go back to last speed command and issue a warning. Instability at Synchronous Speed - Check for stability of the synchronous transfer process/ speed regulator Load can not reach Synchronous Speed Check load conditions for torque limit or low alpha line (low line voltage) Consult factory for review of synchronous transfer parameters Tach Loss F 42 Tach Loss fault Check the tach feedback Temp Feedback Ls (C-Frame only) 232 This fault occurs only if the drive is not running. The drive has detected missing temperature feedback from the cooling system. A missing sensor can be interpreted as either 0C or over 100C, and both are unrealistic values, so it is considered a Feedback Loss. Verify sensor is completely seated properly on TFB. Measure sensor resistance. Verify Fiber Optics are properly seated on TFB Verify the TFB has power Replace if necessary. Terminal USART 241 CIB Hardware Fault CIB Hardware Problem Cycle control Power to the drive, and if the problem still exists the board should be replaced XIO Interface 244 CIB Hardware Fault CIB Hardware Problem Cycle control Power to the drive, and if the problem still exists the board should be replaced Troubleshooting 7-23 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
This fault will only occur during the initial contactor closure and the diagnostic sequence after a start command. The inverter monitors the state of the feedback before a gate pulse is given, and monitors the feedback after a gate pulse has been sent. The SGCT has smart diagnostics, so the feedback may indicate short before firing, and if the pulse is received and the device is really shorted, the diagnostic will toggle the feedback to let you know the problem is with the device, or the power supply for that device.
The firmware now completes a diagnostics sequence immediately after any drive reset, with the goal of detecting faults before any destructive action is taken from the next action Complete a resistance check per the instructions in the manual NOTE: SGCTs may not have completely shorted, and still could read in the k range Any devices with low suspect readings should be changed Check the LED status of the SCGT gate driver card for abnormal readings Complete a Gating Test mode check on the devices Verify the associated 20V power supply is powered and active Verify all the power connections to the SCGT firing card are seated properly 7-24 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS U1A Fbk FO Loss 93 U1B Fbk FO Loss 99 U1C Fbk FO Loss 468 U4A Fbk FO Loss 96 U4B Fbk FO Loss 102 U4C Fbk FO Loss 471 V3A Fbk FO Loss 95 V3B Fbk FO Loss 101 V3C Fbk FO Loss 470 V6A Fbk FO Loss 98 V6B Fbk FO Loss 104 V6C Fbk FO Loss 473 W2A Fbk FO Loss 94 W2B Fbk FO Loss 100 W2C Fbk FO Loss 469 W5A Fbk FO Loss 97 W5B Fbk FO Loss 103 W5C Fbk FO Loss 472
INVERTER SGCT FAULT (Feedback Fiber-Optic Loss)
This fault will only occur during the initial contactor closure and the diagnostic sequence after a start command. The inverter monitors the state of the feedback before a gate pulse is given, and monitors the feedback after a gate pulse has been sent. This fault occurs when the feedback was low from the device before gating, and is still low from the device after gating. The drive then assumes the feedback must be the problem.
The firmware now completes a diagnostics sequence immediately after any drive reset, with the goal of detecting faults before any destructive action is taken from the next action Check that the fiber optic cables are seated properly in the Optical Interface Board and the SCGT firing card Check that the fiber optic cable is not pinched or damaged Complete a resistance check per the instructions in the manual NOTE: SGCTs may not have completely shorted, and still could read in the k range Any devices with low suspect readings should be changed Check the LED status of the SCGT gate driver card for abnormal readings Complete a Gating Test mode check on the devices Verify the associated 20V power supply is powered and active Verify all the power connections to the SCGT firing card are seated properly U1A Gat FO Loss 105 U1B Gat FO Loss 111 U1C Gat FO Loss 474 U4A Gat FO Loss 108 U4B Gat FO Loss 114 U4C Gat FO Loss 477 V3A Gat FO Loss 107 V3B Gat FO Loss 113 V3C Gat FO Loss 476 V6A Gat FO Loss 110 V6B Gat FO Loss 116 V6C Gat FO Loss 479 W2A Gat FO Loss 106 W2B Gat FO Loss 112 W2C Gat FO Loss 475 W5A Gat FO Loss 109 W5B Gat FO Loss 115 W5C Gat FO Loss 478
INVERTER SGCT FAULT (Gating Fiber-Optic Loss)
This fault will only occur during the initial contactor closure and the diagnostic sequence after a start command. The inverter monitors the state of the feedback before a gate pulse is given, and monitors the feedback after a gate pulse has been sent. This fault occurs when the feedback was high from the device before gating, and is still high from the device after gating. The drive then assumes the gating pulse must not have reached the device.
The firmware now completes a diagnostics sequence immediately after any drive reset, with the goal of detecting faults before any destructive action is taken from the next action Check that the fiber optic cables are seated properly in the Optical Interface Board and the SCGT firing card Check that the fiber optic cable is not pinched or damaged Complete a resistance check per the instructions in the manual NOTE: SGCTs may not have completely shorted, and still could read in the k range Any devices with low suspect readings should be changed Check the LED status of the SCGT gate driver card for abnormal readings Complete a Gating Test mode check on the devices Verify the associated 20V power supply is powered and active Verify all the power connections to the SCGT firing card are seated properly Troubleshooting 7-25 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
This fault will occur during operation of the drive. The drive has detected that the feedback from the device was not correct, and does not wait to determine the exact problem. The drive polls the entire bridge 3 times before and 3 times after each gating command. All 6 of these readings for each device must be consistent for the fault to occur. There is also a parameter called Inverter Device Diagnostic Delay (P268), which allows you to change the number of consecutive firings to eliminate nuisance faults. It will still poll 3 times before and after each firing, but will now require the condition to exist for the number of consecutive firings set in the Diagnostic Delay parameter for a fault to occur.
The firmware now completes a diagnostics sequence immediately after any drive reset, with the goal of detecting faults before any destructive action is taken from the next action Complete a resistance check per the instructions in the manual NOTE: SGCTs may not have completely shorted, and still could read in the k range Any devices with low suspect readings should be changed Check the LED status of the SCGT gate driver card for abnormal readings Complete a Gating Test mode check on the devices Verify the associated 20V power supply is powered and active Verify all the power connections to the SCGT firing card are seated properly For nuisance faults, contact the factory about extending the Diagnostic Delay 2U1A Device Flt 291 2U1B Device Flt 297 2U1C Device Flt 336 2U4A Device Flt 294 2U4B Device Flt 300 2U4C Device Flt 339 2V3A Device Flt 293 2V3B Device Flt 299 2V3C Device Flt 338 2V6A Device Flt 296 2V6B Device Flt 302 2V6C Device Flt 341 2W2A Device Flt 292 2W2B Device Flt 298 2W2C Device Flt 337 2W5A Device Flt 295 2W5B Device Flt 301 2W5C Device Flt 340
PWM RECTIFIER SGCT FAULT
This fault will occur during the initial contactor closure, the diagnostic sequence after a start command, or the diagnostic sequence after a stop command. The rectifier monitors the state of the feedback before a gate pulse is given, and monitors the feedback after a gate pulse has been sent. The SGCT has smart diagnostics, so the feedback may indicate short before firing, and if the pulse is received and the device is really shorted, the diagnostic will toggle the feedback to let you know the problem is with the device, or the power supply for that device.
The firmware now completes a diagnostics sequence immediately after any drive reset, with the goal of detecting faults before any destructive action is taken from the next action. The main example of this is closing the input contactor on a shorted bridge. Complete a resistance check per the instructions in the manual NOTE: SGCTs may not have completely shorted, and still could read in the k range Any devices with low suspect readings should be changed Check the LED status of the SCGT gate driver card for abnormal readings Complete a Gating Test mode check on the devices Verify the associated 20V power supply is powered and active Verify all the power connections to the SCGT firing card are seated properly
7-26 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
FAULT MESSAGE FAULT CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS 2U1A Fbk FO Loss 267 2U1B Fbk FO Loss 273 2U1C Fbk FO Loss 324 2U4A Fbk FO Loss 270 2U4B Fbk FO Loss 276 2U4C Fbk FO Loss 327 2V3A Fbk FO Loss 269 2V3B Fbk FO Loss 275 2V3C Fbk FO Loss 326 2V6A Fbk FO Loss 272 2V6B Fbk FO Loss 278 2V6C Fbk FO Loss 329 2W2A Fbk FO Loss 268 2W2B Fbk FO Loss 274 2W2C Fbk FO Loss 325 2W5A Fbk FO Loss 271 2W5B Fbk FO Loss 277 2W5C Fbk FO Loss 328
This fault will occur during the initial contactor closure, the diagnostic sequence after a start command, or the diagnostic sequence after a stop command. The rectifier monitors the state of the feedback before a gate pulse is given, and monitors the feedback after a gate pulse has been sent. This fault occurs when the feedback was low from the device before gating, and is still low from the device after gating. The drive then assumes the feedback must be the problem.
The firmware now completes a diagnostics sequence immediately after any drive reset, with the goal of detecting faults before any destructive action is taken from the next action Verify that the Feedback Fiber-Optic from the SCGT to the FOI board is not damaged or disconnected Verify that the Gate Pulse has been received by the SGCT board using Gating Test Mode Complete a resistance check described in Chapter 4, checking the devices, sharing resistors, and snubber circuitry Replace all faulty components
2U1A Gat FO Loss 279 2U1B Gat FO Loss 285 2U1C Gat FO Loss 330 2U4A Gat FO Loss 282 2U4B Gat FO Loss 288 2U4C Gat FO Loss 333 2V3A Gat FO Loss 281 2V3B Gat FO Loss 287 2V3C Gat FO Loss 332 2V6A Gat FO Loss 284 2V6B Gat FO Loss 290 2V6C Gat FO Loss 335 2W2A Gat FO Loss 280 2W2B Gat FO Loss 286 2W2C Gat FO Loss 331 2W5A Gat FO Loss 283 2W5B Gat FO Loss 289 2W5C Gat FO Loss 334
This fault will occur during the initial contactor closure, the diagnostic sequence after a start command, or the diagnostic sequence after a stop command. The rectifier monitors the state of the feedback before a gate pulse is given, and monitors the feedback after a gate pulse has been sent. This fault occurs when the feedback was high from the device before gating, and is still high from the device after gating. The drive then assumes the gating pulse must not have reached the device.
The firmware now completes a diagnostics sequence immediately after any drive reset, with the goal of detecting faults before any destructive action is taken from the next action Check that the fiber optic cables are seated properly in the Optical Interface Board and the SCGT firing card Check that the fiber optic cable is not pinched or damaged Complete a resistance check per the instructions in the manual NOTE: SGCTs may not have completely shorted, and still could read in the k range Any devices with low suspect readings should be changed Check the LED status of the SCGT gate driver card for abnormal readings Complete a Gating Test mode check on the devices Verify all the power connections to the SCGT firing card are seated properly Troubleshooting 7-27 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
This fault will occur during operation of the drive. The drive has detected that the feedback from the device was not correct, and does not wait to determine the exact problem. The drive polls the entire bridge 3 times before and 3 times after each gating command. All 6 of these readings for each device must be consistent for the fault to occur. There is also a parameter called Rectifier Device Diagnostic Delay (P266), which allows you to change the number of consecutive firings to eliminate nuisance faults. It will still poll 3 times before and after each firing, but will now require the condition to exist for the number of consecutive firings set in the Diagnostic Delay parameter for a fault to occur.
The firmware now completes a diagnostics sequence immediately after any drive reset, with the goal of detecting faults before any destructive action is taken from the next action Complete a resistance check per the instructions in the manual NOTE: SGCTs may not have completely shorted, and still could read in the k range Any devices with low suspect readings should be changed Check the LED status of the SCGT gate driver card for abnormal readings Complete a Gating Test mode check on the devices Verify the associated 20V power supply is powered and active Verify all the power connections to the SCGT firing card are seated properly Reset the drive and let the offline diagnostics further define the problem For nuisance faults, contact the factory about extending the Diagnostic Delay 7-28 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
For SCR rectifiers, this fault will occur after the initial contact closure, or during the diagnostic sequence after a start command. After the Short-Circuit test described below, the drive fires each device, and verifies that the feedback from that device went low. If the feedback does not go low, the drive assumes the SCR must be Open-Circuited.
Complete a resistance check on the rectifier, including the gate-cathode resistance, the snubber and sharing resistors Complete a firing check on the rectifier Verify the snubber circuitry, and the sharing resistors Verify fiber optic integrity from FOI board transmitter to SCRGD board receiver Replace all faulty components
Troubleshooting 7-29 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
For SCR rectifiers, this fault will occur after the initial contact closure, or during the diagnostic sequence after a start command. This is the first test on the rectifier. When all devices blocking, the feedback from the devices should toggle from open to short to open every time the line voltage sine wave passes through zero. If this is consistently showing short (no feedback), then the drive assumes that the device is Short-Circuited.
Complete a resistance check on the rectifier, including the gate-cathode resistance, the snubber and sharing resistors Complete a firing check on the rectifier Verify the snubber circuitry, and the sharing resistors Verify fiber optic integrity from SCRGD board transmitter to FOI board receiver Replace all faulty components
7-30 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
For SCR rectifiers, this fault will occur during operation. After a firing signal is sent to a device, the drive monitors the feedback status to ensure the voltage drops to zero across that device, indicating it has been turned on. If the feedback does not drop to zero before approximately 30-50 sec, the drive will assume the device is open and a fault will occur. There is a 6 cycle fixed delay, which means that this has to occur for 6 consecutive firings before the fault is instigated.
Complete a resistance check on the rectifier, including the gate-cathode resistance, the snubber and sharing resistors Complete a firing check on the rectifier Verify the snubber circuitry, and the sharing resistors Verify fiber optic integrity from FOI board transmitter to SCRGD board receiver Replace all faulty components
Troubleshooting 7-31 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
For SCR rectifiers, this fault will occur during operation. Before an individual leg is fired, the drive takes 5 samples of the voltage across that device. This is because the notching on the line could cause individual readings to be low. If they are all low, the device is assumed to be short-circuited and a fault occurs. There is also a parameter called Rectifier Device Diagnostic Delay (P266), which allows you to change the number of consecutive firings to eliminate nuisance faults. It will still check 5 times before each firing, but will now require the condition to exist for the number of consecutive firings set in the Diagnostic Delay parameter for a fault to occur.
For multiple device faults, the risk of a line to line short exists, so tests with MV isolated should be attempted Complete a resistance check on the rectifier, including the gate-cathode resistance, the snubber and sharing resistors Complete a firing check on the rectifier Verify the snubber circuitry, and the sharing resistors Verify fiber optic integrity from SCRGD board transmitter to FOI board receiver Replace all faulty components For nuisance faults, contact the factory about extending the Diagnostic Delay
7-32 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame WARNING MESSAGES
WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS AC/DC#1 DC Fail 95 AC/DC#2 DC Fail 96 AC/DC#3 DC Fail 97 AC/DC#4 DC Fail 98 AC/DC#5 DC Fail 99 AC/DC#6 DC Fail 100 The output of the specified AC/DC Power Supply has seen the 56VDC output voltage drop below the hardwired trip level. The trip level is fixed in hardware as 52VDC 1.7VDC, depending on hardware tolerances. All of the outputs of the optional multiple AC/DC power supplies are individually monitored and displayed separately. THIS WILL ONLY APPEAR IF YOU HAVE A REDUNDANT POWER SUPPLY. Measure the input voltage and verify it is within limits Measure the output voltage and confirm whether the output level indeed falls below the trip level Verify fault detection wiring is per the drawings, and measure the voltage on the trip signals back to the CIB. The 5VDC is supplied from the CIB to the fault circuit, and is pulled low on the power supply when healthy. Verify the internal cooling fan is operational Replace the Power Supply if required AC300 AC Fail 103 The AC Fail signal from the 300W AC/DC power supplies has been activated. This is treated as a warning since a real loss of this input voltage will result in a subsequent DC fail signal. This happens at 85VAC. Investigate possibility of loss of input voltage to the AC/DC Power Supply Verify output voltage Check alarm signal connections Replace Power Supply if necessary. AC/DC PS AC Fail 102 The AC Fail signal from the 1500W AC/DC power supplies has been activated. We treat this as a warning since a real loss of this input voltage will result in a subsequent DC fail signal. This will occur at 127VAC L- L for 3-phase supplies, and 90VAC for single-phase supplies. Investigate possibility of loss of input voltage to the AC/DC Power Supply Verify output voltage Check alarm signal connections Replace Power Supply if necessary. Adapter 1 Loss 175 Adapter 2 Loss 176 Adapter 3 Loss 177 Adapter 4 Loss 178 Adapter 5 Loss 179 Adapter 6 Loss 180 There has been a loss of communication between the CIB and the identified SCANport Adapter (Polled Communication). This will appear as a warning in the drive when the associated bits in Adapter Loss Mask (P175) are set to a 0. Ensure that the SCANport device is powered Verify the SCANport light status and ensure the device is operating properly Verify the customer SCANport network is properly communicated with the device Check CIB LED status Cycle control power to the drive Change the adapter if all attempts to restore communication fail Troubleshooting 7-33 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Air Filter 29 The Pressure drop at the input to the converter section sensed by the pressure transducer (as a voltage) has dropped below the value set in Pressure Value Alarm (P320). This is dependent on the operation of the Main Cooling Fan. Verify fan rotation Check for blocked airflow in the filters/ heatsinks/ ducting (if installed) Clean as required Improper Alarm settings Verify Pressure Value voltage level when running with clear air flow, and compare to expected values for that specific drive type Verify Alarm and Trip set-up procedure was completed adequately and adjust as necessary Verify for drives with external ducting that there is sufficient air to the drive input Verify supply voltage to differential pressure transducer, and confirm output is stable Autotune TimeLmt 53 Indicates that the autotune test could not measure the parameter in the allotted time. REFER TO THE POWERFLEX 7000 SERIES B MANUAL (CHAPTER 4 COMMISSIONING) ON AUTOTUNE PROCEDURES, RESULTS, AND ACTIONS Auxiliary Protn 71 Standard External Fault/Warning Input included to allow the end-user to install a protective relay/system status contact that can activate a drive fault or warning, depending on configuration of Aux Prot Class (P445) See associated Fault Description Bus Transient 123 The drive has detected a transient of rapid loss of line, and has placed both bridges in freewheel mode until event clears. Check system for capacitive switching events Contact factory for detailed actions Buss Fault Line 200 DEVELOPMENT ERROR NOT ACTIVE Buss Fault Motor 194 DEVELOPMENT ERROR NOT ACTIVE Buss Flt Ext Mem 162 DEVELOPMENT ERROR NOT ACTIVE Buss Flt FPGA 161 DEVELOPMENT ERROR NOT ACTIVE Bypass OV 184 The measured Line-Side Bypass Voltage has exceeded Line Overvoltage Trip (P165) for the duration set in Line Overvoltage Delay (P166). Verify the parameters are set properly Check for possible line voltage transients Verify VSB connections and tap settings, resistor values, and grounds If voltage is too high, change tap settings on the input source to lower voltage to an acceptable level Bypass Rvs Rotn 187 The phase sequence on the voltage measured on the primary side of the Bypass Contactor is not the same as the phase sequence on the output of the drive. The drive will not allow a synchronous transfer unless the phasing is the same Confirm the phase sequences and swap cables if necessary 7-34 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Bypass UV 185 The measured Line-Side Bypass Voltage is less than Line Undervoltage Trip (P167) for the period set by Line Undervoltage Delay (P166). Verify the VSB connections and tap settings, and check resistance of VSB board Megger board to confirm integrity Check for possible source voltage supply problems Use Multimeter and Oscilloscope to check voltages on the drive test points Bypass Volt UB 186 The measured Line-Side Bypass Voltage has exceeded the value set in Line Voltage Unbalance Trip (P271) for the duration set in Line Voltage Unbalance Delay (P272). Verify the VSB connections and tap settings, and check resistance of VSB board Megger board to confirm integrity Check for possible source voltage supply problems Use Multimeter and Oscilloscope to check voltages on the drive voltage test points CIB Battery Low 159 The battery on the CIB that powers the NVRAM has reached a preset low level of 2.6VDC. Replace the PowerCap on the CIB board Conductivity Hi (C-FRAME ONLY)
147 The measured conductivity is greater than 1 S/cm 3 . Verify that no foreign debris has entered the system (iron piping, non-deionized water, etc.) There is no immediate need for action, but be prepared to change the de-ionizing cartridge and run the system, verifying that the conductivity is decreasing Coolant Level Lo (C-FRAME ONLY)
148 The level of the coolant in the reservoir has dropped below the low level warning indicator, activating the warning. You will lose coolant over time through evaporation, but you should still verify that there are no slow leaks in the system Add de-ionized water to the system since this is what normally evaporates, and check the coolant mixture with a glycol tester Coolant Temp Low (C-FRAME ONLY)
145 The measured coolant temperature has dropped below 10C (50F). The warning will not clear until the temperature rises above 15C (58F). Verify that the thermostatic bypass valve (V10) was not left open Warm up the control room ambient to get the drive to an operational level Coolant Temp Hi (C-FRAME ONLY)
146 The measured coolant temperature has exceeded 48C (120F). The warning can not be cleared until the temperature has dropped below 44C (110F). Verify the heat exchanger fans are operating Verify that the thermostatic valve is fully opened Check that all valves are in the normal operating position Ctrl Power Loss 191 This warning tells the drive that the control power has dipped, and this is used in the Autorestart feature algorithm as an indicator to tell the drive to stop gating and wait for control power to return Investigate reliability of the control power Ensure the drive operates as expected when there is a control power outage (UPS must be installed) Troubleshooting 7-35 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS DI Contctr Fdbk 118 This warning indicates that the drive has sensed MV on the front end, but there is no input contactor status coming back to the drive Verify the contactor is closed Confirm the feedback path from the contactor to the XIO Replace XIO if required DI Contctr Open 18 The input contactor has been commanded to close and the contactor closed feedback has not been detected. DI Contctr Clsd 19 The input contactor has been commanded to open and the contactor open feedback has not been detected. DO Contctr Open 20 The output contactor has been commanded to close and the contactor closed feedback has not been detected. DO Contctr Clsd 21 The output contactor has been commanded to open and the contactor open feedback has not been detected. OP Contctr Open 46 The system output contactor has been commanded to close and the contactor closed feedback has not been detected. OP Contctr Clsd 47 The system output contactor has been commanded to open and the contactor open feedback has not been detected. BP Contctr Open 37 The bypass contactor has been commanded to close and the contactor closed feedback has not been detected. BP Contctr Clsd 38 The bypass contactor has been commanded to open and the contactor open feedback has not been detected. Ensure the associated starter unit is set to Normal mode Verify the feedback from the contactor status (normally control relay auxiliary and contactor mechanical auxiliary) is wired properly and powered Verify that there is control power to the contactor Verify the associated SCB I/O Verify that the Holding Coil or Closing Coil is not shorted Review Contactor control wiring These warnings may also occur during the autorestart feature, as the loss of power may also result in the inability to hold in the contactor during the outage 7-36 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS DI IsoSw Open 42 The Drive Input Isolation Switch is Open when it is expected to be closed, which is in Normal mode, DC Current test mode, Open Loop test mode, and Open Circuit test mode, DI IsoSw Clsd 324 The Drive Input Isolation Switch is Closed when it is expected to be open, which is in System Test mode and Gating Test mode. DO IsoSw Open 43 The Drive Output Isolation Switch is Open when it is expected to be closed, which is in Normal mode, DC Current test mode, and Open Loop test mode. DO IsoSw Clsd 325 The Drive Output Isolation Switch is Closed when it is expected to be open, which is in Open Circuit mode, System Test mode and Gating Test mode OP IsoSw Open 45 The System Output Isolation Switch is Open when it is expected to be closed, which is in Normal mode, DC Current test mode, and Open Loop test mode. OP IsoSw Clsd 326 The System Output Isolation Switch is Closed when it is expected to be open, which is in Open Circuit mode, System Test mode and Gating Test mode BP IsoSw Open 44 The Bypass Isolation Switch is Open when it is expected to be closed, which is in Normal mode, DC Current test mode, and Open Loop test mode. BP IsoSw Clsd 327 The Bypass Isolation Switch is Closed when it is expected to be open, which is in Open Circuit mode, System Test mode and Gating Test mode In DC Current test modes, the isolation switches are expected to be closed for DC Current test; although only the input contactor is required the test will run with warnings if the switches are open Ensure the isolation switches are in the proper position for the specific operating mode (Refer to the description of the Parameter 192 IsolSw /Ctctr Cfg in the parameters manual) Verify wiring feedback Verify isolation switch mechanical auxiliary setup DC/DC Redundant 101 The main outputs of the DC/DC power supply (+5VDC, 15VDC) have failed, but the redundant outputs are still active. This is set at 95% of rated value for 15VDC outputs, and 5.00VDC for 5.3VDC output. Redundant Supply is paralleled, so there is no way to confirm output voltage level Verify the output from the alarm signal is wired correctly Replace Power Supply when possible DC Link OT 67 The thermal switch in the drive DC Link Reactor has detected an over-temperature and has opened, but was set up as a warning.. There is a thermal switch in each DC Link winding, and they are connected in series. See associated Fault Description DC Link OC 115 The measured IDC Link Feedback (P322) has exceeded DC Overcurrent Trip (P169), and instantaneously causes a warning. See associated Fault Description Troubleshooting 7-37 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS DC Link Range 126 The value entered for the parameter Link Inductance (P27) is below a minimum value for the programmed Drive/Motor ratings. 6P Rectifier 0.85 pu 18P Rectifier 0.42 pu PWM Rectifier 0.55 pu Review DC Link nameplate data Review Motor and Drive nameplate data and verify that all parameters were entered properly Contact factory if the above seems OK DcLnd Mstr 342 Slave Declined Master-slave only Slave has lost communication with hub PLC, or slave is masked off in parameter Master Mask DCBL Battery Low 125 The PowerCap on the DCB-L that powers the NVRAM where the parameters are stored is below 2.6 V DC. Replace the PowerCap after recording all the parameters to the terminal, through Hyperterminal, with a printer or with DriveTools Reinstall the parameters DCBM Battery Low 188 The PowerCap on the DCB-M is below 2.6 V DC.. This is not critical unless you ever put this board in the rectifier position Replace the PowerCap Desync Delay On 48 A transfer from the Line back to Drive (desync) has been commanded, but it has been less than 1 minute since the transfer from Drive to Line (sync) was completed. As a result, the Output Motor Filter Capacitors have not had time to adequately discharge. Wait for 1 minute and attempt the desync transfer again. DPI Power Loss 109 The 12VDC used for SCANport/DPI communications has dropped below the set trip level. Verify DC/DC power supply output Confirm wiring to the CIB from the DC/DC Power Supply DPI Ram Overflow 163 DEVELOPMENT ERROR There is an internal communication error in the drive control Noise/Grounding Issues Confirm grounding is per the RA drawings Contact the Factory Drive OL 111 A Line Overload warning has been detected, where the overload condition is calculated using DC Current Feedback (P322) and Line Overload Warning (P270) as the point where the overload warning occurs. (P270) is programmed as a percentage of the difference between Line Overload Minimum (P269)and Line Overload Trip (P163). Transient Loading Check torque limit and overload settings and Compare loading to torque settings and trip settings
Drv in Test Mode 50 The drive Operating Mode (P4) is set to DC Current Test Mode when an Autotune Test that turns the motor is initiated
Place drive back in Normal Mode before attempting Autotune Duplcte Mstr 341 Duplicate Master-master only The Powerup Config parameter is set to Master in more than one drive. The first drive to power up will become the master 7-38 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS External 1-16 1-16 These are the optional additional External Faults available when there is an additional XIO board installed. This is configured with XIO Ext Faults (P593), and this message will appear if the specific input (1-16) is configured in Fault Config as a Warning. See associated Fault Description Fan On 30 The drive control is receiving a hardwired fan feedback even though the fan has not been commanded to run. Check Fan feedback wiring and confirm with ED Fan 1 Loss 31 Drives with a Redundant Fan (P141) will give this warning if Fan 1 is running, there were no problems with Fan 2, and Fan 1 is lost. Fan 2 will start and the drive will continue running. Investigate the cause of the Fan 1 loss (OL / damaged relay) Verify Fan 2 is operating with the proper current levels At the next possible shutdown, reset the warnings and Fan 1 can be run again Fan 2 Loss 32 Drives with a Redundant Fan (P141) will give this warning if Fan 2 is running, there were no problems with Fan 1, and Fan 2 is lost. Fan 1 will start and the drive will continue running. Investigate the cause of the Fan 2 loss (OL / damaged relay) Verify Fan 1 is operating with the proper current levels At the next possible shutdown, reset the warnings and Fan 2 can be run again Fan1 ContctrOpen 22 When the drive is running, the feedback from the Fan 1 Contactor auxiliary and Isolation Switch is lost, but the drive will not trip and wait for Power Supply faults or Air Pressure faults to fault the drive. Fan2 ContctrOpen 199 When the drive is running, the feedback from the Fan 2 Contactor auxiliary and Isolation Switch is lost, but the drive will not trip and wait for Power Supply faults or Air Pressure faults to fault the drive. If the drive faults, investigate problems with the fan contactors or the fan overloads If the drive is still running with this warning, there is a problem with the Fan Isolation Switch auxiliary Gate Test Pwr On 119 The gating harness is plugged into the DC/DC power supply, and the drive has detected some current flow This will occur whenever attempting a gating test If there is no gating harness installed, replace the DC/DC power supply Gnrl IO Config 127 The XIO card which was being assigned to the General I/O is not a card which can be used for this purpose. Select the proper slot containing the XIO card which is compatible for General I/O usage using XIO General Input/Output (P592) Gnrl IO Conflict 128 The XIO card previously being used for General I/O has been reassigned for another purpose. Check the configuration of all XIO slots using XIO General Input/Output (P592) and XIO External Faults (P593), and reassign if necessary. Ground Differ 160 This represents an excessive difference between the Analog and the Digital grounds, measured on the CIB Board This could be a problem with the grounding in the drive system Verify grounds are per the drawings Replace CIB to eliminate board as a problem Contact Factory if problem persists Troubleshooting 7-39 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS HeatExchnger Fan (C-FRAME ONLY)
144 The drive has detected a problem from the Liquid-to-Air heat exchanger fans. Verify the Fan O/L settings and conditions Verify the Fan Control Relay status and auxiliary contact signals. Hub Comm Wrn 340 Hub (PLC) Communication Loss Check ControlNet adapter and cable Inertia High 54 Indicates that the Autotune Inertia (P223) was measured higher than 5.0 seconds. REFER TO THE POWERFLEX 7000 SERIES B MANUAL (CHAPTER 4 COMMISSIONING) ON AUTOTUNE PROCEDURES, RESULTS, AND ACTIONS Input Close Dly 39 For PWM drives, this warning indicates that a start command has been given, but the drive is still waiting for the DC voltage to discharge from the line filter capacitors. This can be observed by the status Discharging, on the main screen. This time can be based on the capacitor properties, or Parameter 583 Input Contactor Close Delay (whichever is longer) Wait for the drive Ready status to appear, allowing you to start the drive Verify the time in Parameter 583 is not too long Input Protn #1 65 Standard External Fault/Warning Input included to allow the end-user to install a protective relay (IE Input Feed Protection Relay) auxiliary contact that can activate a drive fault or warning, depending on configuration of InputProt1 Class (P440). See associated Fault Description Input Protn #2 70 Standard External Fault/Warning Input included to allow the end-user to install a second protective relay (IE Input Feed Protection Relay) auxiliary contact that can activate a drive fault or warning, depending on configuration of InputProt2 Class (P445). See associated Fault Description Input Xfmr/LR OT 66 The temperature switch in the drive Input Isolation Transformer or Line Reactor has detected an over-temperature and opened. There is a thermal switch in each phase winding, and they are connected in series. See associated Fault Description Inv Heatsink FO 197 While Running, the Fiber Optic signal from the TFB on the Inverter Heatsink, connected to Channel A fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-M-A is not present. This is only a fault while not running. If this occurs while running it will appear as a warning. Inv ChannelB FO 198 Not Normally Used: While Running, the Fiber Optic signal from the optional TFB connected to Channel B fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-M-B is not present. This is only a fault while not running. If this occurs while running it will appear as a warning. Check TFB and FOI board for power Check the Fiber Optic cables are properly seated in the transmitters and receivers Check the fiber optic cable for kinks, bends, breaks that could be blocking the signal This can occur if the sensor is not connected to the TFB
NOTE: This is a warning because the drive should not fault on the loss of the signal while running. There is no imminent danger to the drive, but the user needs to be aware that there is a temperature feedback signal missing. 7-40 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Inv Heatsink OT 24 The temperature detection on the Inverter Heatsink, connected to Channel A fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-M-A, has exceeded Inverter Heatsink Temperature Warning (P316). Confirm actual temperature in parameters is not higher than the warning value If so, investigate the conditions of the drive (ambient / loading/ elevation / ventilation/ filter status / heatsink clogging) Check the sensor and temperature offline (ambient) for accuracy Inv ChannelB OT 25 Not Normally Used The temperature detection on an Inverter Heatsink, connected to fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-M-B, has exceeded Inverter Temperature Warning Channel B (P571).
Inv HS Sensor 195 While Running, the drive has detected a missing temperature sensor connected to the TFB on the inverter heatsink. A missing sensor can result in either a Fiber Optic Loss fault or a Sensor fault because a missing sensor can be interpreted as either 0C or over 100C, and both are unrealistic values. Inv ChB Sensor 196 Not normally used: While Running, the drive has detected a missing temperature sensor connected to the optional TFB connected to the fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-M-B. A missing sensor can result in either a Fiber Optic Loss fault or a Sensor fault because a missing sensor can be interpreted as either 0C or over 100C, and both are unrealistic values. Verify sensor is completely seated properly on TFB. Measure sensor resistance. Replace if necessary.
NOTE: This is a warning because the drive should not fault on the loss of the signal while running. There is no imminent danger to the drive, but the user needs to be aware that there is a temperature feedback signal missing.
Inv Gate pwr 333 Inverter Gate driver power supply warning The device feedback was not right due to the power loss in the gate driver board. This may not 20VDc PS problem to SGCT but it can be on PS problem on gate driver card. Invalid Alrm Bit 89 DEVELOPMENT ERROR - An unused bit in the first 16 bits in either a fault or warning word has been set and detected by the Alarm Queue server. Either a used bit has been overlooked in the Faults/Warnings database, or the control is incorrectly setting an alarm word. Contact the factory Invalid DIM 90 The drive tried to access the DIM, but either encountered a problem with the checksum on the DIM, or the DIM was not installed This fault may occur on drives upgrading major revisions of firmware (i.e. 2.xxx to 3.xxx), with the older DIM installed, or if the DIM has a failure Remove the DIM Invld Mstr R 344 Invalid Master request-slave only Drive tried to become master when another master was already active Iso Fn1 Cntr 329 Isolation Transformer Fan 1 contactor Isolation transformer Fan 1 status is NOT HIGH while the drive asked the contactor to be closed. Troubleshooting 7-41 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Iso Fn2 Cntr 330 Isolation Transformer Fan 2 contactor Isolation transformer Fan 2 status is NOT HIGH while the drive asked the contactor to be closed Iso Fn1 Loss 331 Isolation Transformer Fan 1 Loss Drive looks for Fan 1 status or air pressure. If any of this lost the drive give this warning. Iso Fn2 Loss 332 Isolation Transformer Fan 2 Loss Drive looks for Fan 2 status or air pressure. If any of this lost the drive give this warning. IsoTx Air Filter (A-Frame Only) 26 The Pressure sensed by the pressure transducer in the integral Isolation Transformer section (as a voltage) has dropped below the value set in Pressure Value Transformer Warning (P655). Verify fan rotation Blocked airflow in the filters / ducting (if installed) Clean as required Improper Warning settings Verify Pressure Value voltage level when running with clear air flow Verify Alarm and Trip set-up procedure was completed adequately and adjust as necessary Verify for drives with external ducting that there is sufficient air to the drive input Verify supply voltage to pressure transducer, and confirm output is stable IxoTx Fan On 328 Isolation Transformer Fan ON warning Isolation transformer Fan status is high while it should be low. L Comm Low 55 Indicates that the Autotune Lc (P217) measured was less than 0.02 pu and the L Commutation (P140) will have to be tuned manually. L Comm High 56 Indicates that the Autotune Lc (P217) measured was greater than 0.15 pu and the L Commutation (P140) will have to be tuned manually. REFER TO THE POWERFLEX 7000 SERIES B MANUAL (CHAPTER 4 COMMISSIONING) ON AUTOTUNE PROCEDURES, RESULTS, AND ACTIONS L Leakage Low 59 Indicates that the Autotune Ls (P220) measured was less than 0.15 pu. L Leakage High 60 Indicates that the Autotune Ls (P220) measured was greater than 0.30 pu. L Magnetize Low 61 Indicates that the Autotune L mag (P221) measured was less than 2.00 pu, and L magnetizing (P131) will have to be tuned manually. L Magnetize High 62 Indicates that the Autotune L mag (P221) measured was greater than 10.00 pu, and L magnetizing (P131) will have to be tuned manually. REFER TO THE POWERFLEX 7000 SERIES B MANUAL (CHAPTER 4 COMMISSIONING) ON AUTOTUNE PROCEDURES, RESULTS, AND ACTIONS Line Cap Range 124 In PWM rectifier drives, the calculated per unit value of the Line Filter Capacitor (P133), based on the values entered for Line Capacitor kVAR (P15), Line Capacitor Volts (P16), and Line Capacitor Frequency (P32) is outside of the normal range of 0.35- 0.55pu. Verify capacitor nameplate data and compare with information entered in drive 7-42 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Line DC Link OV 116 The measured Line DC voltage has exceeded Line DC Overvoltage Trip (P173), and instantaneously causes a warning. See associated Fault Description Line Loss 120 The drive has detected a loss of input voltage from losing the frequency (PLL) lock on the input voltage. This is designed to be a faster method of detecting an undervoltage. The drive responds to this warning as it does to a Master UV warning. Verify the VSB connections and tap settings, and check resistance of VSB board Megger board to confirm integrity Check TSN fusing Check actual voltage values on the Terminal for each bridge and the total line voltage Check for possible source voltage supply problems Liq IO Config (C-Frame Only)
131 The XIO card which was being assigned to the Liquid Cooling System Faults Input is not a card which can be used for this purpose Select the proper slot containing the XIO card which is compatible for Liquid Cooling System Faults usage. Liq IO Conflict (C-Frame Only)
132 The XIO card previously being used for Liquid Cooling System Faults has been reassigned for another purpose. Check the configuration of all XIO slots and reassign if necessary. Logx IO Config 133 The XIO card which was being assigned to Logix IO (basic PLC functionality) is not a card which can be used for this purpose Select the proper slot containing the XIO card which is compatible for Logix IO usage. Logx IO Conflict 134 The XIO card previously being used for Logix IO (basic PLC functionality) has been reassigned for another purpose. Check the configuration of all XIO slots and reassign if necessary. Master UV 112 The measured value V Master Average (P136) is less than Line Undervoltage Trip (P167) with respect to 1/3 Rated Line Voltage (P18) [for 18-pulse drives], and Rated Line Voltage (P18) [for 6-pulse and PWM drives] for the period set by Line Undervoltage Delay (P168). Verify the VSB connections and tap settings, and check resistance of VSB board Megger board to confirm integrity Check TSN fusing Check actual voltage values on the Terminal for each bridge and the total line voltage Check for possible source voltage supply problems Use Multimeter and Oscilloscope to check voltages on the drive test points Motor Cap Range 23 The calculated per unit value of the Motor Filter Capacitor (P128), based on the values entered for Motor Capacitor kVAR (P20), Motor Capacitor Volts (P21), and Motor Capacitor Frequency (P28) is outside of the normal range of 0.26-0.55 pu. Verify capacitor nameplate data and compare with information entered in drive Contact factory Troubleshooting 7-43 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Motor DC Link OV 192 DC Link Voltage on the motor side, measured through the Voltage Sensing Board, has exceeded Motor DC Overvoltage Trip (P193), and instantaneously causes a warning. Verify the motor is connected and the Output Contactor is not open Verify there is no open SGCTs Complete a Resistance and Firing check Check VSB circuit (grounds) through to SCB-M Check Burden resistor values Check the trip parameter setting Motor Load Loss 41 The drive has detected a loss of load condition. This is activated as a warning using the parameter Load Loss Detect (P199), and the necessary setpoints are Load Loss Level (P246), Load Loss Delay (P231), and Load Loss Speed (P259). Verify the parameter settings Ensure that the load should not normally be in an unloaded condition
Motor OL 17 A Motor Overload warning has been detected, where the overload condition is calculated using I Stator (P340) and Motor Overload Warning (P351) as the point where the overload warning occurs. P351 is programmed as a percentage of the difference between Motor Overload Min (P350) and Motor Overload Trip (P179). Transient Loading - Check torque limit and overload settings and Compare loading to torque settings and trip settings
Motor OV 193 The measured Motor AC Voltage has exceeded Motor Overvoltage Trip (P181) for the duration set in Motor Overvoltage Delay (P182), but this has occurred with the drive NOT gating (as in a Sync Transfer event) Possible Causes: Noise from contactor closure Self-Excitation Check for flying start/induced motor rotation Motor Protection 68 Standard External Fault/Warning Input included to allow the end-user to install a protective relay (IE Bulletin 825 Motor Protection Relay) auxiliary contact that can activate a drive fault or warning, depending on configuration of Motor Prot Class (P443). See associated Fault Description Mtr Cap OV W 334 Motor Filter Capacitor Over Voltage This warning occurs when drive is not gating. It may be when motor is coasting. This is drive output V [Surface voltage terminology used in ESP application]. The drive gives this warning in an ESP application only. The protection uses P#181 setting but drive calculates the motor filter cap voltage [Surface V] which is different from motor voltage in ESP application. No DO/OP Ctctr 190 This warning is specifically used for Open Circuit Test Mode, which demands that an Output Contactor be specified in IsoSw/Ctctr Cfg (P192). You will get this warning if the No DO/OP Ctctr fault is masked, and you are attempting Open-Circuit Test. If there truly is no Output Contactor in the system, then you can mask the fault. Then there will be a No OP Ctctr warning, and you can continue with the test. ENSURE THE OUTPUT OF THE DRIVE IS TRULY OPEN-CIRCUITED 7-44 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS No PLL Lock
117
The drive has lost synchronization with the incoming line voltage, and has announced a Phase Lock Loop warning.
Capture the voltage waveforms from the SCB-L test points and examine for inconsistency Verify that the drive power system is properly grounded Check for noise on the control power in the drive Check the grounding for all signal and control wiring Verify the Commutation Inductance parameter is valid and retune if required No Tach Installd 36 The drive has sensed that there is no tachometer/encoder connected, but the Speed Feedback Mode (P89) has been set to Pulse Tach. Verify whether there is a tachometer required for the system, and set the parameter Speed Feedback Mode accordingly Investigate the tachometer for damage Verify the wiring from the drive to the tachometer is per the Electrical Drawing Verify the +15VDC supplying the tachometer is not low/missing NVRAM Cleared 87 The parameters stored in the NVRAM of the DCB are corrupt and have been set to default values. This can occur if new firmware has been loaded into the DCB or Power Capacitors are low. Reload parameters from Terminal Memory. DriveTools, Flashcard, or from a hardcopy Replace PowerCap on DCB-L If parameters still can not be saved, replace the DCBs Opt Flt Config 129 The XIO card which was being assigned to the Optional Faults Input is not a card which can be used for this purpose. Select the proper slot containing the XIO card which is compatible for Optional Faults usage. Opt Flt Conflict 130 The XIO card previously being used for Optional Faults has been reassigned for another purpose. Check the configuration of all XIO slots and reassign if necessary. Parameter Range 88 A parameter was read from NVRAM or the DIM, which was outside the valid range. The parameter has been set to a default value. The Linear # of this parameter has been stored in "Parameter Error", under the Feedback grouping. If this was a result of an INIT operation, contact the factory If this was a result of a LOAD operation, correct the parameter value and perform a SAVE operation Check the settings on the DIM to determine whether it is limiting the paramters max or min values. Phantom Alarm 93 DEVELOPMENT ERROR - An unused bit in the last 16 bits in either a fault or warning word has been set and detected by the Alarm Queue server. These bits are never used in firmware. Either a used bit has been overlooked in the Faults/Warnings database, or the control is incorrectly setting an alarm word. Noise/Grounding Issue Contact the factory
Troubleshooting 7-45 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
143 The drive has detected a fault from one of the pumps in the cooling circuit. Verify the Pump O/L settings and conditions Verify the Pump Control Relay status and auxiliary contact signals. Queues Cleared 91 This means that the drive had to clear the fault and warning queues after an upgrade of the firmware This was an issue because the memory structure changed in 3.xxx firmware No action is required R Stator High 52 Autotune Rs (P219) measured during the autotune test was higher than 0.20 pu, indicating the presence of extremely long motor leads. REFER TO THE POWERFLEX 7000 SERIES B MANUAL (CHAPTER 4 COMMISSIONING) ON AUTOTUNE PROCEDURES, RESULTS, AND ACTIONS Ensure motor windings are connected properly. Rec Gate Pwr 205 Rectifier Gate driver power supply warning The device feedback was not right due to the power loss in the gate driver board. This may not only 20VDC PS problem to SGCT but it can also be on PS problem on gate driver card. This warning can come due to device failure or device online diagnostic Rec Heatsink FO 203 While Not Running, the Fiber Optic signal from the TFB on the Rectifier Heatsink, connected to Channel A fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-L-A is not present. This is only a fault while not running. If this occurs while running it will appear as a warning. Rec ChannelB FO 204 Not Normally Used: While Not Running, the Fiber Optic signal from the optional TFB connected to Channel B fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-L-B is not present. This is only a fault while not running. If this occurs while running it will appear as a warning. Check TFB and FOI board for power Check the Fiber Optic cables are properly seated in the transmitters and receivers Check the fiber optic cable for kinks, bends, breaks that could be blocking the signal This can occur if the sensor is not connected to the TFB
NOTE: This is a warning because the drive should not fault on the loss of the signal while running. There is no imminent danger to the drive, but the user needs to be aware that there is a temperature feedback signal missing. Rec Heatsink OT 121 The temperature detection on the Rectifier Heatsink, connected to Channel A fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-L-A, has exceeded Rectifier Heatsink Temperature Warning (P112). Rec ChannelB OT 122 Not Normally Used The temperature detection on a Rectifier Heatsink, connected to fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-L-B, has exceeded Rectifier Temperature Warning Channel B (P526). Confirm actual temperature in parameters is not higher than the warning value If so, investigate the conditions of the drive (ambient / loading / elevation / ventilation/ filter status / heatsink clogging) Check TFB and FOI board for power and fiber optic integrity Check the sensor and temperature offline (ambient) for accuracy 7-46 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Rec HS Sensor 201 While Running, the drive has detected a missing temperature sensor connected to the TFB on the rectifier heatsink. A missing sensor can result in either a Fiber Optic Loss fault or a Sensor fault because a missing sensor can be interpreted as either 0C or over 100C, and both are unrealistic values. Rec ChB Sensor 202 Not normally used: While Running, the drive has detected a missing temperature sensor connected to the optional TFB connected to the fiber optic receiver RX7 on FOI-L-B. A missing sensor can result in either a Fiber Optic Loss fault or a Sensor fault because a missing sensor can be interpreted as either 0C or over 100C, and both are unrealistic values. Verify sensor is completely seated properly on TFB. Measure sensor resistance. Replace if necessary.
NOTE: This is a warning because the drive should not fault on the loss of the signal while running. There is no imminent danger to the drive, but the user needs to be aware that there is a temperature feedback signal missing.
Reg in Limit 51 Either the Speed Regulator or the Flux Regulator autotune test hit the regulator limit and the results of the test are not valid. REFER TO THE POWERFLEX 7000 SERIES B MANUAL (CHAPTER 4 COMMISSIONING) ON AUTOTUNE PROCEDURES, RESULTS, AND ACTIONS Slip Range 189 This warning appears when unusual values for slip appear, indicating there is either an error in data or an unusual motor. The rated slip for this warning has to be > 10%, or < 0.01% Verify Motor Nameplate Data Contact the factory with the motor data and the application information Slave 0-7 OffL 348-355 Slave (0-7) DAN Communication Loss- Master only Slave is Off line. Slave1 UV 113 The measured value V Slave1 Average (P137) is less than Line Undervoltage Trip (P167) as a percentage of 1/3 Rated Line Voltage (P18), for the period set by Line Undervoltage Delay (P168). Slave2 UV 114 The measured value V Slave2 Average (P138) is less than Line Undervoltage Trip (P167) as a percentage of 1/3 Rated Line Voltage (P18), for the period set by Line Undervoltage Delay (P168). Verify the VSB connections and tap settings, and check resistance of VSB board Megger board to confirm integrity Check TSN fusing Check actual voltage values on the Terminal for each bridge and the total line voltage Check for possible source voltage supply problems Use Multimeter and Oscilloscope to check voltages on the drive test points Slv RfsdMstr 343 Slave refused Master-master only Slave has lost communication with hub PLC, or slave is masked off in parameter Master Mask Troubleshooting 7-47 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Speed Cmd Loss 183 The drive has lost communication with the device responsible for providing the speed command to the drive. This has been set to annunciate as a warning. Ensure that the SCANport device is powered Verify the SCANport light status and ensure the device is operating properly Verify the customer SCANport network is properly communicated with the device Check CIB LED status Cycle control power to the drive SpdProfile Limit 92 The sum of the individual ramp times has exceeded the maximum value for Total Acceleration Time Review Ramp settings and adjust accordingly to ensure they do not exceed the Total Acceleration Time Sync Xfer Failed 40 A Synchronous Transfer was not completed in the time specified in Synchronous Transfer Time (P230). This warning will occur if the Sync Transfer fault is masked, and the drive will continue to run at the last Reference Command before a synchronization command was initiated. Verify that the setup for Synchronous Transfer has been completed Verify that the drive can reach synchronous speed Once stability has been verified, the parameters can be altered to reduce restrictions on synchronous transfer T DC Link High 58 Indicates that the Autotune Tdc (P218) measured was greater than 0.100 pu, and the T DC Link (P115) will have to be tuned manually. T DC Link Low 57 Indicates that the Autotune Tdc (P218) measured was less than 0.020 pu, and the T DC Link (P115) will have to be tuned manually. T Rotor Low 63 Indicates that the Autotune T rotor (P222) measured was less than 0.2 sec, and T rotor (P132) will have to be tuned manually. T Rotor High 64 Indicates that the Autotune T rotor (P222) measured was greater than 5.0 sec, and T rotor (P132) will have to be tuned manually. REFER TO THE POWERFLEX 7000 SERIES B MANUAL (CHAPTER 4 COMMISSIONING) ON AUTOTUNE PROCEDURES, RESULTS, AND ACTIONS Tach Loss W 33 The tachometer feedback has varied from the reference command by the value set in Tach Loss Trip(P235) for the duration set in Tach Loss Delay (P236). The drive should annunciate the warning and continue to run on Stator feedback Verify that the parameter Tachometer Feedback (Line or Motor) is/ is not giving the correct feedback while running Investigate the tachometer for damage Scope the tachometer pulses on SCB and verify they are not corrupted by for example dust in the Optic disc of the tach. Verify the wiring from the drive to the tachometer is per the Electrical Drawing Verify the +15VDC supplying the tachometer is not low/missing Tach Power 35 +15VDC from the DC/DC power supply, sensed on the CIB, is less than the 95% alarm level. Check the output of the DC/DC power supply Check the wiring from the power supply to the CIB Verify the tachometer/encoder wiring 7-48 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS Tach Reversed 34 The drive has sensed that the 2 channels (generally A and B) are reversed. Set the parameter Tachometer Select to None and verify the parameter Tachometer Feedback (Line or Motor)shows the reverse speed Reverse the tachometer channels Temp Feedback Ls (C-Frame Only) 152 While Running, the drive has detected a missing temperature feedback. A missing sensor can be interpreted as either 0C or over 100C, and both are unrealistic values. Verify sensor is completely seated properly on TFB. Measure sensor resistance. Replace if necessary.
NOTE: This is a warning because the drive should not fault on the loss of the signal while running. There is no imminent danger to the drive, but the user needs to be aware that there is a temperature feedback signal missing.
Tuning Abort 49 Autotuning was unable to complete the commanded autotune test in a preset time limit of 2 minutes. Investigate why the Autotune Test aborted, and Retry Autotune Test Verify Autotune default parameters are sufficient to complete test Attempt Manual Tuning UPS Battery Low 106 Warning that the UPS Battery is low. This is not very useful as the UPS battery low occurs at the point where the UPS can no longer run and a fault is initiated. UPS Failed 107 The UPS has had an internal failure. This is a warning because we do not want a signal/wiring error to fault the drive. We are relying on the subsequent power supply faults to protect the drive. Investigate the cause for the UPS failure Check batteries Verify input voltage/UPS wiring Refer to UPS manual Replace UPS if required UPS on Battery 105 Warning that the UPS is now on battery power Check for the reason that the UPS was required, and rectify the situation before the battery power expires UPS on Bypass 104 Warning that the UPS is now on Bypass. This occurs when the drive has switched to UPS, but a UPS fault has forced the system to switch to Bypass, if available. Investigate cause for initial transfer to UPS, and correct. Then investigate why the UPS failed and was forced to go to bypass USART Power Loss 110 Warning that USART voltage detected on the CIB is low. Check all DC/DC voltages test points on CIB (+5V, +15V, +3.3V) Replace DC/DC PS or CIB as required. Xfer Disable 345 Transfer Disabled-master only Transfer of master not allowed while drive is stopping Troubleshooting 7-49 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS XIO Card #1-6 Loss 81-86 An XIO card has dropped off the communications link between the XIO cards and the CIB. Reset the board in an attempt to re- establish communications. Check all connections between the Customer Interface Board and the jumpers between individual adapters Verify the status of all XIO adapters by comparing the LED status to the table in the manual. XIO Power Loss 108 The 24V to the XIO boards has dropped below the set trip level, which is 95% of rated voltage. Verify DC/DC power supply output Confirm wiring to the CIB from the DC/DC Power Supply Check XIO LED status and compare to values in the manual Zero Slip 28 The value for Rated Motor RPM (P26) is the same as speed calculated from Motor Poles (P99) and Rated Motor Frequency (P29). Verify Rated Motor RPM is less than synchronous speed 7-50 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
INVERTER SGCT WARNING FOR REDUNDANT DEVICES or N-1 CAPABILITY ONLY
This warning will only occur during the initial contactor closure and the diagnostic sequence after a start command. The inverter monitors the state of the feedback before a gate pulse is given, and monitors the feedback after a gate pulse has been sent. The SGCT has smart diagnostics, so the feedback may indicate short before firing, and if the pulse is received and the device is really shorted, the diagnostic will toggle the feedback to let you know the problem is with the device, or the power supply for that device.
The firmware now completes a diagnostics sequence immediately after any drive reset, with the goal of detecting problems before any destructive action is taken from the next action Complete a resistance check per the instructions in the manual NOTE: SGCTs may not have completely shorted, and still could read in the k range Any devices with low suspect readings should be changed in matched sets during the next outage Check the LED status of the SCGT gate driver card for abnormal readings Complete a Gating Test mode check on the devices Verify the associated 20V power supply is powered and active Verify all the power connections to the SCGT firing card are seated properly
NOTE: For Redundant devices, there will be no change in the drive operation. For N-1 drives, the drive will attempt to run at a load/speed combination that does not exceed the voltage rating of the remaining devices. U1A Online Wrn 216 U1B Online Wrn 222 U1C Online Wrn 240 U4A Online Wrn 219 U4B Online Wrn 225 U4C Online Wrn 243 V3A Online Wrn 218 V3B Online Wrn 224 V3C Online Wrn 242 V6A Online Wrn 221 V6B Online Wrn 227 V6C Online Wrn 245 W2A Online Wrn 217 W2B Online Wrn 223 W2C Online Wrn 241 W5A Online Wrn 220 W5B Online Wrn 226 W5C Online Wrn 244
INVERTER SGCT WARNING FOR REDUNDANT DEVICES or N-1 CAPABILITY ONLY
This warning will occur during operation of the drive. The drive has detected that the feedback from the device was not correct, and does not wait to determine the exact problem. The drive polls the entire bridge 3 times before and 3 times after each gating command. All 6 of these readings for each device must be consistent for the warning to occur. There is also a parameter called Inverter Device Diagnostic Delay (P268), which allows you to change the number of consecutive firings to eliminate nuisance faults. It will still poll 3 times before and after each firing, but will now require the condition to exist for the number of consecutive firings set in the Diagnostic Delay parameter for a warning to occur.
The firmware now completes a diagnostics sequence immediately after any drive reset, with the goal of detecting faults before any destructive action is taken from the next action Complete a resistance check per the instructions in the manual NOTE: SGCTs may not have completely shorted, and still could read in the k range Any devices with low suspect readings should be changed Check the LED status of the SCGT gate driver card for abnormal readings Complete a Gating Test mode check on the devices Verify the associated 20V power supply is powered and active Verify all the power connections to the SCGT firing card are seated properly For nuisance faults, contact the factory about extending the Diagnostic Delay
NOTE: For Redundant devices, there will be no change in the drive operation. For N-1 drives, the drive will attempt to run at a load/speed combination that does not exceed the voltage rating of the remaining devices. Troubleshooting 7-51 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
PWM RECTIFIER SGCT WARNING FOR REDUNDANT DEVICE CAPABILITY ONLY
This warning will occur during the initial contactor closure, the diagnostic sequence after a start command, or the diagnostic sequence after a stop command. The rectifier monitors the state of the feedback before a gate pulse is given, and monitors the feedback after a gate pulse has been sent. The SGCT has smart diagnostics, so the feedback may indicate short before firing, and if the pulse is received and the device is really shorted, the diagnostic will toggle the feedback to let you know the problem is with the device, or the power supply for that device.
The firmware now completes a diagnostics sequence immediately after any drive reset, with the goal of detecting warnings before any destructive action is taken from the next action. The main example of this is closing the input contactor on a shorted bridge. Complete a resistance check per the instructions in the manual NOTE: SGCTs may not have completely shorted, and still could read in the k range Any devices with low suspect readings should be changed Check the LED status of the SCGT gate driver card for abnormal readings Complete a Gating Test mode check on the devices Verify the associated 20V power supply is powered and active Verify all the power connections to the SCGT firing card are seated properly
NOTE: There is only the Redundant option available on the Rectifier, and only on 6P drives (SCR orPWM). You can not have N-1 operation on the rectifier since we can not control the line voltage. 2U1A Online Wrn 252 2U1B Online Wrn 258 2U1C Online Wrn 276 2U4A Online Wrn 255 2U4B Online Wrn 261 2U4C Online Wrn 279 2V3A Online Wrn 254 2V3B Online Wrn 260 2V3C Online Wrn 278 2V6A Online Wrn 257 2V6B Online Wrn 263 2V6C Online Wrn 281 2W2A Online Wrn 253 2W2B Online Wrn 259 2W2C Online Wrn 277 2W5A Online Wrn 256 2W5B Online Wrn 262 2W5C Online Wrn 280
PWM RECTIFIER SGCT WARNING FOR REDUNDANT DEVICES CAPABILITY ONLY
This warning will occur during operation of the drive. The drive has detected that the feedback from the device was not correct, and does not wait to determine the exact problem. The drive polls the entire bridge 3 times before and 3 times after each gating command. All 6 of these readings for each device must be consistent for the warning to occur. There is also a parameter called Rectifier Device Diagnostic Delay (P266), which allows you to change the number of consecutive firings to eliminate nuisance warnings. It will still poll 3 times before and after each firing, but will now require the condition to exist for the number of consecutive firings set in the Diagnostic Delay parameter for a warning to occur.
The firmware now completes a diagnostics sequence immediately after any drive reset, with the goal of detecting warnings before any destructive action is taken from the next action Complete a resistance check per the instructions in the manual NOTE: SGCTs may not have completely shorted, and still could read in the k range Any devices with low suspect readings should be changed Check the LED status of the SCGT gate driver card for abnormal readings Complete a Gating Test mode check on the devices Verify the associated 20V power supply is powered and active Verify all the power connections to the SCGT firing card are seated properly Reset the drive and let the offline diagnostics further define the problem For nuisance faults, contact the factory about extending the Diagnostic Delay
NOTE: There is only the Redundant option available on the Rectifier, and only on 6P drives (SCR orPWM). You can not have N-1 operation on the rectifier since we can not control the line voltage. 7-52 Troubleshooting 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame WARNING MESSAGE WARNING CODE DESCRIPTION RECOMMENDED ACTIONS 2U1A Offline SC 300 2U1B Offline SC 306 2U1C Offline SC 318 2U4A Offline SC 303 2U4B Offline SC 309 2U4C Offline SC 321 2V3A Offline SC 302 2V3B Offline SC 308 2V3C Offline SC 320 2V6A Offline SC 305 2V6B Offline SC 311 2V6C Offline SC 323 2W2A Offline SC 301 2W2B Offline SC 307 2W2C Offline SC 319 2W5A Offline SC 304 2W5B Offline SC 310 2W5C Offline SC 322
6P SCR RECTIFIER WARNING (Offline Short-Circuit) FOR REDUNDANT DEVICE CAPABILITY ONLY
For SCR rectifiers, this warning will occur after the initial contact closure, or during the diagnostic sequence after a start command. This is the first test on the rectifier. When all devices blocking, the feedback from the devices should toggle from open to short to open every time the line voltage sine wave passes through zero. If this is consistently showing short (no feedback), then the drive assumes that the device is Short-Circuited.
Complete a resistance check on the rectifier, including the gate-cathode resistance, the snubber and sharing resistors Complete a firing check on the rectifier Verify the snubber circuitry, and the sharing resistors Verify fiber optic integrity from SCRGD board transmitter to FOI board receiver Replace all faulty components
NOTE: There is only the Redundant option available on the Rectifier, and only on 6P drives (SCR orPWM). You can not have N-1 operation on the rectifier since we can not control the line voltage.
6P SCR RECTIFIER WARNING (Online Short-Circuit) FOR REDUNDANT DEVICE CAPABILITY ONLY
For SCR rectifiers, this warning will occur during operation. Before an individual leg is fired, the drive takes 5 samples of the voltage across that device. This is because the notching on the line could cause individual readings to be low. If they are all low, the device is assumed to be short- circuited and a warning occurs. There is also a parameter called Rectifier Device Diagnostic Delay (P266), which allows you to change the number of consecutive firings to eliminate nuisance warnings. It will still check 5 times before each firing, but will now require the condition to exist for the number of consecutive firings set in the Diagnostic Delay parameter for a warning to occur.
For multiple device faults, the risk of a line to line short exists, so tests with MV isolated should be attempted Complete a resistance check on the rectifier, including the gate-cathode resistance, the snubber and sharing resistors Complete a firing check on the rectifier Verify the snubber circuitry, and the sharing resistors Verify fiber optic integrity from SCRGD board transmitter to FOI board receiver Replace all faulty components For nuisance faults, contact the factory about extending the Diagnostic Delay
NOTE: There is only the Redundant option available on the Rectifier, and only on 6P drives (SCR orPWM). You can not have N-1 operation on the rectifier since we can not control the line voltage.
Appendix A
7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Catalog Number Explanation for PowerFlex 7000 MV Drives
7000 - A105 D EHD - R18TX - 1 1DD 3LL 760A
First Position Second Position Third Position Fourth Position Fifth Position Sixth Position
Bulletin Number
(Refer to TABLE A-1)
Service Duty / Continuous Current Rating / Altitude Rating Code
(Refer to TABLE A-2)
Enclosure Type
D = NEMA Type 1 w/gaskets and vents (IEC IP42)
Nominal Line Voltage Control Voltage System Frequency
(Reference TABLE A-3)
Rectifier Type Code
R6TX R6LR R18TX RPLR RPTX RPDTD
Options
R6TX 6-pulse rectifier for connection to remote transformer R6LR 6-pulse rectifier with integral line reactor R18TX 18-pulse rectifier for connection to remote transformer RPLR PWM rectifier with integral line reactor RPTX PWM rectifier for connection to remote transformer RPDTD Direct-to-Drive Technology
Table A-1 Catalog Number Descriptions Catalog Number Description 7000A PowerFlex 7000 A Frame Variable Frequency AC Drive, Air-cooled 7000 PowerFlex 7000 B Frame Variable Frequency AC Drive, Air-cooled 7000L PowerFlex 7000 C Frame Variable Frequency AC Drive, Liquid-cooled
A-2 Catalog Number Explanation Drive Selection 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame Table A-2 Service Duty Rating, Continuous Current Rating and Altitude Rating Code Continuous Current Capability Service Duty Rating and Altitude Rating Code Code Rating 40 40 Amp 46 46 Amp 53 53 Amp 61 61 Amp 70 70 Amp 81 81 Amp 93 93 Amp 105 105 Amp 120 120 Amp 140 140 Amp 160 160 Amp 185 185 Amp 215 215 Amp 250 250 Amp 285 285 Amp 325 325 Amp 375 375 Amp 430 430 Amp A = Normal Duty 0-1000 m Altitude (@40C Ambient)
B = Normal Duty 1001-5000 m Altitude (2000 m Altitude @37.5C Ambient) (3000 m Altitude @35.0C Ambient) (4000 m Altitude @32.5C Ambient) (5000 m Altitude @30.0C Ambient)
C = Heavy Duty 0-1000 m Altitude
D = Heavy Duty 1001-5000 m Altitude (2000 m Altitude @37.5C Ambient) (3000 m Altitude @35.0C Ambient) (4000 m Altitude @32.5C Ambient) (5000 m Altitude @30.0C Ambient)
Z = Custom Configuration (Contact Factory)
Table A-3 Nominal Line Voltage, Control Voltage, System Frequency Voltage Nominal Line Control (3 phase) Frequency (Hz) Modification Number (Externally Supplied Control Power) 208 AHD 480 ABD 2400 600 60 ACD 230 CPD 380 CND 3300 400 50 CKD 230 EPD 380 50 END 208 EHD 480 EBD 4160 600 60 ECD 230 JPD 380 JND 6600 400 50 JKD
Catalog Number Explanation Drive Selection A-3
7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
The PowerFlex 7000 medium voltage AC drive selection tables are based on two types of drive service duty ratings:
Normal Duty (110% overload for one (1) Minute, once every 10 minutes) used for Variable Torque (VT) applications only.
Drives with this rating are designed for 100% continuous operation, with 110% overload for one (1) minute, once every 10 minutes.
Heavy Duty (150% for one (1) Minute, once every 10 minutes) used for Constant Torque (CT) or Variable Torque (VT) applications.
Drives with this rating are designed for 100% continuous operation, with 150% overload for one (1) minute, once every 10 minutes.
Service Duty Rating, Continuous Current Rating & Altitude Rating Code
There are five different codes that define service duty and altitude in the drive catalog number per Table A-2.
For example,
Catalog number 7000 A105DEHD-R18TX, has a continuous current rating of 105 amps, with a normal duty service rating up to 1000 meters altitude.
Catalog number 7000 B105DEHD-R18TX has a continuous rating of 105 amps with a normal duty service rating up to 5000 meters altitude. Please note that the ambient temperature rating of the drive is reduced at higher altitudes. If 40C ambient is required at 1001-5000 meters altitude, then a rating code of Z is required.
Catalog number 7000 C105DEHD-R18TX, has a continuous current rating of 105 amps, with a heavy duty service rating up to 1000 meters altitude.
Note: The factory should be contacted for assistance sizing air-cooled drives that require greater than 150% overload. Refer to Table A-5 for typical application load torque profiles, to determine which drive overload rating is best suited for your application.
PowerFlex 7000 Drive Selection Explanation A-4 Catalog Number Explanation Drive Selection 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
A tachometer is required under the following conditions: 1. When speed regulation accuracy must be between 0.01 0.02% of nominal speed. 2. When the zero speed breakaway torque needed is greater than 90% of continuous running torque. 3. When continuous running speed is greater than or equal to 0.1 Hz, but less than 6 Hz. 4. For minimizing restart times using the flying start capability in forward or reverse direction.
Power Flex Speed Regulation Frequency Output Tachometer < 6 Hertz 6 15 Hertz Above 15 Hertz Without Tachometer Not applicable 0.1 % 0.1 % With Tachometer 0.02 % 0.01% 0.01%
Notes: Speed Regulation is based on % of motor synchronous speed. Tachometer to be mounted on the AC machine Operational 15 V DC Power Supply mounted in drive to power the tachometer as a standard option with the tachometer feed back card. Customer is responsible for providing and mounting of tachometer Sleeve bearing motors require the tachometer to have an axial movement tolerance. Recommended tachometers are shaft mounting type. Magneto resistive models are more adaptable to harsh environments. When installing, the tachometer body and electronics must be isolated from ground (options available from the tachometer manufacturer to accomplish this). There are usually limits on tachometer cable lengths. Ensure the maximum length is suitable for the application.
When is a tachometer required? When is a tachometer required? Catalog Number Explanation Drive Selection A-5
7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 The PowerFlex 7000 drives have been tested on a dynamometer to verify performance under locked rotor, accelerating, and low speed- high torque conditions. Table A-5 below shows the PowerFlex 7000 drive torque capabilities as a percent of motor rated torque, independent of the drives momentary overload conditions.
Table A-5 PowerFlex 7000 Drive Torque Capabilities Parameter 7000 Torque Capability Without Tachometer (% of Motor Rated Torque) 7000 Torque Capability With Tachometer (% of Motor Rated Torque) Breakaway Torque 90% 150% 90% ( 0-8 Hertz ) 140% ( 0-8 Hertz ) Accelerating Torque 125% ( 9-75 Hertz ) 140% ( 9-75 Hertz ) 100% ( 1-2 Hertz ) Steady State Torque 125% ( 9-75 Hertz ) ** 140% ( 3-60 Hertz ) ** Maximum Torque Limit 150% 150% ** Drive will require over sizing to achieve greater than 100%continuous torque.
Glossary of Terms
Breakaway Torque: Torque required to start a machine from standstill.
Accelerating Torque: Torque required to accelerate a load to a given speed, in a certain period of time. The following formula may be used to calculate the average torque to accelerate a known inertia (WK 2 ):
T = ( WK 2 change in RPM) / 308t
where, T = acceleration torque in (lb-ft). WK 2 = total system inertia (lb-ft 2 ) that the motor must accelerate, including motor, gear box, and load. t = time (seconds) to accelerate total system load.
Steady State Torque: Continuous operating torque required to control the load, without instability.
Torque Limit: An electronic method of limiting the maximum torque available from the motor.
The software in a drive typically sets the torque limit to 150% of motor rated torque.
B-2 Torque Requirements 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Appendix C 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Drive Logic Command
Drive Logic Command Word Database 2.001 The following is the Logic Command from the output of the Parser. It is a READ only variable in the Drive. Bit Function Value Description Notes 0 Stop Command 0 Stop 1 Start Command (pulsed) 1 Start on Rising Edge only 2 Jog 1 Jog at preset speed 3 Clear Fault Queue 1 Clear Fault Queue 4 Clear Warning Queue 1 Clear Warning Queue 5 Drive Reset 1 Reset All Alarms (Faults and Warnings) 1 Reverse Rotation 6 Direction 0 Forward Rotation. 0 Accel 1 (Default) 7 Start Profile 1 Accel 2 Must be maintained until at Speed. 0 Decel 1 (Default) 8 Stop Profile 1 Decel 2 Must be maintained until Drive stopped. 10,9 Not Used 0 0 No command 0 1 Transfer to Line (Bypass) 1 0 Transfer to Motor 12,11 Synchronization 1 1 Illegal. Ignore this command 13 Force Stop 1 Force a Stop to the Drive DPI Forced on Network Errors 14 Force Fault 1 Force a Class2 Fault in the Drive DPI Forced on Network Errors 15 Not Used C-2 Logic Status Word 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Logic Status Word Database 2.001 The following is the Logic Status word from the Drive. It is common for all SCANport/DPI product specific peripherals. Bit Function Value Description Notes 0 Ready 1 Drive is Ready 1 Running 1 Drive is Running 2 Commanded Direction 1 Drive has been commanded to run forward 0 = Reverse Command 3 Rotating Direction 1 Drive is rotating in the forward direction 0 = Reverse Rotation. 4 Accelerating 1 Drive is accelerating to commanded speed 0 = Drive is at speed 5 Decelerating 1 Drive is decelerating to commanded speed 0 = Drive is at speed or stopped 6 At Speed 1 Drive has reached the commanded speed 7 On Bypass 1 Motor is on bypass 0 = Motor connected to Drive 8 Reverse Disabled 1 The reverse function is disabled. 9 Drive Fault 1 Drive has faulted 10 Drive Warning 1 Drive has encountered a warning 11 Local Lock 1 A DPI or XIO has local control of the drive 12 Forced Stop 1 A DPI adapter or CIB has forced the drive to stop due to internal problems
Logic Status Word C-3 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Product Specific Logic Command Database 2.001
To be used with gateway adapters such as RIO or DeviceNet. Bit Function Value Description Notes 0 Stop 1 Stop Drive using Stop Profile 1 Start (Pulsed) 1 Start Drive on rising edge using Start Profile
2 Jog 1 Jog at default or Preset Speed 3 Clear Faults 1 Clear most recent Fault in Queue 4 Clear Warnings 1 Clear most recent Warning in Queue 5 Clear Queues 1 Clear both Fault and Warning Queues 0 Forward 6 Direction 1 Reverse 7 Disable Reverse 1 Disable Reverse Direction (Maintained) Done in Logic Parser 0 Remote All adapters can control the drive (Full multiplexed control) 8 DPI Local/Remote Profile 1 Local Only the adapter that has been granted permission has control of the Drive (Includes XIO Front Panel Selector Switch) 0 0 No Command 0 1 Transfer to Line 1 0 Transfer to Drive 10,9 Synchronous Transfer 1 1 Illegal 0 Accel 1 (Default) 11 Start Profile 1 Accel 2 Must be maintained until at Speed. 0 Decel 1 (Default) 12 Stop Profile 1 Decel 2 Must be maintained until drive stopped. 0 0 0 No Command 0 0 1 External Ref0 ( Front Panel Pot) 0 1 0 Preset 1 0 1 1 Preset 2 1 0 0 Preset 3 1 0 1 External Ref1 (Programmed Reference) 1 1 0 Manual Reference (Local DPI Adapter) 15,13 Speed Command Select 1 1 1 Not Used
C-4 Logic Status Word 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Drive Logic Command Word Database 3.001 and later The following is the Logic Command from the output of the Parser. It is a READ only variable in the Drive. Bit Function Value Description Notes 0 Stop Command 0 Stop 1 Start Command (pulsed) 1 Start on Rising Edge only 2 Jog 1 Jog at preset speed 3 Clear Fault Queue 1 Clear Fault Queue 4 Clear Warning Queue 1 Clear Warning Queue 5 Drive Reset 1 Reset All Alarms (Faults and Warnings) 1 Reverse Rotation 6 Direction 0 Forward Rotation. 0 Accel 1 (Default) 7 Start Profile 1 Accel 2 Must be maintained until at Speed. 0 Decel 1 (Default) 8 Stop Profile 1 Decel 2 Must be maintained until Drive stopped. 10,9 Not Used 0 0 No command 0 1 Transfer to Line (Bypass) 1 0 Transfer to Motor 12,11 Synchronization 1 1 Illegal. Ignore this command 13 Force Stop 1 Force a Stop to the Drive DPI Forced on Network Errors 14 Force Fault 1 Force a Class2 Fault in the Drive DPI Forced on Network Errors 15 Not Used Logic Status Word C-5 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Logic Status Word Database 3.001 and later The following is the Logic Status word from the Drive. It is common for all SCANport/DPI product specific peripherals. Bit Function Value Description Notes 0 Ready 1 Drive is Ready 1 Running 1 Drive is Running 2 Commanded Direction 1 Drive has been commanded to run forward 0 = Reverse Command 3 Rotating Direction 1 Drive is rotating in the forward direction 0 = Reverse Rotation. 4 Accelerating 1 Drive is accelerating to commanded speed 0 = Drive is at speed 5 Decelerating 1 Drive is decelerating to commanded speed 0 = Drive is at speed or stopped 6 At Speed 1 Drive has reached the commanded speed 7 On Bypass 1 Motor is on bypass 0 = Motor connected to Drive 8 Reverse Enabled 1 The reverse command feature is enabled. Changed in FRN 3.001 from Reverse Disabled 9 Drive Fault 1 Drive has faulted 10 Drive Warning 1 Drive has encountered a warning 11 Local Lock 1 A DPI or XIO has local control of the drive 12 Forced Stop 1 A DPI adapter or CIB has forced the drive to stop due to internal problems
C-6 Logic Status Word 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Product Specific Logic Command Firmware 3.001 and 3.002
To be used with gateway adapters such as RIO or DeviceNet. Bit Function Value Description Notes 0 Stop 1 Stop Drive using Stop Profile 1 Start (Pulsed) 1 Start Drive on rising edge using Start Profile
2 Jog 1 Jog at default or Preset Speed 3 Clear Faults 1 Clear most recent Fault in Queue 4 Clear Warnings 1 Clear most recent Warning in Queue 5 Clear Queues 1 Clear both Fault and Warning Queues 0 Forward 6 Direction 1 Reverse 7 Disable Reverse 1 Disable Reverse Direction (Maintained) Done in Logic Parser 0 Remote All adapters can control the drive (Full multiplexed control) 8 DPI Local/Remote Profile 1 Local Only the adapter that has been granted permission has control of the Drive (Includes XIO Front Panel Selector Switch) 0 0 No Command 0 1 Transfer to Line 1 0 Transfer to Drive 10,9 Synchronous Transfer 1 1 Illegal 0 Accel 1 (Default) 11 Start Profile 1 Accel 2 Must be maintained until at Speed. 0 Decel 1 (Default) 12 Stop Profile 1 Decel 2 Must be maintained until drive stopped. 0 0 0 No Command 0 0 1 External Ref0 ( Front Panel Pot) 0 1 0 Preset 1 0 1 1 Preset 2 1 0 0 Preset 3 1 0 1 External Ref1 (Programmed Reference) 1 1 0 Manual Reference (Local DPI Adapter) 15-13 Speed Command Select 1 1 1 Not Used
Logic Status Word C-7 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Product Specific Logic Command Firmware 3.004 to 5.003
To be used with gateway adapters such as RIO or DeviceNet. Bit Function Value Description Notes 0 Stop 1 Stop Drive using Stop Profile 1 Start (Pulsed) 1 Start Drive on rising edge using Start Profile
2 Jog 1 Jog at default or Preset Speed 3 Clear Fault Queue 1 Clear Fault in Queue 4 Clear Warning Queue 1 Clear Warning in Queue 5 Reset Faults 1 Reset Faults and Warnings 0 1 Forward 1 0 Reverse 7,6 Direction 1 1 Not Used 0 Remote All adapters can control the drive (Full multiplexed control) 8 DPI Local/Remote Profile 1 Local Only the adapter that has been granted permission has control of the Drive (Includes XIO Front Panel Selector Switch) 0 0 No Command 0 1 Transfer to Line 1 0 Transfer to Drive 10,9 Synchronous Transfer 1 1 Illegal 0 Accel 1 (Default) 11 Start Profile 1 Accel 2 Must be maintained until at Speed. 0 Decel 1 (Default) 12 Stop Profile 1 Decel 2 Must be maintained until drive stopped. 0 0 0 No Command 0 0 1 External Ref0 ( Front Panel Pot) 0 1 0 Preset 1 0 1 1 Preset 2 1 0 0 Preset 3 1 0 1 External Ref1 (Programmed Reference) 1 1 0 Manual Reference (Local DPI Adapter) 15-13 Speed Command Select 1 1 1 Not Used
C-8 Logic Status Word 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Appendix D 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Meggering
Drive Meggering When a ground fault occurs, there are three zones in which the problem may appear: input to the drive, the drive, output to the motor. When a ground fault occurs, it indicates a phase conductor has found a path to ground. Depending on the resistance of the path to ground, a current with magnitude ranging from leakage to fault level exists. Based on our experiences in drive systems, the highest probability for the source of the fault exists in either the input or output zones. The drive itself rarely has been a source of a ground fault when it is properly installed. This is not to say there will never be any ground fault problems associated with the drive, but the chances are the fault is outside of the drive. Also, the procedure for meggering the drive is more complex than meggering outside the drive.
With these two factors, it is recommended to first megger the input and output zones when encountering a ground fault. If the location of the ground fault can not be located outside the drive, the drive will need to be meggered. This procedure must be performed with due care as the hazards to drive exists if the safety precautions in the procedure is not followed. This is due to the fact the megger procedure applies high voltage to ground: all the control boards in the drive have been grounded and if not isolated, they will have high potential applied to them causing immediate damage.
Meggering the PowerFlex 7000 A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Use caution when performing a Megger test. High voltage testing is potentially hazardous and may cause severe burns, injury or death. Where appropriate, the cause of the test equipment should be connected to ground.
It is recommended that the insulation levels be checked before energizing power equipment. Performing a Megger test will provide a resistance measurement from the phase to phase and phase to ground by applying a high voltage to the power circuitry. This test is performed to detect ground faults without damaging any equipment.
This test is performed by floating the drive and all connected equipment to a high potential while measuring the leakage current to ground. Floating the drive implies temporary removal of any existing paths to ground necessary for normal operation of the drive. D-2 Meggering 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
There exists the possibility of serious or fatal injury to personnel if safety guidelines are not followed.
The following procedure details how the Megger test on the PowerFlex 7000 is to be performed. Failure to comply to this procedure may result in poor Megger reading and damage to drive control boards.
Equipment Required
Torque Wrench and 7/16 inch socket Phillips Screwdriver 2500/5000 Volt Megger
Procedure
1. Isolate and Lock Out the Drive System from High Voltage
Disconnect any incoming power sources, medium voltage sources should be isolated and locked out and all control power sources should be turned off at their respective circuit breaker(s).
Verify with a potential indictor that power sources have been disconnected, also, the control power in the drive is de-energized.
2. Isolate the Power Circuit from System Ground (Float the drive)
It is necessary to remove the grounds on the following components within the drive. (Refer to the electrical diagrams provided with the equipment to assist in determining the points which need to be disconnected):
Voltage Sensing Boards (VSB) Output Grounding Network (OGN)
Voltage Sensing Boards
Remove all ground connections from all of the VSBs in the drive. This has to be done at the screw terminals on the VSB rather than the ground bus. There are two grounds on each board marked GND 1, and GND 2.
Meggering D-3 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
Note: It is important to disconnect the terminals on the boards rather than from the ground bus as the grounding cable is only rated for 600 V. Injecting a high voltage on the ground cable will degrade the cable insulation. Do not disconnect the white medium voltage wires from the VSBs. They must be included in the test.
The number of VSBs installed in each drive varies depending on the drive configuration.
Output Grounding Network
Remove the ground connection on the OGN (if installed). This connection should be lifted at the OGN capacitor rather than the grounding bus as the grounding cable is only rated for 600 V.
Note: Injecting a high voltage on the ground cable during a Megger test will degrade the cable insulation.
3. Disconnect Connections between Power Circuit and Low Voltage Control
Voltage Sensing Boards
Disconnect connections between the low voltage control and the power circuit are made through ribbon cable connectors. The cables will be plugged into connectors on the Voltage Sensing Board marked J1, J2, and J3, and terminate on the Signal Conditioning Boards. Every ribbon cable connection made on the VSBs should be marked for identification from the factory. Confirm the marking matches the connections, and disconnect the ribbon cables and move them clear of the VSB. If these ribbon cables are not removed from the VSB, then high potential will be applied directly to the low voltage control through the SCBs, and cause immediate damage to those boards.
Note: The VSB ribbon cable insulation is not rated for the potential applied during a Megger test. It is important to disconnect the ribbon cables at the VSB rather than the SCB to avoid exposing the ribbon cables to high potential. D-4 Meggering 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
Potential Transformer Fuses
A Megger test may exceed the rating of potential transformer fusing. Removing the primary fuses from all potential and control power transformers in the system will not only protect them from damage but remove a path from the power circuit back to the drive control.
Transient Suppression Network
A path to ground exists through the TSN network as it has a ground connection to dissipate high energy surges in normal operation. If this ground connection is not isolated the Megger test will indicate a high leakage current reading through this path, falsely indicating a problem in the drive. To isolate this ground path, all fuses on the TSN must be removed before proceeding with the Megger test.
4. Meggering the Drive
Note: Verify the drive and any connected equipment is clear of personnel and tools prior to commencing the Megger test. Barricade off any open or exposed conductors. Conduct a walk-around inspection before commencing the test.
All three phases on the line and machine sides of the drive are connected together through the DC Link and Snubber Network. Therefore a test from any one of the input or output terminals to ground will provide all the sufficient testing required for the drive.
Note: Be sure the Megger is discharged prior to disconnecting it from the equipment.
Connect the Megger to the drive following the specific instructions for that model. If the Megger has a lower voltage setting (normally 500V or 1000V), apply that voltage for 5 seconds as a precursor for the higher voltage rating. This may limit your damage if you forgot to remove any grounds. If the reading is very high, apply 5kV from any drive input or output terminal to ground. Perform a Megger test at 5 kV for 1 minute and record the result. Meggering D-5 7000 B Frame 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007
The test should produce a reading greater than the minimum values listed below. If the test results produced a value lower than these values start segmenting the drive system down into smaller components and repeat the test on each segment to identify the source of the ground fault. This implies isolating the line side of the drive from the machine side by removing the appropriate cables on the DC Link reactor.
The DC Link reactor may have to be completely isolated from the drive, at which point all four of its power cables must disconnected. It is imperative to ensure the electrical components to be meggered are electrically isolated from ground. Items that may produce lower than expected readings are surge capacitors at the motor terminals, motor filter capacitors at the output of the drive. The meggering procedure must follow a systematic segmentation of electrical components to isolate and locate a ground fault.
Type of Drive Minimum Megger Value Liquid Cooled Drive 200 M Ohms Air Cooled Drive 1k M Ohm Drive with input/output Caps Disconnected 5k M Ohm Isolation Transformer 5k M Ohm Motor 5k M Ohm
Note: The motor filter capacitors and line filter capacitors (if applicable) may result in the Megger test result being lower tan expected. These capacitors have internal discharge resistors designed to discharge the capacitors to ground. If you are uncertain of the Megger test results disconnect the output capacitors.
Note: Humidity and dirty standoff insulators may also cause leakage to ground because of tracking. You may have to clean a 'dirty' drive prior to commencing the Megger test.
5. Re-Connecting Connections Between Power Circuit and Low Voltage Control
Reconnect the ribbon cables J1, J2 and J3 in all the VSBs. Do not cross the cable connections. Mixing the feedback cables may result in serious damage to the drive. D-6 Meggering 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 7000 B Frame
6. Re-Connect the Power Circuit to the System Ground
Voltage Sensing Boards
Securely re-connect the two ground conductors on the VSBs.
The two ground connections on the VSB provide a reference point for the VSB and enable the low voltage signal to be fed to the SCBs. If the ground conductor was not connected, the monitored low voltage signal could then rise up to medium voltage potential which is a serious hazard that must be avoided at all times. You must always ensure the ground conductors on the VSB are securely connected before applying medium voltage to the drive.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Failure to connect both ground connections on the voltage sensing board will result in high potential in the Low Voltage cabinet within the drive which will result in damage to the drive control and possible injury or death to personnel.
Output Grounding Network
Reconnect the ground connection on the OGN capacitor. The bolt connection should be torque down to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft). Exceeding the torque rating of this connection may result in damage to the capacitor.
A T T E N T I O N A T T E N T I O N
Failure to reconnect the OGN ground may result in the neutral voltage offset being impressed on the motor cables and stator, which may result in equipment damage. For drives that did not originally have the OGN connected (or even installed), this is not a concern.
Transient Suppression Network
Re-install the fuses on the TSN.
Medium Voltage Products, 135 Dundas Street, Cambridge, ON, N1R 5X1 Canada, Tel: (1) 519.740.4100, Fax: (1) 519.623.8930, www.ab.com/mvb
Publication 7000-UM150G-EN-P January 2007 Copyright 2007 Rockwell Automation, Inc. All rights reserved. Printed in Canada. Supersedes Publication 7000-UM150F-EN-P September 2005